Remove dead code in regcache::dump
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
... / ...
CommitLineData
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3@c
4@c %**start of header
5@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7@setfilename gdb.info
8@c
9@c man begin INCLUDE
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c man end
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24@c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25@c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26@c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27@syncodeindex ky fn
28@syncodeindex tp fn
29
30@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32@syncodeindex vr fn
33
34@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35@c This is updated by GNU Press.
36@set EDITION Tenth
37
38@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39@set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44@c manuals to an info tree.
45@dircategory Software development
46@direntry
47* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48* gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49@end direntry
50
51@copying
52@c man begin COPYRIGHT
53Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65@c man end
66@end copying
67
68@ifnottex
69This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75@end ifset
76Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78@insertcopying
79@end ifnottex
80
81@titlepage
82@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84@sp 1
85@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87@sp 1
88@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89@end ifset
90@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91@page
92@tex
93{\parskip=0pt
94\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97}
98@end tex
99
100@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
10251 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106@insertcopying
107@end titlepage
108@page
109
110@ifnottex
111@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120@end ifset
121Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127software in general. We will miss him.
128
129@menu
130* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137* Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138* Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139* Stack:: Examining the stack
140* Source:: Examining source files
141* Data:: Examining data
142* Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150* Altering:: Altering execution
151* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156* Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162* JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163* In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168* Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169* Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170@end ifset
171@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174@end ifclear
175* In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183* Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185* Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186* Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187* Man Pages:: Manual pages
188* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191* Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192* Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194@end menu
195
196@end ifnottex
197
198@contents
199
200@node Summary
201@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210@itemize @bullet
211@item
212Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214@item
215Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217@item
218Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220@item
221Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223@end itemize
224
225You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230@ref{D,,D}.
231
232@cindex Modula-2
233Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237@ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239@cindex Pascal
240Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243syntax.
244
245@cindex Fortran
246@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248underscore.
249
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253@menu
254* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255* Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
259@node Free Software
260@unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263General Public License
264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
275@node Free Documentation
276@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280include with the free software. Many of our most important
281programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283when an important free software package does not come with a free
284manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285gaps today.
286
287Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291them from the free software world.
292
293That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297contract to make it non-free.
298
299Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318community.
319
320Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328of the manual.
329
330However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334manual to replace it.
335
336Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341the free software community.
342
343If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363published by other publishers, at
364@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366@node Contributors
367@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375blow-by-blow account.
376
377Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379@quotation
380@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383@end quotation
384
385So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387releases:
388Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418support.
419Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439libraries.
440
441Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442about several machine instruction sets.
443
444Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450command-line editing and command history.
451
452Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457symbols.
458
459Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465processors.
466
467Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474watchpoints.
475
476Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514Hat.
515
516Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534Weigand.
535
536Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549@node Sample Session
550@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556@iftex
557In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559@end iftex
560
561@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574@smallexample
575$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576$ @b{./m4}
577@b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579@b{foo}
5800000
581@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583@b{bar}
5840000
585@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588@b{baz}
589@b{Ctrl-d}
590m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591@end smallexample
592
593@noindent
594Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596@smallexample
597$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599@c FIXME... format to come out better.
600@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607(@value{GDBP})
608@end smallexample
609
610@noindent
611@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614that examples fit in this manual.
615
616@smallexample
617(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618@end smallexample
619
620@noindent
621We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624@code{break} command.
625
626@smallexample
627(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629@end smallexample
630
631@noindent
632Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636@smallexample
637(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639@b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641@b{foo}
6420000
643@end smallexample
644
645@noindent
646To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648context where it stops.
649
650@smallexample
651@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656@end smallexample
657
658@noindent
659Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660the next line of the current function.
661
662@smallexample
663(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666@end smallexample
667
668@noindent
669@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674@smallexample
675(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679@end smallexample
680
681@noindent
682The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689@smallexample
690(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700@end smallexample
701
702@noindent
703We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707@smallexample
708(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
7090x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
7110x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718@end smallexample
719
720@noindent
721The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724(@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726@smallexample
727(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738@smallexample
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740533 xfree(rquote);
741534
742535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746537
747538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749540 @}
750541
751542 void
752@end smallexample
753
754@noindent
755Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758@smallexample
759(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762540 @}
763(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764$3 = 9
765(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766$4 = 7
767@end smallexample
768
769@noindent
770That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775assignments.
776
777@smallexample
778(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779$5 = 7
780(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781$6 = 9
782@end smallexample
783
784@noindent
785Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788example that caused trouble initially:
789
790@smallexample
791(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792Continuing.
793
794@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796baz
7970000
798@end smallexample
799
800@noindent
801Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805@smallexample
806@b{Ctrl-d}
807Program exited normally.
808@end smallexample
809
810@noindent
811The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815@smallexample
816(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817@end smallexample
818
819@node Invocation
820@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823The essentials are:
824@itemize @bullet
825@item
826type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827@item
828type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829@end itemize
830
831@menu
832* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836@end menu
837
838@node Invoking GDB
839@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847The command-line options described here are designed
848to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852specifying an executable program:
853
854@smallexample
855@value{GDBP} @var{program}
856@end smallexample
857
858@noindent
859You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860specified:
861
862@smallexample
863@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864@end smallexample
865
866You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867to debug a running process:
868
869@smallexample
870@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871@end smallexample
872
873@noindent
874would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885option processing.
886@smallexample
887@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888@end smallexample
889This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894(or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896@smallexample
897@value{GDBP} --silent
898@end smallexample
899
900@noindent
901You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904@noindent
905Type
906
907@smallexample
908@value{GDBP} -help
909@end smallexample
910
911@noindent
912to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917@samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920@menu
921* File Options:: Choosing files
922* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924@end menu
925
926@node File Options
927@subsection Choosing Files
928
929When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945argument and ignore it.
946
947Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955@c it.
956
957@table @code
958@item -symbols @var{file}
959@itemx -s @var{file}
960@cindex @code{--symbols}
961@cindex @code{-s}
962Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964@item -exec @var{file}
965@itemx -e @var{file}
966@cindex @code{--exec}
967@cindex @code{-e}
968Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971@item -se @var{file}
972@cindex @code{--se}
973Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974file.
975
976@item -core @var{file}
977@itemx -c @var{file}
978@cindex @code{--core}
979@cindex @code{-c}
980Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982@item -pid @var{number}
983@itemx -p @var{number}
984@cindex @code{--pid}
985@cindex @code{-p}
986Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988@item -command @var{file}
989@itemx -x @var{file}
990@cindex @code{--command}
991@cindex @code{-x}
992Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996@item -eval-command @var{command}
997@itemx -ex @var{command}
998@cindex @code{--eval-command}
999@cindex @code{-ex}
1000Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005@smallexample
1006@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008@end smallexample
1009
1010@item -init-command @var{file}
1011@itemx -ix @var{file}
1012@cindex @code{--init-command}
1013@cindex @code{-ix}
1014Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015after loading gdbinit files).
1016@xref{Startup}.
1017
1018@item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019@itemx -iex @var{command}
1020@cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021@cindex @code{-iex}
1022Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023after loading gdbinit files).
1024@xref{Startup}.
1025
1026@item -directory @var{directory}
1027@itemx -d @var{directory}
1028@cindex @code{--directory}
1029@cindex @code{-d}
1030Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032@item -r
1033@itemx -readnow
1034@cindex @code{--readnow}
1035@cindex @code{-r}
1036Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040@end table
1041
1042@node Mode Options
1043@subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048@table @code
1049@anchor{-nx}
1050@item -nx
1051@itemx -n
1052@cindex @code{--nx}
1053@cindex @code{-n}
1054Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057@table @code
1058@item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059This is the system-wide init file.
1060Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063have been processed.
1064@item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065This is the init file in your home directory.
1066It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067command options have been processed.
1068@item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069This is the init file in the current directory.
1070It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071@code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072@code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073@end table
1074
1075For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076For documentation on how to write command files,
1077@xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079@anchor{-nh}
1080@item -nh
1081@cindex @code{--nh}
1082Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083in your home directory.
1084@xref{Startup}.
1085
1086@item -quiet
1087@itemx -silent
1088@itemx -q
1089@cindex @code{--quiet}
1090@cindex @code{--silent}
1091@cindex @code{-q}
1092``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095@item -batch
1096@cindex @code{--batch}
1097Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107make this more useful, the message
1108
1109@smallexample
1110Program exited normally.
1111@end smallexample
1112
1113@noindent
1114(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116mode.
1117
1118@item -batch-silent
1119@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123for an interactive session.
1124
1125This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126messages, for example.
1127
1128Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131@item -return-child-result
1132@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136@itemize @bullet
1137@item
1138@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141@item
1142The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143@item
1144The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145the exit code will be -1.
1146@end itemize
1147
1148This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150interface.
1151
1152@item -nowindows
1153@itemx -nw
1154@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155@cindex @code{-nw}
1156``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160@item -windows
1161@itemx -w
1162@cindex @code{--windows}
1163@cindex @code{-w}
1164If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165used if possible.
1166
1167@item -cd @var{directory}
1168@cindex @code{--cd}
1169Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170instead of the current directory.
1171
1172@item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173@itemx -D @var{directory}
1174@cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175@cindex @code{-D}
1176Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180@item -fullname
1181@itemx -f
1182@cindex @code{--fullname}
1183@cindex @code{-f}
1184@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192frame.
1193
1194@item -annotate @var{level}
1195@cindex @code{--annotate}
1196This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208@item --args
1209@cindex @code{--args}
1210Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212This option stops option processing.
1213
1214@item -baud @var{bps}
1215@itemx -b @var{bps}
1216@cindex @code{--baud}
1217@cindex @code{-b}
1218Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221@item -l @var{timeout}
1222@cindex @code{-l}
1223Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224for remote debugging.
1225
1226@item -tty @var{device}
1227@itemx -t @var{device}
1228@cindex @code{--tty}
1229@cindex @code{-t}
1230Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234@item -tui
1235@cindex @code{--tui}
1236Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257@item -write
1258@cindex @code{--write}
1259Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261(@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263@item -statistics
1264@cindex @code{--statistics}
1265This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268@item -version
1269@cindex @code{--version}
1270This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273@item -configuration
1274@cindex @code{--configuration}
1275This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279@end table
1280
1281@node Startup
1282@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287@enumerate
1288@item
1289Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292@item
1293@cindex init file
1294Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297that file.
1298
1299@anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300@item
1301Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304that file.
1305
1306@anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307@item
1308Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309@samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310@samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312gets loaded.
1313
1314@item
1315Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317@anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318@item
1319Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321@samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322This is only done if the current directory is
1323different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326@value{GDBN}.
1327
1328@item
1329If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332@xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335you must do something like the following:
1336
1337@smallexample
1338$ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339@end smallexample
1340
1341Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342off too late.
1343
1344@item
1345Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346@samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349@item
1350Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353@end enumerate
1354
1355Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365@cindex init file name
1366@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372@file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376@node Quitting GDB
1377@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381@table @code
1382@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385@itemx q
1386To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390error code.
1391@end table
1392
1393@cindex interrupt
1394An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404@node Shell Commands
1405@section Shell Commands
1406
1407If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411@table @code
1412@kindex shell
1413@kindex !
1414@cindex shell escape
1415@item shell @var{command-string}
1416@itemx !@var{command-string}
1417Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422@end table
1423
1424The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426@value{GDBN}:
1427
1428@table @code
1429@kindex make
1430@cindex calling make
1431@item make @var{make-args}
1432Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434@end table
1435
1436@node Logging Output
1437@section Logging Output
1438@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444@table @code
1445@kindex set logging
1446@item set logging on
1447Enable logging.
1448@item set logging off
1449Disable logging.
1450@cindex logging file name
1451@item set logging file @var{file}
1452Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459@kindex show logging
1460@item show logging
1461Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462@end table
1463
1464@node Commands
1465@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473@menu
1474* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475* Completion:: Command completion
1476* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477@end menu
1478
1479@node Command Syntax
1480@section Command Syntax
1481
1482A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489@cindex abbreviation
1490@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498@cindex repeating commands
1499@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518@cindex comment
1519Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523@cindex repeating command sequences
1524@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528for editing.
1529
1530@node Completion
1531@section Command Completion
1532
1533@cindex completion
1534@cindex word completion
1535@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549@smallexample
1550(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551@end smallexample
1552
1553@noindent
1554@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557@smallexample
1558(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559@end smallexample
1560
1561@noindent
1562You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577example:
1578
1579@smallexample
1580(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583make_abs_section make_function_type
1584make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588@end smallexample
1589
1590@noindent
1591After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593command.
1594
1595If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605@smallexample
1606(@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607main
1608<... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609*** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610(@value{GDBP}) b m
1611@end smallexample
1612
1613@noindent
1614This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616@table @code
1617@kindex set max-completions
1618@item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619@itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626completion slow.
1627@kindex show max-completions
1628@item show max-completions
1629Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630during completion.
1631@end table
1632
1633@cindex quotes in commands
1634@cindex completion of quoted strings
1635Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639@value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1648word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1650@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653@smallexample
1654(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1656(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657@end smallexample
1658
1659In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662place:
1663
1664@smallexample
1665(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668@end smallexample
1669
1670@noindent
1671In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1677overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680@cindex completion of structure field names
1681@cindex structure field name completion
1682@cindex completion of union field names
1683@cindex union field name completion
1684When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1687examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689left-hand-side:
1690
1691@smallexample
1692(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693magic to_fputs to_rewind
1694to_data to_isatty to_write
1695to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1696to_flush to_read
1697@end smallexample
1698
1699@noindent
1700This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702follows:
1703
1704@smallexample
1705struct ui_file
1706@{
1707 int *magic;
1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717 void *to_data;
1718@}
1719@end smallexample
1720
1721
1722@node Help
1723@section Getting Help
1724@cindex online documentation
1725@kindex help
1726
1727You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730@table @code
1731@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732@item help
1733@itemx h
1734You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737@smallexample
1738(@value{GDBP}) help
1739List of classes of commands:
1740
1741aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743data -- Examining data
1744files -- Specifying and examining files
1745internals -- Maintenance commands
1746obscure -- Obscure features
1747running -- Running the program
1748stack -- Examining the stack
1749status -- Status inquiries
1750support -- Support facilities
1751tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752 stopping the program
1753user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756commands in that class.
1757Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758documentation.
1759Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760(@value{GDBP})
1761@end smallexample
1762@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764@item help @var{class}
1765Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1767help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769@smallexample
1770(@value{GDBP}) help status
1771Status inquiries.
1772
1773List of commands:
1774
1775@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777info -- Generic command for showing things
1778 about the program being debugged
1779show -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the debugger
1781
1782Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783documentation.
1784Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785(@value{GDBP})
1786@end smallexample
1787
1788@item help @var{command}
1789With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792@kindex apropos
1793@item apropos @var{args}
1794The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1797
1798@smallexample
1799apropos alias
1800@end smallexample
1801
1802@noindent
1803results in:
1804
1805@smallexample
1806@c @group
1807alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812@c @end group
1813@end smallexample
1814
1815@kindex complete
1816@item complete @var{args}
1817The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819command you want completed. For example:
1820
1821@smallexample
1822complete i
1823@end smallexample
1824
1825@noindent results in:
1826
1827@smallexample
1828@group
1829if
1830ignore
1831info
1832inspect
1833@end group
1834@end smallexample
1835
1836@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837@end table
1838
1839In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1843under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1845Index}.
1846
1847@c @group
1848@table @code
1849@kindex info
1850@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851@item info
1852This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857@w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859@kindex set
1860@item set
1861You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863@code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865@kindex show
1866@item show
1867In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868@value{GDBN} itself.
1869You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874@kindex info set
1875To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1878@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881@end table
1882@c @end group
1883
1884Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887@table @code
1888@kindex show version
1889@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890@item show version
1891Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1892information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1893@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1896system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899@value{GDBN}.
1900
1901@kindex show copying
1902@kindex info copying
1903@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904@item show copying
1905@itemx info copying
1906Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908@kindex show warranty
1909@kindex info warranty
1910@item show warranty
1911@itemx info warranty
1912Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915@kindex show configuration
1916@item show configuration
1917Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919@file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922your report.
1923
1924@end table
1925
1926@node Running
1927@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935kill a child process.
1936
1937@menu
1938* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1939* Starting:: Starting your program
1940* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1941* Environment:: Your program's environment
1942
1943* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1944* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1945* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1946* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1947
1948* Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950* Forks:: Debugging forks
1951* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952@end menu
1953
1954@node Compilation
1955@section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1959is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964the compiler.
1965
1966Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1968compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1974recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1984about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998@need 2000
1999@node Starting
2000@section Starting your Program
2001@cindex starting
2002@cindex running
2003
2004@table @code
2005@kindex run
2006@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007@item run
2008@itemx r
2009Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011@value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015@end table
2016
2017If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2020@code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2021like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2022message like this one:
2023
2024@smallexample
2025The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026Try "help target" or "continue".
2027@end smallexample
2028
2029@noindent
2030then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2031first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2036can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2038divided into four categories:
2039
2040@table @asis
2041@item The @emph{arguments.}
2042Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046the arguments.
2047In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048@code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049@value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2050use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051below for details).
2052
2053@item The @emph{environment.}
2054Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059@item The @emph{working directory.}
2060You can set your program's working directory with the command
2061@kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2062command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2063native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2064debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2065Directory}.
2066
2067@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2068Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2069standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2070in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2071set a different device for your program.
2072@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2073
2074@cindex pipes
2075@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2076pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2077program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2078wrong program.
2079@end table
2080
2081When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2082immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2083of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2084stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2085or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2086
2087If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2088time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2089table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2090your current breakpoints.
2091
2092@table @code
2093@kindex start
2094@item start
2095@cindex run to main procedure
2096The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2097With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2098other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2099main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2100execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2101procedure, depending on the language used.
2102
2103The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2104breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2105the @samp{run} command.
2106
2107@cindex elaboration phase
2108Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2109executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2110languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2111constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2112@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2113before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2114will remain to halt execution.
2115
2116Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2117@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2118underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2119reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2120@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2121
2122It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2123these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2124of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2125the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2126breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2127use the @code{starti} command.
2128
2129@kindex starti
2130@item starti
2131@cindex run to first instruction
2132The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2133breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2134invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2135elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2136the start of the elaboration phase.
2137
2138@anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2139@kindex set exec-wrapper
2140@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2141@itemx show exec-wrapper
2142@itemx unset exec-wrapper
2143When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2144launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2145with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2146@var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2147arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2148appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2149your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2150
2151You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2152its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2153this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2154with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2155
2156For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2157the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2158environment:
2159
2160@smallexample
2161(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2162(@value{GDBP}) run
2163@end smallexample
2164
2165This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2166@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2167
2168@kindex set startup-with-shell
2169@anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2170@item set startup-with-shell
2171@itemx set startup-with-shell on
2172@itemx set startup-with-shell off
2173@itemx show startup-with-shell
2174On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2175@value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2176@code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2177substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2178I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2179shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2180startup failures such as:
2181
2182@smallexample
2183(@value{GDBP}) run
2184Starting program: ./a.out
2185During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2186@end smallexample
2187
2188@noindent
2189which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2190@samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2191caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2192initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2193$@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2194@samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2195
2196@anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2197@kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2198@item set auto-connect-native-target
2199@itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2200@itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2201@itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2202
2203By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2204@code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2205native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2206sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2207tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2208with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2209
2210If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2211connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2212connects to the native target, if one is available.
2213
2214If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2215already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2216
2217@smallexample
2218(@value{GDBP}) run
2219Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2220@end smallexample
2221
2222If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2223uses it with the @code{run} command.
2224
2225In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2226@code{target native} command. For example,
2227
2228@smallexample
2229(@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2230(@value{GDBP}) run
2231Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2232(@value{GDBP}) target native
2233(@value{GDBP}) run
2234Starting program: ./a.out
2235[Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2236@end smallexample
2237
2238In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2239@value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2240the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2241disconnect.
2242
2243Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2244@code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2245proc}, @code{info os}.
2246
2247@kindex set disable-randomization
2248@item set disable-randomization
2249@itemx set disable-randomization on
2250This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2251randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2252is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2253reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2254
2255This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2256On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2257
2258@smallexample
2259(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2260@end smallexample
2261
2262@item set disable-randomization off
2263Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2264ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2265disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2266@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2267as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2268disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2269
2270On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2271protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2272cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2273code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2274a code at its expected addresses.
2275
2276Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2277makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2278having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2279library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2280misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2281random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2282startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2283a randomly chosen address.
2284
2285Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2286similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2287a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2288already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2289executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2290
2291Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2292(as long as the randomization is enabled).
2293
2294@item show disable-randomization
2295Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2296the virtual address space of the started program.
2297
2298@end table
2299
2300@node Arguments
2301@section Your Program's Arguments
2302
2303@cindex arguments (to your program)
2304The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2305@code{run} command.
2306They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2307performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2308@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2309@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2310the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2311
2312On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2313@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2314calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2315the program, not by the shell.
2316
2317@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2318@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2319
2320@table @code
2321@kindex set args
2322@item set args
2323Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2324@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2325with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2326using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2327it again without arguments.
2328
2329@kindex show args
2330@item show args
2331Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2332@end table
2333
2334@node Environment
2335@section Your Program's Environment
2336
2337@cindex environment (of your program)
2338The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2339their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2340your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2341path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2342the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2343debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2344environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2345
2346@table @code
2347@kindex path
2348@item path @var{directory}
2349Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2350(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2351The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2352You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2353system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2354MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2355is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2356
2357You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2358working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2359use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2360@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2361@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2362@var{directory} to the search path.
2363@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2364@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2365
2366@kindex show paths
2367@item show paths
2368Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2369environment variable).
2370
2371@kindex show environment
2372@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2373Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2374your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2375print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2376your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2377
2378@kindex set environment
2379@anchor{set environment}
2380@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2381Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2382changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2383it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2384values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2385interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2386parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2387null value.
2388@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2389@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2390
2391For example, this command:
2392
2393@smallexample
2394set env USER = foo
2395@end smallexample
2396
2397@noindent
2398tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2399@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2400are not actually required.)
2401
2402Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2403which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2404If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2405wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2406exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2407
2408Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2409@command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2410@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2411
2412@kindex unset environment
2413@anchor{unset environment}
2414@item unset environment @var{varname}
2415Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2416program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2417@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2418rather than assigning it an empty value.
2419
2420Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2421@command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2422@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2423@end table
2424
2425@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2426the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2427exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2428names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2429non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2430for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2431environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2432affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2433variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2434@file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2435
2436@node Working Directory
2437@section Your Program's Working Directory
2438
2439@cindex working directory (of your program)
2440Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2441initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2442@kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2443command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2444directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2445inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2446debugging.
2447
2448@table @code
2449@kindex set cwd
2450@cindex change inferior's working directory
2451@anchor{set cwd command}
2452@item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2453Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2454@code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2455argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2456it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2457working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2458the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2459@dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2460variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2461uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2462fallback.
2463
2464You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2465the @code{cd} command.
2466@xref{cd command}
2467
2468@kindex show cwd
2469@cindex show inferior's working directory
2470@item show cwd
2471Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2472specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2473directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2474
2475@kindex cd
2476@cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2477@anchor{cd command}
2478@item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2479Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2480given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2481
2482The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2483commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2484@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2485@xref{set cwd command}
2486
2487@kindex pwd
2488@item pwd
2489Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2490@end table
2491
2492It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2493the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2494during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2495configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2496proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2497current working directory of the debuggee.
2498
2499@node Input/Output
2500@section Your Program's Input and Output
2501
2502@cindex redirection
2503@cindex i/o
2504@cindex terminal
2505By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2506the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2507to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2508modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2509running your program.
2510
2511@table @code
2512@kindex info terminal
2513@item info terminal
2514Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2515program is using.
2516@end table
2517
2518You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2519redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2520
2521@smallexample
2522run > outfile
2523@end smallexample
2524
2525@noindent
2526starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2527
2528@kindex tty
2529@cindex controlling terminal
2530Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2531with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2532argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2533commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2534process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2535
2536@smallexample
2537tty /dev/ttyb
2538@end smallexample
2539
2540@noindent
2541directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2542default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2543that as their controlling terminal.
2544
2545An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2546effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2547terminal.
2548
2549When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2550command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2551for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2552for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2553
2554@cindex inferior tty
2555@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2556You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2557display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2558program.
2559
2560@table @code
2561@item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2562@kindex set inferior-tty
2563Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2564restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2565@value{GDBN}.
2566
2567@item show inferior-tty
2568@kindex show inferior-tty
2569Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2570@end table
2571
2572@node Attach
2573@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2574@kindex attach
2575@cindex attach
2576
2577@table @code
2578@item attach @var{process-id}
2579This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2580outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2581targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2582find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2583or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2584
2585@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2586executing the command.
2587@end table
2588
2589To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2590which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2591programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2592also have permission to send the process a signal.
2593
2594When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2595the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2596the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2597(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2598the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2599Specify Files}.
2600
2601The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2602process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2603with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2604you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2605can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2606process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2607attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2608
2609@table @code
2610@kindex detach
2611@item detach
2612When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2613@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2614the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2615that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2616are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2617@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2618executing the command.
2619@end table
2620
2621If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2622that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2623By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2624things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2625@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2626Messages}).
2627
2628@node Kill Process
2629@section Killing the Child Process
2630
2631@table @code
2632@kindex kill
2633@item kill
2634Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2635@end table
2636
2637This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2638running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2639is running.
2640
2641On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2642while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2643@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2644outside the debugger.
2645
2646The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2647relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2648executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2649next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2650reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2651breakpoint settings).
2652
2653@node Inferiors and Programs
2654@section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2655
2656@value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2657session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2658several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2659before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2660multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2661from multiple executables.
2662
2663@cindex inferior
2664@value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2665object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2666a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2667have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2668may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2669identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2670inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2671embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2672of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2673threads running in it.
2674
2675To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2676inferiors}}:
2677
2678@table @code
2679@kindex info inferiors
2680@item info inferiors
2681Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2682
2683@value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2684
2685@enumerate
2686@item
2687the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2688
2689@item
2690the target system's inferior identifier
2691
2692@item
2693the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2694
2695@end enumerate
2696
2697@noindent
2698An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2699indicates the current inferior.
2700
2701For example,
2702@end table
2703@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2704
2705@smallexample
2706(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2707 Num Description Executable
2708 2 process 2307 hello
2709* 1 process 3401 goodbye
2710@end smallexample
2711
2712To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2713
2714@table @code
2715@kindex inferior @var{infno}
2716@item inferior @var{infno}
2717Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2718@var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2719in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2720@end table
2721
2722@vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2723The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2724number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2725breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2726@xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2727information on convenience variables.
2728
2729You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2730@code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2731systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2732automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2733remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2734@w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2735
2736@table @code
2737@kindex add-inferior
2738@item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2739Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2740executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2741the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2742change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2743@code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2744
2745@kindex clone-inferior
2746@item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2747Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2748@var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2749number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2750want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2751
2752@smallexample
2753(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2754 Num Description Executable
2755* 1 process 29964 helloworld
2756(@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2757Added inferior 2.
27581 inferiors added.
2759(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2760 Num Description Executable
2761 2 <null> helloworld
2762* 1 process 29964 helloworld
2763@end smallexample
2764
2765You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2766
2767@kindex remove-inferiors
2768@item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2769Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2770possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2771those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2772
2773@end table
2774
2775To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2776inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2777inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2778using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2779
2780@table @code
2781@kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2782@item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2783Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2784inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2785still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2786but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2787
2788@kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2789@item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2790Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2791number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2792stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2793Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2794@end table
2795
2796After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2797@code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2798a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2799@code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2800
2801
2802To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2803control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2804
2805@table @code
2806@kindex set print inferior-events
2807@cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2808@item set print inferior-events
2809@itemx set print inferior-events on
2810@itemx set print inferior-events off
2811The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2812disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2813inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2814detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2815
2816@kindex show print inferior-events
2817@item show print inferior-events
2818Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2819inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2820@end table
2821
2822Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2823single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2824value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2825
2826
2827Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2828get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2829spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2830info program-spaces}} command.
2831
2832@table @code
2833@kindex maint info program-spaces
2834@item maint info program-spaces
2835Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2836@value{GDBN}.
2837
2838@value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2839
2840@enumerate
2841@item
2842the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2843
2844@item
2845the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2846the @code{file} command.
2847
2848@end enumerate
2849
2850@noindent
2851An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2852indicates the current program space.
2853
2854In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2855information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2856example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2857
2858@smallexample
2859(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2860 Id Executable
2861* 1 hello
2862 2 goodbye
2863 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2864@end smallexample
2865
2866Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2867while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2868some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2869same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2870the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2871
2872@smallexample
2873(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2874 Id Executable
2875* 1 vfork-test
2876 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2877@end smallexample
2878
2879Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2880space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2881@end table
2882
2883@node Threads
2884@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2885
2886@cindex threads of execution
2887@cindex multiple threads
2888@cindex switching threads
2889In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2890may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2891of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2892the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2893that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2894modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2895registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2896
2897@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2898programs:
2899
2900@itemize @bullet
2901@item automatic notification of new threads
2902@item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2903@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2904@item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2905a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2906@item thread-specific breakpoints
2907@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2908messages on thread start and exit.
2909@item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2910the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2911isn't compatible with the program.
2912@end itemize
2913
2914@cindex focus of debugging
2915@cindex current thread
2916The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2917threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2918control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2919This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2920program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2921
2922@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2923@cindex thread identifier (system)
2924@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2925@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2926@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2927Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2928the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2929form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2930whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2931@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2932
2933@smallexample
2934[New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2935@end smallexample
2936
2937@noindent
2938when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2939the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2940further qualifier.
2941
2942@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2943@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2944@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2945@c program?
2946@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2947@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2948@c threads ab initio?
2949
2950@anchor{thread numbers}
2951@cindex thread number, per inferior
2952@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2953For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2954---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2955number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2956between threads of different inferiors.
2957
2958@cindex qualified thread ID
2959You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2960@var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2961@dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2962number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2963inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2964inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2965then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2966inferior.
2967
2968Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2969@var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2970the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2971of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2972
2973@anchor{thread ID lists}
2974@cindex thread ID lists
2975Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2976argument. A list element can be:
2977
2978@enumerate
2979@item
2980A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2981display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2982@samp{1}.
2983
2984@item
2985A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2986qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2987@var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2988
2989@item
2990All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2991without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2992@samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2993given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2994refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2995
2996@end enumerate
2997
2998For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2999thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3000includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
30017 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3002expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
30037.1}.
3004
3005
3006@anchor{global thread numbers}
3007@cindex global thread number
3008@cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3009In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3010assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3011thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3012the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3013you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3014
3015From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3016thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3017program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3018
3019@vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3020@vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3021The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3022@samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3023and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3024useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3025and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3026general information on convenience variables.
3027
3028If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3029usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3030the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3031
3032@smallexample
3033Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3034@end smallexample
3035
3036Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3037
3038@smallexample
3039Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3040@end smallexample
3041
3042@table @code
3043@kindex info threads
3044@item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3045
3046Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3047displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3048threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3049(@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3050
3051@value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3052
3053@enumerate
3054@item
3055the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3056
3057@item
3058the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3059option was specified
3060
3061@item
3062the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3063
3064@item
3065the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3066the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3067program itself.
3068
3069@item
3070the current stack frame summary for that thread
3071@end enumerate
3072
3073@noindent
3074An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3075indicates the current thread.
3076
3077For example,
3078@end table
3079@c end table here to get a little more width for example
3080
3081@smallexample
3082(@value{GDBP}) info threads
3083 Id Target Id Frame
3084* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3085 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3086 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3087 at threadtest.c:68
3088@end smallexample
3089
3090If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3091IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3092Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3093
3094If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3095indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3096
3097@smallexample
3098(@value{GDBP}) info threads
3099 Id GId Target Id Frame
3100 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3101 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3102 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3103* 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3104@end smallexample
3105
3106On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3107Solaris-specific command:
3108
3109@table @code
3110@item maint info sol-threads
3111@kindex maint info sol-threads
3112@cindex thread info (Solaris)
3113Display info on Solaris user threads.
3114@end table
3115
3116@table @code
3117@kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3118@item thread @var{thread-id}
3119Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3120argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3121the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3122inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3123
3124@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3125thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3126
3127@smallexample
3128(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3129[Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3130#0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
31318 printf ("hello\n");
3132@end smallexample
3133
3134@noindent
3135As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3136@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3137threads.
3138
3139@kindex thread apply
3140@cindex apply command to several threads
3141@item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3142The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3143@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3144want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3145lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3146command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3147@var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3148type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3149
3150
3151@kindex thread name
3152@cindex name a thread
3153@item thread name [@var{name}]
3154This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3155given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3156appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3157
3158On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3159determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3160systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3161system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3162@value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3163
3164@kindex thread find
3165@cindex search for a thread
3166@item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3167Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3168matches the supplied regular expression.
3169
3170As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3171this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3172@var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3173is the LWP id.
3174
3175@smallexample
3176(@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3177Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3178(@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3179 Id Target Id Frame
3180 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3181@end smallexample
3182
3183@kindex set print thread-events
3184@cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3185@item set print thread-events
3186@itemx set print thread-events on
3187@itemx set print thread-events off
3188The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3189disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3190started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3191be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3192Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3193
3194@kindex show print thread-events
3195@item show print thread-events
3196Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3197have started and exited.
3198@end table
3199
3200@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3201more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3202programs with multiple threads.
3203
3204@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3205watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3206
3207@anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3208@table @code
3209@kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3210@cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3211@item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3212If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3213directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3214If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3215its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3216Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3217macro.
3218
3219On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3220@code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3221inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3222to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3223specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3224by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3225
3226A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3227refers to the default system directories that are
3228normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3229is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3230(@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3231
3232A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3233refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3234was loaded in the inferior process.
3235
3236For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3237@value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3238If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3239mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3240will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3241If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3242@value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3243
3244Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3245only on some platforms.
3246
3247@kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3248@item show libthread-db-search-path
3249Display current libthread_db search path.
3250
3251@kindex set debug libthread-db
3252@kindex show debug libthread-db
3253@cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3254@item set debug libthread-db
3255@itemx show debug libthread-db
3256Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3257Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3258@end table
3259
3260@node Forks
3261@section Debugging Forks
3262
3263@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3264@cindex multiple processes
3265@cindex processes, multiple
3266On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3267programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3268function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3269parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3270set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3271will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3272will cause it to terminate.
3273
3274However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3275which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3276the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3277only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3278so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3279on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3280get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3281@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3282the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3283the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3284
3285On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3286that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3287functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3288with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3289
3290The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3291connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3292@code{target extended-remote} mode.
3293
3294By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3295the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3296
3297If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3298use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3299
3300@table @code
3301@kindex set follow-fork-mode
3302@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3303Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3304@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3305process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3306
3307@table @code
3308@item parent
3309The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3310unimpeded. This is the default.
3311
3312@item child
3313The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3314unimpeded.
3315
3316@end table
3317
3318@kindex show follow-fork-mode
3319@item show follow-fork-mode
3320Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3321@end table
3322
3323@cindex debugging multiple processes
3324On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3325command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3326
3327@table @code
3328@kindex set detach-on-fork
3329@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3330Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3331retain debugger control over them both.
3332
3333@table @code
3334@item on
3335The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3336@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3337independently. This is the default.
3338
3339@item off
3340Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3341One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3342@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3343is held suspended.
3344
3345@end table
3346
3347@kindex show detach-on-fork
3348@item show detach-on-fork
3349Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3350@end table
3351
3352If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3353will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3354You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3355using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3356to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3357Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3358
3359To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3360from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3361to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3362command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3363and Programs}.
3364
3365If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3366@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3367breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3368@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3369the child process's @code{main}.
3370
3371On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3372cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3373
3374If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3375call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3376process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3377as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3378@value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3379You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3380command.
3381
3382@table @code
3383@kindex set follow-exec-mode
3384@item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3385
3386Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3387@code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3388
3389@code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3390
3391@table @code
3392@item new
3393@value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3394new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3395@code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3396original inferior.
3397
3398For example:
3399
3400@smallexample
3401(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3402(gdb) info inferior
3403 Id Description Executable
3404* 1 <null> prog1
3405(@value{GDBP}) run
3406process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3407Program exited normally.
3408(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3409 Id Description Executable
3410 1 <null> prog1
3411* 2 <null> prog2
3412@end smallexample
3413
3414@item same
3415@value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3416executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3417inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3418e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3419running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3420
3421For example:
3422
3423@smallexample
3424(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3425 Id Description Executable
3426* 1 <null> prog1
3427(@value{GDBP}) run
3428process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3429Program exited normally.
3430(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3431 Id Description Executable
3432* 1 <null> prog2
3433@end smallexample
3434
3435@end table
3436@end table
3437
3438@code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3439@code{target extended-remote} mode.
3440
3441You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3442a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3443Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3444
3445@node Checkpoint/Restart
3446@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3447
3448@cindex checkpoint
3449@cindex restart
3450@cindex bookmark
3451@cindex snapshot of a process
3452@cindex rewind program state
3453
3454On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3455@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3456program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3457later.
3458
3459Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3460happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3461includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3462system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3463moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3464
3465Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3466getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3467a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3468the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3469from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3470start again from there.
3471
3472This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3473steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3474
3475To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3476
3477@table @code
3478@kindex checkpoint
3479@item checkpoint
3480Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3481The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3482is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3483
3484@kindex info checkpoints
3485@item info checkpoints
3486List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3487session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3488listed:
3489
3490@table @code
3491@item Checkpoint ID
3492@item Process ID
3493@item Code Address
3494@item Source line, or label
3495@end table
3496
3497@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3498@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3499Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3500@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3501etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3502was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3503in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3504
3505Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3506are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3507only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3508the debugger.
3509
3510@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3511@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3512Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3513
3514@end table
3515
3516Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3517of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3518(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3519a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3520so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3521opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3522previously read data can be read again.
3523
3524Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3525external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3526from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3527but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3528be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3529been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3530
3531However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3532program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3533again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3534different execution path this time.
3535
3536@cindex checkpoints and process id
3537Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3538different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3539id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3540and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3541If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3542potentially pose a problem.
3543
3544@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3545
3546On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3547is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3548difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3549absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3550absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3551next.
3552
3553A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3554Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3555and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3556process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3557your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3558
3559@node Stopping
3560@chapter Stopping and Continuing
3561
3562The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3563program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3564trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3565
3566Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3567such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3568@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3569change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3570continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3571ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3572explicitly request this information at any time.
3573
3574@table @code
3575@kindex info program
3576@item info program
3577Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3578running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3579@end table
3580
3581@menu
3582* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3583* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3584* Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3585 Skipping over functions and files
3586* Signals:: Signals
3587* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3588@end menu
3589
3590@node Breakpoints
3591@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3592
3593@cindex breakpoints
3594A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3595the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3596control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3597breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3598Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3599should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3600program.
3601
3602On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3603the executable is run.
3604
3605@cindex watchpoints
3606@cindex data breakpoints
3607@cindex memory tracing
3608@cindex breakpoint on memory address
3609@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3610A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3611when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3612of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3613combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3614@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3615watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3616from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3617enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3618same commands.
3619
3620You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3621whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3622Automatic Display}.
3623
3624@cindex catchpoints
3625@cindex breakpoint on events
3626A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3627when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3628exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3629different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3630Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3631other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3632@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3633
3634@cindex breakpoint numbers
3635@cindex numbers for breakpoints
3636@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3637catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3638starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3639features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3640breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3641@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3642enable it again.
3643
3644@cindex breakpoint ranges
3645@cindex breakpoint lists
3646@cindex ranges of breakpoints
3647@cindex lists of breakpoints
3648Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3649on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3650like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3651When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3652are operated on.
3653
3654@menu
3655* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3656* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3657* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3658* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3659* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3660* Conditions:: Break conditions
3661* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3662* Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3663* Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3664* Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3665* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3666* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3667@end menu
3668
3669@node Set Breaks
3670@subsection Setting Breakpoints
3671
3672@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3673@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3674@c
3675@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3676
3677@kindex break
3678@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3679@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3680@cindex latest breakpoint
3681Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3682@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3683number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3684Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3685convenience variables.
3686
3687@table @code
3688@item break @var{location}
3689Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3690function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3691(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3692specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3693before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3694
3695When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3696C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3697@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3698that situation.
3699
3700It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3701only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3702or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3703
3704@item break
3705When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3706the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3707(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3708innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3709returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3710@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3711that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3712@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3713the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3714inside loops.
3715
3716@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3717least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3718would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3719breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3720existed when your program stopped.
3721
3722@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3723Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3724@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3725value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3726@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3727above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3728,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3729
3730@kindex tbreak
3731@item tbreak @var{args}
3732Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3733same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3734way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3735program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3736
3737@kindex hbreak
3738@cindex hardware breakpoints
3739@item hbreak @var{args}
3740Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3741@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3742breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3743have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3744debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3745changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3746provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3747will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3748address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3749breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3750example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3751@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3752or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3753(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3754@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3755For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3756breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3757hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3758
3759@kindex thbreak
3760@item thbreak @var{args}
3761Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3762are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3763the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3764the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3765first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3766command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3767may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3768See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3769
3770@kindex rbreak
3771@cindex regular expression
3772@cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3773@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3774@item rbreak @var{regex}
3775Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3776@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3777matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3778breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3779the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3780them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3781
3782The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3783like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3784shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3785an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3786@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3787match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3788
3789@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3790When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3791breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3792classes.
3793
3794@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3795The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3796@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3797
3798@smallexample
3799(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3800@end smallexample
3801
3802@item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3803If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3804the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3805specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3806every function in a given file:
3807
3808@smallexample
3809(@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3810@end smallexample
3811
3812The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3813optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3814
3815@kindex info breakpoints
3816@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3817@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3818@itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3819Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3820not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3821about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3822For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3823
3824@table @emph
3825@item Breakpoint Numbers
3826@item Type
3827Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3828@item Disposition
3829Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3830@item Enabled or Disabled
3831Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3832that are not enabled.
3833@item Address
3834Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3835pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3836contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3837library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3838See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3839have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3840@item What
3841Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3842line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3843the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3844the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3845@end table
3846
3847@noindent
3848If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3849``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3850@value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3851is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3852the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3853its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3854
3855Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3856allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3857validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3858breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3859
3860@noindent
3861@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3862number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3863convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3864the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3865listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3866
3867@noindent
3868@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3869has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3870@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3871hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3872was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3873will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3874
3875@noindent
3876For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3877@code{info break} also displays that count.
3878
3879@end table
3880
3881@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3882your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3883the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3884(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3885
3886@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3887@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3888It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3889in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3890
3891@itemize @bullet
3892@item
3893Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3894
3895@item
3896For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3897instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3898
3899@item
3900For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3901correspond to any number of instantiations.
3902
3903@item
3904For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3905several places where that function is inlined.
3906@end itemize
3907
3908In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3909the relevant locations.
3910
3911A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3912table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3913each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3914address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3915addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3916locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3917@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3918
3919For example:
3920
3921@smallexample
3922Num Type Disp Enb Address What
39231 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3924 stop only if i==1
3925 breakpoint already hit 1 time
39261.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
39271.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3928@end smallexample
3929
3930You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
3931each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3932@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3933@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
3934@code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
3935locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
3936in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
3937@kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
3938in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
3939Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
3940all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
3941
3942@cindex pending breakpoints
3943It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3944Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3945and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3946this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3947any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3948set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3949debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3950symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3951breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3952a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3953is not yet resolved.
3954
3955After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3956@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3957shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3958pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3959ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3960that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3961
3962This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3963example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3964a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3965a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3966
3967Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3968differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3969enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3970
3971@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3972happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3973address specification to an address:
3974
3975@kindex set breakpoint pending
3976@kindex show breakpoint pending
3977@table @code
3978@item set breakpoint pending auto
3979This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3980location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3981
3982@item set breakpoint pending on
3983This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3984result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3985
3986@item set breakpoint pending off
3987This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3988unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3989not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3990
3991@item show breakpoint pending
3992Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3993@end table
3994
3995The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3996variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3997as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3998
3999@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4000For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4001software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4002breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4003breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4004breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4005breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4006breakpoints.
4007
4008You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4009
4010@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4011@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4012@table @code
4013@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4014This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4015will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4016breakpoint must be used.
4017
4018@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4019This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4020type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4021trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4022@end table
4023
4024@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4025at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4026executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4027code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4028the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4029behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4030target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4031targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4032This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4033
4034@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4035@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4036@table @code
4037@item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4038All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4039the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4040removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4041
4042@item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4043Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4044the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4045breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4046removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4047@end table
4048
4049@value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4050when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4051debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4052
4053If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4054download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4055
4056This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4057
4058@kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4059@kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4060@table @code
4061@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4062This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4063conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4064the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4065for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4066
4067@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4068This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4069to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4070is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4071breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4072is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4073cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4074that is only known to the host. Examples include
4075conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4076that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4077that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4078target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4079evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4080
4081@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4082This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4083conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4084the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4085not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4086to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4087@end table
4088
4089
4090@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4091@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4092@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4093special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4094programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4095starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4096You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4097@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4098
4099
4100@node Set Watchpoints
4101@subsection Setting Watchpoints
4102
4103@cindex setting watchpoints
4104You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4105expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4106this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4107The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4108as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4109
4110@itemize @bullet
4111@item
4112A reference to the value of a single variable.
4113
4114@item
4115An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4116@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4117address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4118
4119@item
4120An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4121expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4122language (@pxref{Languages}).
4123@end itemize
4124
4125You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4126not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4127@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4128@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4129the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4130valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4131pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4132@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4133the expression changes.
4134
4135@cindex software watchpoints
4136@cindex hardware watchpoints
4137Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4138hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4139program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4140times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4141catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4142culprit.)
4143
4144On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4145@value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4146slow down the running of your program.
4147
4148@table @code
4149@kindex watch
4150@item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4151Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4152expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4153changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4154to watch the value of a single variable:
4155
4156@smallexample
4157(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4158@end smallexample
4159
4160If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4161argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4162@var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4163change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4164that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4165with Hardware Watchpoints.
4166
4167Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4168(see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4169instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4170@value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4171and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4172to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4173result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4174error.
4175
4176The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4177of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4178feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4179Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4180to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4181(the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4182the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4183Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4184addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4185watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4186Examples:
4187
4188@smallexample
4189(@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4190(@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4191@end smallexample
4192
4193@kindex rwatch
4194@item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4195Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4196by the program.
4197
4198@kindex awatch
4199@item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4200Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4201or written into by the program.
4202
4203@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4204@item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4205This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4206@code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4207@end table
4208
4209If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4210dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4211never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4212a never-changing value:
4213
4214@smallexample
4215(@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4216Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4217(@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4218Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4219@end smallexample
4220
4221@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4222watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4223value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4224cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4225executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4226@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4227
4228@cindex use only software watchpoints
4229You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4230@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4231zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4232the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4233watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4234@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4235mechanism of watching expression values.)
4236
4237@table @code
4238@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4239@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4240Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4241
4242@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4243@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4244Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4245@end table
4246
4247For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4248watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4249hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4250
4251When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4252
4253@smallexample
4254Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4255@end smallexample
4256
4257@noindent
4258if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4259
4260Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4261hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4262value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4263every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4264that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4265hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4266will print a message like this:
4267
4268@smallexample
4269Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4270@end smallexample
4271
4272Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4273data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4274watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4275can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4276cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4277double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4278wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4279into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4280
4281If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4282to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4283Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4284time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4285able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4286warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4287
4288@smallexample
4289Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4290@end smallexample
4291
4292@noindent
4293If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4294
4295Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4296exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4297That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4298expression with separately allocated resources.
4299
4300If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4301any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4302kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4303
4304@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4305(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4306they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4307which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4308being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4309and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4310rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4311way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4312@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4313
4314@cindex watchpoints and threads
4315@cindex threads and watchpoints
4316In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4317watched expression from every thread.
4318
4319@quotation
4320@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4321have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4322watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4323single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4324change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4325confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4326software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4327when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4328watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4329@end quotation
4330
4331@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4332
4333@node Set Catchpoints
4334@subsection Setting Catchpoints
4335@cindex catchpoints, setting
4336@cindex exception handlers
4337@cindex event handling
4338
4339You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4340kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4341shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4342
4343@table @code
4344@kindex catch
4345@item catch @var{event}
4346Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4347
4348@table @code
4349@item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4350@itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4351@itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4352@kindex catch throw
4353@kindex catch rethrow
4354@kindex catch catch
4355@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4356The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4357
4358If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4359regular expression will be caught.
4360
4361@vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4362The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4363exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4364exception being thrown.
4365
4366There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4367@value{GDBN}:
4368
4369@itemize @bullet
4370@item
4371The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4372systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4373supported.
4374
4375@item
4376The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4377variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4378If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4379These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4380or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4381built.
4382
4383@item
4384The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4385instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4386
4387@item
4388When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4389location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4390support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4391(@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4392
4393@item
4394If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4395control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4396raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4397returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4398simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4399that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4400you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4401disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4402controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4403
4404@item
4405You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4406
4407@item
4408You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4409@end itemize
4410
4411@item exception
4412@kindex catch exception
4413@cindex Ada exception catching
4414@cindex catch Ada exceptions
4415An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4416at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4417the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4418Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4419
4420When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4421name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4422fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4423@value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4424rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4425called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4426the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4427Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4428
4429@item exception unhandled
4430@kindex catch exception unhandled
4431An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4432
4433@item assert
4434@kindex catch assert
4435A failed Ada assertion.
4436
4437@item exec
4438@kindex catch exec
4439@cindex break on fork/exec
4440A call to @code{exec}.
4441
4442@item syscall
4443@itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4444@kindex catch syscall
4445@cindex break on a system call.
4446A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4447syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4448from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4449@value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4450debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4451argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4452will be caught.
4453
4454@var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4455underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4456GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4457names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4458
4459@c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4460@c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4461@c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4462@c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4463
4464Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4465each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4466facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4467available choices.
4468
4469You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4470number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4471identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4472name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4473into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4474may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4475list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4476behind the OS upgrades).
4477
4478You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4479the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4480instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4481network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4482to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4483available in every system. You can use the command completion
4484facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4485syscall groups available on your environment.
4486
4487The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4488arguments to it:
4489
4490@smallexample
4491(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4492Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4493(@value{GDBP}) r
4494Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4495
4496Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4497 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4498(@value{GDBP}) c
4499Continuing.
4500
4501Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4502 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4503(@value{GDBP})
4504@end smallexample
4505
4506Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4507
4508@smallexample
4509(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4510Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4511(@value{GDBP}) r
4512Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4513
4514Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4515 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4516(@value{GDBP}) c
4517Continuing.
4518
4519Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4520 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4521(@value{GDBP})
4522@end smallexample
4523
4524An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4525below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4526file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4527
4528@smallexample
4529(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4530Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4531(@value{GDBP}) r
4532Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4533
4534Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4535 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4536(@value{GDBP}) c
4537Continuing.
4538
4539Program exited normally.
4540(@value{GDBP})
4541@end smallexample
4542
4543Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4544
4545@smallexample
4546(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4547Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4548'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4549'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4550(@value{GDBP}) r
4551Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4552
4553Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4554 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4555
4556(@value{GDBP}) c
4557Continuing.
4558@end smallexample
4559
4560However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4561in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4562a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4563but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4564
4565@smallexample
4566(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4567warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4568Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4569(@value{GDBP})
4570@end smallexample
4571
4572If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4573it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4574architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4575you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4576notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4577name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4578
4579@smallexample
4580(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4581warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4582warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4583GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4584Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4585(@value{GDBP})
4586@end smallexample
4587
4588Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4589
4590Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4591number. In this case, you would see something like:
4592
4593@smallexample
4594(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4595Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4596@end smallexample
4597
4598Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4599
4600@item fork
4601@kindex catch fork
4602A call to @code{fork}.
4603
4604@item vfork
4605@kindex catch vfork
4606A call to @code{vfork}.
4607
4608@item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4609@itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4610@kindex catch load
4611@kindex catch unload
4612The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4613given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4614matches one of the affected libraries.
4615
4616@item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4617@kindex catch signal
4618The delivery of a signal.
4619
4620With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4621used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4622@samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4623
4624With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4625@value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4626signal names.
4627
4628Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4629@code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4630will be caught.
4631
4632One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4633@code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4634catchpoint.
4635
4636When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4637@code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4638However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4639on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4640commands.
4641
4642@end table
4643
4644@item tcatch @var{event}
4645@kindex tcatch
4646Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4647automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4648
4649@end table
4650
4651Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4652
4653
4654@node Delete Breaks
4655@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4656
4657@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4658@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4659It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4660catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4661to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4662breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4663
4664With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4665where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4666delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4667their breakpoint numbers.
4668
4669It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4670automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4671when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4672
4673@table @code
4674@kindex clear
4675@item clear
4676Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4677selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4678the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4679breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4680
4681@item clear @var{location}
4682Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4683@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4684most useful ones are listed below:
4685
4686@table @code
4687@item clear @var{function}
4688@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4689Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4690
4691@item clear @var{linenum}
4692@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4693Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4694@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4695@end table
4696
4697@cindex delete breakpoints
4698@kindex delete
4699@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4700@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4701Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4702list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4703breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4704confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4705@end table
4706
4707@node Disabling
4708@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4709
4710@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4711Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4712prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4713it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4714that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4715
4716You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4717the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4718one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4719print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4720do not know which numbers to use.
4721
4722Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4723affects all of its locations.
4724
4725A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4726different states of enablement:
4727
4728@itemize @bullet
4729@item
4730Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4731with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4732@item
4733Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4734@item
4735Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4736disabled.
4737@item
4738Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4739N times, then becomes disabled.
4740@item
4741Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4742immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4743set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4744@end itemize
4745
4746You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4747watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4748
4749@table @code
4750@kindex disable
4751@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4752@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4753Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4754listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4755options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4756case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4757@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4758
4759@kindex enable
4760@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4761Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4762become effective once again in stopping your program.
4763
4764@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4765Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4766of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4767
4768@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4769Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4770@var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4771breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4772@value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4773count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4774decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4775
4776@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4777Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4778deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4779Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4780@end table
4781
4782@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4783@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4784Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4785,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4786subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4787the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4788breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4789breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4790Stepping}.)
4791
4792@node Conditions
4793@subsection Break Conditions
4794@cindex conditional breakpoints
4795@cindex breakpoint conditions
4796
4797@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4798@c in particular for a watchpoint?
4799The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4800specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4801breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4802programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4803a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4804and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4805
4806This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4807situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4808when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4809by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4810@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4811
4812Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4813since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4814it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4815and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4816one.
4817
4818Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4819your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4820that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4821format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4822unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4823that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4824program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4825breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4826conditions for the
4827purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4828(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4829
4830Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4831the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4832@value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4833(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4834independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4835locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4836
4837In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4838when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4839response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4840since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4841every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4842
4843Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4844@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4845Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4846with the @code{condition} command.
4847
4848You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4849The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4850@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4851catchpoint.
4852
4853@table @code
4854@kindex condition
4855@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4856Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4857watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4858breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4859@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4860@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4861syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4862referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4863symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4864prints an error message:
4865
4866@smallexample
4867No symbol "foo" in current context.
4868@end smallexample
4869
4870@noindent
4871@value{GDBN} does
4872not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4873command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4874@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4875
4876@item condition @var{bnum}
4877Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4878an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4879@end table
4880
4881@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4882A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4883breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4884useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4885count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4886is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4887therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4888ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4889the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4890value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4891your program reaches it.
4892
4893@table @code
4894@kindex ignore
4895@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4896Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4897The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4898execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4899takes no action.
4900
4901To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4902a count of zero.
4903
4904When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4905breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4906@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4907Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4908
4909If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4910condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4911@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4912
4913You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4914as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4915is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4916Variables}.
4917@end table
4918
4919Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4920
4921
4922@node Break Commands
4923@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4924
4925@cindex breakpoint commands
4926You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4927commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4928example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4929enable other breakpoints.
4930
4931@table @code
4932@kindex commands
4933@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4934@item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4935@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4936@itemx end
4937Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4938themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4939@code{end} to terminate the commands.
4940
4941To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4942follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4943
4944With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4945watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4946encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4947command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4948set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4949@code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4950creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4951Expressions}).
4952@end table
4953
4954Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4955disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4956
4957You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4958use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4959that resumes execution.
4960
4961Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4962execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4963(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4964another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4965ambiguities about which list to execute.
4966
4967@kindex silent
4968If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4969usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4970be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4971then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4972see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4973meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4974
4975The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4976print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4977breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4978
4979For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4980value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4981
4982@smallexample
4983break foo if x>0
4984commands
4985silent
4986printf "x is %d\n",x
4987cont
4988end
4989@end smallexample
4990
4991One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4992you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4993of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4994erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4995to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4996so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4997command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4998
4999@smallexample
5000break 403
5001commands
5002silent
5003set x = y + 4
5004cont
5005end
5006@end smallexample
5007
5008@node Dynamic Printf
5009@subsection Dynamic Printf
5010
5011@cindex dynamic printf
5012@cindex dprintf
5013The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5014formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5015inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5016having to recompile it.
5017
5018In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5019you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5020For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5021program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5022characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5023redirects to files and so forth.
5024
5025If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5026ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5027ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5028with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5029the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5030target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5031everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5032
5033@table @code
5034@kindex dprintf
5035@item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5036Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5037more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5038To print several values, separate them with commas.
5039
5040@item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5041Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5042styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5043dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5044print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5045explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5046
5047@table @code
5048@item gdb
5049@kindex dprintf-style gdb
5050Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5051
5052@item call
5053@kindex dprintf-style call
5054Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5055@code{printf}).
5056
5057@item agent
5058@kindex dprintf-style agent
5059Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5060the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5061support running commands on the target.
5062@end table
5063
5064@item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5065Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5066default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5067that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5068command.
5069
5070@item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5071Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5072@value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5073a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5074@code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5075string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5076
5077As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5078that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5079you could do the following:
5080
5081@example
5082(gdb) set dprintf-style call
5083(gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5084(gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5085(gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5086Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5087(gdb) info break
50881 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5089 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5090 continue
5091(gdb)
5092@end example
5093
5094Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5095as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5096the variable settings.
5097
5098@item set disconnected-dprintf on
5099@itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5100@kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5101Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5102@value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5103if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5104
5105@item show disconnected-dprintf off
5106@kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5107Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5108
5109@end table
5110
5111@value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5112relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5113in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5114may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5115all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5116those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5117
5118@node Save Breakpoints
5119@subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5120
5121To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5122breakpoints}} command.
5123
5124@table @code
5125@kindex save breakpoints
5126@cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5127@item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5128This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5129their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5130suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5131types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5132tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5133@code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5134with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5135because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5136watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5137are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5138breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5139and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5140that can no longer be recreated.
5141@end table
5142
5143@node Static Probe Points
5144@subsection Static Probe Points
5145
5146@cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5147@cindex static probe point, DTrace
5148@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5149for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5150runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5151
5152Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5153ELF-compatible systems:
5154
5155@itemize @bullet
5156
5157@item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5158@acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5159@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5160for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5161probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5162from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5163@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5164for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5165
5166@item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5167@acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5168C@t{++} languages.
5169@end itemize
5170
5171@cindex semaphores on static probe points
5172Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5173for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5174using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5175@value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5176breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5177breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5178@code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5179the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5180
5181You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5182probes}, with optional arguments:
5183
5184@table @code
5185@kindex info probes
5186@item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5187If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5188@code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5189probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5190
5191If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5192names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5193probes from all providers are listed.
5194
5195If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5196when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5197considered when deciding whether to display them.
5198
5199If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5200object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5201given, all object files are considered.
5202
5203@item info probes all
5204List the available static probes, from all types.
5205@end table
5206
5207@cindex enabling and disabling probes
5208Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5209enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5210handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5211disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5212
5213You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5214commands, with optional arguments:
5215
5216@table @code
5217@kindex enable probes
5218@item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5219If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5220provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5221all probes from all providers are enabled.
5222
5223If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5224names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5225are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5226
5227If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5228object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5229given, all object files are considered.
5230
5231@kindex disable probes
5232@item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5233See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5234optional arguments accepted by this command.
5235@end table
5236
5237@vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5238A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5239point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5240at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5241convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5242@code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5243probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5244types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5245provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5246the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5247convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5248at the current probe point.
5249
5250These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5251any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5252an error message.
5253
5254
5255@c @ifclear BARETARGET
5256@node Error in Breakpoints
5257@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5258
5259If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5260watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5261
5262@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5263@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5264@smallexample
5265Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5266You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5267@end smallexample
5268
5269@noindent
5270This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5271only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5272watchpoints it needs to insert.
5273
5274When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5275hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5276
5277@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5278@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5279@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5280
5281Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5282which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5283@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5284with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5285
5286One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5287a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5288bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5289constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5290bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5291honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5292first in the bundle.
5293
5294It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5295instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5296a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5297another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5298breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5299printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5300is hit.
5301
5302A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5303that's been subject to address adjustment:
5304
5305@smallexample
5306warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5307@end smallexample
5308
5309Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5310internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5311verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5312desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5313other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5314E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5315instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5316cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5317
5318@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5319adjusted breakpoints:
5320
5321@smallexample
5322warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5323to 0x00010410.
5324@end smallexample
5325
5326When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5327action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5328frequently than expected.
5329
5330@node Continuing and Stepping
5331@section Continuing and Stepping
5332
5333@cindex stepping
5334@cindex continuing
5335@cindex resuming execution
5336@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5337completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5338one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5339line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5340particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5341your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5342it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5343@samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5344or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5345handlers}).)
5346
5347@table @code
5348@kindex continue
5349@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5350@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5351@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5352@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5353@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5354Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5355any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5356@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5357ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5358@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5359
5360The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5361stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5362@code{continue} is ignored.
5363
5364The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5365debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5366purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5367@code{continue}.
5368@end table
5369
5370To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5371(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5372calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5373Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5374
5375A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5376(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5377beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5378is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5379and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5380interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5381
5382@table @code
5383@kindex step
5384@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5385@item step
5386Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5387line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5388abbreviated @code{s}.
5389
5390@quotation
5391@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5392@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5393@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5394@c distinction here.
5395@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5396within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5397execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5398debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5399is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5400without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5401below.
5402@end quotation
5403
5404The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5405line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5406@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5407to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5408the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5409called within the line.
5410
5411Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5412number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5413@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5414on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5415was any debugging information about the routine.
5416
5417@item step @var{count}
5418Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5419breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5420@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5421
5422@kindex next
5423@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5424@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5425Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5426This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5427the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5428control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5429that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5430is abbreviated @code{n}.
5431
5432An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5433
5434
5435@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5436@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5437@c
5438@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5439@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5440@c function are executed without stopping.
5441
5442The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5443source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5444@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5445
5446@kindex set step-mode
5447@item set step-mode
5448@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5449@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5450@itemx set step-mode on
5451The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5452stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5453information rather than stepping over it.
5454
5455This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5456machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5457want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5458
5459@item set step-mode off
5460Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5461debug information. This is the default.
5462
5463@item show step-mode
5464Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5465source line debug information.
5466
5467@kindex finish
5468@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5469@item finish
5470Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5471returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5472abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5473
5474Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5475,Returning from a Function}).
5476
5477@kindex until
5478@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5479@cindex run until specified location
5480@item until
5481@itemx u
5482Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5483current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5484stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5485command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5486automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5487than the address of the jump.
5488
5489This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5490though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5491exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5492simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5493through the next iteration.
5494
5495@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5496stack frame.
5497
5498@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5499of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5500example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5501(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5502@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5503
5504@smallexample
5505(@value{GDBP}) f
5506#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5507206 expand_input();
5508(@value{GDBP}) until
5509195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5510@end smallexample
5511
5512This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5513generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5514start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5515written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5516to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5517expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5518statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5519
5520@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5521instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5522argument.
5523
5524@item until @var{location}
5525@itemx u @var{location}
5526Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5527reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5528the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5529This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5530hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5531location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5532implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5533invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5534line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5535line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5536invocations have returned.
5537
5538@smallexample
553994 int factorial (int value)
554095 @{
554196 if (value > 1) @{
554297 value *= factorial (value - 1);
554398 @}
554499 return (value);
5545100 @}
5546@end smallexample
5547
5548
5549@kindex advance @var{location}
5550@item advance @var{location}
5551Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5552required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5553@ref{Specify Location}.
5554Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5555frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5556not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5557have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5558
5559
5560@kindex stepi
5561@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5562@item stepi
5563@itemx stepi @var{arg}
5564@itemx si
5565Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5566
5567It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5568instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5569instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5570Display,, Automatic Display}.
5571
5572An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5573
5574@need 750
5575@kindex nexti
5576@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5577@item nexti
5578@itemx nexti @var{arg}
5579@itemx ni
5580Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5581proceed until the function returns.
5582
5583An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5584
5585@end table
5586
5587@anchor{range stepping}
5588@cindex range stepping
5589@cindex target-assisted range stepping
5590By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5591target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5592use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5593tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5594addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5595line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5596be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5597possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5598remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5599stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5600enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5601if necessary:
5602
5603@table @code
5604@kindex set range-stepping
5605@kindex show range-stepping
5606@item set range-stepping
5607@itemx show range-stepping
5608Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5609
5610If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5611target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5612multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5613single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5614default is @code{on}.
5615
5616@end table
5617
5618@node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5619@section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5620@cindex skipping over functions and files
5621
5622The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5623uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5624skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5625a particular file when stepping.
5626
5627For example, consider the following C function:
5628
5629@smallexample
5630101 int func()
5631102 @{
5632103 foo(boring());
5633104 bar(boring());
5634105 @}
5635@end smallexample
5636
5637@noindent
5638Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5639are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5640at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5641step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5642
5643One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5644command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5645is called from many places.
5646
5647A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5648@value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5649@code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5650@code{foo}.
5651
5652Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5653(@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5654name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5655
5656On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5657``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5658on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5659expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5660the underlying system.
5661See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5662description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5663
5664@table @code
5665@kindex skip
5666@item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5667The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5668that specify what to skip.
5669The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5670
5671@table @code
5672@item -file @var{file}
5673@itemx -fi @var{file}
5674Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5675
5676@item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5677@itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5678@cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5679Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5680over when stepping.
5681
5682@smallexample
5683(gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5684@end smallexample
5685
5686@item -function @var{linespec}
5687@itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5688Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5689named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5690@xref{Specify Location}.
5691
5692@item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5693@itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5694@cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5695Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5696
5697This form is useful for complex function names.
5698For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5699constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5700write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5701the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5702regular expression makes this easier.
5703
5704@smallexample
5705(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5706@end smallexample
5707
5708If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5709in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5710
5711@smallexample
5712(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5713@end smallexample
5714@end table
5715
5716If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5717will be skipped.
5718
5719@kindex skip function
5720@item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5721After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5722function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5723stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5724
5725If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5726will be skipped.
5727
5728(If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5729@kbd{skip function file}.)
5730
5731@kindex skip file
5732@item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5733After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5734will be skipped over when stepping.
5735
5736@smallexample
5737(gdb) skip file boring.c
5738File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5739@end smallexample
5740
5741If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5742you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5743@end table
5744
5745Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5746These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5747
5748@table @code
5749@kindex info skip
5750@item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5751Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5752print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5753@code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5754
5755@table @emph
5756@item Identifier
5757A number identifying this skip.
5758@item Enabled or Disabled
5759Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5760Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5761@item Glob
5762If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5763Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5764@item File
5765The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5766If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5767@item RE
5768If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5769Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5770@item Function
5771The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5772If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5773@end table
5774
5775@kindex skip delete
5776@item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5777Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5778skips.
5779
5780@kindex skip enable
5781@item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5782Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5783skips.
5784
5785@kindex skip disable
5786@item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5787Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5788skips.
5789
5790@end table
5791
5792@node Signals
5793@section Signals
5794@cindex signals
5795
5796A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5797operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5798kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5799signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5800@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5801memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5802the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5803requested an alarm).
5804
5805@cindex fatal signals
5806Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5807functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5808errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5809program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5810@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5811fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5812
5813@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5814program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5815signal.
5816
5817@cindex handling signals
5818Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5819@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5820(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5821but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5822You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5823
5824@table @code
5825@kindex info signals
5826@kindex info handle
5827@item info signals
5828@itemx info handle
5829Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5830handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5831the defined types of signals.
5832
5833@item info signals @var{sig}
5834Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5835
5836@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5837
5838@item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5839Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5840for details about this command.
5841
5842@kindex handle
5843@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5844Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5845can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5846@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5847@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5848known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5849say what change to make.
5850@end table
5851
5852@c @group
5853The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5854Their full names are:
5855
5856@table @code
5857@item nostop
5858@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5859still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5860
5861@item stop
5862@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5863the @code{print} keyword as well.
5864
5865@item print
5866@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5867
5868@item noprint
5869@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5870implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5871
5872@item pass
5873@itemx noignore
5874@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5875can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5876and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5877
5878@item nopass
5879@itemx ignore
5880@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5881@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5882@end table
5883@c @end group
5884
5885When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5886program until you
5887continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5888effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5889after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5890command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5891program sees that signal when you continue.
5892
5893The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5894non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5895@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5896erroneous signals.
5897
5898You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5899seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5900or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5901due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5902values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5903execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5904a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5905you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5906Program a Signal}.
5907
5908@cindex stepping and signal handlers
5909@anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5910
5911@value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5912that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5913a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5914in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5915stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5916words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5917signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5918nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5919the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5920signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5921that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5922note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5923signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5924
5925@anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5926
5927If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5928handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5929or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5930step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5931
5932Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5933to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5934resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5935stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5936
5937Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5938of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5939
5940@smallexample
5941(@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5942Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5943SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5944(@value{GDBP}) c
5945Continuing.
5946
5947Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5948main () sigusr1.c:28
594928 p = 0;
5950(@value{GDBP}) si
5951sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
59529 @{
5953@end smallexample
5954
5955The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5956program to receive the signal first:
5957
5958@smallexample
5959(@value{GDBP}) n
596028 p = 0;
5961(@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5962(@value{GDBP}) si
5963sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
59649 @{
5965(@value{GDBP})
5966@end smallexample
5967
5968@cindex extra signal information
5969@anchor{extra signal information}
5970
5971On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5972associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5973delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5974by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5975that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5976receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5977target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5978$_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5979standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5980system header.
5981
5982Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5983referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5984
5985@smallexample
5986@group
5987(@value{GDBP}) continue
5988Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
59890x0000000000400766 in main ()
599069 *(int *)p = 0;
5991(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5992type = struct @{
5993 int si_signo;
5994 int si_errno;
5995 int si_code;
5996 union @{
5997 int _pad[28];
5998 struct @{...@} _kill;
5999 struct @{...@} _timer;
6000 struct @{...@} _rt;
6001 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6002 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6003 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6004 @} _sifields;
6005@}
6006(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6007type = struct @{
6008 void *si_addr;
6009@}
6010(@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6011$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6012@end group
6013@end smallexample
6014
6015Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6016
6017@cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6018@cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6019On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6020violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6021In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6022depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6023With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6024kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6025bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6026information is displayed.
6027
6028The usual output of a segfault is:
6029@smallexample
6030Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
60310x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
603268 value = *(p + len);
6033@end smallexample
6034
6035While a bound violation is presented as:
6036@smallexample
6037Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6038Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6039Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
60400x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
604168 value = *(p + len);
6042@end smallexample
6043
6044@node Thread Stops
6045@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6046
6047@cindex stopped threads
6048@cindex threads, stopped
6049
6050@cindex continuing threads
6051@cindex threads, continuing
6052
6053@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6054(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6055are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6056debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6057when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6058or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6059@value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6060@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6061you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6062
6063@menu
6064* All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6065* Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6066* Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6067* Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6068* Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6069* Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6070@end menu
6071
6072@node All-Stop Mode
6073@subsection All-Stop Mode
6074
6075@cindex all-stop mode
6076
6077In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6078@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6079allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6080switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6081underfoot.
6082
6083Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6084executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6085like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6086
6087In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6088Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6089system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6090execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6091single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6092statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6093stops.
6094
6095You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6096continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6097thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6098first thread completes whatever you requested.
6099
6100@cindex automatic thread selection
6101@cindex switching threads automatically
6102@cindex threads, automatic switching
6103Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6104signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6105signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6106message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6107thread.
6108
6109On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6110locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6111
6112@table @code
6113@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6114@cindex scheduler locking mode
6115@cindex lock scheduler
6116Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6117record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6118locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6119the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6120@code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6121threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6122that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6123threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6124completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6125@samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6126breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6127current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6128@code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6129@code{on} in replay mode.
6130
6131@item show scheduler-locking
6132Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6133@end table
6134
6135@cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6136By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6137@code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6138threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6139is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6140@code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6141inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6142forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6143it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6144situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6145of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6146to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6147you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6148inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6149
6150@table @code
6151@kindex set schedule-multiple
6152@item set schedule-multiple
6153Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6154when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6155all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6156of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6157@code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6158or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6159
6160@item show schedule-multiple
6161Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6162multiple processes.
6163@end table
6164
6165@node Non-Stop Mode
6166@subsection Non-Stop Mode
6167
6168@cindex non-stop mode
6169
6170@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6171@c with more details.
6172
6173For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6174mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6175the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6176minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6177where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6178respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6179
6180In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6181@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6182threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6183execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6184only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6185in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6186ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6187one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6188one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6189independently and simultaneously.
6190
6191To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6192or attach to your program:
6193
6194@smallexample
6195# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6196set pagination off
6197
6198# Finally, turn it on!
6199set non-stop on
6200@end smallexample
6201
6202You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6203
6204@table @code
6205@kindex set non-stop
6206@item set non-stop on
6207Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6208@item set non-stop off
6209Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6210@kindex show non-stop
6211@item show non-stop
6212Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6213@end table
6214
6215Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6216not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6217In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6218@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6219not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6220since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6221non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6222default.
6223
6224In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6225by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6226To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6227
6228You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6229(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6230while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6231The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6232always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6233
6234Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6235running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6236In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6237but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6238To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6239
6240Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6241
6242In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6243that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6244thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6245command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6246changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6247previously current thread.
6248
6249@node Background Execution
6250@subsection Background Execution
6251
6252@cindex foreground execution
6253@cindex background execution
6254@cindex asynchronous execution
6255@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6256
6257@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6258foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6259(asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6260the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6261another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6262a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6263
6264If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6265message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6266
6267To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6268the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6269just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6270are:
6271
6272@table @code
6273@kindex run&
6274@item run
6275@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6276
6277@item attach
6278@kindex attach&
6279@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6280
6281@item step
6282@kindex step&
6283@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6284
6285@item stepi
6286@kindex stepi&
6287@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6288
6289@item next
6290@kindex next&
6291@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6292
6293@item nexti
6294@kindex nexti&
6295@xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6296
6297@item continue
6298@kindex continue&
6299@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6300
6301@item finish
6302@kindex finish&
6303@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6304
6305@item until
6306@kindex until&
6307@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6308
6309@end table
6310
6311Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6312mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6313However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6314the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6315previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6316mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6317
6318You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6319using the @code{interrupt} command.
6320
6321@table @code
6322@kindex interrupt
6323@item interrupt
6324@itemx interrupt -a
6325
6326Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6327@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6328only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6329use @code{interrupt -a}.
6330@end table
6331
6332@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6333@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6334
6335When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6336Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6337breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6338
6339@table @code
6340@cindex breakpoints and threads
6341@cindex thread breakpoints
6342@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6343@item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6344@itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6345@var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6346writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6347specify some source line.
6348
6349Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6350to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6351particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6352is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6353in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6354
6355If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6356breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6357program.
6358
6359You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6360well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6361after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6362
6363@smallexample
6364(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6365@end smallexample
6366
6367@end table
6368
6369Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6370@value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6371thread list. For example:
6372
6373@smallexample
6374(@value{GDBP}) c
6375Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6376@end smallexample
6377
6378There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6379thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6380@code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6381Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6382(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6383@value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6384explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6385command.
6386
6387@node Interrupted System Calls
6388@subsection Interrupted System Calls
6389
6390@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6391@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6392@cindex premature return from system calls
6393There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6394multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6395breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6396system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6397consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6398that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6399stop execution.
6400
6401To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6402each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6403style anyways.
6404
6405For example, do not write code like this:
6406
6407@smallexample
6408 sleep (10);
6409@end smallexample
6410
6411The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6412at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6413
6414Instead, write this:
6415
6416@smallexample
6417 int unslept = 10;
6418 while (unslept > 0)
6419 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6420@end smallexample
6421
6422A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6423conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6424multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6425@value{GDBN}.
6426
6427Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6428monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6429When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6430prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6431
6432@node Observer Mode
6433@subsection Observer Mode
6434
6435If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6436without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6437variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6438whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6439at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6440
6441When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6442be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6443@code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6444mode.
6445
6446Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6447combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6448@code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6449then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6450stream will still not be able to be placed.
6451
6452@table @code
6453
6454@kindex observer
6455@item set observer on
6456@itemx set observer off
6457When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6458below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6459non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6460normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6461
6462@item show observer
6463Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6464
6465@kindex may-write-registers
6466@item set may-write-registers on
6467@itemx set may-write-registers off
6468This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6469registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6470@code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6471
6472@item show may-write-registers
6473Show the current permission to write registers.
6474
6475@kindex may-write-memory
6476@item set may-write-memory on
6477@itemx set may-write-memory off
6478This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6479of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6480defaults to @code{on}.
6481
6482@item show may-write-memory
6483Show the current permission to write memory.
6484
6485@kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6486@item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6487@itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6488This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6489This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6490by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6491
6492@item show may-insert-breakpoints
6493Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6494
6495@kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6496@item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6497@itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6498This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6499tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6500non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6501@code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6502
6503@item show may-insert-tracepoints
6504Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6505
6506@kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6507@item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6508@itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6509This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6510tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6511fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6512control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6513
6514@item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6515Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6516
6517@kindex may-interrupt
6518@item set may-interrupt on
6519@itemx set may-interrupt off
6520This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6521program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6522@code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6523@kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6524
6525@item show may-interrupt
6526Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6527
6528@end table
6529
6530@node Reverse Execution
6531@chapter Running programs backward
6532@cindex reverse execution
6533@cindex running programs backward
6534
6535When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6536you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6537If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6538``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6539
6540A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6541to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6542program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6543revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6544deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6545all target environments can support reverse execution.
6546
6547When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6548have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6549order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6550thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6551the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6552instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6553a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6554should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6555prior values@footnote{
6556Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6557memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6558targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6559
6560The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6561requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6562@value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6563results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6564@value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6565assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6566consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6567}.
6568
6569If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6570reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6571
6572@table @code
6573@kindex reverse-continue
6574@kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6575@item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6576@itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6577Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6578in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6579exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6580asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6581
6582@kindex reverse-step
6583@kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6584@item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6585Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6586different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6587
6588Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6589at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6590executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6591debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6592the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6593statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6594
6595Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6596called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6597
6598@kindex reverse-stepi
6599@kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6600@item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6601Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6602to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6603counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6604if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6605back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6606
6607@kindex reverse-next
6608@kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6609@item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6610Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6611the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6612calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6613the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6614to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6615just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6616line of a function back to its return to its caller
6617@footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6618
6619@kindex reverse-nexti
6620@kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6621@item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6622Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6623in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6624That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6625another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6626in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6627frame) is reached.
6628
6629@kindex reverse-finish
6630@item reverse-finish
6631Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6632current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6633where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6634function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6635
6636@kindex set exec-direction
6637@item set exec-direction
6638Set the direction of target execution.
6639@item set exec-direction reverse
6640@cindex execute forward or backward in time
6641@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6642exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6643@code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6644command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6645@item set exec-direction forward
6646@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6647This is the default.
6648@end table
6649
6650
6651@node Process Record and Replay
6652@chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6653@cindex process record and replay
6654@cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6655
6656On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6657and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6658replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6659
6660@cindex replay mode
6661When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6662for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6663mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6664instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6665code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6666really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6667program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6668changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6669execution log.
6670
6671@cindex record mode
6672If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6673@value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6674inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6675for future replay.
6676
6677The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6678(@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6679inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6680this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6681log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6682support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6683
6684When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6685replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6686previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6687platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6688
6689For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6690@value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6691
6692@table @code
6693@kindex target record
6694@kindex target record-full
6695@kindex target record-btrace
6696@kindex record
6697@kindex record full
6698@kindex record btrace
6699@kindex record btrace bts
6700@kindex record btrace pt
6701@kindex record bts
6702@kindex record pt
6703@kindex rec
6704@kindex rec full
6705@kindex rec btrace
6706@kindex rec btrace bts
6707@kindex rec btrace pt
6708@kindex rec bts
6709@kindex rec pt
6710@item record @var{method}
6711This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6712recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6713the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6714recording methods are available:
6715
6716@table @code
6717@item full
6718Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6719replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6720execution.
6721
6722@item btrace @var{format}
6723Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6724data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6725be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6726execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6727execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6728Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6729be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6730
6731The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6732the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6733formats are available:
6734
6735@table @code
6736@item bts
6737@cindex branch trace store
6738Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6739this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6740branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6741
6742@item pt
6743@cindex Intel Processor Trace
6744Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6745format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6746that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6747
6748The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6749trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6750number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6751
6752Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6753expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6754increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6755buffer-size with care.
6756@end table
6757
6758Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6759@end table
6760
6761The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6762already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6763the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6764with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6765
6766@cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6767Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6768will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6769is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6770doesn't support displaced stepping.
6771
6772@cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6773@cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6774If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6775the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6776all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6777does not support these two modes.
6778
6779@kindex record stop
6780@kindex rec s
6781@item record stop
6782Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6783replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6784inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6785
6786When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6787the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6788next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6789you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6790will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6791
6792On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6793while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6794but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6795at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6796usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6797
6798When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6799process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6800
6801@kindex record goto
6802@item record goto
6803Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6804ways to specify the location to go to:
6805
6806@table @code
6807@item record goto begin
6808@itemx record goto start
6809Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6810
6811@item record goto end
6812Go to the end of the execution log.
6813
6814@item record goto @var{n}
6815Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6816@end table
6817
6818@kindex record save
6819@item record save @var{filename}
6820Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6821Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6822@var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6823
6824This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6825
6826@kindex record restore
6827@item record restore @var{filename}
6828Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6829File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6830
6831@kindex set record full
6832@item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6833@itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6834Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6835recording method. Default value is 200000.
6836
6837If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6838deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6839instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6840instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6841instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6842(Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6843lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6844the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6845
6846If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6847delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6848recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6849
6850@kindex show record full
6851@item show record full insn-number-max
6852Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6853recording method.
6854
6855@item set record full stop-at-limit
6856Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6857number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6858default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6859first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6860continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6861to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6862oldest one to be deleted.
6863
6864If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6865oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6866
6867@item show record full stop-at-limit
6868Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6869
6870@item set record full memory-query
6871Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6872changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6873If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6874case.
6875
6876If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6877ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6878@value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6879instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6880results.
6881
6882@item show record full memory-query
6883Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6884
6885@kindex set record btrace
6886The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6887convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6888the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6889read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6890disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6891In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6892You can use the following command for that:
6893
6894@item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6895Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6896accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6897@value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6898If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6899and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6900to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6901position.
6902
6903@kindex show record btrace
6904@item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6905Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6906
6907@kindex set record btrace bts
6908@item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6909@itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6910Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6911format. Default is 64KB.
6912
6913If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6914allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6915that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6916The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6917@var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6918buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6919the @acronym{BTS} format.
6920
6921If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6922allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6923
6924Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6925also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6926
6927@item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6928Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6929tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6930
6931@kindex set record btrace pt
6932@item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6933@itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6934Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6935Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6936
6937If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6938allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6939that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6940format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6941requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6942actual buffer size for each thread.
6943
6944If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6945allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6946
6947Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6948also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6949
6950@item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6951Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6952tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6953
6954@kindex info record
6955@item info record
6956Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6957method:
6958
6959@table @code
6960@item full
6961For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6962record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6963
6964@itemize @bullet
6965@item
6966Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6967@item
6968Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6969@item
6970Highest recorded instruction number.
6971@item
6972Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6973@item
6974Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6975@item
6976Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6977@end itemize
6978
6979@item btrace
6980For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6981
6982@itemize @bullet
6983@item
6984Recording format.
6985@item
6986Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6987@item
6988Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6989instructions.
6990@item
6991Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6992@end itemize
6993
6994For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6995@itemize @bullet
6996@item
6997Size of the perf ring buffer.
6998@end itemize
6999
7000For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7001@itemize @bullet
7002@item
7003Size of the perf ring buffer.
7004@end itemize
7005@end table
7006
7007@kindex record delete
7008@kindex rec del
7009@item record delete
7010When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7011subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7012from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7013recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7014
7015@kindex record instruction-history
7016@kindex rec instruction-history
7017@item record instruction-history
7018Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7019default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7020the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7021are printed in execution order.
7022
7023It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7024@code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7025as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7026
7027The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7028current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7029times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7030every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7031@code{/p} modifier.
7032
7033To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7034instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7035omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7036
7037Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7038feature is not available for all recording formats.
7039
7040There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7041disassemble:
7042
7043@table @code
7044@item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7045Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7046@var{insn}.
7047
7048@item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7049Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7050@var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7051@var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7052@var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7053instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7054
7055@item record instruction-history
7056Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7057
7058@item record instruction-history -
7059Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7060
7061@item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7062Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7063@var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7064number @var{end} is included.
7065@end table
7066
7067This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7068
7069@kindex set record
7070@item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7071@itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7072Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7073instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7074A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7075
7076@kindex show record
7077@item show record instruction-history-size
7078Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7079instruction-history} command.
7080
7081@kindex record function-call-history
7082@kindex rec function-call-history
7083@item record function-call-history
7084Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7085line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7086function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7087for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7088specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7089the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7090to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7091specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7092given together.
7093
7094@smallexample
7095(@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
70961 void foo (void)
70972 @{
70983 @}
70994
71005 void bar (void)
71016 @{
71027 ...
71038 foo ();
71049 ...
710510 @}
7106(@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
71071 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
71082 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
71093 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7110@end smallexample
7111
7112By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7113@code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7114printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7115to print:
7116
7117@table @code
7118@item record function-call-history @var{func}
7119Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7120
7121@item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7122Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7123@var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7124function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7125prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7126
7127@item record function-call-history
7128Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7129
7130@item record function-call-history -
7131Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7132
7133@item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7134Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7135function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7136@end table
7137
7138This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7139
7140@item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7141@itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7142Define how many lines to print in the
7143@code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7144A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7145
7146@item show record function-call-history-size
7147Show how many lines to print in the
7148@code{record function-call-history} command.
7149@end table
7150
7151
7152@node Stack
7153@chapter Examining the Stack
7154
7155When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7156stopped and how it got there.
7157
7158@cindex call stack
7159Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7160is generated.
7161That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7162the arguments of the call,
7163and the local variables of the function being called.
7164The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7165The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7166stack}.
7167
7168When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7169stack allow you to see all of this information.
7170
7171@cindex selected frame
7172One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7173@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7174particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7175your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7176special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7177interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7178
7179When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7180currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7181@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7182
7183@menu
7184* Frames:: Stack frames
7185* Backtrace:: Backtraces
7186* Selection:: Selecting a frame
7187* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7188* Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7189
7190@end menu
7191
7192@node Frames
7193@section Stack Frames
7194
7195@cindex frame, definition
7196@cindex stack frame
7197The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7198frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7199with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7200to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7201which the function is executing.
7202
7203@cindex initial frame
7204@cindex outermost frame
7205@cindex innermost frame
7206When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7207function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7208@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7209made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7210is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7211the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7212actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7213recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7214
7215@cindex frame pointer
7216Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7217stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7218kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7219address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7220in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7221(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7222
7223@cindex frame number
7224@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7225zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7226and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7227they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7228frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7229
7230@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7231@c underflow problems.
7232@cindex frameless execution
7233Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7234without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7235@smallexample
7236@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7237@end smallexample
7238generates functions without a frame.)
7239This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7240the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7241with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7242has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7243it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7244correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7245no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7246
7247@node Backtrace
7248@section Backtraces
7249
7250@cindex traceback
7251@cindex call stack traces
7252A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7253line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7254frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7255stack.
7256
7257@anchor{backtrace-command}
7258@table @code
7259@kindex backtrace
7260@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7261@item backtrace
7262@itemx bt
7263Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7264frames in the stack.
7265
7266You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7267character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7268
7269@item backtrace @var{n}
7270@itemx bt @var{n}
7271Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7272
7273@item backtrace -@var{n}
7274@itemx bt -@var{n}
7275Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7276
7277@item backtrace full
7278@itemx bt full
7279@itemx bt full @var{n}
7280@itemx bt full -@var{n}
7281Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7282@var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7283
7284@item backtrace no-filters
7285@itemx bt no-filters
7286@itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7287@itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7288@itemx bt no-filters full
7289@itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7290@itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7291Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7292Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7293frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7294relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7295support.
7296@end table
7297
7298@kindex where
7299@kindex info stack
7300The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7301are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7302
7303@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7304In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7305backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7306several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7307(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7308apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7309the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7310multi-threaded program.
7311
7312Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7313The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7314print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7315line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7316counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7317line number.
7318
7319Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7320@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7321
7322@smallexample
7323@group
7324#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7325 at builtin.c:993
7326#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7327#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7328 at macro.c:71
7329(More stack frames follow...)
7330@end group
7331@end smallexample
7332
7333@noindent
7334The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7335value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7336code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7337
7338@noindent
7339The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7340@code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7341only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7342@kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7343on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7344
7345@cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7346@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7347If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7348optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7349never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7350passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7351in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7352arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7353such a backtrace might look like:
7354
7355@smallexample
7356@group
7357#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7358 at builtin.c:993
7359#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7360#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7361 at macro.c:71
7362(More stack frames follow...)
7363@end group
7364@end smallexample
7365
7366@noindent
7367The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7368shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7369
7370If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7371either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7372you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7373
7374@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7375@cindex program entry point
7376@cindex startup code, and backtrace
7377Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7378libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7379@code{main}@footnote{
7380Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7381environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7382entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7383When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7384it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7385system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7386
7387If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7388in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7389
7390@table @code
7391@item set backtrace past-main
7392@itemx set backtrace past-main on
7393@kindex set backtrace
7394Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7395
7396@item set backtrace past-main off
7397Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7398default.
7399
7400@item show backtrace past-main
7401@kindex show backtrace
7402Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7403
7404@item set backtrace past-entry
7405@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7406Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7407This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7408and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7409
7410@item set backtrace past-entry off
7411Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7412application. This is the default.
7413
7414@item show backtrace past-entry
7415Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7416
7417@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7418@itemx set backtrace limit 0
7419@itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7420@cindex backtrace limit
7421Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7422or zero means unlimited levels.
7423
7424@item show backtrace limit
7425Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7426@end table
7427
7428You can control how file names are displayed.
7429
7430@table @code
7431@item set filename-display
7432@itemx set filename-display relative
7433@cindex filename-display
7434Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7435
7436@item set filename-display basename
7437Display only basename of a filename.
7438
7439@item set filename-display absolute
7440Display an absolute filename.
7441
7442@item show filename-display
7443Show the current way to display filenames.
7444@end table
7445
7446@node Selection
7447@section Selecting a Frame
7448
7449Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7450whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7451selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7452of the stack frame just selected.
7453
7454@table @code
7455@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7456@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7457@item frame @var{n}
7458@itemx f @var{n}
7459Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7460(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7461innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7462@code{main}.
7463
7464@item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7465@itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7466Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7467chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7468impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7469addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7470switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7471specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7472
7473@kindex up
7474@item up @var{n}
7475Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7476numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7477frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7478
7479@kindex down
7480@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7481@item down @var{n}
7482Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7483positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7484lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7485You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7486@end table
7487
7488All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7489frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7490arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7491frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7492
7493@need 1000
7494For example:
7495
7496@smallexample
7497@group
7498(@value{GDBP}) up
7499#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7500 at env.c:10
750110 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7502@end group
7503@end smallexample
7504
7505After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7506prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7507You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7508editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7509@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7510for details.
7511
7512@table @code
7513@kindex select-frame
7514@item select-frame
7515The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7516not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7517intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7518output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7519
7520@kindex down-silently
7521@kindex up-silently
7522@item up-silently @var{n}
7523@itemx down-silently @var{n}
7524These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7525respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7526causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7527in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7528distracting.
7529@end table
7530
7531@node Frame Info
7532@section Information About a Frame
7533
7534There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7535stack frame.
7536
7537@table @code
7538@item frame
7539@itemx f
7540When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7541frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7542selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7543argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7544@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7545
7546@kindex info frame
7547@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7548@item info frame
7549@itemx info f
7550This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7551including:
7552
7553@itemize @bullet
7554@item
7555the address of the frame
7556@item
7557the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7558@item
7559the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7560@item
7561the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7562@item
7563the address of the frame's arguments
7564@item
7565the address of the frame's local variables
7566@item
7567the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7568@item
7569which registers were saved in the frame
7570@end itemize
7571
7572@noindent The verbose description is useful when
7573something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7574the usual conventions.
7575
7576@item info frame @var{addr}
7577@itemx info f @var{addr}
7578Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7579selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7580command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7581architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7582@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7583
7584@kindex info args
7585@item info args
7586Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7587
7588@item info locals
7589@kindex info locals
7590Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7591line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7592accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7593
7594@end table
7595
7596@node Frame Filter Management
7597@section Management of Frame Filters.
7598@cindex managing frame filters
7599
7600Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7601output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7602
7603Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7604within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7605
7606@table @code
7607@kindex info frame-filter
7608@item info frame-filter
7609Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7610their name, priority and enabled status.
7611
7612@kindex disable frame-filter
7613@anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7614@item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7615Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7616@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7617@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7618@code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7619dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7620across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7621of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7622@var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7623may be enabled again later.
7624
7625@kindex enable frame-filter
7626@item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7627Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7628@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7629@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7630@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7631dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7632all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7633filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7634@var{filter-dictionary}.
7635
7636Example:
7637
7638@smallexample
7639(gdb) info frame-filter
7640
7641global frame-filters:
7642 Priority Enabled Name
7643 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7644 100 Yes Reverse
7645
7646progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7647 Priority Enabled Name
7648 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7649
7650objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7651 Priority Enabled Name
7652 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7653
7654(gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7655(gdb) info frame-filter
7656
7657global frame-filters:
7658 Priority Enabled Name
7659 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7660 100 Yes Reverse
7661
7662progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7663 Priority Enabled Name
7664 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7665
7666objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7667 Priority Enabled Name
7668 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7669
7670(gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7671(gdb) info frame-filter
7672
7673global frame-filters:
7674 Priority Enabled Name
7675 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7676 100 Yes Reverse
7677
7678progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7679 Priority Enabled Name
7680 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7681
7682objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7683 Priority Enabled Name
7684 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7685@end smallexample
7686
7687@kindex set frame-filter priority
7688@item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7689Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7690@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7691@var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7692@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7693dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7694
7695@kindex show frame-filter priority
7696@item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7697Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7698@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7699@var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7700@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7701dictionary resides.
7702
7703Example:
7704
7705@smallexample
7706(gdb) info frame-filter
7707
7708global frame-filters:
7709 Priority Enabled Name
7710 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7711 100 Yes Reverse
7712
7713progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7714 Priority Enabled Name
7715 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7716
7717objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7718 Priority Enabled Name
7719 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7720
7721(gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7722(gdb) info frame-filter
7723
7724global frame-filters:
7725 Priority Enabled Name
7726 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7727 50 Yes Reverse
7728
7729progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7730 Priority Enabled Name
7731 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7732
7733objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7734 Priority Enabled Name
7735 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7736@end smallexample
7737@end table
7738
7739@node Source
7740@chapter Examining Source Files
7741
7742@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7743information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7744used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7745the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7746(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7747execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7748source files by explicit command.
7749
7750If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7751prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7752@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7753
7754@menu
7755* List:: Printing source lines
7756* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7757* Edit:: Editing source files
7758* Search:: Searching source files
7759* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7760* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7761@end menu
7762
7763@node List
7764@section Printing Source Lines
7765
7766@kindex list
7767@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7768To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7769(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7770There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7771print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7772
7773Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7774
7775@table @code
7776@item list @var{linenum}
7777Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7778current source file.
7779
7780@item list @var{function}
7781Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7782@var{function}.
7783
7784@item list
7785Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7786@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7787printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7788as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7789Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7790
7791@item list -
7792Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7793@end table
7794
7795@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7796By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7797the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7798
7799@table @code
7800@kindex set listsize
7801@item set listsize @var{count}
7802@itemx set listsize unlimited
7803Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7804the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7805Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7806
7807@kindex show listsize
7808@item show listsize
7809Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7810@end table
7811
7812Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7813so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7814than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7815argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7816each repetition moves up in the source file.
7817
7818In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7819@dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7820of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7821to specify some source line.
7822
7823Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7824
7825@table @code
7826@item list @var{location}
7827Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7828
7829@item list @var{first},@var{last}
7830Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7831locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7832source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7833the same source file as the first location.
7834
7835@item list ,@var{last}
7836Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7837
7838@item list @var{first},
7839Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7840
7841@item list +
7842Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7843
7844@item list -
7845Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7846
7847@item list
7848As described in the preceding table.
7849@end table
7850
7851@node Specify Location
7852@section Specifying a Location
7853@cindex specifying location
7854@cindex location
7855@cindex source location
7856
7857@menu
7858* Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7859* Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7860* Address Locations:: Address locations
7861@end menu
7862
7863Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7864of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7865debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7866Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7867linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7868
7869@node Linespec Locations
7870@subsection Linespec Locations
7871@cindex linespec locations
7872
7873A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7874as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7875specifying a linespec:
7876
7877@table @code
7878@item @var{linenum}
7879Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7880
7881@item -@var{offset}
7882@itemx +@var{offset}
7883Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7884line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7885printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7886execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7887(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7888used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7889this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7890linespec.
7891
7892@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7893Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7894If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7895source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7896@var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7897name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7898@file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7899
7900@item @var{function}
7901Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7902For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7903
7904@item @var{function}:@var{label}
7905Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7906
7907@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7908Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7909in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7910function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7911functions in different source files.
7912
7913@item @var{label}
7914Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7915in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7916If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7917is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7918
7919@cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7920@item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7921The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7922applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7923information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7924specifies the location of such a static probe.
7925
7926If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7927or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7928If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7929If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7930each one of those probes.
7931@end table
7932
7933@node Explicit Locations
7934@subsection Explicit Locations
7935@cindex explicit locations
7936
7937@dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7938location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7939
7940Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7941file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7942sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7943line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7944explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7945
7946For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7947defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7948named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7949the symbol table to know.
7950
7951The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7952following table:
7953
7954@table @code
7955@item -source @var{filename}
7956The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7957files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7958to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7959@value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7960name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7961
7962@item -function @var{function}
7963The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7964on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7965or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7966In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7967
7968@item -label @var{label}
7969The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7970name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7971selected stack frame.
7972
7973@item -line @var{number}
7974The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7975be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7976the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7977relative to the current line.
7978@end table
7979
7980Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7981trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7982
7983@node Address Locations
7984@subsection Address Locations
7985@cindex address locations
7986
7987@dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7988the generalized form *@var{address}.
7989
7990For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7991specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7992other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7993parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7994source files.
7995
7996Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7997language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7998address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7999semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8000that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8001of @var{address}:
8002
8003@table @code
8004@item @var{expression}
8005Any expression valid in the current working language.
8006
8007@item @var{funcaddr}
8008An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8009C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8010simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8011of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8012@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8013(although the Pascal form also works).
8014
8015This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8016before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8017
8018@item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8019Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8020file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8021specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8022functions with identical names in different source files.
8023@end table
8024
8025@node Edit
8026@section Editing Source Files
8027@cindex editing source files
8028
8029@kindex edit
8030@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8031To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8032The editing program of your choice
8033is invoked with the current line set to
8034the active line in the program.
8035Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8036want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8037
8038@table @code
8039@item edit @var{location}
8040Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8041that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8042specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8043of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8044command most commonly used:
8045
8046@table @code
8047@item edit @var{number}
8048Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8049
8050@item edit @var{function}
8051Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8052@end table
8053
8054@end table
8055
8056@subsection Choosing your Editor
8057You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8058@footnote{
8059The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8060following command-line syntax:
8061@smallexample
8062ex +@var{number} file
8063@end smallexample
8064The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8065the file where to start editing.}.
8066By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8067by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8068@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8069@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8070@smallexample
8071EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8072export EDITOR
8073gdb @dots{}
8074@end smallexample
8075or in the @code{csh} shell,
8076@smallexample
8077setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8078gdb @dots{}
8079@end smallexample
8080
8081@node Search
8082@section Searching Source Files
8083@cindex searching source files
8084
8085There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8086regular expression.
8087
8088@table @code
8089@kindex search
8090@kindex forward-search
8091@kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8092@item forward-search @var{regexp}
8093@itemx search @var{regexp}
8094The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8095starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8096@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8097synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8098@code{fo}.
8099
8100@kindex reverse-search
8101@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8102The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8103with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8104for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8105this command as @code{rev}.
8106@end table
8107
8108@node Source Path
8109@section Specifying Source Directories
8110
8111@cindex source path
8112@cindex directories for source files
8113Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8114files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8115the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8116session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8117this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8118it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8119in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8120
8121For example, suppose an executable references the file
8122@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8123@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8124fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8125fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8126message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8127source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8128Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8129the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8130@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8131@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8132
8133Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8134names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8135instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8136is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8137@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8138that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8139
8140Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8141source files.
8142
8143Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8144any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8145each line is in the file.
8146
8147@kindex directory
8148@kindex dir
8149When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8150and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8151To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8152
8153The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8154script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8155
8156In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8157that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8158rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8159debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8160directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8161two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8162the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8163In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8164@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8165of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8166source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8167name to look up the sources.
8168
8169Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8170moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8171@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8172@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8173@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8174of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8175substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8176(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8177
8178To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8179@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8180For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8181@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8182not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8183is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8184not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8185
8186In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8187command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8188the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8189subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8190subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8191preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8192allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8193command.
8194
8195@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8196The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8197longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8198the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8199for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8200located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8201method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8202
8203@cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8204@cindex default source path substitution
8205You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8206configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8207@samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8208should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8209prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8210directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8211automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8212location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8213with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8214together.
8215
8216@table @code
8217@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8218@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8219Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8220directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8221(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8222part of absolute file names) or
8223whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8224path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8225
8226@kindex cdir
8227@kindex cwd
8228@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8229@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8230@cindex compilation directory
8231@cindex current directory
8232@cindex working directory
8233@cindex directory, current
8234@cindex directory, compilation
8235You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8236directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8237working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8238tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8239session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8240directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8241
8242@item directory
8243Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8244
8245@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8246@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8247
8248@item set directories @var{path-list}
8249@kindex set directories
8250Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8251@samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8252
8253@item show directories
8254@kindex show directories
8255Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8256
8257@anchor{set substitute-path}
8258@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8259@kindex set substitute-path
8260Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8261current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8262@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8263
8264For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8265@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8266
8267@smallexample
8268(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8269@end smallexample
8270
8271@noindent
8272will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8273@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8274@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8275
8276In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8277the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8278defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8279the substitution.
8280
8281For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8282
8283@smallexample
8284(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8285(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8286@end smallexample
8287
8288@noindent
8289@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8290@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8291use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8292@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8293
8294
8295@item unset substitute-path [path]
8296@kindex unset substitute-path
8297If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8298for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8299A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8300
8301If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8302
8303@item show substitute-path [path]
8304@kindex show substitute-path
8305If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8306which would rewrite that path, if any.
8307
8308If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8309rules.
8310
8311@end table
8312
8313If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8314interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8315versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8316
8317@enumerate
8318@item
8319Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8320
8321@item
8322Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8323directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8324directories in one command.
8325@end enumerate
8326
8327@node Machine Code
8328@section Source and Machine Code
8329@cindex source line and its code address
8330
8331You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8332addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8333a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8334@code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8335source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8336mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8337line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8338well as hex.
8339
8340@table @code
8341@kindex info line
8342@item info line @var{location}
8343Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8344source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8345the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8346@end table
8347
8348For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8349the object code for the first line of function
8350@code{m4_changequote}:
8351
8352@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8353@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8354@smallexample
8355(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8356Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8357@end smallexample
8358
8359@noindent
8360@cindex code address and its source line
8361We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8362@var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8363@smallexample
8364(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8365Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8366@end smallexample
8367
8368@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8369@cindex @code{x} command, default address
8370@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8371After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8372is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8373sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8374,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8375convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8376Variables}).
8377
8378@table @code
8379@kindex disassemble
8380@cindex assembly instructions
8381@cindex instructions, assembly
8382@cindex machine instructions
8383@cindex listing machine instructions
8384@item disassemble
8385@itemx disassemble /m
8386@itemx disassemble /s
8387@itemx disassemble /r
8388This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8389instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8390the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8391as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8392The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8393program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8394command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8395surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8396be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8397arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8398
8399@table @code
8400@item @var{start},@var{end}
8401the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8402@item @var{start},+@var{length}
8403the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8404@code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8405@end table
8406
8407@noindent
8408When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8409printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8410
8411The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8412@samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8413
8414If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8415the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8416@end table
8417
8418The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8419HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8420
8421@smallexample
8422(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8423Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8424 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8425 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8426 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8427 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8428 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8429 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8430 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8431 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8432End of assembler dump.
8433@end smallexample
8434
8435Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8436with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8437function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8438
8439@smallexample
8440(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8441Dump of assembler code for function main:
84425 @{
8443 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8444 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8445 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8446 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8447 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8448
84496 printf ("Hello.\n");
8450=> 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8451 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8452
84537 return 0;
84548 @}
8455 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8456 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8457 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8458
8459End of assembler dump.
8460@end smallexample
8461
8462The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8463there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8464The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8465Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8466@code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8467This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8468and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8469Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8470several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8471
8472@file{foo.h}:
8473
8474@smallexample
8475int
8476foo (int a)
8477@{
8478 if (a < 0)
8479 return a * 2;
8480 if (a == 0)
8481 return 1;
8482 return a + 10;
8483@}
8484@end smallexample
8485
8486@file{foo.c}:
8487
8488@smallexample
8489#include "foo.h"
8490volatile int x, y;
8491int
8492main ()
8493@{
8494 x = foo (y);
8495 return 0;
8496@}
8497@end smallexample
8498
8499@smallexample
8500(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8501Dump of assembler code for function main:
85025 @{
8503
85046 x = foo (y);
8505 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8506 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8507
85087 return 0;
85098 @}
8510 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8511 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8512 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8513 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8514
8515End of assembler dump.
8516(@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8517Dump of assembler code for function main:
8518foo.c:
85195 @{
85206 x = foo (y);
8521 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8522
8523foo.h:
85244 if (a < 0)
8525 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8526 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8527
85286 if (a == 0)
85297 return 1;
85308 return a + 10;
8531 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8532 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8533 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8534 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8535
8536foo.c:
85376 x = foo (y);
8538 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8539
85407 return 0;
85418 @}
8542 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8543 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8544
8545foo.h:
85465 return a * 2;
8547 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8548 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8549End of assembler dump.
8550@end smallexample
8551
8552Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8553
8554@smallexample
8555(gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8556Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8557 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8558 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8559 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8560 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8561End of assembler dump.
8562@end smallexample
8563
8564Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8565So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8566in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8567and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8568
8569Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8570mnemonics or other syntax.
8571
8572For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8573instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8574libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8575location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8576might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8577
8578@table @code
8579@kindex set disassembler-options
8580@cindex disassembler options
8581@item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8582This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8583the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8584@code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8585manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8586(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8587The default value is the empty string.
8588
8589If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8590multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8591Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8592and S/390.
8593
8594@kindex show disassembler-options
8595@item show disassembler-options
8596Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8597@end table
8598
8599@table @code
8600@kindex set disassembly-flavor
8601@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8602@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8603@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8604Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8605program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8606
8607Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8608can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8609The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8610assemblers for x86-based targets.
8611
8612@kindex show disassembly-flavor
8613@item show disassembly-flavor
8614Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8615@end table
8616
8617@table @code
8618@kindex set disassemble-next-line
8619@kindex show disassemble-next-line
8620@item set disassemble-next-line
8621@itemx show disassemble-next-line
8622Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8623line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8624display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8625program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8626displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8627possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8628(e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8629info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8630next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8631AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8632if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8633@value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8634with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8635OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8636instruction.
8637@end table
8638
8639
8640@node Data
8641@chapter Examining Data
8642
8643@cindex printing data
8644@cindex examining data
8645@kindex print
8646@kindex inspect
8647The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8648command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8649evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8650program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8651Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8652Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8653
8654@table @code
8655@item print @var{expr}
8656@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8657@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8658value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8659you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8660@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8661Formats}.
8662
8663@item print
8664@itemx print /@var{f}
8665@cindex reprint the last value
8666If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8667@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8668conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8669@end table
8670
8671A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8672It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8673specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8674
8675If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8676fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8677command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8678Table}.
8679
8680@cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8681@kindex explore
8682Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8683through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8684the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8685offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8686abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8687itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8688embedded in the higher level data types.
8689
8690@table @code
8691@item explore @var{arg}
8692@var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8693visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8694@end table
8695
8696The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8697example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8698C program as
8699
8700@smallexample
8701struct SimpleStruct
8702@{
8703 int i;
8704 double d;
8705@};
8706
8707struct ComplexStruct
8708@{
8709 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8710 int arr[10];
8711@};
8712@end smallexample
8713
8714@noindent
8715followed by variable declarations as
8716
8717@smallexample
8718struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8719struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8720@end smallexample
8721
8722@noindent
8723then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8724@code{explore} command as follows.
8725
8726@smallexample
8727(gdb) explore cs
8728The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8729the following fields:
8730
8731 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8732 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8733
8734Enter the field number of choice:
8735@end smallexample
8736
8737@noindent
8738Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8739prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8740the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8741pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8742the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8743value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8744be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8745field will be explored as if it were an array.
8746
8747@smallexample
8748`cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8749Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8750The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8751SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8752
8753 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8754 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8755
8756Press enter to return to parent value:
8757@end smallexample
8758
8759@noindent
8760If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8761entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8762prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8763to explore.
8764
8765@smallexample
8766`cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8767Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8768
8769`(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8770
8771(cs.arr)[5] = 4
8772
8773Press enter to return to parent value:
8774@end smallexample
8775
8776In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8777leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8778return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8779level data structure).
8780
8781Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8782explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8783variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8784program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8785same example as above, your can explore the type
8786@code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8787@code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8788
8789@smallexample
8790(gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8791@end smallexample
8792
8793@noindent
8794By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8795session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8796manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8797example.
8798
8799The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8800@code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8801a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8802being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8803exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8804
8805@table @code
8806@item explore value @var{expr}
8807@cindex explore value
8808This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8809expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8810current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8811command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8812command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8813
8814@item explore type @var{arg}
8815@cindex explore type
8816This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8817@var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8818debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8819is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8820debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8821identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8822argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8823this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8824being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8825@end table
8826
8827@menu
8828* Expressions:: Expressions
8829* Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8830* Variables:: Program variables
8831* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8832* Output Formats:: Output formats
8833* Memory:: Examining memory
8834* Auto Display:: Automatic display
8835* Print Settings:: Print settings
8836* Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8837* Value History:: Value history
8838* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8839* Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8840* Registers:: Registers
8841* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8842* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8843* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8844* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8845* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8846* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8847* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8848 character set than GDB does
8849* Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8850* Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8851* Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8852@end menu
8853
8854@node Expressions
8855@section Expressions
8856
8857@cindex expressions
8858@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8859compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8860by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8861@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8862casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8863you compiled your program to include this information; see
8864@ref{Compilation}.
8865
8866@cindex arrays in expressions
8867@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8868the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8869you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8870of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8871to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8872is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8873
8874Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8875this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8876Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8877languages.
8878
8879In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8880expressions regardless of your programming language.
8881
8882@cindex casts, in expressions
8883Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8884useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8885at that address in memory.
8886@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8887
8888@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8889to programming languages:
8890
8891@table @code
8892@item @@
8893@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8894@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8895
8896@item ::
8897@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8898function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8899
8900@cindex @{@var{type}@}
8901@cindex type casting memory
8902@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8903@cindex casts, to view memory
8904@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8905Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8906memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8907an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8908operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8909of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8910@end table
8911
8912@node Ambiguous Expressions
8913@section Ambiguous Expressions
8914@cindex ambiguous expressions
8915
8916Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8917some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8918a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8919different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8920involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8921templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8922the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8923
8924In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8925the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8926can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8927@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8928qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8929as well.
8930
8931When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8932has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8933possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8934The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8935aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8936used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8937menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8938choices.
8939
8940For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8941breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8942We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8943
8944@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8945@smallexample
8946@group
8947(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8948[0] cancel
8949[1] all
8950[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8951[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8952[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8953[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8954[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8955[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8956> 2 4 6
8957Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8958Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8959Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8960Multiple breakpoints were set.
8961Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8962 breakpoints.
8963(@value{GDBP})
8964@end group
8965@end smallexample
8966
8967@table @code
8968@kindex set multiple-symbols
8969@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8970@cindex multiple-symbols menu
8971
8972This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8973is ambiguous.
8974
8975By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8976the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8977automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8978a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8979inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8980then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8981For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8982in the use of the menu.
8983
8984When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8985when an ambiguity is detected.
8986
8987Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8988an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8989
8990@kindex show multiple-symbols
8991@item show multiple-symbols
8992Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8993@end table
8994
8995@node Variables
8996@section Program Variables
8997
8998The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8999in your program.
9000
9001Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9002(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9003
9004@itemize @bullet
9005@item
9006global (or file-static)
9007@end itemize
9008
9009@noindent or
9010
9011@itemize @bullet
9012@item
9013visible according to the scope rules of the
9014programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9015@end itemize
9016
9017@noindent This means that in the function
9018
9019@smallexample
9020foo (a)
9021 int a;
9022@{
9023 bar (a);
9024 @{
9025 int b = test ();
9026 bar (b);
9027 @}
9028@}
9029@end smallexample
9030
9031@noindent
9032you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9033executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9034examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9035the block where @code{b} is declared.
9036
9037@cindex variable name conflict
9038There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9039scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9040in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9041function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9042happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9043you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9044using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9045
9046@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9047@ifnotinfo
9048@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9049@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9050@end ifnotinfo
9051@smallexample
9052@var{file}::@var{variable}
9053@var{function}::@var{variable}
9054@end smallexample
9055
9056@noindent
9057Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9058static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9059make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9060to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9061
9062@smallexample
9063(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9064@end smallexample
9065
9066The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9067static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9068in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9069simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9070to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9071
9072@smallexample
9073void
9074foo (int a)
9075@{
9076 if (a < 10)
9077 bar (a);
9078 else
9079 process (a); /* Stop here */
9080@}
9081
9082int
9083bar (int a)
9084@{
9085 foo (a + 5);
9086@}
9087@end smallexample
9088
9089@noindent
9090For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9091here is what you might see
9092when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9093
9094@smallexample
9095(@value{GDBP}) p a
9096$1 = 10
9097(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9098$2 = 5
9099(@value{GDBP}) up 2
9100#2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9101(@value{GDBP}) p a
9102$3 = 5
9103(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9104$4 = 0
9105@end smallexample
9106
9107@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9108These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9109similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9110conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9111overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9112
9113For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9114that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9115include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9116@code{some_global}.
9117
9118@smallexample
9119(@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9120$1 = 23
9121(@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9122A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9123(@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9124$2 = 27
9125@end smallexample
9126
9127@cindex wrong values
9128@cindex variable values, wrong
9129@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9130@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9131@quotation
9132@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9133wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9134scope, and just before exit.
9135@end quotation
9136You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9137This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9138set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9139stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9140values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9141also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9142after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9143variable definitions may be gone.
9144
9145This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9146To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9147when compiling.
9148
9149@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9150Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9151unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9152opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9153offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9154might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9155happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9156
9157@smallexample
9158No symbol "foo" in current context.
9159@end smallexample
9160
9161To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9162different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9163formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9164options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9165info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9166
9167If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9168@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9169by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9170type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9171
9172@cindex no debug info variables
9173If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9174which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9175includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9176@xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9177cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9178variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9179example, in a C program:
9180
9181@smallexample
9182 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9183 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9184 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9185 $1 = 3.14
9186@end smallexample
9187
9188If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9189value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9190error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9191Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9192to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9193
9194@smallexample
9195Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
919629 i++;
9197(gdb) next
919830 e (i);
9199(gdb) print i
9200$1 = 31
9201(gdb) print i@@entry
9202$2 = 30
9203@end smallexample
9204
9205Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9206signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9207printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9208@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9209defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9210For program code
9211
9212@smallexample
9213char var0[] = "A";
9214signed char var1[] = "A";
9215@end smallexample
9216
9217You get during debugging
9218@smallexample
9219(gdb) print var0
9220$1 = "A"
9221(gdb) print var1
9222$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9223@end smallexample
9224
9225@node Arrays
9226@section Artificial Arrays
9227
9228@cindex artificial array
9229@cindex arrays
9230@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9231It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9232same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9233dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9234program.
9235
9236You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9237@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9238operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9239and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9240of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9241the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9242argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9243following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9244example. If a program says
9245
9246@smallexample
9247int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9248@end smallexample
9249
9250@noindent
9251you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9252
9253@smallexample
9254p *array@@len
9255@end smallexample
9256
9257The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9258with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9259subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9260Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9261(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9262
9263Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9264This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9265The value need not be in memory:
9266@smallexample
9267(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9268$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9269@end smallexample
9270
9271As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9272@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9273the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9274@smallexample
9275(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9276$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9277@end smallexample
9278
9279Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9280moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9281actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9282of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9283to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9284Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9285interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9286instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9287structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9288in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9289
9290@smallexample
9291set $i = 0
9292p dtab[$i++]->fv
9293@key{RET}
9294@key{RET}
9295@dots{}
9296@end smallexample
9297
9298@node Output Formats
9299@section Output Formats
9300
9301@cindex formatted output
9302@cindex output formats
9303By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9304this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9305in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9306at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9307these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9308
9309The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9310already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9311@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9312letters supported are:
9313
9314@table @code
9315@item x
9316Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9317hexadecimal.
9318
9319@item d
9320Print as integer in signed decimal.
9321
9322@item u
9323Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9324
9325@item o
9326Print as integer in octal.
9327
9328@item t
9329Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9330@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9331used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9332see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9333
9334@item a
9335@cindex unknown address, locating
9336@cindex locate address
9337Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9338the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9339where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9340
9341@smallexample
9342(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9343$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9344@end smallexample
9345
9346@noindent
9347The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9348@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9349
9350@item c
9351Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9352prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9353character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9354for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9355
9356Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9357@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9358constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9359data.
9360
9361@item f
9362Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9363using typical floating point syntax.
9364
9365@item s
9366@cindex printing strings
9367@cindex printing byte arrays
9368Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9369data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9370are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9371natural types.
9372
9373Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9374@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9375strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9376array.
9377
9378@item z
9379Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9380printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9381to the size of the integer type.
9382
9383@item r
9384@cindex raw printing
9385Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9386use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9387Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9388value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9389pretty-printer which might exist.
9390@end table
9391
9392For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9393
9394@smallexample
9395p/x $pc
9396@end smallexample
9397
9398@noindent
9399Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9400names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9401
9402To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9403you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9404expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9405
9406@node Memory
9407@section Examining Memory
9408
9409You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9410any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9411
9412@cindex examining memory
9413@table @code
9414@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9415@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9416@itemx x @var{addr}
9417@itemx x
9418Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9419@end table
9420
9421@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9422much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9423expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9424If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9425Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9426
9427@table @r
9428@item @var{n}, the repeat count
9429The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9430how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9431number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9432@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9433@c 4.1.2.
9434
9435@item @var{f}, the display format
9436The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9437(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9438@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9439The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9440each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9441
9442@item @var{u}, the unit size
9443The unit size is any of
9444
9445@table @code
9446@item b
9447Bytes.
9448@item h
9449Halfwords (two bytes).
9450@item w
9451Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9452@item g
9453Giant words (eight bytes).
9454@end table
9455
9456Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9457default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9458the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9459the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9460Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
946132-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9462Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9463current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9464modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9465UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9466be altered.
9467
9468@item @var{addr}, starting display address
9469@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9470memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9471it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9472@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9473@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9474other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9475the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9476starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9477a value from memory).
9478@end table
9479
9480For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9481(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9482starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9483words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9484@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9485
9486You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9487from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9488halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9489
9490Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9491letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9492unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9493specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9494(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9495
9496Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9497and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9498@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9499including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9500the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9501slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9502follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9503@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9504instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9505
9506If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9507the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9508address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9509format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9510instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9511available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9512
9513All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9514easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9515you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9516instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9517with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9518the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9519for successive uses of @code{x}.
9520
9521When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9522counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9523
9524@smallexample
9525(@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9526 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9527 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9528 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9529=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9530 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9531@end smallexample
9532
9533@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9534The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9535in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9536would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9537subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9538@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9539examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9540@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9541the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9542
9543If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9544are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9545address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9546
9547@anchor{addressable memory unit}
9548@cindex addressable memory unit
9549Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9550that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9551targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9552Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9553@dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9554when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9555@dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9556the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9557addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9558
9559@cindex remote memory comparison
9560@cindex target memory comparison
9561@cindex verify remote memory image
9562@cindex verify target memory image
9563When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9564(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9565in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9566downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9567whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9568@code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9569
9570@table @code
9571@kindex compare-sections
9572@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9573Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9574executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9575the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9576arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9577@code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9578
9579Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9580target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9581(@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9582@end table
9583
9584@node Auto Display
9585@section Automatic Display
9586@cindex automatic display
9587@cindex display of expressions
9588
9589If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9590(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9591display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9592Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9593to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9594The automatic display looks like this:
9595
9596@smallexample
95972: foo = 38
95983: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9599@end smallexample
9600
9601@noindent
9602This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9603displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9604specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9605whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9606specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9607or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9608
9609@table @code
9610@kindex display
9611@item display @var{expr}
9612Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9613each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9614
9615@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9616
9617@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9618For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9619count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9620arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9621@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9622
9623@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9624For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9625number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9626be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9627doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9628@end table
9629
9630For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9631instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9632is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9633
9634@table @code
9635@kindex delete display
9636@kindex undisplay
9637@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9638@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9639Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9640numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9641argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9642numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9643or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9644
9645@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9646(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9647
9648@kindex disable display
9649@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9650Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9651item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9652enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9653want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9654single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9655the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9656numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9657
9658@kindex enable display
9659@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9660Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9661again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9662Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9663command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9664of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9665display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9666
9667@item display
9668Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9669done when your program stops.
9670
9671@kindex info display
9672@item info display
9673Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9674automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9675values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9676It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9677because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9678@end table
9679
9680@cindex display disabled out of scope
9681If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9682sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9683expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9684variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9685@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9686@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9687continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9688there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9689automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9690is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9691
9692@node Print Settings
9693@section Print Settings
9694
9695@cindex format options
9696@cindex print settings
9697@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9698and symbols are printed.
9699
9700@noindent
9701These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9702
9703@table @code
9704@kindex set print
9705@item set print address
9706@itemx set print address on
9707@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9708@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9709traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9710even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9711is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9712@code{set print address on}:
9713
9714@smallexample
9715@group
9716(@value{GDBP}) f
9717#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9718 at input.c:530
9719530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9720@end group
9721@end smallexample
9722
9723@item set print address off
9724Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9725this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9726
9727@smallexample
9728@group
9729(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9730(@value{GDBP}) f
9731#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9732530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9733@end group
9734@end smallexample
9735
9736You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9737dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9738@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9739all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9740
9741@kindex show print
9742@item show print address
9743Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9744@end table
9745
9746When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9747closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9748identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9749source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9750@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9751you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9752it prints a symbolic address:
9753
9754@table @code
9755@item set print symbol-filename on
9756@cindex source file and line of a symbol
9757@cindex symbol, source file and line
9758Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9759symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9760
9761@item set print symbol-filename off
9762Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9763default.
9764
9765@item show print symbol-filename
9766Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9767line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9768@end table
9769
9770Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9771numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9772number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9773
9774Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9775printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9776
9777@table @code
9778@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9779@itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9780@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9781Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9782offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9783@var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9784to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9785it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9786
9787@item show print max-symbolic-offset
9788Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9789symbolic address.
9790@end table
9791
9792@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9793@cindex pointer, finding referent
9794If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9795@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9796and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9797@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9798For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9799at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9800
9801@smallexample
9802(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9803(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9804$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9805@end smallexample
9806
9807@quotation
9808@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9809does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9810the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9811@end quotation
9812
9813You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9814@samp{set print symbol on}:
9815
9816@table @code
9817@item set print symbol on
9818Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9819one exists.
9820
9821@item set print symbol off
9822Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9823address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9824corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9825
9826@item show print symbol
9827Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9828address.
9829@end table
9830
9831Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9832
9833@table @code
9834@item set print array
9835@itemx set print array on
9836@cindex pretty print arrays
9837Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9838but uses more space. The default is off.
9839
9840@item set print array off
9841Return to compressed format for arrays.
9842
9843@item show print array
9844Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9845arrays.
9846
9847@cindex print array indexes
9848@item set print array-indexes
9849@itemx set print array-indexes on
9850Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9851convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9852index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9853
9854@item set print array-indexes off
9855Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9856
9857@item show print array-indexes
9858Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9859arrays.
9860
9861@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9862@itemx set print elements unlimited
9863@cindex number of array elements to print
9864@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9865Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9866If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9867printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9868This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9869When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9870Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9871that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9872
9873@item show print elements
9874Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9875If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9876
9877@item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9878@kindex set print frame-arguments
9879@cindex printing frame argument values
9880@cindex print all frame argument values
9881@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9882@cindex do not print frame argument values
9883This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9884when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9885values are:
9886
9887@table @code
9888@item all
9889The values of all arguments are printed.
9890
9891@item scalars
9892Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9893complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9894by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9895only scalar arguments are shown:
9896
9897@smallexample
9898#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9899 at frame-args.c:23
9900@end smallexample
9901
9902@item none
9903None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9904is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9905
9906@smallexample
9907#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9908 at frame-args.c:23
9909@end smallexample
9910@end table
9911
9912By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9913to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9914of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9915of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9916information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9917Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9918the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9919especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9920to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9921thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9922
9923@item show print frame-arguments
9924Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9925
9926@item set print raw frame-arguments on
9927Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9928
9929@item set print raw frame-arguments off
9930Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9931for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9932otherwise print the value in raw form.
9933This is the default.
9934
9935@item show print raw frame-arguments
9936Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9937
9938@anchor{set print entry-values}
9939@item set print entry-values @var{value}
9940@kindex set print entry-values
9941Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9942@value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9943the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9944and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9945unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9946
9947The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9948@value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9949this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9950@code{no} setting.
9951
9952This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9953the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9954@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9955this information.
9956
9957The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9958
9959@table @code
9960@item no
9961Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9962point.
9963@smallexample
9964#0 equal (val=5)
9965#0 different (val=6)
9966#0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9967#0 born (val=10)
9968#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9969@end smallexample
9970
9971@item only
9972Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9973values are never printed.
9974@smallexample
9975#0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9976#0 different (val@@entry=5)
9977#0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9978#0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9979#0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9980@end smallexample
9981
9982@item preferred
9983Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9984entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9985value for such parameter.
9986@smallexample
9987#0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9988#0 different (val@@entry=5)
9989#0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9990#0 born (val=10)
9991#0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9992@end smallexample
9993
9994@item if-needed
9995Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9996value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9997parameter.
9998@smallexample
9999#0 equal (val=5)
10000#0 different (val=6)
10001#0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10002#0 born (val=10)
10003#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10004@end smallexample
10005
10006@item both
10007Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10008point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10009optimizations.
10010@smallexample
10011#0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10012#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10013#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10014#0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10015#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10016@end smallexample
10017
10018@item compact
10019Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10020function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10021value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10022values are known and identical, print the shortened
10023@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10024@smallexample
10025#0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10026#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10027#0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10028#0 born (val=10)
10029#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10030@end smallexample
10031
10032@item default
10033Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10034entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10035if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10036@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10037@smallexample
10038#0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10039#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10040#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10041#0 born (val=10)
10042#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10043@end smallexample
10044@end table
10045
10046For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10047entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10048
10049@item show print entry-values
10050Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10051entry.
10052
10053@item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10054@itemx set print repeats unlimited
10055@cindex repeated array elements
10056Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10057elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10058array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10059@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10060identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10061themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10062cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10063is 10.
10064
10065@item show print repeats
10066Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10067elements.
10068
10069@item set print null-stop
10070@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10071Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10072@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10073contain only short strings.
10074The default is off.
10075
10076@item show print null-stop
10077Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10078@sc{null} character.
10079
10080@item set print pretty on
10081@cindex print structures in indented form
10082@cindex indentation in structure display
10083Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10084per line, like this:
10085
10086@smallexample
10087@group
10088$1 = @{
10089 next = 0x0,
10090 flags = @{
10091 sweet = 1,
10092 sour = 1
10093 @},
10094 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10095@}
10096@end group
10097@end smallexample
10098
10099@item set print pretty off
10100Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10101
10102@smallexample
10103@group
10104$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10105meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10106@end group
10107@end smallexample
10108
10109@noindent
10110This is the default format.
10111
10112@item show print pretty
10113Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10114
10115@item set print sevenbit-strings on
10116@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10117@cindex octal escapes in strings
10118Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10119@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10120character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10121best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10122high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10123
10124@item set print sevenbit-strings off
10125Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10126international character sets, and is the default.
10127
10128@item show print sevenbit-strings
10129Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10130
10131@item set print union on
10132@cindex unions in structures, printing
10133Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10134and other unions. This is the default setting.
10135
10136@item set print union off
10137Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10138structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10139instead.
10140
10141@item show print union
10142Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10143structures and other unions.
10144
10145For example, given the declarations
10146
10147@smallexample
10148typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10149typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10150typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10151 Bug_forms;
10152
10153struct thing @{
10154 Species it;
10155 union @{
10156 Tree_forms tree;
10157 Bug_forms bug;
10158 @} form;
10159@};
10160
10161struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10162@end smallexample
10163
10164@noindent
10165with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10166
10167@smallexample
10168$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10169@end smallexample
10170
10171@noindent
10172and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10173
10174@smallexample
10175$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10176@end smallexample
10177
10178@noindent
10179@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10180and in Pascal.
10181@end table
10182
10183@need 1000
10184@noindent
10185These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10186
10187@table @code
10188@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10189@item set print demangle
10190@itemx set print demangle on
10191Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10192(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10193linkage. The default is on.
10194
10195@item show print demangle
10196Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10197
10198@item set print asm-demangle
10199@itemx set print asm-demangle on
10200Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10201in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10202The default is off.
10203
10204@item show print asm-demangle
10205Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10206or demangled form.
10207
10208@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10209@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10210@kindex set demangle-style
10211@item set demangle-style @var{style}
10212Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10213represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10214
10215@table @code
10216@item auto
10217Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10218This is the default.
10219
10220@item gnu
10221Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10222
10223@item hp
10224Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10225
10226@item lucid
10227Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10228
10229@item arm
10230Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10231@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10232debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10233require further enhancement to permit that.
10234
10235@end table
10236If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10237
10238@item show demangle-style
10239Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10240
10241@item set print object
10242@itemx set print object on
10243@cindex derived type of an object, printing
10244@cindex display derived types
10245When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10246(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10247the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10248required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10249type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10250type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10251working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10252
10253@item set print object off
10254Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10255virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10256
10257@item show print object
10258Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10259
10260@item set print static-members
10261@itemx set print static-members on
10262@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10263Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10264
10265@item set print static-members off
10266Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10267
10268@item show print static-members
10269Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10270
10271@item set print pascal_static-members
10272@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10273@cindex static members of Pascal objects
10274@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10275Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10276
10277@item set print pascal_static-members off
10278Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10279
10280@item show print pascal_static-members
10281Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10282
10283@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10284@item set print vtbl
10285@itemx set print vtbl on
10286@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10287@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10288@cindex VTBL display
10289Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10290(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10291ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10292
10293@item set print vtbl off
10294Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10295
10296@item show print vtbl
10297Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10298@end table
10299
10300@node Pretty Printing
10301@section Pretty Printing
10302
10303@value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10304Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10305mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10306
10307@menu
10308* Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10309* Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10310* Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10311@end menu
10312
10313@node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10314@subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10315
10316When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10317registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10318pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10319
10320Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10321The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10322pretty-printers with their names.
10323If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10324@dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10325Each such subprinter has its own name.
10326The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10327
10328Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10329Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10330debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10331do anything special.
10332
10333There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10334
10335@itemize @bullet
10336@item
10337Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10338all inferiors.
10339
10340@item
10341Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10342when debugging that program.
10343@xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10344
10345@item
10346Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10347with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10348@xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10349@end itemize
10350
10351@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10352pretty-printers are selected,
10353
10354@xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10355for new types.
10356
10357@node Pretty-Printer Example
10358@subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10359
10360Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10361
10362@smallexample
10363(@value{GDBP}) print s
10364$1 = @{
10365 static npos = 4294967295,
10366 _M_dataplus = @{
10367 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10368 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10369 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10370 @},
10371 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10372 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10373 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10374 @}
10375@}
10376@end smallexample
10377
10378With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10379
10380@smallexample
10381(@value{GDBP}) print s
10382$2 = "abcd"
10383@end smallexample
10384
10385@node Pretty-Printer Commands
10386@subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10387@cindex pretty-printer commands
10388
10389@table @code
10390@kindex info pretty-printer
10391@item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10392Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10393This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10394
10395@var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10396whose pretty-printers to list.
10397Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10398(@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10399and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10400@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10401looks up a printer from these three objects.
10402
10403@var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10404to list.
10405
10406@kindex disable pretty-printer
10407@item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10408Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10409A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10410
10411@kindex enable pretty-printer
10412@item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10413Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10414@end table
10415
10416Example:
10417
10418Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10419named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10420another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10421@code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10422
10423@smallexample
10424(gdb) info pretty-printer
10425library1.so:
10426 foo
10427library2.so:
10428 bar
10429 bar1
10430 bar2
10431(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10432library2.so:
10433 bar
10434 bar1
10435 bar2
10436(gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
104371 printer disabled
104382 of 3 printers enabled
10439(gdb) info pretty-printer
10440library1.so:
10441 foo [disabled]
10442library2.so:
10443 bar
10444 bar1
10445 bar2
10446(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
104471 printer disabled
104481 of 3 printers enabled
10449(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10450library1.so:
10451 foo [disabled]
10452library2.so:
10453 bar
10454 bar1 [disabled]
10455 bar2
10456(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
104571 printer disabled
104580 of 3 printers enabled
10459(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10460library1.so:
10461 foo [disabled]
10462library2.so:
10463 bar [disabled]
10464 bar1 [disabled]
10465 bar2
10466@end smallexample
10467
10468Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10469as can each individual subprinter.
10470
10471@node Value History
10472@section Value History
10473
10474@cindex value history
10475@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10476Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10477@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10478Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10479(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10480When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10481since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10482symbol table.
10483
10484@cindex @code{$}
10485@cindex @code{$$}
10486@cindex history number
10487The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10488refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10489@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10490printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10491history number.
10492
10493To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10494history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10495remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10496the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10497@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10498is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10499@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10500
10501For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10502want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10503
10504@smallexample
10505p *$
10506@end smallexample
10507
10508If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10509to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10510
10511@smallexample
10512p *$.next
10513@end smallexample
10514
10515@noindent
10516You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10517command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10518
10519Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10520@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10521
10522@smallexample
10523print x
10524set x=5
10525@end smallexample
10526
10527@noindent
10528then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10529remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10530
10531@table @code
10532@kindex show values
10533@item show values
10534Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10535This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10536values} does not change the history.
10537
10538@item show values @var{n}
10539Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10540
10541@item show values +
10542Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10543values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10544@end table
10545
10546Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10547same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10548
10549@node Convenience Vars
10550@section Convenience Variables
10551
10552@cindex convenience variables
10553@cindex user-defined variables
10554@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10555@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10556exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10557setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10558of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10559
10560Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10561@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10562the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10563(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10564by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10565
10566You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10567expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10568For example:
10569
10570@smallexample
10571set $foo = *object_ptr
10572@end smallexample
10573
10574@noindent
10575would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10576@code{object_ptr}.
10577
10578Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10579value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10580value with another assignment at any time.
10581
10582Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10583variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10584that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10585variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10586
10587@table @code
10588@kindex show convenience
10589@cindex show all user variables and functions
10590@item show convenience
10591Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10592as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10593Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10594
10595@kindex init-if-undefined
10596@cindex convenience variables, initializing
10597@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10598Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10599for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10600to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10601convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10602override default values used in a command script.
10603
10604If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10605any side-effects do not occur.
10606@end table
10607
10608One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10609incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10610a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10611
10612@smallexample
10613set $i = 0
10614print bar[$i++]->contents
10615@end smallexample
10616
10617@noindent
10618Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10619
10620Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10621values likely to be useful.
10622
10623@table @code
10624@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10625@item $_
10626The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10627the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10628commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10629set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10630and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10631except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10632to the type of @code{$__}.
10633
10634@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10635@item $__
10636The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10637to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10638to match the format in which the data was printed.
10639
10640@item $_exitcode
10641@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10642When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10643automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10644resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10645
10646@item $_exitsignal
10647@vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10648When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10649@value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10650and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10651
10652To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10653(i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10654@code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10655@code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10656Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10657
10658@smallexample
10659#include <signal.h>
10660
10661int
10662main (int argc, char *argv[])
10663@{
10664 raise (SIGALRM);
10665 return 0;
10666@}
10667@end smallexample
10668
10669A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10670or signalled would be:
10671
10672@smallexample
10673(@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10674Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10675End with a line saying just ``end''.
10676>if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10677 >echo The program has exited\n
10678 >else
10679 >echo The program has signalled\n
10680 >end
10681>end
10682(@value{GDBP}) run
10683Starting program:
10684
10685Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10686The program no longer exists.
10687(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10688The program has signalled
10689@end smallexample
10690
10691As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10692debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10693@code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10694@code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10695
10696@smallexample
10697(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10698The program has exited
10699@end smallexample
10700
10701@item $_exception
10702The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10703thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10704
10705@item $_probe_argc
10706@itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10707Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10708
10709@item $_sdata
10710@vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10711The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10712data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10713@code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10714if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10715
10716@item $_siginfo
10717@vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10718The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10719(@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10720could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10721For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10722
10723@item $_tlb
10724@vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10725The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10726applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10727gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10728@xref{General Query Packets}.
10729This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10730
10731@item $_inferior
10732The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10733Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10734
10735@item $_thread
10736The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10737
10738@item $_gthread
10739The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10740
10741@end table
10742
10743@node Convenience Funs
10744@section Convenience Functions
10745
10746@cindex convenience functions
10747@value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10748have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10749function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10750however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10751@value{GDBN}.
10752
10753These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10754@code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10755
10756@table @code
10757
10758@item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10759@findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10760Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10761returns zero.
10762
10763A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10764is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10765(see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10766it is @code{void}:
10767
10768@smallexample
10769(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10770$1 = void
10771(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10772$2 = 1
10773(@value{GDBP}) run
10774Starting program: ./a.out
10775[Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10776(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10777$3 = 0
10778(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10779$4 = 0
10780@end smallexample
10781
10782In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10783@code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10784program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10785be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10786execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10787@code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10788anymore.
10789
10790The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10791program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10792
10793@smallexample
10794void
10795foo (void)
10796@{
10797@}
10798@end smallexample
10799
10800The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10801
10802@smallexample
10803(@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10804$1 = void
10805(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10806$2 = 1
10807(@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10808(@value{GDBP}) print $v
10809$3 = void
10810(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10811$4 = 1
10812@end smallexample
10813
10814@end table
10815
10816These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10817@code{Python} support.
10818
10819@table @code
10820
10821@item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10822@findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10823Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10824@var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10825Otherwise it returns zero.
10826
10827@item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10828@findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10829Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10830@var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10831The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10832regular expression support.
10833
10834@item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10835@findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10836Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10837Otherwise it returns zero.
10838
10839@item $_strlen(@var{str})
10840@findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10841Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10842
10843@item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10844@findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10845Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10846Otherwise it returns zero.
10847
10848If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10849it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10850The default is 1.
10851
10852Example:
10853
10854@smallexample
10855(gdb) backtrace
10856#0 bottom_func ()
10857 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10858#1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10859 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10860#2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10861 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10862#3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10863 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10864(gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10865$1 = 1
10866(gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10867$1 = 1
10868@end smallexample
10869
10870@item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10871@findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10872Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10873@var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10874
10875If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10876it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10877The default is 1.
10878
10879@item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10880@findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10881Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10882Otherwise it returns zero.
10883
10884If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10885it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10886The default is 1.
10887
10888This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10889checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10890by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10891frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10892
10893@item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10894@findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10895Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10896@var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10897
10898If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10899it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10900The default is 1.
10901
10902This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10903checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10904by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10905frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10906
10907@item $_as_string(@var{value})
10908@findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10909Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10910
10911This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10912enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10913an enumerated type:
10914
10915@smallexample
10916(gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10917Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10918@end smallexample
10919
10920@end table
10921
10922@value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10923convenience functions.
10924
10925@table @code
10926@item help function
10927@kindex help function
10928@cindex show all convenience functions
10929Print a list of all convenience functions.
10930@end table
10931
10932@node Registers
10933@section Registers
10934
10935@cindex registers
10936You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10937with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10938for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10939your machine.
10940
10941@table @code
10942@kindex info registers
10943@item info registers
10944Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10945and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10946
10947@kindex info all-registers
10948@cindex floating point registers
10949@item info all-registers
10950Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10951and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10952
10953@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10954Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10955As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10956the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10957the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10958@end table
10959
10960@anchor{standard registers}
10961@cindex stack pointer register
10962@cindex program counter register
10963@cindex process status register
10964@cindex frame pointer register
10965@cindex standard registers
10966@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10967expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10968architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10969@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10970the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10971pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10972register that contains the processor status. For example,
10973you could print the program counter in hex with
10974
10975@smallexample
10976p/x $pc
10977@end smallexample
10978
10979@noindent
10980or print the instruction to be executed next with
10981
10982@smallexample
10983x/i $pc
10984@end smallexample
10985
10986@noindent
10987or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10988one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10989memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10990stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10991stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10992regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10993see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10994
10995@smallexample
10996set $sp += 4
10997@end smallexample
10998
10999Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11000your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11001so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11002shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11003registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11004can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11005is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11006
11007@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11008integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11009special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11010registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11011to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11012(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11013@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11014
11015Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11016means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11017the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11018sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11019coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11020programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11021cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11022that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11023prints the data in both formats.
11024
11025@cindex SSE registers (x86)
11026@cindex MMX registers (x86)
11027Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11028in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11029have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11030together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11031registers in @code{struct} notation:
11032
11033@smallexample
11034(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11035$1 = @{
11036 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11037 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11038 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11039 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11040 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11041 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11042 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11043@}
11044@end smallexample
11045
11046@noindent
11047To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11048view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11049value to a @code{struct} member:
11050
11051@smallexample
11052 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11053@end smallexample
11054
11055Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11056(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11057value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11058were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11059true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11060frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11061
11062@cindex caller-saved registers
11063@cindex call-clobbered registers
11064@cindex volatile registers
11065@cindex <not saved> values
11066Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11067callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11068registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11069the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11070frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11071@value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11072(``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11073machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11074saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11075its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11076explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11077displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11078that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11079if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11080in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11081This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11082the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11083call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11084however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11085may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11086frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11087register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11088represent the value the register had just before the call.
11089
11090@node Floating Point Hardware
11091@section Floating Point Hardware
11092@cindex floating point
11093
11094Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11095you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11096
11097@table @code
11098@kindex info float
11099@item info float
11100Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11101point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11102floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11103the ARM and x86 machines.
11104@end table
11105
11106@node Vector Unit
11107@section Vector Unit
11108@cindex vector unit
11109
11110Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11111more information about the status of the vector unit.
11112
11113@table @code
11114@kindex info vector
11115@item info vector
11116Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11117layout vary depending on the hardware.
11118@end table
11119
11120@node OS Information
11121@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11122@cindex OS information
11123
11124@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11125you debug your program.
11126
11127@cindex auxiliary vector
11128@cindex vector, auxiliary
11129Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11130startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11131specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11132binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11133hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11134identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11135Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11136@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11137targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11138support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11139@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11140
11141@table @code
11142@kindex info auxv
11143@item info auxv
11144Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11145live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11146numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11147tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11148pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11149most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11150an unrecognized tag.
11151@end table
11152
11153On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11154information and show it to you. The types of information available
11155will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11156target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11157@ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11158functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11159@samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11160
11161@table @code
11162@kindex info os
11163@item info os @var{infotype}
11164
11165Display OS information of the requested type.
11166
11167On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11168
11169@anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11170@table @code
11171@kindex info os cpus
11172@item cpus
11173Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11174the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11175different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11176CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11177kernel initialization.
11178
11179@kindex info os files
11180@item files
11181Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11182file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11183owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11184of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11185
11186@kindex info os modules
11187@item modules
11188Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11189module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11190bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11191module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11192in memory.
11193
11194@kindex info os msg
11195@item msg
11196Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11197message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11198queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11199on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11200that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11201of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11202message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11203the message queue was last changed.
11204
11205@kindex info os processes
11206@item processes
11207Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11208@value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11209command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11210that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11211properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11212the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11213
11214@kindex info os procgroups
11215@item procgroups
11216Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11217@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11218to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11219identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11220first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11221so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11222and the process group leader is listed first.
11223
11224@kindex info os semaphores
11225@item semaphores
11226Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11227semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11228set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11229set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11230and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11231
11232@kindex info os shm
11233@item shm
11234Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11235For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11236the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11237region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11238attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11239attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11240attached to, detach from, and changed.
11241
11242@kindex info os sockets
11243@item sockets
11244Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11245socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11246remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11247the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11248connection.
11249
11250@kindex info os threads
11251@item threads
11252Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11253@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11254belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11255processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11256process is not listed.
11257@end table
11258
11259@item info os
11260If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11261@var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11262@var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11263types, this command will report an error.
11264@end table
11265
11266@node Memory Region Attributes
11267@section Memory Region Attributes
11268@cindex memory region attributes
11269
11270@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11271required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11272attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11273accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11274target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11275fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11276user can override the fetched regions.
11277
11278Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11279memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11280accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11281been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11282all memory.
11283
11284When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11285to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11286
11287@table @code
11288@kindex mem
11289@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11290Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11291attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11292monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11293case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11294(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11295
11296@item mem auto
11297Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11298regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11299
11300@kindex delete mem
11301@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11302Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11303monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11304
11305@kindex disable mem
11306@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11307Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11308A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11309It may be enabled again later.
11310
11311@kindex enable mem
11312@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11313Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11314
11315@kindex info mem
11316@item info mem
11317Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11318for each region:
11319
11320@table @emph
11321@item Memory Region Number
11322@item Enabled or Disabled.
11323Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11324Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11325
11326@item Lo Address
11327The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11328
11329@item Hi Address
11330The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11331
11332@item Attributes
11333The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11334@end table
11335@end table
11336
11337
11338@subsection Attributes
11339
11340@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11341The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11342write accesses to a memory region.
11343
11344While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11345memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11346etc.@: from accessing memory.
11347
11348@table @code
11349@item ro
11350Memory is read only.
11351@item wo
11352Memory is write only.
11353@item rw
11354Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11355@end table
11356
11357@subsubsection Memory Access Size
11358The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11359accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11360require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11361specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11362
11363@table @code
11364@item 8
11365Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11366@item 16
11367Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11368@item 32
11369Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11370@item 64
11371Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11372@end table
11373
11374@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11375@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11376@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11377@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11378@c
11379@c @table @code
11380@c @item hwbreak
11381@c Always use hardware breakpoints
11382@c @item swbreak (default)
11383@c @end table
11384
11385@subsubsection Data Cache
11386The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11387memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11388protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11389does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11390registers.
11391
11392@table @code
11393@item cache
11394Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11395@item nocache
11396Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11397@end table
11398
11399@subsection Memory Access Checking
11400@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11401not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11402regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11403better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11404
11405@table @code
11406@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11407@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11408If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11409explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11410to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11411memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11412treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11413The default value is @code{on}.
11414@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11415@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11416Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11417@end table
11418
11419
11420@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11421@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11422@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11423@c
11424@c @table @code
11425@c @item verify
11426@c @item noverify (default)
11427@c @end table
11428
11429@node Dump/Restore Files
11430@section Copy Between Memory and a File
11431@cindex dump/restore files
11432@cindex append data to a file
11433@cindex dump data to a file
11434@cindex restore data from a file
11435
11436You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11437@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11438@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11439@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11440memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11441Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11442append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11443
11444@table @code
11445
11446@kindex dump
11447@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11448@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11449Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11450or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11451
11452The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11453@table @code
11454@item binary
11455Raw binary form.
11456@item ihex
11457Intel hex format.
11458@item srec
11459Motorola S-record format.
11460@item tekhex
11461Tektronix Hex format.
11462@item verilog
11463Verilog Hex format.
11464@end table
11465
11466@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11467@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11468@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11469form.
11470
11471@kindex append
11472@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11473@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11474Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11475or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11476(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11477
11478@kindex restore
11479@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11480Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11481@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11482file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11483must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11484
11485If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11486contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11487they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11488a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11489from that location.
11490
11491If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11492file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11493These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11494the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11495
11496@end table
11497
11498@node Core File Generation
11499@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11500@cindex dump core from inferior
11501
11502A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11503image of a running process and its process status (register values
11504etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11505crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11506automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11507the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11508the post-mortem debugging mode.
11509
11510Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11511are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11512@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11513
11514@table @code
11515@kindex gcore
11516@kindex generate-core-file
11517@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11518@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11519Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11520@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11521specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11522@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11523
11524Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11525this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11526
11527On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11528file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11529dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11530
11531@kindex set use-coredump-filter
11532@anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11533@item set use-coredump-filter on
11534@itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11535Enable or disable the use of the file
11536@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11537files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11538memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11539file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11540
11541To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11542@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11543which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11544is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11545types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11546configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11547about the bits that can be set in the
11548@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11549manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11550
11551By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11552@code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11553and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11554to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11555value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11556(anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11557@code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11558This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11559@end table
11560
11561@node Character Sets
11562@section Character Sets
11563@cindex character sets
11564@cindex charset
11565@cindex translating between character sets
11566@cindex host character set
11567@cindex target character set
11568
11569If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11570represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11571@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11572you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11573character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11574@dfn{target character set}.
11575
11576For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11577uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11578remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11579running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11580then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11581@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11582target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11583@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11584character and string literals in expressions.
11585
11586@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11587the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11588target-charset} command, described below.
11589
11590Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11591support:
11592
11593@table @code
11594@item set target-charset @var{charset}
11595@kindex set target-charset
11596Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11597list of supported target character sets, type
11598@kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11599
11600@item set host-charset @var{charset}
11601@kindex set host-charset
11602Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11603
11604By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11605system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11606@code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11607automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11608case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11609
11610@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11611set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11612@value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11613
11614@item set charset @var{charset}
11615@kindex set charset
11616Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11617above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11618@value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11619for both host and target.
11620
11621@item show charset
11622@kindex show charset
11623Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11624
11625@item show host-charset
11626@kindex show host-charset
11627Show the name of the current host character set.
11628
11629@item show target-charset
11630@kindex show target-charset
11631Show the name of the current target character set.
11632
11633@item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11634@kindex set target-wide-charset
11635Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11636the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11637display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11638@kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11639
11640@item show target-wide-charset
11641@kindex show target-wide-charset
11642Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11643@end table
11644
11645Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11646Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11647@file{charset-test.c}:
11648
11649@smallexample
11650#include <stdio.h>
11651
11652char ascii_hello[]
11653 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11654 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11655char ibm1047_hello[]
11656 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11657 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11658
11659main ()
11660@{
11661 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11662@}
11663@end smallexample
11664
11665In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11666containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11667encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11668
11669We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11670
11671@smallexample
11672$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11673$ gdb -nw charset-test
11674GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11675Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11676@dots{}
11677(@value{GDBP})
11678@end smallexample
11679
11680We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11681@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11682strings:
11683
11684@smallexample
11685(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11686The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11687(@value{GDBP})
11688@end smallexample
11689
11690For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11691initial character set:
11692@smallexample
11693(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11694(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11695The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11696(@value{GDBP})
11697@end smallexample
11698
11699Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11700host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11701characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11702them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11703@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11704
11705@smallexample
11706(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11707$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11708(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11709$2 = 72 'H'
11710(@value{GDBP})
11711@end smallexample
11712
11713@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11714literals you use in expressions:
11715
11716@smallexample
11717(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11718$3 = 43 '+'
11719(@value{GDBP})
11720@end smallexample
11721
11722The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11723character.
11724
11725@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11726target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11727character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11728
11729@smallexample
11730(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11731$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11732(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11733$5 = 200 '\310'
11734(@value{GDBP})
11735@end smallexample
11736
11737If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11738@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11739
11740@smallexample
11741(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11742ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11743(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11744@end smallexample
11745
11746We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11747program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11748@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11749target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11750@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11751
11752@smallexample
11753(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11754(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11755The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11756The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11757(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11758$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11759(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11760$7 = 72 '\110'
11761(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11762$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11763(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11764$9 = 200 'H'
11765(@value{GDBP})
11766@end smallexample
11767
11768As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11769string literals you use in expressions:
11770
11771@smallexample
11772(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11773$10 = 78 '+'
11774(@value{GDBP})
11775@end smallexample
11776
11777The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11778character.
11779
11780@node Caching Target Data
11781@section Caching Data of Targets
11782@cindex caching data of targets
11783
11784@value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11785Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11786@xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11787Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11788(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11789remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11790Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11791since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11792values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11793(@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11794is executing.
11795Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11796known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11797rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11798in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11799stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11800in the code segment.
11801Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11802cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11803
11804@table @code
11805@kindex set remotecache
11806@item set remotecache on
11807@itemx set remotecache off
11808This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11809with old scripts.
11810
11811@kindex show remotecache
11812@item show remotecache
11813Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11814
11815@kindex set stack-cache
11816@item set stack-cache on
11817@itemx set stack-cache off
11818Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11819caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11820
11821@kindex show stack-cache
11822@item show stack-cache
11823Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11824
11825@kindex set code-cache
11826@item set code-cache on
11827@itemx set code-cache off
11828Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11829use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11830performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11831
11832@kindex show code-cache
11833@item show code-cache
11834Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11835accesses.
11836
11837@kindex info dcache
11838@item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11839Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11840current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11841includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11842number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11843command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11844
11845If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11846printed in hex.
11847
11848@item set dcache size @var{size}
11849@cindex dcache size
11850@kindex set dcache size
11851Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11852
11853@item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11854@cindex dcache line-size
11855@kindex set dcache line-size
11856Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11857Must be a power of 2.
11858
11859@item show dcache size
11860@kindex show dcache size
11861Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11862
11863@item show dcache line-size
11864@kindex show dcache line-size
11865Show default size of dcache lines.
11866
11867@end table
11868
11869@node Searching Memory
11870@section Search Memory
11871@cindex searching memory
11872
11873Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11874@code{find} command.
11875
11876@table @code
11877@kindex find
11878@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11879@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11880Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11881etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11882@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11883@end table
11884
11885@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11886They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11887
11888@table @r
11889@item @var{s}, search query size
11890The size of each search query value.
11891
11892@table @code
11893@item b
11894bytes
11895@item h
11896halfwords (two bytes)
11897@item w
11898words (four bytes)
11899@item g
11900giant words (eight bytes)
11901@end table
11902
11903All values are interpreted in the current language.
11904This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11905then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11906
11907If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11908value's type in the current language.
11909This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11910pattern as a mixture of types.
11911Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11912a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11913which is typically four bytes.
11914
11915@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11916The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11917@end table
11918
11919You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11920 (@code{"}).
11921The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11922regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11923
11924The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11925number of matches found.
11926
11927The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11928@samp{$_}.
11929A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11930
11931For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11932
11933@smallexample
11934void
11935hello ()
11936@{
11937 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11938 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11939 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11940 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11941 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11942@}
11943@end smallexample
11944
11945@noindent
11946you get during debugging:
11947
11948@smallexample
11949(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
119500x804956d <hello.1620+6>
119511 pattern found
11952(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
119530x8049567 <hello.1620>
119540x804956d <hello.1620+6>
119552 patterns found
11956(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
119570x8049567 <hello.1620>
119581 pattern found
11959(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
119600x8049560 <mixed.1625>
119611 pattern found
11962(gdb) print $numfound
11963$1 = 1
11964(gdb) print $_
11965$2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11966@end smallexample
11967
11968@node Value Sizes
11969@section Value Sizes
11970
11971Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11972@value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11973some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11974may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11975@value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11976
11977@table @code
11978@kindex set max-value-size
11979@item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11980@itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11981Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11982contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11983requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11984
11985Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11986allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11987
11988There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11989order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11990currently 16 bytes.
11991
11992The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11993complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11994integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11995@var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11996@value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11997@var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11998succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11999size is less than @var{bytes}.
12000
12001The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12002
12003@kindex show max-value-size
12004@item show max-value-size
12005Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12006allocate for the contents of a value.
12007@end table
12008
12009@node Optimized Code
12010@chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12011@cindex optimized code, debugging
12012@cindex debugging optimized code
12013
12014Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12015disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12016directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12017applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12018diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12019information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12020the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12021
12022@value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12023can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12024progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12025where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12026
12027When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12028optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12029really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12030exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12031variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12032variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12033
12034Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12035@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12036doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12037please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12038@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12039
12040@menu
12041* Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12042* Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12043@end menu
12044
12045@node Inline Functions
12046@section Inline Functions
12047@cindex inline functions, debugging
12048
12049@dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12050body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12051routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12052non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12053arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12054them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12055You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12056@code{info frame} command.
12057
12058For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12059record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12060@value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12061other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12062when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12063do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12064@samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12065function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12066displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12067local variables in the caller.
12068
12069The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12070unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12071the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12072start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12073the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12074the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12075instructions are executed.
12076
12077This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12078context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12079a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12080this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12081
12082There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12083function calls are the same as normal calls:
12084
12085@itemize @bullet
12086@item
12087Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12088work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12089may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12090function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12091version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12092or inside the inlined function instead.
12093
12094@item
12095@value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12096using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12097debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12098and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12099
12100@end itemize
12101
12102@node Tail Call Frames
12103@section Tail Call Frames
12104@cindex tail call frames, debugging
12105
12106Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12107unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12108instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12109call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12110instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12111
12112During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12113function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12114@code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12115then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12116some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12117@code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12118return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12119
12120This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12121the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12122@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12123this information.
12124
12125@kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12126kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12127
12128@smallexample
12129(gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12130 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12131(gdb) info frame
12132Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12133 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12134 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12135 source language c++.
12136 Arglist at unknown address.
12137 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12138@end smallexample
12139
12140The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12141There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12142used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12143callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12144tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12145unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12146
12147@table @code
12148@anchor{set debug entry-values}
12149@item set debug entry-values
12150@kindex set debug entry-values
12151When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12152values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12153tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12154of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12155result.
12156
12157@item show debug entry-values
12158@kindex show debug entry-values
12159Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12160values at function entry and tail calls.
12161@end table
12162
12163The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12164call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12165reference by variable @code{x}):
12166
12167@smallexample
12168static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12169void (*x) (void) = c;
12170static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12171static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12172int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12173
12174Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12175DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12176a () at t.c:3
121773 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12178(gdb) bt
12179#0 a () at t.c:3
12180#1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12181@end smallexample
12182
12183Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12184
12185@smallexample
12186int i;
12187static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12188static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12189static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12190static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12191static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12192@{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12193static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12194int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12195
12196tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12197tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12198tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12199(gdb) bt
12200#0 f () at t.c:2
12201#1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12202#2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12203@end smallexample
12204
12205@set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12206@set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12207
12208@c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12209@ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12210@set ARROW @click{}
12211@set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12212@set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12213@end ifset
12214@ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12215@set ARROW ->
12216@set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12217@set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12218@end ifclear
12219
12220Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12221The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12222@value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12223
12224@code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12225has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12226prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12227printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12228futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12229any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12230
12231For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12232@code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12233also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12234therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12235omitted.
12236
12237There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12238entry may fail:
12239
12240@smallexample
12241int v;
12242static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12243static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12244static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12245static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12246@{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12247int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12248
12249(gdb) bt
12250#0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12251#1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12252function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12253i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12254#2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12255@end smallexample
12256
12257@value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12258function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12259tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12260@value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12261prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12262
12263@node Macros
12264@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12265
12266Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12267``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12268@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12269the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12270where it was defined.
12271
12272You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12273with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12274include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12275with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12276
12277A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12278and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12279points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12280no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12281uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12282@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12283see @ref{List}.
12284
12285Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12286macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12287the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12288
12289@table @code
12290
12291@kindex macro expand
12292@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12293@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12294@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12295@item macro expand @var{expression}
12296@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12297Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12298@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12299not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12300it can be any string of tokens.
12301
12302@kindex macro exp1
12303@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12304@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12305@cindex expand macro once
12306@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12307expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12308@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12309left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12310particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12311expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12312parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12313can be any string of tokens.
12314
12315@kindex info macro
12316@cindex macro definition, showing
12317@cindex definition of a macro, showing
12318@cindex macros, from debug info
12319@item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12320Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12321and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12322definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12323argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12324the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12325
12326@kindex info macros
12327@item info macros @var{location}
12328Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12329by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12330command-line where those definitions were established.
12331
12332@kindex macro define
12333@cindex user-defined macros
12334@cindex defining macros interactively
12335@cindex macros, user-defined
12336@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12337@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12338Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12339invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12340@var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12341``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12342defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12343@var{arglist}.
12344
12345A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12346expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12347@code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12348all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12349as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12350
12351@kindex macro undef
12352@item macro undef @var{macro}
12353Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12354This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12355define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12356in the program being debugged.
12357
12358@kindex macro list
12359@item macro list
12360List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12361@end table
12362
12363@cindex macros, example of debugging with
12364Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12365show our source files:
12366
12367@smallexample
12368$ cat sample.c
12369#include <stdio.h>
12370#include "sample.h"
12371
12372#define M 42
12373#define ADD(x) (M + x)
12374
12375main ()
12376@{
12377#define N 28
12378 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12379#undef N
12380 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12381#define N 1729
12382 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12383@}
12384$ cat sample.h
12385#define Q <
12386$
12387@end smallexample
12388
12389Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12390@value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12391minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12392and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12393version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12394includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12395information.
12396
12397@smallexample
12398$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12399$
12400@end smallexample
12401
12402Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12403
12404@smallexample
12405$ gdb -nw sample
12406GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12407Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12408GDB is free software, @dots{}
12409(@value{GDBP})
12410@end smallexample
12411
12412We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12413program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12414to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12415
12416@smallexample
12417(@value{GDBP}) list main
124183
124194 #define M 42
124205 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
124216
124227 main ()
124238 @{
124249 #define N 28
1242510 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
1242611 #undef N
1242712 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12428(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12429Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12430#define ADD(x) (M + x)
12431(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12432Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12433 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12434#define Q <
12435(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12436expands to: (42 + 1)
12437(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12438expands to: once (M + 1)
12439(@value{GDBP})
12440@end smallexample
12441
12442In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12443the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12444@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12445which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12446
12447Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12448force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12449
12450@smallexample
12451(@value{GDBP}) break main
12452Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12453(@value{GDBP}) run
12454Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12455
12456Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
1245710 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12458(@value{GDBP})
12459@end smallexample
12460
12461At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12462
12463@smallexample
12464(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12465Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12466#define N 28
12467(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12468expands to: 28 < 42
12469(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12470$1 = 1
12471(@value{GDBP})
12472@end smallexample
12473
12474As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12475give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12476thereof) in force at each point:
12477
12478@smallexample
12479(@value{GDBP}) next
12480Hello, world!
1248112 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12482(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12483The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12484at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12485(@value{GDBP}) next
12486We're so creative.
1248714 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12488(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12489Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12490#define N 1729
12491(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12492expands to: 1729 < 42
12493(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12494$2 = 0
12495(@value{GDBP})
12496@end smallexample
12497
12498In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12499line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12500such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12501of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12502
12503@smallexample
12504(@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12505Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12506-D__STDC__=1
12507(@value{GDBP})
12508@end smallexample
12509
12510
12511@node Tracepoints
12512@chapter Tracepoints
12513@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12514@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12515
12516@cindex tracepoints
12517In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12518the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12519anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12520depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12521might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12522fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12523to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12524
12525Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12526specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12527arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12528Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12529those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12530expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12531for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12532a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12533in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12534values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12535unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12536
12537The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12538targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12539how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12540remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12541support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12542packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12543Packets}.
12544
12545It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12546of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12547through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12548
12549This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12550
12551@menu
12552* Set Tracepoints::
12553* Analyze Collected Data::
12554* Tracepoint Variables::
12555* Trace Files::
12556@end menu
12557
12558@node Set Tracepoints
12559@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12560
12561Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12562tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12563breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12564standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12565tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12566of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12567as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12568
12569For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12570of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12571it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12572local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12573commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12574tracepoint was hit.
12575
12576Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12577tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12578commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12579either.
12580
12581@cindex fast tracepoints
12582Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12583a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12584faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12585
12586@cindex static tracepoints
12587@cindex markers, static tracepoints
12588@cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12589Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12590that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12591in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12592tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12593instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12594the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12595address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12596investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12597support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12598points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12599tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12600@value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12601registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12602point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12603The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12604instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12605static tracepoint marker.
12606
12607@code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12608@xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12609
12610This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12611conditions and actions.
12612
12613@menu
12614* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12615* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12616* Tracepoint Passcounts::
12617* Tracepoint Conditions::
12618* Trace State Variables::
12619* Tracepoint Actions::
12620* Listing Tracepoints::
12621* Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12622* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12623* Tracepoint Restrictions::
12624@end menu
12625
12626@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12627@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12628
12629@table @code
12630@cindex set tracepoint
12631@kindex trace
12632@item trace @var{location}
12633The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12634Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12635@xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12636which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12637collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12638or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12639supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12640in tracing}).
12641If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12642these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12643command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12644not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12645@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12646address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12647Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12648until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12649@value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12650@value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12651tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12652the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12653
12654Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12655
12656@smallexample
12657(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12658
12659(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12660
12661(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12662
12663(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12664
12665(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12666@end smallexample
12667
12668@noindent
12669You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12670
12671@item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12672Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12673@var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12674if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12675@xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12676information on tracepoint conditions.
12677
12678@item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12679@cindex set fast tracepoint
12680@cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12681@kindex ftrace
12682The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12683support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12684less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12685instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12686may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12687location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12688message.
12689
12690@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12691@code{trace}.
12692
12693On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12694be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12695placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12696program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12697such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12698address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12699to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12700to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12701
12702@example
12703sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12704@end example
12705
12706@noindent
12707which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12708trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12709
12710@item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12711@cindex set static tracepoint
12712@cindex static tracepoints, setting
12713@cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12714@kindex strace
12715The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12716support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12717instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12718be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12719which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12720
12721@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12722@code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12723@code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12724identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12725depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12726using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12727of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12728@xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12729Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12730tracing engine:
12731
12732@smallexample
12733main ()
12734@{
12735 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12736@}
12737@end smallexample
12738
12739@noindent
12740the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12741@code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12742
12743@smallexample
12744(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12745Cnt Enb ID Address What
127461 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12747 Data: "str %s"
12748[etc...]
12749@end smallexample
12750
12751@noindent
12752so you may probe the marker above with:
12753
12754@smallexample
12755(@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12756@end smallexample
12757
12758Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12759$_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12760call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12761that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12762string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12763string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12764static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12765the @samp{Data:} field.
12766
12767You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12768the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12769@value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12770
12771@vindex $tpnum
12772@cindex last tracepoint number
12773@cindex recent tracepoint number
12774@cindex tracepoint number
12775The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12776of the most recently set tracepoint.
12777
12778@kindex delete tracepoint
12779@cindex tracepoint deletion
12780@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12781Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12782default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12783@code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12784
12785Examples:
12786
12787@smallexample
12788(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12789
12790(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12791@end smallexample
12792
12793@noindent
12794You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12795@end table
12796
12797@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12798@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12799
12800These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12801
12802@table @code
12803@kindex disable tracepoint
12804@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12805Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12806@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12807a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12808a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12809If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12810has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12811change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12812next trace experiment.
12813
12814@kindex enable tracepoint
12815@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12816Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12817issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12818tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12819become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12820next time a trace experiment is run.
12821@end table
12822
12823@node Tracepoint Passcounts
12824@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12825
12826@table @code
12827@kindex passcount
12828@cindex tracepoint pass count
12829@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12830Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12831automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12832@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12833the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12834@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12835passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12836given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12837user.
12838
12839Examples:
12840
12841@smallexample
12842(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12843@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12844
12845(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12846@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12847(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12848(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12849(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12850(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12851(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12852(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12853@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12854@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12855@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12856@end smallexample
12857@end table
12858
12859@node Tracepoint Conditions
12860@subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12861@cindex conditional tracepoints
12862@cindex tracepoint conditions
12863
12864The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12865reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12866a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12867programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12868tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12869program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12870is true.
12871
12872Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12873using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12874@xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12875also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12876just as with breakpoints.
12877
12878Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12879the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12880expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12881suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12882Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12883accesses, and so forth.
12884
12885For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12886frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12887could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12888of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12889through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12890collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12891search through.
12892
12893@smallexample
12894(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12895@end smallexample
12896
12897@node Trace State Variables
12898@subsection Trace State Variables
12899@cindex trace state variables
12900
12901A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12902created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12903that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12904but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12905using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12906integers.
12907
12908Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12909to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12910experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12911trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12912
12913@cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12914Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12915them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12916variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12917while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12918the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12919cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12920@code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12921variable with the same name.
12922
12923@table @code
12924
12925@item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12926@kindex tvariable
12927The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12928@code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12929@var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12930entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12931otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12932@code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12933variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12934existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12935value. The default initial value is 0.
12936
12937@item info tvariables
12938@kindex info tvariables
12939List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12940Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12941currently running.
12942
12943@item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12944@kindex delete tvariable
12945Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12946are specified.
12947
12948@end table
12949
12950@node Tracepoint Actions
12951@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12952
12953@table @code
12954@kindex actions
12955@cindex tracepoint actions
12956@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12957This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12958tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12959specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12960recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12961@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12962actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12963terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12964far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12965@code{while-stepping}.
12966
12967@code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12968Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12969actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12970
12971@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12972To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12973and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12974
12975@smallexample
12976(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12977
12978(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12979
12980(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12981@end smallexample
12982
12983In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12984commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12985hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12986following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12987followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12988sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12989terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12990list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12991
12992@smallexample
12993(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12994(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12995Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12996> collect bar,baz
12997> collect $regs
12998> while-stepping 12
12999 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13000 > end
13001end
13002@end smallexample
13003
13004@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13005@item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13006Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13007This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13008In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13009special arguments are supported:
13010
13011@table @code
13012@item $regs
13013Collect all registers.
13014
13015@item $args
13016Collect all function arguments.
13017
13018@item $locals
13019Collect all local variables.
13020
13021@item $_ret
13022Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13023of a backtrace.
13024
13025@emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13026determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13027collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13028for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13029When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13030found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13031
13032@item $_probe_argc
13033Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13034tracepoint is located.
13035@xref{Static Probe Points}.
13036
13037@item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13038@var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13039from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13040@xref{Static Probe Points}.
13041
13042@item $_sdata
13043@vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13044Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13045static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13046Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13047instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13048tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13049character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13050instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13051Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13052
13053@smallexample
13054 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13055 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13056@end smallexample
13057
13058In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13059@samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13060inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13061@value{GDBN}.
13062@end table
13063
13064You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13065with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13066arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13067
13068The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13069@code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13070particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13071to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13072@code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13073number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13074@samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13075@samp{mystr}.
13076
13077The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13078particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13079
13080@kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13081@item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13082Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13083command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13084are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13085state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13086values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13087action were used.
13088
13089@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13090@item while-stepping @var{n}
13091Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13092collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13093command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13094(followed by its own @code{end} command):
13095
13096@smallexample
13097> while-stepping 12
13098 > collect $regs, myglobal
13099 > end
13100>
13101@end smallexample
13102
13103@noindent
13104Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13105@code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13106you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13107@code{stepping}.
13108
13109@item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13110@kindex set default-collect
13111@cindex default collection action
13112This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13113hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13114to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13115individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13116@code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13117local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13118
13119@item show default-collect
13120@kindex show default-collect
13121Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13122tracepoint hit.
13123
13124@end table
13125
13126@node Listing Tracepoints
13127@subsection Listing Tracepoints
13128
13129@table @code
13130@kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13131@kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13132@cindex information about tracepoints
13133@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13134Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13135specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13136tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13137@code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13138command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13139
13140A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13141tracing:
13142
13143@itemize @bullet
13144@item
13145its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13146
13147@item
13148the state about installed on target of each location
13149@end itemize
13150
13151@smallexample
13152(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13153Num Type Disp Enb Address What
131541 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13155 while-stepping 20
13156 collect globfoo, $regs
13157 end
13158 collect globfoo2
13159 end
13160 pass count 1200
131612 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13162 collect $eip
131632.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13164 installed on target
131652.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13166 installed on target
131672.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
131683 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13169 not installed on target
13170(@value{GDBP})
13171@end smallexample
13172
13173@noindent
13174This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13175@end table
13176
13177@node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13178@subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13179
13180@table @code
13181@kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13182@cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13183@item info static-tracepoint-markers
13184Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13185program.
13186
13187For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13188
13189@table @emph
13190@item Count
13191An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13192stable identifier.
13193@item ID
13194The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13195@item Enabled or Disabled
13196Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13197that are not enabled.
13198@item Address
13199Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13200@item What
13201Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13202number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13203allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13204will be left blank.
13205@end table
13206
13207@noindent
13208In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13209
13210@table @emph
13211@item Data
13212User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13213UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13214marker call.
13215@item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13216The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13217@end table
13218
13219@smallexample
13220(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13221Cnt ID Enb Address What
132221 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13223 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13224 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
132252 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13226 Data: str %s
13227(@value{GDBP})
13228@end smallexample
13229@end table
13230
13231@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13232@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13233
13234@table @code
13235@kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13236@cindex start a new trace experiment
13237@cindex collected data discarded
13238@item tstart
13239This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13240It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13241trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13242are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13243experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13244especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13245the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13246information, and so forth.
13247
13248@kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13249@cindex stop a running trace experiment
13250@item tstop
13251This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13252supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13253useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13254instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13255needs to be stopped quickly.
13256
13257@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13258automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13259(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13260
13261@kindex tstatus
13262@cindex status of trace data collection
13263@cindex trace experiment, status of
13264@item tstatus
13265This command displays the status of the current trace data
13266collection.
13267@end table
13268
13269Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13270
13271@smallexample
13272(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13273(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13274Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13275> collect $regs,$locals,$args
13276> while-stepping 11
13277 > collect $regs
13278 > end
13279> end
13280(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13281 [time passes @dots{}]
13282(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13283@end smallexample
13284
13285@anchor{disconnected tracing}
13286@cindex disconnected tracing
13287You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13288@value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13289involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13290ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13291terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13292unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13293@code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13294continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13295
13296@table @code
13297@item set disconnected-tracing on
13298@itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13299@kindex set disconnected-tracing
13300Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13301has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13302@code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13303matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13304for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13305
13306@item show disconnected-tracing
13307@kindex show disconnected-tracing
13308Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13309
13310@end table
13311
13312When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13313still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13314meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13315it will continue after reconnection.
13316
13317Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13318tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13319information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13320to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13321have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13322the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13323debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13324which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13325necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13326created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13327
13328@cindex circular trace buffer
13329If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13330can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13331buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13332frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13333collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13334hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13335buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13336@samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13337including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13338buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13339the next run.
13340
13341@table @code
13342@item set circular-trace-buffer on
13343@itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13344@kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13345Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13346for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13347fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13348data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13349
13350@item show circular-trace-buffer
13351@kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13352Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13353match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13354match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13355for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13356
13357@end table
13358
13359@table @code
13360@item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13361@itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13362@kindex set trace-buffer-size
13363Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13364targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13365the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13366@code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13367likes. This is also the default.
13368
13369@item show trace-buffer-size
13370@kindex show trace-buffer-size
13371Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13372will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13373and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13374target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13375not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13376to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13377@end table
13378
13379@table @code
13380@item set trace-user @var{text}
13381@kindex set trace-user
13382
13383@item show trace-user
13384@kindex show trace-user
13385
13386@item set trace-notes @var{text}
13387@kindex set trace-notes
13388Set the trace run's notes.
13389
13390@item show trace-notes
13391@kindex show trace-notes
13392Show the trace run's notes.
13393
13394@item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13395@kindex set trace-stop-notes
13396Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13397@code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13398stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13399
13400@item show trace-stop-notes
13401@kindex show trace-stop-notes
13402Show the trace run's stop notes.
13403
13404@end table
13405
13406@node Tracepoint Restrictions
13407@subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13408
13409@cindex tracepoint restrictions
13410There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13411described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13412without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13413the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13414examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13415collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13416is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13417mentioned here.
13418
13419@itemize @bullet
13420
13421@item
13422Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13423the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13424You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13425convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13426state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13427functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13428cannot be collected either.
13429
13430@item
13431Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13432@code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13433behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13434instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13435may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13436tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13437variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13438tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13439where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13440program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13441
13442@item
13443Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13444may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13445in a misleading way.
13446
13447@item
13448When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13449dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13450being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13451not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13452dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13453collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13454@code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13455by @code{ptr}.
13456
13457@item
13458It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13459tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13460bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13461(adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13462target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13463Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13464using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13465depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13466if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13467stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13468invalid address.
13469
13470@item
13471If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13472infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13473the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13474for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13475multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13476inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13477@value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13478it to zero.
13479
13480@end itemize
13481
13482@node Analyze Collected Data
13483@section Using the Collected Data
13484
13485After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13486for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13487collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13488snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13489consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13490examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13491specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13492snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13493registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13494rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13495debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13496(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13497behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13498when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13499the buffer will fail.
13500
13501@menu
13502* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13503* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13504* save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13505@end menu
13506
13507@node tfind
13508@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13509
13510@kindex tfind
13511@cindex select trace snapshot
13512@cindex find trace snapshot
13513The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13514@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13515counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13516snapshot is selected.
13517
13518Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13519
13520@table @code
13521@item tfind start
13522Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13523@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13524
13525@item tfind none
13526Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13527
13528@item tfind end
13529Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13530
13531@item tfind
13532No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13533one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13534
13535@item tfind -
13536Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13537retracing earlier steps.
13538
13539@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13540Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13541proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13542argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13543for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13544
13545@item tfind pc @var{addr}
13546Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13547program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13548snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13549snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13550
13551@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13552Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13553addresses (exclusive).
13554
13555@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13556Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13557@var{addr2} (inclusive).
13558
13559@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13560Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13561the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13562that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13563trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13564next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13565@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13566stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13567@end table
13568
13569The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13570designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13571instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13572snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13573trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13574simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13575snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13576@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13577The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13578for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13579no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13580(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13581no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13582tracepoint as the current one.
13583
13584In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13585these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13586scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13587you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13588registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13589
13590@smallexample
13591(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13592(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13593> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13594 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13595> tfind
13596> end
13597
13598Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13599Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13600Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13601Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13602Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13603Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13604Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13605Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13606Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13607Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13608Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13609@end smallexample
13610
13611Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13612the buffer:
13613
13614@smallexample
13615(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13616(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13617> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13618> tfind line
13619> end
13620
13621Frame 0, X = 1
13622Frame 7, X = 2
13623Frame 13, X = 255
13624@end smallexample
13625
13626@node tdump
13627@subsection @code{tdump}
13628@kindex tdump
13629@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13630@cindex tracepoint data, display
13631
13632This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13633the current trace snapshot.
13634
13635@smallexample
13636(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13637(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13638Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13639> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13640> end
13641
13642(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13643
13644(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13645#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13646at gdb_test.c:444
13647444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13648
13649(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13650Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13651d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13652d1 0x18 24
13653d2 0x80 128
13654d3 0x33 51
13655d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13656d5 0x22 34
13657d6 0xe0 224
13658d7 0x380035 3670069
13659a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13660a1 0x3000668 50333288
13661a2 0x100 256
13662a3 0x322000 3284992
13663a4 0x3000698 50333336
13664a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13665fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13666sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13667ps 0x0 0
13668pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13669fpcontrol 0x0 0
13670fpstatus 0x0 0
13671fpiaddr 0x0 0
13672p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13673p1 = (void *) 0x11
13674p2 = (void *) 0x22
13675p3 = (void *) 0x33
13676p4 = (void *) 0x44
13677p5 = (void *) 0x55
13678p6 = (void *) 0x66
13679gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13680
13681(@value{GDBP})
13682@end smallexample
13683
13684@code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13685actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13686@code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13687actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13688
13689Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13690uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13691frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13692collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13693to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13694body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13695then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13696list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13697same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13698@c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13699
13700@node save tracepoints
13701@subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13702@kindex save tracepoints
13703@kindex save-tracepoints
13704@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13705
13706This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13707their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13708suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13709tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13710Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13711alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13712
13713@node Tracepoint Variables
13714@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13715@cindex tracepoint variables
13716@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13717
13718@table @code
13719@vindex $trace_frame
13720@item (int) $trace_frame
13721The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13722snapshot is selected.
13723
13724@vindex $tracepoint
13725@item (int) $tracepoint
13726The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13727
13728@vindex $trace_line
13729@item (int) $trace_line
13730The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13731
13732@vindex $trace_file
13733@item (char []) $trace_file
13734The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13735
13736@vindex $trace_func
13737@item (char []) $trace_func
13738The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13739@end table
13740
13741Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13742use @code{output} instead.
13743
13744Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13745stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13746data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13747which are managed by the target.
13748
13749@smallexample
13750(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13751
13752(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13753> output $trace_file
13754> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13755> tfind
13756> end
13757@end smallexample
13758
13759@node Trace Files
13760@section Using Trace Files
13761@cindex trace files
13762
13763In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13764longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13765for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13766dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13767of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13768
13769@table @code
13770
13771@kindex tsave
13772@item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13773@itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13774Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13775assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13776necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13777then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13778optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13779the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13780more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13781@code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13782By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13783You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13784format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13785that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13786@indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13787
13788@kindex target tfile
13789@kindex tfile
13790@kindex target ctf
13791@kindex ctf
13792@item target tfile @var{filename}
13793@itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13794Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13795a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13796a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13797@code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13798the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13799Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13800the host.
13801
13802@smallexample
13803(@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13804(@value{GDBP}) tfind
13805Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
1380639 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13807(@value{GDBP}) tdump
13808Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13809i = 0
13810a = 0
13811b = 1 '\001'
13812c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13813d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13814(@value{GDBP}) p b
13815$1 = 1
13816@end smallexample
13817
13818@end table
13819
13820@node Overlays
13821@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13822@cindex overlays
13823
13824If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13825memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13826problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13827use overlays.
13828
13829@menu
13830* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13831* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13832* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13833 mapped by asking the inferior.
13834* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13835@end menu
13836
13837@node How Overlays Work
13838@section How Overlays Work
13839@cindex mapped overlays
13840@cindex unmapped overlays
13841@cindex load address, overlay's
13842@cindex mapped address
13843@cindex overlay area
13844
13845Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13846kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13847other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13848management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13849adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13850
13851One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13852independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13853@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13854their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13855instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13856largest overlay as well.
13857
13858Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13859overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13860for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13861there.
13862
13863@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13864@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13865@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13866
13867@smallexample
13868@group
13869 Data Instruction Larger
13870Address Space Address Space Address Space
13871+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13872| | | | | |
13873+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13874| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13875| variables | | program | | +-----------+
13876| and heap | | | | | |
13877+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13878| | +-----------+ | | | load address
13879+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13880 | | | | | |
13881 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13882 address | | | | | |
13883 | overlay | <-' | | |
13884 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13885 | | <---. | | load address
13886 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13887 | | | |
13888 +-----------+ | |
13889 +-----------+
13890 | |
13891 +-----------+
13892
13893 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13894@end group
13895@end smallexample
13896
13897The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13898and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13899its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13900Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13901may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13902data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13903program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13904program and the overlay area.
13905
13906An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13907@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13908instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13909in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13910is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13911the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13912called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13913
13914Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13915program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13916global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13917
13918@itemize @bullet
13919
13920@item
13921Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13922must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13923return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13924overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13925
13926@item
13927If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13928will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13929your program's performance.
13930
13931@item
13932The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13933overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13934mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13935and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13936You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13937addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13938ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13939
13940@item
13941The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13942to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13943instruction and data spaces.
13944
13945@end itemize
13946
13947The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13948improved in many ways:
13949
13950@itemize @bullet
13951
13952@item
13953If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13954hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13955contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13956This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13957area in the usual way.
13958
13959@item
13960If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13961overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13962
13963@item
13964You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13965general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13966code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13967return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13968the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13969must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13970different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13971
13972@end itemize
13973
13974
13975@node Overlay Commands
13976@section Overlay Commands
13977
13978To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13979correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13980virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13981mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13982@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13983variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13984
13985@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13986you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13987
13988@table @code
13989@item overlay off
13990@kindex overlay
13991Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13992disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13993always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13994overlay support is disabled.
13995
13996@item overlay manual
13997@cindex manual overlay debugging
13998Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13999relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14000using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14001commands described below.
14002
14003@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14004@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14005@cindex map an overlay
14006Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14007be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14008overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14009functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14010that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14011@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14012
14013@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14014@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14015@cindex unmap an overlay
14016Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14017must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14018When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14019overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14020
14021@item overlay auto
14022Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14023consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14024to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14025Overlay Debugging}.
14026
14027@item overlay load-target
14028@itemx overlay load
14029@cindex reloading the overlay table
14030Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14031re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14032stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14033overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14034useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14035
14036@item overlay list-overlays
14037@itemx overlay list
14038@cindex listing mapped overlays
14039Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14040addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14041
14042@end table
14043
14044Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14045of the function the address falls in:
14046
14047@smallexample
14048(@value{GDBP}) print main
14049$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14050@end smallexample
14051@noindent
14052When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14053unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14054asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14055unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14056
14057@smallexample
14058(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14059No sections are mapped.
14060(@value{GDBP}) print foo
14061$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14062@end smallexample
14063@noindent
14064When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14065name normally:
14066
14067@smallexample
14068(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14069Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14070 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14071(@value{GDBP}) print foo
14072$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14073@end smallexample
14074
14075When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14076address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14077overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14078@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14079code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14080
14081@itemize @bullet
14082@item
14083@cindex breakpoints in overlays
14084@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14085You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14086@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14087@item
14088@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14089unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14090overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14091you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14092breakpoints properly.
14093@end itemize
14094
14095
14096@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14097@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14098@cindex automatic overlay debugging
14099
14100@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14101are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14102inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14103@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14104looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14105current state of the overlays.
14106
14107Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14108@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14109
14110@table @asis
14111
14112@item @code{_ovly_table}:
14113This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14114
14115@smallexample
14116struct
14117@{
14118 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14119 unsigned long vma;
14120
14121 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14122 unsigned long size;
14123
14124 /* The overlay's load address. */
14125 unsigned long lma;
14126
14127 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14128 zero otherwise. */
14129 unsigned long mapped;
14130@}
14131@end smallexample
14132
14133@item @code{_novlys}:
14134This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14135number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14136
14137@end table
14138
14139To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14140looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14141@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14142executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14143the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14144currently mapped.
14145
14146In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14147@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14148will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14149calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14150will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14151are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14152in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14153overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14154are not being executed.
14155
14156@node Overlay Sample Program
14157@section Overlay Sample Program
14158@cindex overlay example program
14159
14160When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14161at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14162addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14163Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14164since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14165architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14166portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14167
14168However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14169program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14170suite. The program consists of the following files from
14171@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14172
14173@table @file
14174@item overlays.c
14175The main program file.
14176@item ovlymgr.c
14177A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14178@item foo.c
14179@itemx bar.c
14180@itemx baz.c
14181@itemx grbx.c
14182Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14183@item d10v.ld
14184@itemx m32r.ld
14185Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14186and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14187@end table
14188
14189You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14190cross-compiler like this:
14191
14192@smallexample
14193$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14194$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14195$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14196$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14197$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14198$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14199$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14200 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14201@end smallexample
14202
14203The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14204you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14205target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14206
14207
14208@node Languages
14209@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14210@cindex languages
14211
14212Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14213rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14214dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14215Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14216represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14217@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14218
14219@cindex working language
14220Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14221allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14222native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14223consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14224language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14225language}.
14226
14227@menu
14228* Setting:: Switching between source languages
14229* Show:: Displaying the language
14230* Checks:: Type and range checks
14231* Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14232* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14233@end menu
14234
14235@node Setting
14236@section Switching Between Source Languages
14237
14238There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14239set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14240@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14241defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14242used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14243are printed, etc.
14244
14245In addition to the working language, every source file that
14246@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14247file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14248source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14249language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14250controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14251show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14252set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14253set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14254Displaying the Language}.
14255
14256This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14257as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14258another language. In that case, make the
14259program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14260@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14261program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14262
14263@menu
14264* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14265* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14266* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14267@end menu
14268
14269@node Filenames
14270@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14271
14272If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14273@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14274
14275@table @file
14276@item .ada
14277@itemx .ads
14278@itemx .adb
14279@itemx .a
14280Ada source file.
14281
14282@item .c
14283C source file
14284
14285@item .C
14286@itemx .cc
14287@itemx .cp
14288@itemx .cpp
14289@itemx .cxx
14290@itemx .c++
14291C@t{++} source file
14292
14293@item .d
14294D source file
14295
14296@item .m
14297Objective-C source file
14298
14299@item .f
14300@itemx .F
14301Fortran source file
14302
14303@item .mod
14304Modula-2 source file
14305
14306@item .s
14307@itemx .S
14308Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14309@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14310@end table
14311
14312In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14313extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14314
14315@node Manually
14316@subsection Setting the Working Language
14317
14318If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14319expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14320your program.
14321
14322@kindex set language
14323If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14324command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14325a language, such as
14326@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14327For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14328
14329Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14330language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14331to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14332source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14333languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14334source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14335command such as:
14336
14337@smallexample
14338print a = b + c
14339@end smallexample
14340
14341@noindent
14342might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14343@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14344printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14345@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14346
14347@node Automatically
14348@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14349
14350To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14351@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14352then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14353frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14354working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14355frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14356or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14357does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14358not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14359
14360This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14361entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14362written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14363a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14364case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14365
14366@node Show
14367@section Displaying the Language
14368
14369The following commands help you find out which language is the
14370working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14371
14372@table @code
14373@item show language
14374@anchor{show language}
14375@kindex show language
14376Display the current working language. This is the
14377language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14378build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14379
14380@item info frame
14381@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14382Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14383working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14384@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14385information listed here.
14386
14387@item info source
14388@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14389Display the source language of this source file.
14390@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14391information listed here.
14392@end table
14393
14394In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14395not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14396with a language explicitly:
14397
14398@table @code
14399@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14400@kindex set extension-language
14401Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14402assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14403
14404@item info extensions
14405@kindex info extensions
14406List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14407@end table
14408
14409@node Checks
14410@section Type and Range Checking
14411
14412Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14413errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14414checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14415sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14416these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14417by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14418errors when your program is running.
14419
14420By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14421rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14422the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14423into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14424
14425@menu
14426* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14427* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14428@end menu
14429
14430@cindex type checking
14431@cindex checks, type
14432@node Type Checking
14433@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14434
14435Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14436arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14437otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14438errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14439
14440@smallexample
14441int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14442
14443(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14444$1 = 2
14445@exdent but
14446(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14447Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14448@end smallexample
14449
14450The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14451@samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14452
14453For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14454@value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14455to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14456When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14457expressions like the second example above.
14458
14459Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14460related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14461For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14462a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14463with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14464little sense to evaluate anyway.
14465
14466@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14467
14468@kindex set check type
14469@kindex show check type
14470@table @code
14471@item set check type on
14472@itemx set check type off
14473Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14474evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14475message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14476
14477@item show check type
14478Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14479is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14480@end table
14481
14482@cindex range checking
14483@cindex checks, range
14484@node Range Checking
14485@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14486
14487In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14488bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14489checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14490computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14491not exceed the bounds of the array.
14492
14493For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14494@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14495always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14496warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14497
14498A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14499array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14500of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14501error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14502result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14503the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14504
14505@smallexample
14506@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14507@end smallexample
14508
14509This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14510specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14511Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14512
14513@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14514
14515@kindex set check range
14516@kindex show check range
14517@table @code
14518@item set check range auto
14519Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14520@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14521each language.
14522
14523@item set check range on
14524@itemx set check range off
14525Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14526current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14527match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14528then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14529
14530@item set check range warn
14531Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14532but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14533expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14534memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14535systems).
14536
14537@item show range
14538Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14539being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14540@end table
14541
14542@node Supported Languages
14543@section Supported Languages
14544
14545@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14546OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14547@c This is false ...
14548Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14549language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14550and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14551,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14552language.
14553
14554The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14555supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14556tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14557@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14558formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14559books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14560language reference or tutorial.
14561
14562@menu
14563* C:: C and C@t{++}
14564* D:: D
14565* Go:: Go
14566* Objective-C:: Objective-C
14567* OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14568* Fortran:: Fortran
14569* Pascal:: Pascal
14570* Rust:: Rust
14571* Modula-2:: Modula-2
14572* Ada:: Ada
14573@end menu
14574
14575@node C
14576@subsection C and C@t{++}
14577
14578@cindex C and C@t{++}
14579@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14580
14581Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14582to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14583together.
14584
14585@cindex C@t{++}
14586@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14587@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14588The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14589compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14590effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14591C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14592compiler (@code{aCC}).
14593
14594@menu
14595* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14596* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14597* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14598* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14599* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14600* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14601* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14602* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14603@end menu
14604
14605@node C Operators
14606@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14607
14608@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14609
14610Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14611@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14612often defined on groups of types.
14613
14614For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14615
14616@itemize @bullet
14617
14618@item
14619@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14620specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14621
14622@item
14623@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14624@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14625
14626@item
14627@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14628
14629@item
14630@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14631
14632@end itemize
14633
14634@noindent
14635The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14636in order of increasing precedence:
14637
14638@table @code
14639@item ,
14640The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14641are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14642expression being the last expression evaluated.
14643
14644@item =
14645Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14646assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14647
14648@item @var{op}=
14649Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14650and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14651@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14652@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14653@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14654
14655@item ?:
14656The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14657of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14658should be of an integral type.
14659
14660@item ||
14661Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14662
14663@item &&
14664Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14665
14666@item |
14667Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14668
14669@item ^
14670Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14671
14672@item &
14673Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14674
14675@item ==@r{, }!=
14676Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14677expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14678
14679@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14680Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14681Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14682and non-zero for true.
14683
14684@item <<@r{, }>>
14685left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14686
14687@item @@
14688The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14689
14690@item +@r{, }-
14691Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14692pointer types.
14693
14694@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14695Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14696defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14697integral types.
14698
14699@item ++@r{, }--
14700Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14701operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14702when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14703operation takes place.
14704
14705@item *
14706Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14707@code{++}.
14708
14709@item &
14710Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14711
14712For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14713allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14714to examine the address
14715where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14716stored.
14717
14718@item -
14719Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14720precedence as @code{++}.
14721
14722@item !
14723Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14724@code{++}.
14725
14726@item ~
14727Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14728@code{++}.
14729
14730
14731@item .@r{, }->
14732Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14733@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14734pointer based on the stored type information.
14735Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14736
14737@item .*@r{, }->*
14738Dereferences of pointers to members.
14739
14740@item []
14741Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14742@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14743
14744@item ()
14745Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14746
14747@item ::
14748C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14749and @code{class} types.
14750
14751@item ::
14752Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14753(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14754above.
14755@end table
14756
14757If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14758attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14759predefined meaning.
14760
14761@node C Constants
14762@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14763
14764@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14765
14766@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14767following ways:
14768
14769@itemize @bullet
14770@item
14771Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14772specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14773by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14774@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14775@code{long} value.
14776
14777@item
14778Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14779point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14780exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14781@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14782sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14783A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14784@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14785the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14786a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14787constant.
14788
14789@item
14790Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14791integral equivalents.
14792
14793@item
14794Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14795(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14796(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14797be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14798the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14799of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14800@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14801@samp{\n} for newline.
14802
14803Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14804constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14805form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14806computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14807
14808@item
14809String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14810double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14811above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14812a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14813characters.
14814
14815Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14816with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14817computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14818
14819@item
14820Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14821to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14822
14823@item
14824Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14825and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14826integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14827and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14828@end itemize
14829
14830@node C Plus Plus Expressions
14831@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14832
14833@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14834@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14835
14836@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14837@cindex C@t{++} compilers
14838@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14839@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14840@quotation
14841@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14842the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14843@value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14844with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14845debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14846popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14847work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14848code. @xref{Compilation}.
14849@end quotation
14850
14851@enumerate
14852
14853@cindex member functions
14854@item
14855Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14856
14857@smallexample
14858count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14859@end smallexample
14860
14861@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14862@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14863@item
14864While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14865expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14866that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14867pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14868declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14869
14870@cindex call overloaded functions
14871@cindex overloaded functions, calling
14872@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14873@item
14874You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14875call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14876perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14877calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14878in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14879default arguments.
14880
14881It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14882promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14883class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14884functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14885number of function arguments.
14886
14887Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14888@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14889,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14890
14891You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14892explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14893@smallexample
14894p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14895@end smallexample
14896
14897The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14898see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14899
14900@cindex reference declarations
14901@item
14902@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14903references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14904source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14905
14906In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14907reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14908avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14909The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14910you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14911
14912@item
14913@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14914expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14915one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14916necessary, for example in an expression like
14917@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14918resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14919debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14920
14921@item
14922@value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14923specification.
14924@end enumerate
14925
14926@node C Defaults
14927@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14928
14929@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14930
14931If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14932defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14933C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14934selects the working language.
14935
14936If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14937recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14938@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14939these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14940@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14941for further details.
14942
14943@node C Checks
14944@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14945
14946@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14947
14948By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14949checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14950will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14951constants to pointers.
14952
14953Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14954indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14955that is not itself an array.
14956
14957@node Debugging C
14958@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14959
14960The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14961the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14962inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14963appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14964
14965The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14966with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14967,Expressions}.
14968
14969@node Debugging C Plus Plus
14970@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14971
14972@cindex commands for C@t{++}
14973
14974Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14975designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14976
14977@table @code
14978@cindex break in overloaded functions
14979@item @r{breakpoint menus}
14980When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14981@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14982locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14983@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14984
14985@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14986@item rbreak @var{regex}
14987Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14988breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14989classes.
14990@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14991
14992@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14993@item catch throw
14994@itemx catch rethrow
14995@itemx catch catch
14996Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14997Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14998
14999@cindex inheritance
15000@item ptype @var{typename}
15001Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15002@var{typename}.
15003@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15004
15005@item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15006The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15007method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15008one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15009multiple inheritance is in use.
15010
15011@cindex C@t{++} demangling
15012@item demangle @var{name}
15013Demangle @var{name}.
15014@xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15015
15016@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15017@item set print demangle
15018@itemx show print demangle
15019@itemx set print asm-demangle
15020@itemx show print asm-demangle
15021Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15022displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15023@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15024
15025@item set print object
15026@itemx show print object
15027Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15028@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15029
15030@item set print vtbl
15031@itemx show print vtbl
15032Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15033@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15034(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15035ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15036
15037@kindex set overload-resolution
15038@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15039@item set overload-resolution on
15040Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15041is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15042and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15043using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15044Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15045If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15046
15047@item set overload-resolution off
15048Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15049overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15050chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15051symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15052overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15053searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15054argument types.
15055
15056@kindex show overload-resolution
15057@item show overload-resolution
15058Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15059
15060@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15061You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15062the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15063@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15064also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15065available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15066@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15067@end table
15068
15069@node Decimal Floating Point
15070@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15071@cindex decimal floating point format
15072
15073@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15074decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15075@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15076specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15077
15078There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15079Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15080PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15081configured target.
15082
15083Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15084to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15085(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15086
15087In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15088point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15089underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15090
15091In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15092to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15093See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15094
15095@node D
15096@subsection D
15097
15098@cindex D
15099@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15100GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15101specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15102
15103@node Go
15104@subsection Go
15105
15106@cindex Go (programming language)
15107@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15108@file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15109
15110Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15111
15112@table @code
15113@cindex current Go package
15114@item The current Go package
15115The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15116specifying global variables and functions.
15117
15118For example, given the program:
15119
15120@example
15121package main
15122var myglob = "Shall we?"
15123func main () @{
15124 // ...
15125@}
15126@end example
15127
15128When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15129
15130@example
15131(gdb) p myglob
15132(gdb) p main.myglob
15133@end example
15134
15135@cindex builtin Go types
15136@item Builtin Go types
15137The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15138as a string.
15139
15140@cindex builtin Go functions
15141@item Builtin Go functions
15142The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15143function and handles it internally.
15144
15145@cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15146@item Restrictions on Go expressions
15147All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15148The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15149Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15150@end table
15151
15152@node Objective-C
15153@subsection Objective-C
15154
15155@cindex Objective-C
15156This section provides information about some commands and command
15157options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15158@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15159few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15160
15161@menu
15162* Method Names in Commands::
15163* The Print Command with Objective-C::
15164@end menu
15165
15166@node Method Names in Commands
15167@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15168
15169The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15170names as line specifications:
15171
15172@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15173@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15174@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15175@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15176@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15177@itemize
15178@item @code{clear}
15179@item @code{break}
15180@item @code{info line}
15181@item @code{jump}
15182@item @code{list}
15183@end itemize
15184
15185A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15186
15187@smallexample
15188-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15189@end smallexample
15190
15191where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15192plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15193name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15194brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15195source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15196instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15197debugged, enter:
15198
15199@smallexample
15200break -[Fruit create]
15201@end smallexample
15202
15203To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15204enter:
15205
15206@smallexample
15207list +[NSText initialize]
15208@end smallexample
15209
15210In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15211required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15212sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15213is also possible to specify just a method name:
15214
15215@smallexample
15216break create
15217@end smallexample
15218
15219You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15220your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15221you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15222method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15223none apply.
15224
15225As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15226@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15227
15228@smallexample
15229clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15230@end smallexample
15231
15232@node The Print Command with Objective-C
15233@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15234@cindex Objective-C, print objects
15235@kindex print-object
15236@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15237
15238The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15239
15240@smallexample
15241print -[@var{object} hash]
15242@end smallexample
15243
15244@cindex print an Objective-C object description
15245@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15246@noindent
15247will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15248and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15249@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15250the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15251with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15252function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15253
15254@node OpenCL C
15255@subsection OpenCL C
15256
15257@cindex OpenCL C
15258This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15259
15260@menu
15261* OpenCL C Datatypes::
15262* OpenCL C Expressions::
15263* OpenCL C Operators::
15264@end menu
15265
15266@node OpenCL C Datatypes
15267@subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15268
15269@cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15270@value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15271by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15272data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15273extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15274
15275@node OpenCL C Expressions
15276@subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15277
15278@cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15279@value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15280lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15281supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15282
15283@node OpenCL C Operators
15284@subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15285
15286@cindex OpenCL C Operators
15287@value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15288vector data types.
15289
15290@node Fortran
15291@subsection Fortran
15292@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15293
15294@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15295currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15296
15297@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15298Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15299among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15300functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15301will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15302underscore.
15303
15304@menu
15305* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15306* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15307* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15308@end menu
15309
15310@node Fortran Operators
15311@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15312
15313@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15314
15315Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15316@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15317arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15318
15319@table @code
15320@item **
15321The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15322of the second one.
15323
15324@item :
15325The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15326represent a section of array.
15327
15328@item %
15329The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15330types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15331this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15332union type.
15333@end table
15334
15335@node Fortran Defaults
15336@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15337
15338@cindex Fortran Defaults
15339
15340Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15341default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15342change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15343@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15344
15345@node Special Fortran Commands
15346@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15347
15348@cindex Special Fortran commands
15349
15350@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15351such as displaying common blocks.
15352
15353@table @code
15354@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15355@kindex info common
15356@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15357This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15358block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15359all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15360printed.
15361@end table
15362
15363@node Pascal
15364@subsection Pascal
15365
15366@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15367Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15368nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15369entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15370syntax.
15371
15372The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15373controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15374@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15375
15376@node Rust
15377@subsection Rust
15378
15379@value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15380Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15381parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15382peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15383
15384@itemize @bullet
15385@item
15386Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15387crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15388crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15389
15390That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15391crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15392to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15393@samp{B}.
15394
15395As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15396items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15397
15398@item
15399Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15400expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15401For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15402@samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15403@samp{K::x::y}.
15404
15405However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15406debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15407circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15408a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15409scope.
15410
15411In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15412the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15413
15414@item
15415The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15416expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15417
15418@item
15419Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15420
15421@item
15422The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15423@code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15424never be destroyed.
15425
15426@item
15427@value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15428to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15429will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15430
15431@item
15432@value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15433cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15434context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15435invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15436operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15437example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15438@code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15439@code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15440
15441@item
15442As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15443the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15444features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15445@itemize @bullet
15446
15447@item
15448Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15449
15450@item
15451Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15452
15453@item
15454Operator overloading is not implemented.
15455
15456@item
15457When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15458type names.
15459
15460@item
15461The type @code{Self} is not available.
15462
15463@item
15464@code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15465available in the crate.
15466@end itemize
15467@end itemize
15468
15469@node Modula-2
15470@subsection Modula-2
15471
15472@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15473
15474The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15475output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15476developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15477attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15478to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15479table.
15480
15481@cindex expressions in Modula-2
15482@menu
15483* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15484* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15485* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15486* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15487* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15488* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15489* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15490* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15491* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15492@end menu
15493
15494@node M2 Operators
15495@subsubsection Operators
15496@cindex Modula-2 operators
15497
15498Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15499@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15500often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15501following definitions hold:
15502
15503@itemize @bullet
15504
15505@item
15506@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15507their subranges.
15508
15509@item
15510@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15511
15512@item
15513@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15514
15515@item
15516@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15517@var{type}}.
15518
15519@item
15520@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15521
15522@item
15523@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15524
15525@item
15526@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15527@end itemize
15528
15529@noindent
15530The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15531increasing precedence:
15532
15533@table @code
15534@item ,
15535Function argument or array index separator.
15536
15537@item :=
15538Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15539@var{value}.
15540
15541@item <@r{, }>
15542Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15543types.
15544
15545@item <=@r{, }>=
15546Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15547on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15548set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15549
15550@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15551Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15552Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15553available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15554comment character.
15555
15556@item IN
15557Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15558Same precedence as @code{<}.
15559
15560@item OR
15561Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15562
15563@item AND@r{, }&
15564Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15565
15566@item @@
15567The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15568
15569@item +@r{, }-
15570Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15571and difference on set types.
15572
15573@item *
15574Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15575on set types.
15576
15577@item /
15578Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15579types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15580
15581@item DIV@r{, }MOD
15582Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15583precedence as @code{*}.
15584
15585@item -
15586Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15587
15588@item ^
15589Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15590
15591@item NOT
15592Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15593@code{^}.
15594
15595@item .
15596@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15597precedence as @code{^}.
15598
15599@item []
15600Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15601
15602@item ()
15603Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15604as @code{^}.
15605
15606@item ::@r{, }.
15607@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15608@end table
15609
15610@quotation
15611@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15612treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15613@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15614@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15615@end quotation
15616
15617
15618@node Built-In Func/Proc
15619@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15620@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15621
15622Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15623In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15624
15625@table @var
15626
15627@item a
15628represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15629
15630@item c
15631represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15632
15633@item i
15634represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15635
15636@item m
15637represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15638same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15639be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15640
15641@item n
15642represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15643
15644@item r
15645represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15646
15647@item t
15648represents a type.
15649
15650@item v
15651represents a variable.
15652
15653@item x
15654represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15655explanation of the function for details.
15656@end table
15657
15658All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15659
15660@table @code
15661@item ABS(@var{n})
15662Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15663
15664@item CAP(@var{c})
15665If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15666equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15667
15668@item CHR(@var{i})
15669Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15670
15671@item DEC(@var{v})
15672Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15673
15674@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15675Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15676new value.
15677
15678@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15679Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15680set.
15681
15682@item FLOAT(@var{i})
15683Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15684
15685@item HIGH(@var{a})
15686Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15687
15688@item INC(@var{v})
15689Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15690
15691@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15692Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15693new value.
15694
15695@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15696Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15697there. Returns the new set.
15698
15699@item MAX(@var{t})
15700Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15701
15702@item MIN(@var{t})
15703Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15704
15705@item ODD(@var{i})
15706Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15707
15708@item ORD(@var{x})
15709Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15710value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15711the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15712ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15713
15714@item SIZE(@var{x})
15715Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15716variable or a type.
15717
15718@item TRUNC(@var{r})
15719Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15720
15721@item TSIZE(@var{x})
15722Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15723variable or a type.
15724
15725@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15726Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15727@end table
15728
15729@quotation
15730@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15731@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15732an error.
15733@end quotation
15734
15735@cindex Modula-2 constants
15736@node M2 Constants
15737@subsubsection Constants
15738
15739@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15740ways:
15741
15742@itemize @bullet
15743
15744@item
15745Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15746expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15747rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15748trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15749
15750@item
15751Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15752decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15753then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15754@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15755digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15756digits.
15757
15758@item
15759Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15760like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15761also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15762followed by a @samp{C}.
15763
15764@item
15765String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15766pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15767Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15768Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15769sequences.
15770
15771@item
15772Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15773
15774@item
15775Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15776@code{FALSE}.
15777
15778@item
15779Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15780
15781@item
15782Set constants are not yet supported.
15783@end itemize
15784
15785@node M2 Types
15786@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15787@cindex Modula-2 types
15788
15789Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15790syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15791types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15792print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15793This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15794sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15795
15796The first example contains the following section of code:
15797
15798@smallexample
15799VAR
15800 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15801 r: [20..40] ;
15802@end smallexample
15803
15804@noindent
15805and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15806@code{r} and @code{s}.
15807
15808@smallexample
15809(@value{GDBP}) print s
15810@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15811(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15812SET OF CHAR
15813(@value{GDBP}) print r
1581421
15815(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15816[20..40]
15817@end smallexample
15818
15819@noindent
15820Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15821
15822@smallexample
15823VAR
15824 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15825@end smallexample
15826
15827@noindent
15828then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15829
15830@smallexample
15831(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15832type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15833@end smallexample
15834
15835@noindent
15836Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15837expressions using the debugger.
15838
15839The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15840and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15841
15842@smallexample
15843VAR
15844 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15845@end smallexample
15846
15847@smallexample
15848(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15849ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15850@end smallexample
15851
15852Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15853is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15854arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15855above.
15856
15857Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15858
15859@smallexample
15860TYPE
15861 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15862 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15863VAR
15864 s: t ;
15865BEGIN
15866 s := blue ;
15867@end smallexample
15868
15869@noindent
15870The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15871and value of a variable.
15872
15873@smallexample
15874(@value{GDBP}) print s
15875$1 = blue
15876(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15877type = [blue..yellow]
15878@end smallexample
15879
15880@noindent
15881In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15882displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15883their @code{C} counterparts.
15884
15885@smallexample
15886VAR
15887 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15888BEGIN
15889 s[1] := 1 ;
15890@end smallexample
15891
15892@smallexample
15893(@value{GDBP}) print s
15894$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15895(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15896type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15897@end smallexample
15898
15899The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15900pointer types as shown in this example:
15901
15902@smallexample
15903VAR
15904 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15905BEGIN
15906 NEW(s) ;
15907 s^[1] := 1 ;
15908@end smallexample
15909
15910@noindent
15911and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15912
15913@smallexample
15914(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15915type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15916@end smallexample
15917
15918@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15919Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15920types:
15921
15922@smallexample
15923TYPE
15924 foo = RECORD
15925 f1: CARDINAL ;
15926 f2: CHAR ;
15927 f3: myarray ;
15928 END ;
15929
15930 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15931 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15932VAR
15933 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15934@end smallexample
15935
15936@noindent
15937and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15938below.
15939
15940@smallexample
15941(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15942type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15943 f1 : CARDINAL;
15944 f2 : CHAR;
15945 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15946END
15947@end smallexample
15948
15949@node M2 Defaults
15950@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15951@cindex Modula-2 defaults
15952
15953If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15954both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15955Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15956selected the working language.
15957
15958If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15959code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15960working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15961Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15962
15963@node Deviations
15964@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15965@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15966
15967A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15968This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15969
15970@itemize @bullet
15971@item
15972Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15973integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15974debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15975pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15976through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15977returned a pointer.)
15978
15979@item
15980C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15981non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15982escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15983printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15984
15985@item
15986The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15987argument.
15988
15989@item
15990All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15991@end itemize
15992
15993@node M2 Checks
15994@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15995@cindex Modula-2 checks
15996
15997@quotation
15998@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15999range checking.
16000@end quotation
16001@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16002
16003@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16004
16005@itemize @bullet
16006@item
16007They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16008@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16009
16010@item
16011They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16012@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16013@end itemize
16014
16015As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16016whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16017
16018Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16019index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16020
16021@node M2 Scope
16022@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16023@cindex scope
16024@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16025@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16026@ifinfo
16027@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16028@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16029@end ifinfo
16030@ifnotinfo
16031@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16032@end ifnotinfo
16033
16034There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16035(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16036similar syntax:
16037
16038@smallexample
16039
16040@var{module} . @var{id}
16041@var{scope} :: @var{id}
16042@end smallexample
16043
16044@noindent
16045where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16046@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16047identifier within your program, except another module.
16048
16049Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16050specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16051found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16052enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16053
16054Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16055the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16056definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16057an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16058module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16059@var{module}.
16060
16061@node GDB/M2
16062@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16063
16064Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16065Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16066specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16067@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16068apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16069analogue in Modula-2.
16070
16071The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16072with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16073intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16074created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16075address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16076@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16077
16078@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16079In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16080interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16081
16082@node Ada
16083@subsection Ada
16084@cindex Ada
16085
16086The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16087output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16088Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16089attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16090to be difficult.
16091
16092
16093@cindex expressions in Ada
16094@menu
16095* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16096 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16097 in @value{GDBN}.
16098* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16099* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16100* Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16101 subprograms.
16102* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16103* Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16104* Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16105* Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16106* Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16107 Profile
16108* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16109@end menu
16110
16111@node Ada Mode Intro
16112@subsubsection Introduction
16113@cindex Ada mode, general
16114
16115The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16116syntax, with some extensions.
16117The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16118
16119@itemize @bullet
16120@item
16121That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16122arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16123leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16124program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16125
16126@item
16127That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16128are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16129
16130@item
16131That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16132@end itemize
16133
16134Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16135user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16136according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16137names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16138ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16139
16140The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16141As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16142was translated from an Ada source file.
16143
16144While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16145mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16146(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16147middle (to allow based literals).
16148
16149@node Omissions from Ada
16150@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16151@cindex Ada, omissions from
16152
16153Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16154
16155@itemize @bullet
16156@item
16157Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16158
16159@itemize @minus
16160@item
16161@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16162 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16163
16164@item
16165@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16166
16167@item
16168@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16169
16170@item
16171@t{'Tag}.
16172
16173@item
16174@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16175operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16176
16177@item
16178@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16179@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16180
16181@item
16182@t{'Address}.
16183@end itemize
16184
16185@item
16186The names in
16187@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16188concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16189not currently available.
16190
16191@item
16192Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16193equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16194for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16195They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16196types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16197(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16198zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16199indeterminate values.
16200
16201@item
16202The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16203@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16204are not implemented.
16205
16206@item
16207@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16208@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16209@cindex aggregates (Ada)
16210There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16211permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16212
16213@smallexample
16214(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16215(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16216(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16217(@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16218(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16219(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16220@end smallexample
16221
16222Changing a
16223discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16224undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16225However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16226them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16227aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16228declared to have a type such as:
16229
16230@smallexample
16231type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16232 Id : Integer;
16233 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16234end record;
16235@end smallexample
16236
16237you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16238assignments:
16239
16240@smallexample
16241(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16242(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16243@end smallexample
16244
16245As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16246rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16247components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16248component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16249original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16250indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16251redundant component associations, although which component values are
16252assigned in such cases is not defined.
16253
16254@item
16255Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16256
16257@item
16258The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16259than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16260which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16261looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16262function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16263the proper resolution.
16264
16265@item
16266The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16267
16268@item
16269Entry calls are not implemented.
16270
16271@item
16272Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16273formats are not supported.
16274
16275@item
16276It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16277
16278@item
16279The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16280are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16281context.
16282Should your program
16283redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16284you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16285@end itemize
16286
16287@node Additions to Ada
16288@subsubsection Additions to Ada
16289@cindex Ada, deviations from
16290
16291As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16292extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16293
16294@itemize @bullet
16295@item
16296If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16297a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16298then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16299@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16300Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16301in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16302Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16303which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16304
16305@item
16306@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16307appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16308you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16309
16310@item
16311The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16312@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16313
16314@item
16315A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16316(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16317@end itemize
16318
16319In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16320additions specific to Ada:
16321
16322@itemize @bullet
16323@item
16324The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16325its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16326
16327@smallexample
16328(@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16329(@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16330@end smallexample
16331
16332@item
16333The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16334the value of its right-hand operand.
16335This allows, for example,
16336complex conditional breaks:
16337
16338@smallexample
16339(@value{GDBP}) break f
16340(@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16341@end smallexample
16342
16343@item
16344Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16345characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16346which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16347@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16348(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16349sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16350in strings. For example,
16351@smallexample
16352 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16353@end smallexample
16354@noindent
16355contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16356after each period.
16357
16358@item
16359The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16360@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16361to write
16362
16363@smallexample
16364(@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16365@end smallexample
16366
16367@item
16368When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16369array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16370For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16371of 3 might print as
16372
16373@smallexample
16374(3 => 10, 17, 1)
16375@end smallexample
16376
16377@noindent
16378That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16379clause.
16380
16381@item
16382You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16383multi-character subsequence of
16384their names (an exact match gets preference).
16385For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16386in place of @t{a'length}.
16387
16388@item
16389@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16390Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16391to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16392some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16393For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16394enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16395For example,
16396@smallexample
16397(@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16398@end smallexample
16399
16400@item
16401Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16402access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16403specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16404selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16405object.
16406
16407@end itemize
16408
16409@node Overloading support for Ada
16410@subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16411@cindex overloading, Ada
16412
16413The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16414the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16415actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16416the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16417procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16418functions to procedures elsewhere.
16419
16420If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16421one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16422use, for instance:
16423
16424@smallexample
16425(@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16426Multiple matches for f
16427[0] cancel
16428[1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16429[2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16430>
16431@end smallexample
16432
16433In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16434(type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16435instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16436
16437Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16438case:
16439
16440@table @code
16441
16442@kindex set ada print-signatures
16443@item set ada print-signatures
16444Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16445selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16446@xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16447
16448@kindex show ada print-signatures
16449@item show ada print-signatures
16450Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16451overloads selection menu.
16452@xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16453
16454@end table
16455
16456@node Stopping Before Main Program
16457@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16458
16459@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16460It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16461before reaching the main procedure.
16462As defined in the Ada Reference
16463Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16464@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16465elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16466@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16467
16468@node Ada Exceptions
16469@subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16470
16471A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16472
16473@table @code
16474@kindex info exceptions
16475@item info exceptions
16476@itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16477The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16478defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16479With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16480whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16481@end table
16482
16483Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16484without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16485argument.
16486
16487@smallexample
16488(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16489All defined Ada exceptions:
16490constraint_error: 0x613da0
16491program_error: 0x613d20
16492storage_error: 0x613ce0
16493tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16494const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16495(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16496All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16497constraint_error: 0x613da0
16498const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16499@end smallexample
16500
16501It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16502when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16503
16504@node Ada Tasks
16505@subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16506@cindex Ada, tasking
16507
16508Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16509@value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16510
16511@table @code
16512@kindex info tasks
16513@item info tasks
16514This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16515
16516
16517@smallexample
16518@iftex
16519@leftskip=0.5cm
16520@end iftex
16521(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16522 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16523 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16524 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16525 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16526* 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16527
16528@end smallexample
16529
16530@noindent
16531In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16532task currently being inspected.
16533
16534@table @asis
16535@item ID
16536Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16537
16538@item TID
16539The Ada task ID.
16540
16541@item P-ID
16542The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16543
16544@item Pri
16545The base priority of the task.
16546
16547@item State
16548Current state of the task.
16549
16550@table @code
16551@item Unactivated
16552The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16553executing.
16554
16555@item Runnable
16556The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16557for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16558
16559@item Terminated
16560The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16561that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16562terminated themselves.
16563
16564@item Child Activation Wait
16565The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16566
16567@item Accept Statement
16568The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16569
16570@item Waiting on entry call
16571The task is waiting on an entry call.
16572
16573@item Async Select Wait
16574The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16575select statement.
16576
16577@item Delay Sleep
16578The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16579alternative open.
16580
16581@item Child Termination Wait
16582The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16583waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16584waiting on a terminate Phase.
16585
16586@item Wait Child in Term Alt
16587The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16588finish terminating.
16589
16590@item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16591The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16592@end table
16593
16594@item Name
16595Name of the task in the program.
16596
16597@end table
16598
16599@kindex info task @var{taskno}
16600@item info task @var{taskno}
16601This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16602the following example:
16603@smallexample
16604@iftex
16605@leftskip=0.5cm
16606@end iftex
16607(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16608 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16609 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16610* 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16611(@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16612Ada Task: 0x807c468
16613Name: task_1
16614Thread: 0x807f378
16615Parent: 1 (main_task)
16616Base Priority: 15
16617State: Runnable
16618@end smallexample
16619
16620@item task
16621@kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16622@cindex current Ada task ID
16623This command prints the ID of the current task.
16624
16625@smallexample
16626@iftex
16627@leftskip=0.5cm
16628@end iftex
16629(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16630 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16631 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16632* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16633(@value{GDBP}) task
16634[Current task is 2]
16635@end smallexample
16636
16637@item task @var{taskno}
16638@cindex Ada task switching
16639This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16640command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16641from the current task to the given task.
16642
16643@smallexample
16644@iftex
16645@leftskip=0.5cm
16646@end iftex
16647(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16648 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16649 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16650* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16651(@value{GDBP}) task 1
16652[Switching to task 1]
16653#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16654(@value{GDBP}) bt
16655#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16656#1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16657#2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16658#3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16659#4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16660@end smallexample
16661
16662@item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16663@itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16664@cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16665@cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16666@kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16667These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16668command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16669@var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16670in @ref{Specify Location}.
16671
16672Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16673to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16674particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16675numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16676column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16677
16678If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16679breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16680program.
16681
16682You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16683well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16684breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16685
16686For example,
16687
16688@smallexample
16689@iftex
16690@leftskip=0.5cm
16691@end iftex
16692(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16693 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16694 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16695 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16696 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16697* 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16698(@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16699Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16700(@value{GDBP}) cont
16701Continuing.
16702task # 1 running
16703task # 2 running
16704
16705Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
1670615 flush;
16707(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16708 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16709 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16710* 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16711 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16712 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16713@end smallexample
16714@end table
16715
16716@node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16717@subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16718@cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16719
16720When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16721tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16722the platform being used.
16723For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16724switching is not supported.
16725
16726On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16727memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16728a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16729privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16730Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16731file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16732
16733@node Ravenscar Profile
16734@subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16735@cindex Ravenscar Profile
16736
16737The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16738specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16739requirements.
16740
16741@table @code
16742@kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16743@cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16744@item set ravenscar task-switching on
16745Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16746Profile. This is the default.
16747
16748@kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16749@item set ravenscar task-switching off
16750Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16751Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16752for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16753the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16754To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16755
16756@kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16757@item show ravenscar task-switching
16758Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16759using the Ravenscar Profile.
16760
16761@end table
16762
16763@node Ada Glitches
16764@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16765@cindex Ada, problems
16766
16767Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16768we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16769@value{GDBN},
16770some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16771and the GNU Ada compiler.
16772
16773@itemize @bullet
16774@item
16775Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16776storage are invisible to the debugger.
16777
16778@item
16779Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16780argument lists are treated as positional).
16781
16782@item
16783Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16784
16785@item
16786Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16787floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16788the host machine.
16789
16790@item
16791The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16792the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16793this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16794look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16795symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16796defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16797local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16798GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16799you can usually resolve the confusion
16800by qualifying the problematic names with package
16801@code{Standard} explicitly.
16802@end itemize
16803
16804Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16805information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16806of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16807around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16808to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16809enabled.
16810
16811@kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16812@kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16813@table @code
16814
16815@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16816Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16817value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16818types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16819a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16820This is the default.
16821
16822@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16823This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16824sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16825trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16826the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16827@code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16828recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16829
16830@end table
16831
16832@cindex GNAT descriptive types
16833@cindex GNAT encoding
16834Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16835of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16836@file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16837how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16838In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16839which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16840
16841These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16842format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16843types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16844Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16845types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16846a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16847those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16848well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16849
16850@table @code
16851
16852@kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16853@item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16854Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16855The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16856
16857@kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16858@item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16859Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16860
16861@end table
16862
16863@node Unsupported Languages
16864@section Unsupported Languages
16865
16866@cindex unsupported languages
16867@cindex minimal language
16868In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16869@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16870It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16871of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16872This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16873an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16874
16875If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16876select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16877language.
16878
16879@node Symbols
16880@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16881
16882The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16883symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16884program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16885does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16886program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16887(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16888file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16889
16890@cindex symbol names
16891@cindex names of symbols
16892@cindex quoting names
16893Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16894characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16895most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16896source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16897are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16898ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16899@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16900@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16901
16902@smallexample
16903p 'foo.c'::x
16904@end smallexample
16905
16906@noindent
16907looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16908
16909@table @code
16910@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16911@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16912@kindex set case-sensitive
16913@item set case-sensitive on
16914@itemx set case-sensitive off
16915@itemx set case-sensitive auto
16916Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16917with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16918Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16919case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16920case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16921you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16922suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16923matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16924case-insensitive matches.
16925
16926@kindex show case-sensitive
16927@item show case-sensitive
16928This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16929lookups.
16930
16931@kindex set print type methods
16932@item set print type methods
16933@itemx set print type methods on
16934@itemx set print type methods off
16935Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16936declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16937passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16938print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16939display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16940cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16941
16942@kindex show print type methods
16943@item show print type methods
16944This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16945classes.
16946
16947@kindex set print type typedefs
16948@item set print type typedefs
16949@itemx set print type typedefs on
16950@itemx set print type typedefs off
16951
16952Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16953defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16954passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16955print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16956display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16957@code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16958Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16959printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16960types.
16961
16962@kindex show print type typedefs
16963@item show print type typedefs
16964This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16965printing classes.
16966
16967@kindex info address
16968@cindex address of a symbol
16969@item info address @var{symbol}
16970Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16971variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16972local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16973is always stored.
16974
16975Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16976at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16977the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16978
16979@kindex info symbol
16980@cindex symbol from address
16981@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16982@item info symbol @var{addr}
16983Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16984If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16985nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16986
16987@smallexample
16988(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16989_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16990@end smallexample
16991
16992@noindent
16993This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16994it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16995
16996For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16997library containing the symbol is also printed:
16998
16999@smallexample
17000(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17001_start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17002(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17003__read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17004@end smallexample
17005
17006@kindex demangle
17007@cindex demangle
17008@item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17009Demangle @var{name}.
17010If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17011@var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17012
17013The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17014and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17015
17016The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17017of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17018
17019@kindex whatis
17020@item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17021Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17022or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17023@code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17024
17025If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17026is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17027assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17028
17029If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17030literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17031defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17032the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17033variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17034@code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17035fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17036name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17037such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17038
17039If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17040@code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17041Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17042in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17043underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17044unroll it.
17045
17046For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17047@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17048@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17049
17050@var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17051Available flags are:
17052
17053@table @code
17054@item r
17055Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17056parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17057members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17058
17059@item m
17060Do not print methods defined in the class.
17061
17062@item M
17063Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17064exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17065
17066@item t
17067Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17068whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17069names are substituted when printing other types.
17070
17071@item T
17072Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17073exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17074@end table
17075
17076@kindex ptype
17077@item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17078@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17079detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17080@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17081
17082Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17083@code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17084a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17085of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17086present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17087the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17088fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17089@code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17090
17091For example, for this variable declaration:
17092
17093@smallexample
17094typedef double real_t;
17095struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17096typedef struct complex complex_t;
17097complex_t var;
17098real_t *real_pointer_var;
17099@end smallexample
17100
17101@noindent
17102the two commands give this output:
17103
17104@smallexample
17105@group
17106(@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17107type = complex_t
17108(@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17109type = struct complex @{
17110 real_t real;
17111 double imag;
17112@}
17113(@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17114type = struct complex
17115(@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17116type = struct complex
17117(@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17118type = struct complex @{
17119 real_t real;
17120 double imag;
17121@}
17122(@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17123type = real_t *
17124(@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17125type = double *
17126@end group
17127@end smallexample
17128
17129@noindent
17130As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17131the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17132
17133@cindex incomplete type
17134Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17135of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17136program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17137the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17138given these declarations:
17139
17140@smallexample
17141 struct foo;
17142 struct foo *fooptr;
17143@end smallexample
17144
17145@noindent
17146but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17147
17148@smallexample
17149 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17150 $1 = <incomplete type>
17151@end smallexample
17152
17153@noindent
17154``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17155completely specified.
17156
17157@cindex unknown type
17158Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17159from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17160happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17161includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17162exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17163dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17164information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17165@value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17166
17167@smallexample
17168 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17169 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17170@end smallexample
17171
17172@xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17173of such variables.
17174
17175@kindex info types
17176@item info types @var{regexp}
17177@itemx info types
17178Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17179expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17180no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17181complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17182types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17183@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17184name is @code{value}.
17185
17186This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17187@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17188lists all source files where a type is defined.
17189
17190@kindex info type-printers
17191@item info type-printers
17192Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17193have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17194@command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17195is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17196type printers.
17197
17198@code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17199
17200@kindex enable type-printer
17201@kindex disable type-printer
17202@item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17203@item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17204These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17205
17206@kindex info scope
17207@cindex local variables
17208@item info scope @var{location}
17209List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17210accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17211an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17212to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17213details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17214
17215@smallexample
17216(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17217Scope for command_line_handler:
17218Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17219Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17220Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17221Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17222Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17223Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17224Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17225@end smallexample
17226
17227@noindent
17228This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17229during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17230collect}.
17231
17232@kindex info source
17233@item info source
17234Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17235the function containing the current point of execution:
17236@itemize @bullet
17237@item
17238the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17239@item
17240the directory it was compiled in,
17241@item
17242its length, in lines,
17243@item
17244which programming language it is written in,
17245@item
17246if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17247(which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17248@item
17249whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17250if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17251@item
17252whether the debugging information includes information about
17253preprocessor macros.
17254@end itemize
17255
17256
17257@kindex info sources
17258@item info sources
17259Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17260debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17261have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17262
17263@kindex info functions
17264@item info functions
17265Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17266
17267@item info functions @var{regexp}
17268Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17269whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17270Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17271include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17272start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17273that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17274@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17275
17276@kindex info variables
17277@item info variables
17278Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17279outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17280
17281@item info variables @var{regexp}
17282Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17283variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17284@var{regexp}.
17285
17286@kindex info classes
17287@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17288@item info classes
17289@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17290Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17291(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17292expression.
17293
17294@kindex info selectors
17295@item info selectors
17296@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17297Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17298(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17299expression.
17300
17301@ignore
17302This was never implemented.
17303@kindex info methods
17304@item info methods
17305@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17306The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17307methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17308specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17309C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17310from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17311@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17312which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17313@end ignore
17314
17315@cindex opaque data types
17316@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17317@item set opaque-type-resolution on
17318Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17319declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17320@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17321source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17322another source file. The default is on.
17323
17324A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17325the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17326
17327@item set opaque-type-resolution off
17328Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17329is printed as follows:
17330@smallexample
17331@{<no data fields>@}
17332@end smallexample
17333
17334@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17335@item show opaque-type-resolution
17336Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17337
17338@kindex set print symbol-loading
17339@cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17340@item set print symbol-loading
17341@itemx set print symbol-loading full
17342@itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17343@itemx set print symbol-loading off
17344The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17345printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17346By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17347shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17348debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17349can be annoying.
17350When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17351and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17352it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17353libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17354
17355@kindex show print symbol-loading
17356@item show print symbol-loading
17357Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17358entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17359
17360@kindex maint print symbols
17361@cindex symbol dump
17362@kindex maint print psymbols
17363@cindex partial symbol dump
17364@kindex maint print msymbols
17365@cindex minimal symbol dump
17366@item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17367@itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17368@itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17369@itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17370@itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17371Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17372the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17373If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17374that objfile.
17375If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17376with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17377@code{main}.
17378If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17379source file.
17380
17381These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17382These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17383@samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17384tables.
17385You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17386If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17387about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17388defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17389Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17390``ELF symbols''.
17391
17392@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17393@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17394
17395@kindex maint info symtabs
17396@kindex maint info psymtabs
17397@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17398@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17399@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17400@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17401@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17402@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17403
17404List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17405structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17406given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17407copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17408structure in more detail. For example:
17409
17410@smallexample
17411(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17412@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17413 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17414 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17415 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17416 readin no
17417 fullname (null)
17418 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17419 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17420 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17421 dependencies (none)
17422 @}
17423@}
17424(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17425(@value{GDBP})
17426@end smallexample
17427@noindent
17428We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17429the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17430and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17431If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17432read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17433
17434@smallexample
17435(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17436Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17437line 1574.
17438(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17439@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17440 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17441 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17442 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17443 dirname (null)
17444 fullname (null)
17445 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17446 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17447 debugformat DWARF 2
17448 @}
17449@}
17450(@value{GDBP})
17451@end smallexample
17452
17453@kindex maint info line-table
17454@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17455@cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17456@item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17457
17458List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17459instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17460given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17461
17462@kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17463@cindex symbol cache size
17464@item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17465Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17466The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17467most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17468with different sizes.
17469
17470@kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17471@item maint show symbol-cache-size
17472Show the size of the symbol cache.
17473
17474@kindex maint print symbol-cache
17475@cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17476@item maint print symbol-cache
17477Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17478This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17479
17480@kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17481@cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17482@item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17483Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17484This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17485
17486@kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17487@cindex symbol cache, flushing
17488@item maint flush-symbol-cache
17489Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17490This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17491It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17492
17493@end table
17494
17495@node Altering
17496@chapter Altering Execution
17497
17498Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17499find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17500correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17501experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17502program.
17503
17504For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17505locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17506address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17507
17508@menu
17509* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17510* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17511* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17512* Returning:: Returning from a function
17513* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17514* Patching:: Patching your program
17515* Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17516@end menu
17517
17518@node Assignment
17519@section Assignment to Variables
17520
17521@cindex assignment
17522@cindex setting variables
17523To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17524@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17525
17526@smallexample
17527print x=4
17528@end smallexample
17529
17530@noindent
17531stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17532value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17533@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17534information on operators in supported languages.
17535
17536@kindex set variable
17537@cindex variables, setting
17538If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17539@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17540really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17541not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17542,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17543
17544If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17545appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17546variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17547to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17548program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17549a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17550command @code{set width}:
17551
17552@smallexample
17553(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17554type = double
17555(@value{GDBP}) p width
17556$4 = 13
17557(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17558Invalid syntax in expression.
17559@end smallexample
17560
17561@noindent
17562The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17563order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17564
17565@smallexample
17566(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17567@end smallexample
17568
17569Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17570with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17571@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17572your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17573to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17574the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17575
17576@smallexample
17577@group
17578(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17579type = double
17580(@value{GDBP}) p g
17581$1 = 1
17582(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17583(@value{GDBP}) p g
17584$2 = 1
17585(@value{GDBP}) r
17586The program being debugged has been started already.
17587Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17588Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17589"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17590 Invalid bfd target.
17591(@value{GDBP}) show g
17592The current BFD target is "=4".
17593@end group
17594@end smallexample
17595
17596@noindent
17597The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17598@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17599@code{g}, use
17600
17601@smallexample
17602(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17603@end smallexample
17604
17605@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17606freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17607and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17608same length or shorter.
17609@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17610@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17611
17612To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17613construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17614(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17615to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17616and representation in memory), and
17617
17618@smallexample
17619set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17620@end smallexample
17621
17622@noindent
17623stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17624
17625@node Jumping
17626@section Continuing at a Different Address
17627
17628Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17629it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17630an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17631
17632@table @code
17633@kindex jump
17634@kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17635@item jump @var{location}
17636@itemx j @var{location}
17637Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17638if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17639of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17640practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17641@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17642
17643The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17644the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17645register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17646a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17647be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17648of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17649confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17650executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17651well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17652@end table
17653
17654On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17655command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17656difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17657changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17658example,
17659
17660@smallexample
17661set $pc = 0x485
17662@end smallexample
17663
17664@noindent
17665makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17666address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17667@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17668
17669The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17670up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17671that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17672detail.
17673
17674@c @group
17675@node Signaling
17676@section Giving your Program a Signal
17677@cindex deliver a signal to a program
17678
17679@table @code
17680@kindex signal
17681@item signal @var{signal}
17682Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17683signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17684signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17685SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17686
17687Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17688giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17689a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17690@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17691signal.
17692
17693@emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17694delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17695reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17696stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17697suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17698same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17699the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17700@value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17701
17702Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17703@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17704causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17705the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17706passes the signal directly to your program.
17707
17708@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17709after executing the command.
17710
17711@kindex queue-signal
17712@item queue-signal @var{signal}
17713Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17714when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17715the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17716@code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17717The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17718otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17719You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17720@code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17721
17722Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17723for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17724will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17725of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17726@code{continue} command.
17727
17728This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17729is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17730be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17731(@pxref{Signals}).
17732@end table
17733@c @end group
17734
17735@xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17736commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17737
17738@node Returning
17739@section Returning from a Function
17740
17741@table @code
17742@cindex returning from a function
17743@kindex return
17744@item return
17745@itemx return @var{expression}
17746You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17747command. If you give an
17748@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17749value.
17750@end table
17751
17752When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17753(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17754discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17755be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17756
17757This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17758Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17759innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17760specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17761of functions.
17762
17763The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17764program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17765returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17766and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17767selected stack frame returns naturally.
17768
17769@value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17770the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17771type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17772OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17773CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17774registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17775specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17776current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17777assignment into the right register(s).
17778
17779Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17780use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17781debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17782function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17783int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17784into a @code{long long int}:
17785
17786@smallexample
17787Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
1778829 return 31;
17789(@value{GDBP}) return -1
17790Make func return now? (y or n) y
17791#0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
1779243 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17793(@value{GDBP})
17794@end smallexample
17795
17796However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17797function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17798to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17799in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17800typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17801of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17802architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17803an appropriate cast explicitly:
17804
17805@smallexample
17806Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17807(@value{GDBP}) return -1
17808Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17809Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17810(@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17811Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17812#0 0x00400526 in main ()
17813(@value{GDBP})
17814@end smallexample
17815
17816@node Calling
17817@section Calling Program Functions
17818
17819@table @code
17820@cindex calling functions
17821@cindex inferior functions, calling
17822@item print @var{expr}
17823Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17824The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17825debugged.
17826
17827@kindex call
17828@item call @var{expr}
17829Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17830returned values.
17831
17832You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17833execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17834(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17835with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17836print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17837value history.
17838@end table
17839
17840It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17841@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17842the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17843in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17844
17845Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17846call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17847exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17848frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17849an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17850dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17851seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17852in that case is controlled by the
17853@code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17854
17855@table @code
17856@item set unwindonsignal
17857@kindex set unwindonsignal
17858@cindex unwind stack in called functions
17859@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17860Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17861that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17862@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17863the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17864default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17865received.
17866
17867@item show unwindonsignal
17868@kindex show unwindonsignal
17869Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17870@value{GDBN}.
17871
17872@item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17873@kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17874@cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17875@cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17876Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17877unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17878debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17879it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17880the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17881the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17882
17883@item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17884@kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17885Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17886@value{GDBN}.
17887
17888@end table
17889
17890@subsection Calling functions with no debug info
17891
17892@cindex no debug info functions
17893Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
17894In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
17895including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
17896the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
17897function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
17898to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
17899
17900For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
17901to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
17902declared return type. For example:
17903
17904@smallexample
17905(@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
17906'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
17907(@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
17908$1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
17909@end smallexample
17910
17911Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
17912casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
17913prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
17914calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
17915
17916@smallexample
17917(@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
17918@end smallexample
17919
17920@noindent
17921and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
17922
17923@smallexample
17924float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
17925@end smallexample
17926
17927@noindent
17928these calls are equivalent:
17929
17930@smallexample
17931(@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
17932(@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17933@end smallexample
17934
17935If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
17936old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
17937that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
17938promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
17939promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
17940float parameters, and no debug info:
17941
17942@smallexample
17943float
17944multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
17945 float v1, v2;
17946@{
17947 return v1 * v2;
17948@}
17949@end smallexample
17950
17951@noindent
17952you call it like this:
17953
17954@smallexample
17955 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17956@end smallexample
17957
17958@node Patching
17959@section Patching Programs
17960
17961@cindex patching binaries
17962@cindex writing into executables
17963@cindex writing into corefiles
17964
17965By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17966executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17967alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17968patching your program's binary.
17969
17970If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17971explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17972want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17973repairs.
17974
17975@table @code
17976@kindex set write
17977@item set write on
17978@itemx set write off
17979If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17980core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17981off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17982
17983If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17984@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17985write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17986
17987@item show write
17988@kindex show write
17989Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17990as well as reading.
17991@end table
17992
17993@node Compiling and Injecting Code
17994@section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17995@cindex injecting code
17996@cindex writing into executables
17997@cindex compiling code
17998
17999@value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18000programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18001@file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18002This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18003
18004@table @code
18005@kindex compile code
18006@item compile code @var{source-code}
18007@itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18008Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18009language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18010injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18011@value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18012message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18013successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18014and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18015It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18016After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18017new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18018
18019The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18020The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18021E.g.:
18022
18023@smallexample
18024compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18025@end smallexample
18026
18027If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18028may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18029from actual source code. E.g.:
18030
18031@smallexample
18032compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18033@end smallexample
18034
18035Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18036enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18037following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18038allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18039have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18040editor.
18041
18042@smallexample
18043compile code
18044>printf ("hello\n");
18045>printf ("world\n");
18046>end
18047@end smallexample
18048
18049Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18050provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18051specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18052@code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18053inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18054@var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18055inferior symbols otherwise.
18056
18057@kindex compile file
18058@item compile file @var{filename}
18059@itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18060Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18061
18062@smallexample
18063compile file /home/user/example.c
18064@end smallexample
18065@end table
18066
18067@table @code
18068@item compile print @var{expr}
18069@itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18070Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18071current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18072value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18073you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18074@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18075Formats}.
18076
18077@item compile print
18078@itemx compile print /@var{f}
18079@cindex reprint the last value
18080Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18081multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18082command without any text following the command. This will start the
18083multiple-line editor.
18084@end table
18085
18086@noindent
18087The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18088
18089@table @code
18090@anchor{set debug compile}
18091@item set debug compile
18092@cindex compile command debugging info
18093Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18094injecting the code. The default is off.
18095
18096@item show debug compile
18097Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18098compiling and injecting the code.
18099@end table
18100
18101@subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18102
18103@value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18104to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18105and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18106injecting process.
18107
18108@noindent
18109The options used, in increasing precedence:
18110
18111@table @asis
18112@item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18113These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18114system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18115(@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18116
18117@item compilation options recorded in the target
18118@value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18119into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18120to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18121explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18122@value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18123platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18124try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18125
18126@item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18127@end table
18128
18129@noindent
18130You can override compilation options using the following command:
18131
18132@table @code
18133@item set compile-args
18134@cindex compile command options override
18135Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18136@code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18137from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18138compilation.
18139
18140@item show compile-args
18141Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18142This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18143use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18144@end table
18145
18146@subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18147
18148There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18149command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18150highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18151
18152@table @asis
18153@item C code examples and caveats
18154When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18155attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18156code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18157access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18158the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18159
18160Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18161follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18162much like any other normal debugging session.
18163
18164@smallexample
18165void function1 (void)
18166@{
18167 int i = 42;
18168 printf ("function 1\n");
18169@}
18170
18171void function2 (void)
18172@{
18173 int j = 12;
18174 function1 ();
18175@}
18176
18177int main(void)
18178@{
18179 int k = 6;
18180 int *p;
18181 function2 ();
18182 return 0;
18183@}
18184@end smallexample
18185
18186For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18187been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18188@code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18189
18190To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18191program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18192@code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18193information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18194be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18195
18196So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18197information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18198all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18199out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18200@code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18201the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18202and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18203read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18204@code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18205@code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18206
18207@smallexample
18208compile code k = 3;
18209@end smallexample
18210
18211@noindent
18212the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18213something else in the example program changes it, or another
18214@code{compile} command changes it.
18215
18216Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18217injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18218@code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18219currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18220are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18221
18222@smallexample
18223compile code j = 3;
18224@end smallexample
18225
18226@noindent
18227will result in a compilation error message.
18228
18229Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18230scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18231the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18232
18233You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18234part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18235of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18236the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18237
18238@smallexample
18239compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18240@end smallexample
18241
18242However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18243command has completed:
18244
18245@smallexample
18246compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18247@end smallexample
18248
18249@noindent
18250a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18251exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18252command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18253when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18254code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18255
18256@smallexample
18257compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18258@end smallexample
18259
18260The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18261@code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18262it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18263assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18264changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18265variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18266to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18267would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18268
18269@smallexample
18270compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18271@end smallexample
18272
18273In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18274@code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18275However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18276assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18277location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18278in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18279or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18280
18281Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18282defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18283command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18284Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18285@code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18286need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18287
18288@smallexample
18289(gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18290(gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18291gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18292Compilation failed.
18293(gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
1829442
18295@end smallexample
18296
18297Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18298accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18299Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18300will print to the console.
18301@end table
18302
18303@subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18304
18305@value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18306which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18307than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18308@value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18309target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18310by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18311taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18312@value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18313
18314
18315Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18316@code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18317debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18318example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18319@code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18320for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18321pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18322
18323On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18324shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18325default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18326variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18327compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18328according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18329specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18330
18331@table @code
18332@item set compile-gcc
18333@cindex compile command driver filename override
18334Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18335@code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18336an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18337default.
18338
18339@item show compile-gcc
18340Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18341If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18342under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18343@end table
18344
18345@node GDB Files
18346@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18347
18348@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18349both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18350program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18351@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18352
18353@menu
18354* Files:: Commands to specify files
18355* File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18356* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18357* MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18358* Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18359* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18360* Data Files:: GDB data files
18361@end menu
18362
18363@node Files
18364@section Commands to Specify Files
18365
18366@cindex symbol table
18367@cindex core dump file
18368
18369You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18370way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18371@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18372Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18373
18374Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18375@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18376specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18377via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18378Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18379new files are useful.
18380
18381@table @code
18382@cindex executable file
18383@kindex file
18384@item file @var{filename}
18385Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18386symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18387executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18388directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18389@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18390directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18391to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18392and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18393
18394@cindex unlinked object files
18395@cindex patching object files
18396You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18397the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18398file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18399if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18400@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18401that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18402case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18403the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18404
18405@item file
18406@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18407has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18408
18409@kindex exec-file
18410@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18411Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18412in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18413if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18414discard information on the executable file.
18415
18416@kindex symbol-file
18417@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18418Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18419searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18420table and program to run from the same file.
18421
18422@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18423program's symbol table.
18424
18425The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18426some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18427contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18428which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18429@value{GDBN}.
18430
18431@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18432executing it once.
18433
18434When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18435understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18436generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18437other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18438Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18439using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18440optimized code.
18441
18442For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18443using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18444symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18445quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18446details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18447
18448The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18449start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18450occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18451file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18452pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18453Warnings and Messages}.)
18454
18455We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18456symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18457symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18458still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18459in stabs format.
18460
18461@kindex readnow
18462@cindex reading symbols immediately
18463@cindex symbols, reading immediately
18464@item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18465@itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18466You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18467tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18468load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18469entire symbol table available.
18470
18471@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18472@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18473@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18474@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18475@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18476@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18477@c files.
18478
18479@kindex core-file
18480@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18481@itemx core
18482Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18483of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18484address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18485executable file itself for other parts.
18486
18487@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18488to be used.
18489
18490Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18491under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18492wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18493the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18494(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18495
18496@kindex add-symbol-file
18497@cindex dynamic linking
18498@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18499@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18500@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18501The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18502information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18503when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18504into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18505address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18506this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18507of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18508section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18509@var{address} as an expression.
18510
18511The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18512originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18513@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18514thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18515
18516Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18517
18518@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18519@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18520@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18521@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18522@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18523Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18524executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18525relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18526information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18527
18528@itemize @bullet
18529@item
18530the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18531that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18532@item
18533every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18534been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18535@item
18536you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18537provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18538@end itemize
18539
18540@noindent
18541Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18542relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18543typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18544important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18545procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18546assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18547general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18548relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18549as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18550way.
18551
18552@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18553
18554@kindex remove-symbol-file
18555@item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18556@item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18557Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18558file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18559that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18560
18561@smallexample
18562(gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18563add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18564 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18565(y or n) y
18566Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18567(gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18568Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18569(gdb)
18570@end smallexample
18571
18572
18573@code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18574
18575@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18576@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18577@cindex load symbols from memory
18578@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18579Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18580object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18581For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18582process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18583some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18584evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18585For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18586@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18587
18588@kindex section
18589@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18590The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18591@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18592exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18593@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18594itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18595@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18596their addresses.
18597
18598@kindex info files
18599@kindex info target
18600@item info files
18601@itemx info target
18602@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18603current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18604including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18605use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18606command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18607current ones.
18608
18609@kindex maint info sections
18610@item maint info sections
18611Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18612is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18613displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18614offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18615@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18616may be arbitrarily combined):
18617
18618@table @code
18619@item ALLOBJ
18620Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18621@item @var{sections}
18622Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18623@item @var{section-flags}
18624Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18625The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18626@table @code
18627@item ALLOC
18628Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18629Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18630@item LOAD
18631Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18632Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18633@item RELOC
18634Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18635@item READONLY
18636Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18637@item CODE
18638Section contains executable code only.
18639@item DATA
18640Section contains data only (no executable code).
18641@item ROM
18642Section will reside in ROM.
18643@item CONSTRUCTOR
18644Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18645@item HAS_CONTENTS
18646Section is not empty.
18647@item NEVER_LOAD
18648An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18649@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18650A notification to the linker that the section contains
18651COFF shared library information.
18652@item IS_COMMON
18653Section contains common symbols.
18654@end table
18655@end table
18656@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18657@cindex read-only sections
18658@item set trust-readonly-sections on
18659Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18660really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18661In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18662out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18663For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18664enhancement to debugging performance.
18665
18666The default is off.
18667
18668@item set trust-readonly-sections off
18669Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18670the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18671and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18672
18673@item show trust-readonly-sections
18674Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18675@end table
18676
18677All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18678as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18679name and remembers it that way.
18680
18681@cindex shared libraries
18682@anchor{Shared Libraries}
18683@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18684Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18685DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18686
18687On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18688shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18689
18690@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18691when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18692(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18693references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18694debugging a core file).
18695
18696@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18697@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18698@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18699
18700There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18701symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18702particularly large or there are many of them.
18703
18704To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18705commands:
18706
18707@table @code
18708@kindex set auto-solib-add
18709@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18710If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18711will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18712attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18713informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18714is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18715@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18716
18717@cindex memory used for symbol tables
18718If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18719takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18720memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18721symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18722auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18723library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18724@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18725the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18726
18727@kindex show auto-solib-add
18728@item show auto-solib-add
18729Display the current autoloading mode.
18730@end table
18731
18732@cindex load shared library
18733To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18734command:
18735
18736@table @code
18737@kindex info sharedlibrary
18738@kindex info share
18739@item info share @var{regex}
18740@itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18741Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18742that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18743all shared libraries that are loaded.
18744
18745@kindex info dll
18746@item info dll @var{regex}
18747This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18748
18749@kindex sharedlibrary
18750@kindex share
18751@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18752@itemx share @var{regex}
18753Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18754Unix regular expression.
18755As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18756required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18757@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18758loaded.
18759
18760@item nosharedlibrary
18761@kindex nosharedlibrary
18762@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18763Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18764that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18765libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18766discarded.
18767@end table
18768
18769Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18770when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18771to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18772Catchpoints}).
18773
18774@value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18775command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18776less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18777conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18778
18779@table @code
18780@item set stop-on-solib-events
18781@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18782This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18783when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18784The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18785shared library.
18786
18787@item show stop-on-solib-events
18788@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18789Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18790library events happen.
18791@end table
18792
18793Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18794configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18795this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18796on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18797libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18798provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18799copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18800not.
18801
18802@cindex where to look for shared libraries
18803For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18804libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18805may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18806to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18807
18808@table @code
18809@cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18810@cindex system root, alternate
18811@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18812@kindex set sysroot
18813@item set sysroot @var{path}
18814Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18815absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18816runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18817target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18818attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18819executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18820@value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18821@code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18822to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18823e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18824@var{path}.
18825
18826If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18827system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18828from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18829target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18830Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18831following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18832root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18833sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18834@file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18835functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18836provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18837to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18838named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18839equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18840
18841For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18842SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18843absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18844@value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18845slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18846
18847@smallexample
18848 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18849@end smallexample
18850
18851Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18852@var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18853system:
18854
18855@smallexample
18856 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18857@end smallexample
18858
18859If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18860the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18861for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18862colons:
18863
18864@smallexample
18865 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18866@end smallexample
18867
18868This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18869with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18870copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18871@samp{z}):
18872
18873@smallexample
18874 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18875 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18876 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18877@end smallexample
18878
18879@noindent
18880and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18881@value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18882@file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18883
18884If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18885removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18886
18887@smallexample
18888 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18889@end smallexample
18890
18891This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18892if you don't want or need to.
18893
18894The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18895sysroot}.
18896
18897@cindex default system root
18898@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18899You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18900@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18901@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18902@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18903automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18904location.
18905
18906@kindex show sysroot
18907@item show sysroot
18908Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18909
18910@kindex set solib-search-path
18911@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18912If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18913directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18914is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18915path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18916use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18917@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18918finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18919it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18920of shared library symbols.
18921
18922@kindex show solib-search-path
18923@item show solib-search-path
18924Display the current shared library search path.
18925
18926@cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18927@kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18928@kindex show target-file-system-kind
18929@item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18930Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18931
18932Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18933make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18934example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18935system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18936@value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18937@file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18938drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18939indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18940normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18941the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18942as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18943it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18944shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18945with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18946@code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18947to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18948map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18949semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18950to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18951tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18952current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18953Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18954
18955@table @code
18956@item unix
18957Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18958kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18959are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18960the forward slash.
18961
18962@item dos-based
18963Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18964File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18965followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18966both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18967considered directory separators.
18968
18969@item auto
18970Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18971target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18972This is the default.
18973@end table
18974@end table
18975
18976@cindex file name canonicalization
18977@cindex base name differences
18978When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18979frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18980program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18981@dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18982even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18983portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18984This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18985cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18986references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18987facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18988using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18989using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18990@code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18991pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18992comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18993
18994@table @code
18995@item set basenames-may-differ
18996@kindex set basenames-may-differ
18997Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18998
18999@item show basenames-may-differ
19000@kindex show basenames-may-differ
19001Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19002@end table
19003
19004@node File Caching
19005@section File Caching
19006@cindex caching of opened files
19007@cindex caching of bfd objects
19008
19009To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19010reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19011BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19012allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19013
19014@table @code
19015@kindex maint info bfds
19016@item maint info bfds
19017This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19018@value{GDBN}.
19019
19020@kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19021@kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19022@kindex bfd caching
19023@item maint set bfd-sharing
19024@item maint show bfd-sharing
19025Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19026enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19027than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19028already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19029that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19030re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19031objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19032
19033@kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19034@kindex bfd caching
19035@item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19036Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19037
19038@kindex show debug bfd-cache
19039@kindex bfd caching
19040@item show debug bfd-cache
19041Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19042@end table
19043
19044@node Separate Debug Files
19045@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19046@cindex separate debugging information files
19047@cindex debugging information in separate files
19048@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19049@cindex debugging information directory, global
19050@cindex global debugging information directories
19051@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19052@cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19053
19054@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19055file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19056@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19057Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19058than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19059information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19060install only when they need to debug a problem.
19061
19062@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19063file:
19064
19065@itemize @bullet
19066@item
19067The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19068the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19069usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19070name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19071(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19072debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19073checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19074the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19075
19076@item
19077The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19078also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19079only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19080for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19081this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19082command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19083The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19084explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19085below.
19086@end itemize
19087
19088Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19089uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19090
19091@itemize @bullet
19092@item
19093For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19094the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19095directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19096directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19097directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19098
19099@item
19100For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19101@file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19102a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19103first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19104are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19105hex characters, not 10.)
19106@end itemize
19107
19108So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19109@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19110file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19111@code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19112@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19113debug information files, in the indicated order:
19114
19115@itemize @minus
19116@item
19117@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19118@item
19119@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19120@item
19121@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19122@item
19123@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19124@end itemize
19125
19126@anchor{debug-file-directory}
19127Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19128configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19129you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19130@value{GDBN} is currently using.
19131
19132@table @code
19133
19134@kindex set debug-file-directory
19135@item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19136Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19137information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19138concatenating them by a path separator.
19139
19140@kindex show debug-file-directory
19141@item show debug-file-directory
19142Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19143information files.
19144
19145@end table
19146
19147@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19148@cindex debug link sections
19149A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19150@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19151
19152@itemize
19153@item
19154A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19155a zero byte,
19156@item
19157zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19158boundary within the section, and
19159@item
19160a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19161executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19162information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19163zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19164@end itemize
19165
19166Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19167contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19168described above.
19169
19170@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19171@cindex build ID sections
19172The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19173ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19174often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19175It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19176the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19177algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19178content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19179value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19180stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19181
19182The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19183executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19184debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19185should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19186but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19187in an ordinary executable.
19188
19189The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19190@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19191the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19192following commands:
19193
19194@smallexample
19195@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19196@kbd{strip -g foo}
19197@end smallexample
19198
19199@noindent
19200These commands remove the debugging
19201information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19202@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19203two files:
19204
19205@itemize @bullet
19206@item
19207The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19208behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19209
19210@smallexample
19211@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19212@end smallexample
19213
19214Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19215a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19216foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19217the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19218
19219@item
19220Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19221the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19222compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19223utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19224@end itemize
19225
19226@noindent
19227
19228@cindex CRC algorithm definition
19229The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19230IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19231
19232@c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19233@c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19234@c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19235@c different ways!
19236@ifhtml
19237@display
19238@html
19239 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19240 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19241@end html
19242@end display
19243@end ifhtml
19244@ifnothtml
19245@display
19246 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19247 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19248@end display
19249@end ifnothtml
19250
19251The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19252significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19253@code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19254the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19255CRC.
19256
19257@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19258@dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19259However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19260@emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19261trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19262
19263To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19264which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19265initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19266this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19267@code{0xffffffff}.
19268
19269@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19270@smallexample
19271unsigned long
19272gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19273 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19274@{
19275 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19276 @{
19277 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19278 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19279 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19280 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19281 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19282 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19283 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19284 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19285 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19286 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19287 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19288 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19289 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19290 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19291 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19292 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19293 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19294 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19295 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19296 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19297 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19298 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19299 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19300 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19301 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19302 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19303 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19304 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19305 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19306 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19307 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19308 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19309 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19310 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19311 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19312 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19313 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19314 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19315 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19316 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19317 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19318 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19319 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19320 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19321 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19322 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19323 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19324 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19325 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19326 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19327 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19328 0x2d02ef8d
19329 @};
19330 unsigned char *end;
19331
19332 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19333 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19334 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19335 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19336@}
19337@end smallexample
19338
19339@noindent
19340This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19341
19342@node MiniDebugInfo
19343@section Debugging information in a special section
19344@cindex separate debug sections
19345@cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19346
19347Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19348special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19349@dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19350is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19351
19352The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19353information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19354replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19355Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19356@value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19357debugging information might be included in the section.
19358
19359@value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19360then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19361can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19362
19363This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19364standard utilities:
19365
19366@smallexample
19367# Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19368# to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19369nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19370 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19371
19372# Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19373# (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19374# of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19375nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19376 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19377 | sort > funcsyms
19378
19379# Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19380# table.
19381comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19382
19383# Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19384objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19385
19386# Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19387# removing some unnecessary sections.
19388objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19389 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19390
19391# Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19392strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19393
19394# Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19395# original binary.
19396xz mini_debuginfo
19397objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19398@end smallexample
19399
19400@node Index Files
19401@section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19402@cindex index files
19403@cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19404
19405When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19406file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19407@value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19408on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19409@value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19410startup.
19411
19412The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19413write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19414using @command{objcopy}.
19415
19416To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19417
19418@table @code
19419@item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19420@kindex save gdb-index
19421Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19422@value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19423with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19424@var{directory}.
19425@end table
19426
19427Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19428file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19429
19430@smallexample
19431$ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19432 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19433@end smallexample
19434
19435@value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19436sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19437they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19438To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19439specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19440The default is @code{off}.
19441This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19442@xref{Index Section Format}.
19443
19444@emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19445must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19446
19447@smallexample
19448$ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19449@end smallexample
19450
19451Instead you must do, for example,
19452
19453@smallexample
19454$ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19455@end smallexample
19456
19457There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19458for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19459currently work for programs using Ada.
19460
19461@node Symbol Errors
19462@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19463
19464While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19465such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19466output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19467they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19468debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19469about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19470only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19471times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19472to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19473complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19474Messages}).
19475
19476The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19477
19478@table @code
19479@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19480
19481The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19482(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19483error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19484in its outer scope blocks.
19485
19486@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19487the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19488may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19489function.
19490
19491@item block at @var{address} out of order
19492
19493The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19494order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19495do so.
19496
19497@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19498locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19499can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19500@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19501Messages}.)
19502
19503@item bad block start address patched
19504
19505The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19506smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19507to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19508
19509@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19510starting on the previous source line.
19511
19512@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19513
19514@cindex foo
19515Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19516larger than the size of the string table.
19517
19518@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19519name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19520with this name.
19521
19522@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19523
19524The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19525not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19526uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19527
19528@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19529This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19530are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19531debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19532on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19533and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19534
19535@item stub type has NULL name
19536
19537@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19538
19539@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19540The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19541information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19542it.
19543
19544@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19545
19546@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19547
19548@end table
19549
19550@node Data Files
19551@section GDB Data Files
19552
19553@cindex prefix for data files
19554@value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19555are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19556
19557You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19558is currently using.
19559
19560@table @code
19561@kindex set data-directory
19562@item set data-directory @var{directory}
19563Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19564to @var{directory}.
19565
19566@kindex show data-directory
19567@item show data-directory
19568Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19569@end table
19570
19571@cindex default data directory
19572@cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19573You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19574@samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19575@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19576@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19577automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19578location.
19579
19580The data directory may also be specified with the
19581@code{--data-directory} command line option.
19582@xref{Mode Options}.
19583
19584@node Targets
19585@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19586
19587@cindex debugging target
19588A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19589
19590Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19591in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19592you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19593flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19594host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19595realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19596command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19597(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19598
19599@cindex target architecture
19600It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19601architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19602one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19603command.
19604
19605@table @code
19606@kindex set architecture
19607@kindex show architecture
19608@item set architecture @var{arch}
19609This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19610value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19611supported architectures.
19612
19613@item show architecture
19614Show the current target architecture.
19615
19616@item set processor
19617@itemx processor
19618@kindex set processor
19619@kindex show processor
19620These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19621and @code{show architecture}.
19622@end table
19623
19624@menu
19625* Active Targets:: Active targets
19626* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19627* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19628@end menu
19629
19630@node Active Targets
19631@section Active Targets
19632
19633@cindex stacking targets
19634@cindex active targets
19635@cindex multiple targets
19636
19637There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19638recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19639and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19640on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19641example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19642the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19643recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19644presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19645remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19646
19647Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19648file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19649specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19650command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19651
19652@node Target Commands
19653@section Commands for Managing Targets
19654
19655@table @code
19656@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19657Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19658process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19659facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19660protocol of the target machine.
19661
19662Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19663typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19664with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19665
19666The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19667after executing the command.
19668
19669@kindex help target
19670@item help target
19671Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19672currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19674
19675@item help target @var{name}
19676Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19677select it.
19678
19679@kindex set gnutarget
19680@item set gnutarget @var{args}
19681@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19682knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19683a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19684with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19685with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19686
19687@quotation
19688@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19689you must know the actual BFD name.
19690@end quotation
19691
19692@noindent
19693@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19694
19695@kindex show gnutarget
19696@item show gnutarget
19697Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19698@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19699@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19700and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19701@end table
19702
19703@cindex common targets
19704Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19705configuration):
19706
19707@table @code
19708@kindex target
19709@item target exec @var{program}
19710@cindex executable file target
19711An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19712@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19713
19714@item target core @var{filename}
19715@cindex core dump file target
19716A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19717@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19718
19719@item target remote @var{medium}
19720@cindex remote target
19721A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19722connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19723protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19724
19725For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19726machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19727
19728@smallexample
19729target remote /dev/ttya
19730@end smallexample
19731
19732@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19733useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19734system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19735clobbered by the download.
19736
19737@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19738@cindex built-in simulator target
19739Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19740In general,
19741@smallexample
19742 target sim
19743 load
19744 run
19745@end smallexample
19746@noindent
19747works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19748drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19749provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19750see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19751Processors}.
19752
19753@item target native
19754@cindex native target
19755Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19756@code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19757etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19758(@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19759
19760@end table
19761
19762Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19763your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19764
19765Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19766you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19767various aspects of this process.
19768
19769@table @code
19770
19771@item set hash
19772@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19773@cindex hash mark while downloading
19774This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19775downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19776displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19777monitor.
19778
19779@item show hash
19780@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19781Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19782
19783@item set debug monitor
19784@kindex set debug monitor
19785@cindex display remote monitor communications
19786Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19787@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19788
19789@item show debug monitor
19790@kindex show debug monitor
19791Show the current status of displaying communications between
19792@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19793@end table
19794
19795@table @code
19796
19797@kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19798@item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19799@anchor{load}
19800Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19801@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19802is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19803on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19804@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19805the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19806
19807If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19808execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19809target is @dots{}}''
19810
19811The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19812For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19813link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19814specifies a fixed address.
19815@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19816
19817It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19818specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19819@var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19820
19821Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19822load programs into flash memory.
19823
19824@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19825@end table
19826
19827@table @code
19828
19829@kindex flash-erase
19830@item flash-erase
19831@anchor{flash-erase}
19832
19833Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19834
19835@end table
19836
19837@node Byte Order
19838@section Choosing Target Byte Order
19839
19840@cindex choosing target byte order
19841@cindex target byte order
19842
19843Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19844offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19845orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19846designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19847which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19848@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19849
19850@table @code
19851@kindex set endian
19852@item set endian big
19853Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19854
19855@item set endian little
19856Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19857
19858@item set endian auto
19859Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19860executable.
19861
19862@item show endian
19863Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19864
19865@end table
19866
19867Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19868data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19869target system.
19870
19871
19872@node Remote Debugging
19873@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19874@cindex remote debugging
19875
19876If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19877@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19878For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19879or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19880powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19881
19882Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19883to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19884@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19885but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19886write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19887communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19888
19889Other remote targets may be available in your
19890configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19891
19892@menu
19893* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19894* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19895* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19896* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19897* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19898@end menu
19899
19900@node Connecting
19901@section Connecting to a Remote Target
19902@cindex remote debugging, connecting
19903@cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19904@cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19905@cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19906@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19907@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19908
19909This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19910types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19911symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19912connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19913
19914@subsection Types of Remote Connections
19915
19916@value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19917mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19918support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19919differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19920
19921@table @asis
19922
19923@cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19924@item Result of detach or program exit
19925@strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19926detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19927@code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19928
19929@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19930you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19931though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19932running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19933
19934When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19935invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19936was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19937@code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19938
19939@item Specifying the program to debug
19940For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19941program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19942some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19943target.
19944
19945@strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19946on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19947(@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19948
19949@cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19950@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19951on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19952to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19953
19954@anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19955You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19956or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19957option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19958the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19959@code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19960@code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19961(@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19962@option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19963
19964@item The @code{run} command
19965@strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19966supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19967the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19968remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19969@kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19970
19971@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19972supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19973@code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19974the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19975wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19976
19977If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19978@code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19979resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19980@code{target remote} mode.
19981
19982@anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19983@item Attaching
19984@strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19985not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19986must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19987
19988@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19989you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19990established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19991@code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19992(@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19993
19994@end table
19995
19996@anchor{Host and target files}
19997@subsection Host and Target Files
19998@cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19999@cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20000
20001@value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20002information for your program running on the target. This requires
20003access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20004symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20005remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20006
20007Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20008@pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20009the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20010target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20011@code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20012
20013If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20014program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20015unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20016@code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20017the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20018the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20019may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20020target libraries.
20021
20022The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20023and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20024system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20025are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20026during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20027files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20028programs.
20029
20030@subsection Remote Connection Commands
20031@cindex remote connection commands
20032@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20033over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20034each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20035program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20036@code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20037establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20038arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20039
20040@table @code
20041
20042@item target remote @var{serial-device}
20043@itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20044@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20045Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20046to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20047
20048@smallexample
20049target remote /dev/ttyb
20050@end smallexample
20051
20052If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20053@samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20054(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20055@code{target} command.
20056
20057@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20058@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20059@itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20060@itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20061@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20062Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20063The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20064address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20065the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20066it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20067target.
20068
20069For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20070@code{manyfarms}:
20071
20072@smallexample
20073target remote manyfarms:2828
20074@end smallexample
20075
20076If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20077debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20078same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20079port 1234 on your local machine:
20080
20081@smallexample
20082target remote :1234
20083@end smallexample
20084@noindent
20085
20086Note that the colon is still required here.
20087
20088@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20089@itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20090@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20091Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20092connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20093
20094@smallexample
20095target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20096@end smallexample
20097
20098When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20099keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20100can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20101cause havoc with your debugging session.
20102
20103@item target remote | @var{command}
20104@itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20105@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20106Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20107pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20108by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20109protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20110standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20111that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20112using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20113
20114If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20115@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20116program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20117
20118@end table
20119
20120@cindex interrupting remote programs
20121@cindex remote programs, interrupting
20122Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20123interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20124program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20125and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20126interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20127
20128@smallexample
20129Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20130Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20131@end smallexample
20132
20133In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20134the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20135you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20136@kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20137
20138In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20139@value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20140
20141@table @code
20142@kindex detach (remote)
20143@item detach
20144When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20145@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20146Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20147will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20148command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20149another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20150still connected to the target.
20151
20152@kindex disconnect
20153@item disconnect
20154The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20155the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20156(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20157the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20158another target.
20159
20160@cindex send command to remote monitor
20161@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20162@cindex add new commands for external monitor
20163@kindex monitor
20164@item monitor @var{cmd}
20165This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20166remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20167sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20168can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20169and implement.
20170@end table
20171
20172@node File Transfer
20173@section Sending files to a remote system
20174@cindex remote target, file transfer
20175@cindex file transfer
20176@cindex sending files to remote systems
20177
20178Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20179connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20180for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20181running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20182e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20183the only way to upload or download files.
20184
20185Not all remote targets support these commands.
20186
20187@table @code
20188@kindex remote put
20189@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20190Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20191@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20192
20193@kindex remote get
20194@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20195Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20196on the host system.
20197
20198@kindex remote delete
20199@item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20200Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20201
20202@end table
20203
20204@node Server
20205@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20206
20207@kindex gdbserver
20208@cindex remote connection without stubs
20209@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20210allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20211@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20212linking in the usual debugging stub.
20213
20214@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20215because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20216that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20217@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20218@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20219because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20220also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20221started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20222Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20223the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20224do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20225by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20226choice for debugging.
20227
20228@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20229or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20230protocol.
20231
20232@quotation
20233@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20234Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20235@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20236target system with the same privileges as the user running
20237@code{gdbserver}.
20238@end quotation
20239
20240@anchor{Running gdbserver}
20241@subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20242@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20243@cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20244
20245Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20246program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20247@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20248strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20249system does all the symbol handling.
20250
20251To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20252the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20253syntax is:
20254
20255@smallexample
20256target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20257@end smallexample
20258
20259@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20260hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20261stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20262For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20263@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20264@file{/dev/com1}:
20265
20266@smallexample
20267target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20268@end smallexample
20269
20270@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20271with it.
20272
20273To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20274
20275@smallexample
20276target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20277@end smallexample
20278
20279The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20280specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20281TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20282expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20283(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20284you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20285TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20286reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20287conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20288and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20289@code{target remote} command.
20290
20291The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20292with ssh:
20293
20294@smallexample
20295(gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20296@end smallexample
20297
20298The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20299and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20300a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20301You could elide it if you want to.
20302
20303Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20304@code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20305display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20306Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20307
20308@anchor{Attaching to a program}
20309@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20310@cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20311@cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20312
20313On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20314This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20315
20316@smallexample
20317target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20318@end smallexample
20319
20320@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20321necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20322
20323In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20324@value{GDBN} attach command
20325(@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20326
20327@pindex pidof
20328You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20329@code{pidof} utility:
20330
20331@smallexample
20332target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20333@end smallexample
20334
20335In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20336has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20337@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20338
20339@subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20340
20341This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20342port.
20343
20344@code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20345terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20346extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20347@value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20348which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20349mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20350cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20351stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20352
20353When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20354Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20355completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20356
20357@cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20358By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20359subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20360with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20361connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20362means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20363first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20364connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20365connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20366@option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20367multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20368instance closes its port after the first connection.
20369
20370@anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20371@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20372
20373You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20374specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20375attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20376program. For more information,
20377@pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20378
20379@cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20380The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20381status information about the debugging process.
20382@cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20383The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20384remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20385@code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20386
20387@cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20388The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20389@code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20390Possible options are:
20391
20392@table @code
20393@item none
20394Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20395@item all
20396Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20397@item timestamps
20398Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20399@end table
20400
20401Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20402appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20403
20404@cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20405The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20406for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20407wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20408@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20409
20410@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20411command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20412program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20413runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20414
20415You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20416its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20417this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20418with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20419
20420For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20421the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20422environment:
20423
20424@smallexample
20425$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20426@end smallexample
20427
20428@cindex @option{--selftest}
20429The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20430
20431@smallexample
20432$ gdbserver --selftest
20433Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20434@end smallexample
20435
20436These tests are disabled in release.
20437@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20438
20439The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20440@itemize
20441
20442@item
20443Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20444
20445@item
20446Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20447(@pxref{Host and target files}).
20448Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20449connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20450@value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20451@code{--with-sysroot}).
20452
20453@item
20454Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20455For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20456the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20457text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20458@samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20459command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20460program is already on the target.
20461
20462@end itemize
20463
20464@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20465@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20466@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20467
20468During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20469@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20470Here are the available commands.
20471
20472@table @code
20473@item monitor help
20474List the available monitor commands.
20475
20476@item monitor set debug 0
20477@itemx monitor set debug 1
20478Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20479
20480@item monitor set remote-debug 0
20481@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20482Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20483protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20484
20485@item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20486Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20487Possible options are:
20488
20489@table @code
20490@item none
20491Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20492@item all
20493Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20494@item timestamps
20495Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20496@end table
20497
20498Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20499appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20500
20501@item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20502@cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20503When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20504directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20505libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20506@samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20507
20508The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20509not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20510
20511@item monitor exit
20512Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20513@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20514detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20515Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20516of a multi-process mode debug session.
20517
20518@end table
20519
20520@subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20521@cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20522
20523On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20524tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20525
20526For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20527@dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20528This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20529@code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20530requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20531support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20532@url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20533is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20534standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20535@code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20536to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20537using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20538
20539There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20540
20541@table @code
20542@item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20543
20544You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20545library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20546@code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20547
20548@item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20549
20550You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20551your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20552support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20553cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20554in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20555@option{--wrapper} command line option.
20556
20557@item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20558
20559On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20560by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20561of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20562systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20563command for that. For example:
20564
20565@smallexample
20566(@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20567@end smallexample
20568
20569Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20570available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20571@end table
20572
20573On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20574systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20575remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20576loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20577program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20578case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20579features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20580libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20581main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20582@code{gdbserver} like so:
20583
20584@smallexample
20585$ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20586@end smallexample
20587
20588Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20589
20590@smallexample
20591$ gdb myprogram
20592(@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
205930x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20594(@value{GDBP}) b main
20595(@value{GDBP}) continue
20596@end smallexample
20597
20598The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20599process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20600command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20601process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20602tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20603tracing.
20604
20605@node Remote Configuration
20606@section Remote Configuration
20607
20608@kindex set remote
20609@kindex show remote
20610This section documents the configuration options available when
20611debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20612extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20613system-call-allowed}.
20614
20615@table @code
20616@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20617@cindex address size for remote targets
20618@cindex bits in remote address
20619Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20620number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20621that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20622default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20623
20624@item show remoteaddresssize
20625Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20626
20627@item set serial baud @var{n}
20628@cindex baud rate for remote targets
20629Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20630value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20631remote targets.
20632
20633@item show serial baud
20634Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20635
20636@item set serial parity @var{parity}
20637Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20638@code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20639
20640@item show serial parity
20641Show the current parity of the serial port.
20642
20643@item set remotebreak
20644@cindex interrupt remote programs
20645@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20646@anchor{set remotebreak}
20647If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20648when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20649on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20650character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20651expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20652
20653@item show remotebreak
20654Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20655interrupt the remote program.
20656
20657@item set remoteflow on
20658@itemx set remoteflow off
20659@kindex set remoteflow
20660Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20661on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20662
20663@item show remoteflow
20664@kindex show remoteflow
20665Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20666
20667@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20668Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20669communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20670@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20671@code{ascii}.
20672
20673@item show remotelogbase
20674Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20675protocol.
20676
20677@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20678@cindex record serial communications on file
20679Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20680default is not to record at all.
20681
20682@item show remotelogfile.
20683Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20684serial communications.
20685
20686@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20687@cindex timeout for serial communications
20688@cindex remote timeout
20689Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20690@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20691
20692@item show remotetimeout
20693Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20694responses.
20695
20696@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20697@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20698@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20699@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20700@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20701@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20702Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20703watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20704
20705@cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20706@cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20707@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20708@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20709Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20710a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20711as unlimited.
20712
20713@item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20714Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20715a remote hardware watchpoint.
20716
20717@item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20718@itemx show remote exec-file
20719@anchor{set remote exec-file}
20720@cindex executable file, for remote target
20721Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20722extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20723target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20724filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20725
20726@item set remote interrupt-sequence
20727@cindex interrupt remote programs
20728@cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20729Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20730@samp{BREAK-g} as the
20731sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20732@samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20733is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20734Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20735It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20736
20737@item show interrupt-sequence
20738Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20739is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20740@code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20741also known as Magic SysRq g.
20742
20743@item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20744@cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20745Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20746@value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20747Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20748which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20749
20750@item show interrupt-on-connect
20751Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20752to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20753
20754@kindex set tcp
20755@kindex show tcp
20756@item set tcp auto-retry on
20757@cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20758Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20759debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20760condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20761before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20762enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20763to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20764@code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20765
20766@item set tcp auto-retry off
20767Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20768
20769@item show tcp auto-retry
20770Show the current auto-retry setting.
20771
20772@item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20773@itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20774@cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20775@cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20776Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20777@var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20778(enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20779that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20780value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20781@value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20782unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20783
20784@item show tcp connect-timeout
20785Show the current connection timeout setting.
20786@end table
20787
20788@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20789The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20790your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20791can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20792packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20793packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20794or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20795all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20796see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20797
20798During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20799If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20800in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20801@value{GDBN} developers.
20802
20803For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20804packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20805are:
20806
20807@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20808@item Command Name
20809@tab Remote Packet
20810@tab Related Features
20811
20812@item @code{fetch-register}
20813@tab @code{p}
20814@tab @code{info registers}
20815
20816@item @code{set-register}
20817@tab @code{P}
20818@tab @code{set}
20819
20820@item @code{binary-download}
20821@tab @code{X}
20822@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20823
20824@item @code{read-aux-vector}
20825@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20826@tab @code{info auxv}
20827
20828@item @code{symbol-lookup}
20829@tab @code{qSymbol}
20830@tab Detecting multiple threads
20831
20832@item @code{attach}
20833@tab @code{vAttach}
20834@tab @code{attach}
20835
20836@item @code{verbose-resume}
20837@tab @code{vCont}
20838@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20839
20840@item @code{run}
20841@tab @code{vRun}
20842@tab @code{run}
20843
20844@item @code{software-breakpoint}
20845@tab @code{Z0}
20846@tab @code{break}
20847
20848@item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20849@tab @code{Z1}
20850@tab @code{hbreak}
20851
20852@item @code{write-watchpoint}
20853@tab @code{Z2}
20854@tab @code{watch}
20855
20856@item @code{read-watchpoint}
20857@tab @code{Z3}
20858@tab @code{rwatch}
20859
20860@item @code{access-watchpoint}
20861@tab @code{Z4}
20862@tab @code{awatch}
20863
20864@item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20865@tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20866@tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20867
20868@item @code{target-features}
20869@tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20870@tab @code{set architecture}
20871
20872@item @code{library-info}
20873@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20874@tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20875
20876@item @code{memory-map}
20877@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20878@tab @code{info mem}
20879
20880@item @code{read-sdata-object}
20881@tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20882@tab @code{print $_sdata}
20883
20884@item @code{read-spu-object}
20885@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20886@tab @code{info spu}
20887
20888@item @code{write-spu-object}
20889@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20890@tab @code{info spu}
20891
20892@item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20893@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20894@tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20895
20896@item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20897@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20898@tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20899
20900@item @code{threads}
20901@tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20902@tab @code{info threads}
20903
20904@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20905@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20906@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20907
20908@item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20909@tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20910@tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20911
20912@item @code{search-memory}
20913@tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20914@tab @code{find}
20915
20916@item @code{supported-packets}
20917@tab @code{qSupported}
20918@tab Remote communications parameters
20919
20920@item @code{catch-syscalls}
20921@tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20922@tab @code{catch syscall}
20923
20924@item @code{pass-signals}
20925@tab @code{QPassSignals}
20926@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20927
20928@item @code{program-signals}
20929@tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20930@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20931
20932@item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20933@tab @code{vFile:close}
20934@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20935
20936@item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20937@tab @code{vFile:open}
20938@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20939
20940@item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20941@tab @code{vFile:pread}
20942@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20943
20944@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20945@tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20946@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20947
20948@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20949@tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20950@tab @code{remote delete}
20951
20952@item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20953@tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20954@tab Host I/O
20955
20956@item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20957@tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20958@tab Host I/O
20959
20960@item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20961@tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20962@tab Host I/O
20963
20964@item @code{noack-packet}
20965@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20966@tab Packet acknowledgment
20967
20968@item @code{osdata}
20969@tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20970@tab @code{info os}
20971
20972@item @code{query-attached}
20973@tab @code{qAttached}
20974@tab Querying remote process attach state.
20975
20976@item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20977@tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20978@tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20979
20980@item @code{trace-status}
20981@tab @code{qTStatus}
20982@tab @code{tstatus}
20983
20984@item @code{traceframe-info}
20985@tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20986@tab Traceframe info
20987
20988@item @code{install-in-trace}
20989@tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20990@tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20991
20992@item @code{disable-randomization}
20993@tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20994@tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20995
20996@item @code{startup-with-shell}
20997@tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
20998@tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
20999
21000@item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21001@tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21002@tab @code{set environment}
21003
21004@item @code{environment-unset}
21005@tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21006@tab @code{unset environment}
21007
21008@item @code{environment-reset}
21009@tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21010@tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21011
21012@item @code{set-working-dir}
21013@tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21014@tab @code{set cwd}
21015
21016@item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21017@tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21018@tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21019
21020@item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21021@tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21022@tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21023
21024@item @code{swbreak-feature}
21025@tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21026@tab @code{break}
21027
21028@item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21029@tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21030@tab @code{hbreak}
21031
21032@item @code{fork-event-feature}
21033@tab @code{fork stop reason}
21034@tab @code{fork}
21035
21036@item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21037@tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21038@tab @code{vfork}
21039
21040@item @code{exec-event-feature}
21041@tab @code{exec stop reason}
21042@tab @code{exec}
21043
21044@item @code{thread-events}
21045@tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21046@tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21047
21048@item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21049@tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21050@tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21051
21052@end multitable
21053
21054@node Remote Stub
21055@section Implementing a Remote Stub
21056
21057@cindex debugging stub, example
21058@cindex remote stub, example
21059@cindex stub example, remote debugging
21060The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21061communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21062@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21063these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21064implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21065with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21066organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21067
21068@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21069To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21070@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21071prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21072program, you need:
21073
21074@enumerate
21075@item
21076A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21077have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21078your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21079
21080@item
21081A C subroutine library to support your program's
21082subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21083
21084@item
21085A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21086download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21087manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21088documentation.
21089@end enumerate
21090
21091The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21092communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21093machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21094
21095@table @emph
21096@item On the host,
21097@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21098else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21099(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21100
21101@item On the target,
21102you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21103implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21104subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21105
21106On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21107@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21108@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21109@end table
21110
21111The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21112machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21113@sc{sparc} boards.
21114
21115@cindex remote serial stub list
21116These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21117
21118@table @code
21119
21120@item i386-stub.c
21121@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21122@cindex Intel
21123@cindex i386
21124For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21125
21126@item m68k-stub.c
21127@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21128@cindex Motorola 680x0
21129@cindex m680x0
21130For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21131
21132@item sh-stub.c
21133@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21134@cindex Renesas
21135@cindex SH
21136For Renesas SH architectures.
21137
21138@item sparc-stub.c
21139@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21140@cindex Sparc
21141For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21142
21143@item sparcl-stub.c
21144@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21145@cindex Fujitsu
21146@cindex SparcLite
21147For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21148
21149@end table
21150
21151The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21152recently added stubs.
21153
21154@menu
21155* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21156* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21157* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21158@end menu
21159
21160@node Stub Contents
21161@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21162
21163@cindex remote serial stub
21164The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21165subroutines:
21166
21167@table @code
21168@item set_debug_traps
21169@findex set_debug_traps
21170@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21171This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21172program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21173program's startup code.
21174
21175@item handle_exception
21176@findex handle_exception
21177@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21178This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21179explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21180run when a trap is triggered.
21181
21182@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21183execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21184with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21185protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21186representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21187information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21188retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21189execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21190@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21191machine.
21192
21193@item breakpoint
21194@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21195Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21196breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21197way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21198machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21199pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21200@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21201simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21202again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21203your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21204@value{GDBN} session gets control.
21205
21206Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21207to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21208start of your debugging session.
21209@end table
21210
21211@node Bootstrapping
21212@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21213
21214@cindex remote stub, support routines
21215The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21216chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21217debugging target machine.
21218
21219First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21220serial port.
21221
21222@table @code
21223@item int getDebugChar()
21224@findex getDebugChar
21225Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21226It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21227different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21228
21229@item void putDebugChar(int)
21230@findex putDebugChar
21231Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21232It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21233different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21234@end table
21235
21236@cindex control C, and remote debugging
21237@cindex interrupting remote targets
21238If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21239running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21240for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21241character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21242remote system to stop.
21243
21244Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21245probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21246is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21247@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21248
21249Other routines you need to supply are:
21250
21251@table @code
21252@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21253@findex exceptionHandler
21254Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21255handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21256way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21257are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21258containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21259The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21260its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21261might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21262exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21263@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21264and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21265you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21266should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21267
21268For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21269gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21270should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21271@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21272help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21273
21274@item void flush_i_cache()
21275@findex flush_i_cache
21276On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21277instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21278instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21279
21280On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21281function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21282@end table
21283
21284@noindent
21285You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21286
21287@table @code
21288@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21289@findex memset
21290This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21291memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21292@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21293either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21294@end table
21295
21296If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21297library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21298but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21299subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21300
21301
21302@node Debug Session
21303@subsection Putting it All Together
21304
21305@cindex remote serial debugging summary
21306In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21307steps.
21308
21309@enumerate
21310@item
21311Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21312(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21313@display
21314@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21315@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21316@end display
21317
21318@item
21319Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21320procedure is called:
21321
21322@smallexample
21323set_debug_traps();
21324breakpoint();
21325@end smallexample
21326
21327On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21328automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21329breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21330@code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21331after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21332doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21333progress.
21334
21335@item
21336For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21337@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21338
21339@smallexample
21340void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21341@end smallexample
21342
21343@noindent
21344but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21345function in your program, that function is called when
21346@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21347error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21348one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21349
21350@item
21351Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21352your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21353
21354@item
21355Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21356the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21357
21358@item
21359@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21360@c document that. FIXME.
21361Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21362whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21363
21364@item
21365Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21366(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21367
21368@end enumerate
21369
21370@node Configurations
21371@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21372
21373While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21374cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21375describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21376
21377There are three major categories of configurations: native
21378configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21379operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21380different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21381are quite different from each other.
21382
21383@menu
21384* Native::
21385* Embedded OS::
21386* Embedded Processors::
21387* Architectures::
21388@end menu
21389
21390@node Native
21391@section Native
21392
21393This section describes details specific to particular native
21394configurations.
21395
21396@menu
21397* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21398* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21399* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21400* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21401* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21402* Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21403@end menu
21404
21405@node BSD libkvm Interface
21406@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21407
21408@cindex libkvm
21409@cindex kernel memory image
21410@cindex kernel crash dump
21411
21412BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21413interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21414memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21415uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21416dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21417special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21418the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21419@code{kvm} target:
21420
21421@smallexample
21422(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21423@end smallexample
21424
21425For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21426argument:
21427
21428@smallexample
21429(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21430@end smallexample
21431
21432Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21433available:
21434
21435@table @code
21436@kindex kvm
21437@item kvm pcb
21438Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21439
21440@item kvm proc
21441Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21442modern FreeBSD systems.
21443@end table
21444
21445@node SVR4 Process Information
21446@subsection SVR4 Process Information
21447@cindex /proc
21448@cindex examine process image
21449@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21450
21451Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21452@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21453process using file-system subroutines.
21454
21455If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21456facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21457information about the process running your program, or about any
21458process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21459@sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21460
21461This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21462that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21463
21464@table @code
21465@kindex info proc
21466@cindex process ID
21467@item info proc
21468@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21469Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21470process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21471that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21472debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21473line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21474executable file's absolute file name.
21475
21476On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21477@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21478within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21479a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21480needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21481a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21482
21483@item info proc cmdline
21484@cindex info proc cmdline
21485Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21486specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21487
21488@item info proc cwd
21489@cindex info proc cwd
21490Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21491specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21492
21493@item info proc exe
21494@cindex info proc exe
21495Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21496to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21497
21498@item info proc mappings
21499@cindex memory address space mappings
21500Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21501information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21502rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21503includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21504memory access rights to that range.
21505
21506@item info proc stat
21507@itemx info proc status
21508@cindex process detailed status information
21509These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21510the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21511how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21512the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21513consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21514value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21515(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21516
21517@item info proc all
21518Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21519above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21520
21521@ignore
21522@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21523@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21524@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21525@kindex info proc times
21526@item info proc times
21527Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21528its children.
21529
21530@kindex info proc id
21531@item info proc id
21532Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21533the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21534@end ignore
21535
21536@item set procfs-trace
21537@kindex set procfs-trace
21538@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21539This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21540
21541@item show procfs-trace
21542@kindex show procfs-trace
21543Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21544
21545@item set procfs-file @var{file}
21546@kindex set procfs-file
21547Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21548@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21549contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21550standard output.
21551
21552@item show procfs-file
21553@kindex show procfs-file
21554Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21555
21556@item proc-trace-entry
21557@itemx proc-trace-exit
21558@itemx proc-untrace-entry
21559@itemx proc-untrace-exit
21560@kindex proc-trace-entry
21561@kindex proc-trace-exit
21562@kindex proc-untrace-entry
21563@kindex proc-untrace-exit
21564These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21565from the @code{syscall} interface.
21566
21567@item info pidlist
21568@kindex info pidlist
21569@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21570For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21571processes and all the threads within each process.
21572
21573@item info meminfo
21574@kindex info meminfo
21575@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21576For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21577@end table
21578
21579@node DJGPP Native
21580@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21581@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21582@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21583@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21584
21585@cindex DPMI
21586@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21587MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21588that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21589top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21590
21591@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21592defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21593subsection describes those commands.
21594
21595@table @code
21596@kindex info dos
21597@item info dos
21598This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21599information about the target system and important OS structures.
21600
21601@kindex sysinfo
21602@cindex MS-DOS system info
21603@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21604@item info dos sysinfo
21605This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21606platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21607DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21608
21609@cindex GDT
21610@cindex LDT
21611@cindex IDT
21612@cindex segment descriptor tables
21613@cindex descriptor tables display
21614@item info dos gdt
21615@itemx info dos ldt
21616@itemx info dos idt
21617These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21618and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21619tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21620that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21621descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21622descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21623rights.
21624
21625A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21626segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21627allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21628conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21629additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21630
21631@cindex garbled pointers
21632These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21633Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21634displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21635display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21636example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21637debugged program's data segment:
21638
21639@smallexample
21640@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21641@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21642@end smallexample
21643
21644@noindent
21645This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21646the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21647
21648@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21649@item info dos pde
21650@itemx info dos pte
21651These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21652Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21653data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21654into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21655page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21656may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21657Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21658that is currently in use.
21659
21660Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21661Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21662the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21663@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21664Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21665means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21666the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21667
21668@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21669These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21670Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21671controller.
21672
21673These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21674
21675@cindex physical address from linear address
21676@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21677This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21678address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21679already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21680because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21681segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21682the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21683
21684@smallexample
21685@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21686@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21687@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21688@end smallexample
21689
21690@noindent
21691This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21692whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21693attributes of that page.
21694
21695Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21696since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21697address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21698be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21699declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21700@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21701
21702Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21703transfer buffer:
21704
21705@smallexample
21706@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21707@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21708@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21709@end smallexample
21710
21711@noindent
21712(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
217133rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21714clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21715memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21716linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21717
21718This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21719@end table
21720
21721@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21722In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21723debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21724to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21725
21726@table @code
21727@kindex set com1base
21728@kindex set com1irq
21729@kindex set com2base
21730@kindex set com2irq
21731@kindex set com3base
21732@kindex set com3irq
21733@kindex set com4base
21734@kindex set com4irq
21735@item set com1base @var{addr}
21736This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21737port.
21738
21739@item set com1irq @var{irq}
21740This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21741for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21742
21743There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21744etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21745other 3 COM ports.
21746
21747@kindex show com1base
21748@kindex show com1irq
21749@kindex show com2base
21750@kindex show com2irq
21751@kindex show com3base
21752@kindex show com3irq
21753@kindex show com4base
21754@kindex show com4irq
21755The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21756display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21757lines used by the COM ports.
21758
21759@item info serial
21760@kindex info serial
21761@cindex DOS serial port status
21762This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21763port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21764IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21765counts of various errors encountered so far.
21766@end table
21767
21768
21769@node Cygwin Native
21770@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21771@cindex MS Windows debugging
21772@cindex native Cygwin debugging
21773@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21774
21775@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21776DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21777
21778@cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21779@cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21780MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21781special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21782by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21783supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21784sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21785ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21786
21787There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21788this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21789described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21790
21791@table @code
21792@kindex info w32
21793@item info w32
21794This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21795information about the target system and important OS structures.
21796
21797@item info w32 selector
21798This command displays information returned by
21799the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21800It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21801a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21802Without argument, this command displays information
21803about the six segment registers.
21804
21805@item info w32 thread-information-block
21806This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21807Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21808selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21809
21810@kindex signal-event
21811@item signal-event @var{id}
21812This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21813crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21814
21815To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21816@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21817@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21818(for x86_64 versions):
21819
21820@itemize @minus
21821@item
21822@code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21823Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21824"attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21825
21826The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21827crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21828the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21829to attach.
21830
21831@item
21832@code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21833make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21834automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21835``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21836terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21837@end itemize
21838
21839@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21840@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21841@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21842@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21843If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21844happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21845@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21846exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21847``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21848Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21849@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21850
21851@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21852@item show cygwin-exceptions
21853Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21854inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21855
21856@kindex set new-console
21857@item set new-console @var{mode}
21858If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21859be started in a new console on next start.
21860If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21861be started in the same console as the debugger.
21862
21863@kindex show new-console
21864@item show new-console
21865Displays whether a new console is used
21866when the debuggee is started.
21867
21868@kindex set new-group
21869@item set new-group @var{mode}
21870This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21871start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21872This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21873@samp{Ctrl-C}.
21874
21875@kindex show new-group
21876@item show new-group
21877Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21878
21879@kindex set debugevents
21880@item set debugevents
21881This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21882to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21883signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21884unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21885Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21886
21887@kindex set debugexec
21888@item set debugexec
21889This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21890(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21891
21892@kindex set debugexceptions
21893@item set debugexceptions
21894This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21895debuggee seen by the debugger.
21896
21897@kindex set debugmemory
21898@item set debugmemory
21899This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21900and writes by the debugger.
21901
21902@kindex set shell
21903@item set shell
21904This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21905via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21906
21907@kindex show shell
21908@item show shell
21909Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21910
21911@end table
21912
21913@menu
21914* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21915@end menu
21916
21917@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21918@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21919@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21920@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21921
21922Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21923not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21924@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21925symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21926information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21927describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21928``minimal symbols''.
21929
21930Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21931will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21932start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21933program run once to completion.
21934
21935@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21936
21937In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21938tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21939DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21940also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21941sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21942(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21943necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21944contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21945exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21946
21947Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21948though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21949symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21950some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21951@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21952(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21953
21954@smallexample
21955(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21956All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21957
21958Non-debugging symbols:
219590x77e885f4 CreateFileA
219600x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21961@end smallexample
21962
21963@smallexample
21964(@value{GDBP}) info function !
21965All functions matching regular expression "!":
21966
21967Non-debugging symbols:
219680x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
219690x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
219700x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21971[etc...]
21972@end smallexample
21973
21974@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21975
21976Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21977type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21978refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21979contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21980contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21981means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21982a function within a DLL without a running program.
21983
21984Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21985automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21986variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21987type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21988problem:
21989
21990@smallexample
21991(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21992'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21993@end smallexample
21994
21995@smallexample
21996(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21997'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21998@end smallexample
21999
22000And two possible solutions:
22001
22002@smallexample
22003(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22004$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22005@end smallexample
22006
22007@smallexample
22008(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
220090x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22010(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
220110x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22012(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
220130x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22014@end smallexample
22015
22016Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22017starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22018examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22019function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22020to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22021
22022@smallexample
22023(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22024Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22025@end smallexample
22026
22027The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22028break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22029safe.
22030
22031@node Hurd Native
22032@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22033@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22034
22035This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22036@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22037
22038@table @code
22039@item set signals
22040@itemx set sigs
22041@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22042@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22043This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22044@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22045affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22046@code{signals}.
22047
22048@item show signals
22049@itemx show sigs
22050@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22051@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22052Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22053
22054@item set signal-thread
22055@itemx set sigthread
22056@kindex set signal-thread
22057@kindex set sigthread
22058This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22059thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22060process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22061signal-thread}.
22062
22063@item show signal-thread
22064@itemx show sigthread
22065@kindex show signal-thread
22066@kindex show sigthread
22067These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22068delivered a signal.
22069
22070@item set stopped
22071@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22072This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22073as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22074continued by delivering a signal to it.
22075
22076@item show stopped
22077@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22078This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22079stopped.
22080
22081@item set exceptions
22082@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22083Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22084When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22085single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22086trapping on.
22087
22088@item show exceptions
22089@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22090Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22091
22092@item set task pause
22093@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22094@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22095@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22096This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22097Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22098whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22099effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22100to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22101thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22102
22103@item show task pause
22104@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22105Show the current state of task suspension.
22106
22107@item set task detach-suspend-count
22108@cindex task suspend count
22109@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22110This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22111@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22112
22113@item show task detach-suspend-count
22114Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22115
22116@item set task exception-port
22117@itemx set task excp
22118@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22119This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22120forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22121rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22122
22123@item set noninvasive
22124@cindex noninvasive task options
22125This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22126invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22127is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22128@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22129
22130@item info send-rights
22131@itemx info receive-rights
22132@itemx info port-rights
22133@itemx info port-sets
22134@itemx info dead-names
22135@itemx info ports
22136@itemx info psets
22137@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22138@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22139@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22140@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22141@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22142These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22143receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22144There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22145port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22146
22147@item set thread pause
22148@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22149@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22150@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22151This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22152control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22153thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22154off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22155Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22156control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22157task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22158only the current thread.
22159
22160@item show thread pause
22161@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22162This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22163
22164@item set thread run
22165This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22166
22167@item show thread run
22168Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22169
22170@item set thread detach-suspend-count
22171@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22172@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22173This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22174thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22175found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22176takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22177
22178@item show thread detach-suspend-count
22179Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22180detaching.
22181
22182@item set thread exception-port
22183@itemx set thread excp
22184Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22185overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22186@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22187
22188@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22189Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22190value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22191changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22192
22193@item set thread default
22194@itemx show thread default
22195@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22196Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22197default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22198thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22199variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22200threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22201the non-default commands.
22202@end table
22203
22204@node Darwin
22205@subsection Darwin
22206@cindex Darwin
22207
22208@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22209
22210@table @code
22211@item set debug darwin @var{num}
22212@kindex set debug darwin
22213When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22214the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22215
22216@item show debug darwin
22217@kindex show debug darwin
22218Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22219
22220@item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22221@kindex set debug mach-o
22222When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22223@value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22224file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22225values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22226problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22227usage.
22228
22229@item show debug mach-o
22230@kindex show debug mach-o
22231Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22232
22233@item set mach-exceptions on
22234@itemx set mach-exceptions off
22235@kindex set mach-exceptions
22236On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22237mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22238Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22239better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22240
22241@item show mach-exceptions
22242@kindex show mach-exceptions
22243Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22244@end table
22245
22246
22247@node Embedded OS
22248@section Embedded Operating Systems
22249
22250This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22251embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22252architectures.
22253
22254@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22255various real-time operating systems.
22256
22257@node Embedded Processors
22258@section Embedded Processors
22259
22260This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22261configurations.
22262
22263@cindex send command to simulator
22264Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22265allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22266
22267@table @code
22268@item sim @var{command}
22269@kindex sim@r{, a command}
22270Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22271documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22272acceptable commands.
22273@end table
22274
22275
22276@menu
22277* ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22278* ARM:: ARM
22279* M68K:: Motorola M68K
22280* MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22281* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22282* PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22283* AVR:: Atmel AVR
22284* CRIS:: CRIS
22285* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22286@end menu
22287
22288@node ARC
22289@subsection Synopsys ARC
22290@cindex Synopsys ARC
22291@cindex ARC specific commands
22292@cindex ARC600
22293@cindex ARC700
22294@cindex ARC EM
22295@cindex ARC HS
22296
22297@value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22298
22299@table @code
22300@item set debug arc
22301@kindex set debug arc
22302Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22303default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22304
22305@item show debug arc
22306@kindex show debug arc
22307Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22308
22309@item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22310@kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22311Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22312
22313@end table
22314
22315@node ARM
22316@subsection ARM
22317
22318@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22319
22320@table @code
22321@item set arm disassembler
22322@kindex set arm
22323This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22324@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22325
22326@item show arm disassembler
22327@kindex show arm
22328Show the current disassembly style.
22329
22330@item set arm apcs32
22331@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22332This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22333
22334@item show arm apcs32
22335Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22336
22337@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22338This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22339argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22340
22341@table @code
22342@item auto
22343Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22344@item softfpa
22345Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22346processors.
22347@item fpa
22348GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22349@item softvfp
22350Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22351@item vfp
22352VFP co-processor.
22353@end table
22354
22355@item show arm fpu
22356Show the current type of the FPU.
22357
22358@item set arm abi
22359This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22360
22361@item show arm abi
22362Show the currently used ABI.
22363
22364@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22365@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22366whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22367@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22368available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22369use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22370register).
22371
22372@item show arm fallback-mode
22373Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22374
22375@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22376This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22377instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22378causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22379of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22380
22381@item show arm force-mode
22382Show the current forced instruction mode.
22383
22384@item set debug arm
22385Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22386target support subsystem.
22387
22388@item show debug arm
22389Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22390@end table
22391
22392@table @code
22393@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22394The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22395
22396@table @code
22397@item --swi-support=@var{type}
22398Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22399@var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22400The default value is @code{all}.
22401
22402@table @code
22403@item none
22404@item demon
22405@item angel
22406@item redboot
22407@item all
22408@end table
22409@end table
22410@end table
22411
22412@node M68K
22413@subsection M68k
22414
22415The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22416
22417@node MicroBlaze
22418@subsection MicroBlaze
22419@cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22420@cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22421
22422The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22423FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22424usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22425Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22426This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22427the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22428communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22429presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22430@code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22431this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22432commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22433
22434Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22435
22436@table @code
22437@item target remote :1234
22438Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22439on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22440
22441@item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22442Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22443running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22444
22445@item load
22446Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22447
22448@item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22449Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22450
22451@item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22452Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22453@end table
22454
22455@node MIPS Embedded
22456@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22457
22458@noindent
22459@value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22460
22461@table @code
22462@item set mipsfpu double
22463@itemx set mipsfpu single
22464@itemx set mipsfpu none
22465@itemx set mipsfpu auto
22466@itemx show mipsfpu
22467@kindex set mipsfpu
22468@kindex show mipsfpu
22469@cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22470@cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22471If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22472coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22473need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22474file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22475functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22476@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22477functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22478with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22479processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22480double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22481@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22482
22483In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22484floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22485and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22486
22487As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22488@samp{show mipsfpu}.
22489@end table
22490
22491@node PowerPC Embedded
22492@subsection PowerPC Embedded
22493
22494@cindex DVC register
22495@value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22496implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22497
22498@smallexample
22499(@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22500 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22501@end smallexample
22502
22503The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22504such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22505debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22506variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22507is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22508or newer.
22509
22510When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22511ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22512in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22513watching variables of scalar types.
22514
22515You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22516region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22517
22518@smallexample
22519(@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22520(@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22521@end smallexample
22522
22523PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22524about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22525
22526@cindex ranged breakpoint
22527PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22528@dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22529the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22530the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22531use the @code{break-range} command.
22532
22533@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22534
22535@table @code
22536@kindex break-range
22537@item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22538Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22539@var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22540a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22541location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22542for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22543The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22544executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22545(including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22546
22547@kindex set powerpc
22548@item set powerpc soft-float
22549@itemx show powerpc soft-float
22550Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22551convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22552on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22553
22554@item set powerpc vector-abi
22555@itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22556Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22557arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22558@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22559@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22560registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22561based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22562
22563@item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22564@itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22565Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22566of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22567address of its first byte.
22568
22569@end table
22570
22571@node AVR
22572@subsection Atmel AVR
22573@cindex AVR
22574
22575When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22576following AVR-specific commands:
22577
22578@table @code
22579@item info io_registers
22580@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22581@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22582This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22583each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22584@end table
22585
22586@node CRIS
22587@subsection CRIS
22588@cindex CRIS
22589
22590When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22591following CRIS-specific commands:
22592
22593@table @code
22594@item set cris-version @var{ver}
22595@cindex CRIS version
22596Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22597The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22598case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22599
22600@item show cris-version
22601Show the current CRIS version.
22602
22603@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22604@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22605Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22606Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22607@code{R59}.
22608
22609@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22610Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22611
22612@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22613@cindex CRIS mode
22614Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22615debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22616@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22617
22618@item show cris-mode
22619Show the current CRIS mode.
22620@end table
22621
22622@node Super-H
22623@subsection Renesas Super-H
22624@cindex Super-H
22625
22626For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22627commands:
22628
22629@table @code
22630@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22631@kindex set sh calling-convention
22632Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22633Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22634With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22635convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22636that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22637is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22638is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22639regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22640default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22641does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22642
22643@item show sh calling-convention
22644@kindex show sh calling-convention
22645Show the current calling convention setting.
22646
22647@end table
22648
22649
22650@node Architectures
22651@section Architectures
22652
22653This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22654all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22655
22656@menu
22657* AArch64::
22658* i386::
22659* Alpha::
22660* MIPS::
22661* HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22662* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22663* PowerPC::
22664* Nios II::
22665* Sparc64::
22666@end menu
22667
22668@node AArch64
22669@subsection AArch64
22670@cindex AArch64 support
22671
22672When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22673following special commands:
22674
22675@table @code
22676@item set debug aarch64
22677@kindex set debug aarch64
22678This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22679messages are to be displayed.
22680
22681@item show debug aarch64
22682Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22683
22684@end table
22685
22686@node i386
22687@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22688
22689@table @code
22690@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22691@kindex set struct-convention
22692@cindex struct return convention
22693@cindex struct/union returned in registers
22694Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22695@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22696@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22697default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22698are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22699@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22700be returned in a register.
22701
22702@item show struct-convention
22703@kindex show struct-convention
22704Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22705from functions.
22706@end table
22707
22708
22709@subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22710@cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22711
22712Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22713@footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22714registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22715which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22716memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22717complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22718(1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22719
22720@samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22721through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22722display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22723upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22724@value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22725can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22726
22727As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22728access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22729bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22730
22731@smallexample
22732 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22733 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22734@end smallexample
22735
22736This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22737change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22738counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22739Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22740the pointer.
22741
22742Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22743application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22744the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22745bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22746bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22747
22748@table @code
22749@item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22750@kindex show mpx bound
22751Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22752
22753@item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22754@kindex set mpx bound
22755Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22756This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22757whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22758for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22759@end table
22760
22761When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22762GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22763before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22764pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22765
22766This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22767program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22768Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22769clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22770function.
22771
22772You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22773execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22774called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22775continuing the execution. For example:
22776
22777@smallexample
22778 $ break *upper
22779 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22780 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22781 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22782 $ print $bnd0
22783 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22784@end smallexample
22785
22786At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22787violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22788set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22789
22790@node Alpha
22791@subsection Alpha
22792
22793See the following section.
22794
22795@node MIPS
22796@subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22797
22798@cindex stack on Alpha
22799@cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22800@cindex Alpha stack
22801@cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22802Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22803sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22804find the beginning of a function.
22805
22806@cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22807To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22808@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22809you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22810commands:
22811
22812@table @code
22813@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22814@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22815Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22816search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22817default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22818larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22819and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22820this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22821
22822@item show heuristic-fence-post
22823Display the current limit.
22824@end table
22825
22826@noindent
22827These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22828for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22829
22830Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22831programs:
22832
22833@table @code
22834@item set mips abi @var{arg}
22835@kindex set mips abi
22836@cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22837Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22838values of @var{arg} are:
22839
22840@table @samp
22841@item auto
22842The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22843default).
22844@item o32
22845@item o64
22846@item n32
22847@item n64
22848@item eabi32
22849@item eabi64
22850@end table
22851
22852@item show mips abi
22853@kindex show mips abi
22854Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22855
22856@item set mips compression @var{arg}
22857@kindex set mips compression
22858@cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22859Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22860@acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22861inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22862internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22863when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22864the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22865Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22866provided by the executable.
22867
22868Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22869The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22870executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22871identified as such.
22872
22873This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22874debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22875implicitly from an executable.
22876
22877The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22878identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22879@acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22880are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22881compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22882
22883@item show mips compression
22884@kindex show mips compression
22885Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22886@value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22887
22888@item set mipsfpu
22889@itemx show mipsfpu
22890@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22891
22892@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22893@kindex set mips mask-address
22894@cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22895This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22896@acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22897@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22898setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22899
22900@item show mips mask-address
22901@kindex show mips mask-address
22902Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22903not.
22904
22905@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22906@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22907This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22908transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22909that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22910and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22911
22912@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22913@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22914Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22915
22916@item set debug mips
22917@kindex set debug mips
22918This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22919target code in @value{GDBN}.
22920
22921@item show debug mips
22922@kindex show debug mips
22923Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22924@end table
22925
22926
22927@node HPPA
22928@subsection HPPA
22929@cindex HPPA support
22930
22931When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22932following special commands:
22933
22934@table @code
22935@item set debug hppa
22936@kindex set debug hppa
22937This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22938messages are to be displayed.
22939
22940@item show debug hppa
22941Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22942
22943@item maint print unwind @var{address}
22944@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22945This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22946given @var{address}.
22947
22948@end table
22949
22950
22951@node SPU
22952@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22953@cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22954@cindex SPU
22955
22956When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22957it provides the following special commands:
22958
22959@table @code
22960@item info spu event
22961@kindex info spu
22962Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22963and pending event status.
22964
22965@item info spu signal
22966Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22967signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22968notification channels.
22969
22970@item info spu mailbox
22971Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22972in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22973SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22974
22975@item info spu dma
22976Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22977DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22978and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22979
22980@item info spu proxydma
22981Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22982Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22983and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22984
22985@end table
22986
22987When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22988on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22989special commands:
22990
22991@table @code
22992@item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22993@kindex set spu
22994Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22995will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22996function. The default is @code{off}.
22997
22998@item show spu stop-on-load
22999@kindex show spu
23000Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23001
23002@item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23003Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23004@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23005cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23006view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23007does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23008
23009@item show spu auto-flush-cache
23010Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23011
23012@end table
23013
23014@node PowerPC
23015@subsection PowerPC
23016@cindex PowerPC architecture
23017
23018When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23019pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23020numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23021in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23022@code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23023
23024The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23025by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23026@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23027
23028For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23029wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23030
23031@node Nios II
23032@subsection Nios II
23033@cindex Nios II architecture
23034
23035When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23036it provides the following special commands:
23037
23038@table @code
23039
23040@item set debug nios2
23041@kindex set debug nios2
23042This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23043target code in @value{GDBN}.
23044
23045@item show debug nios2
23046@kindex show debug nios2
23047Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23048@end table
23049
23050@node Sparc64
23051@subsection Sparc64
23052@cindex Sparc64 support
23053@cindex Application Data Integrity
23054@subsubsection ADI Support
23055
23056The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23057detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23058ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23059version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23060the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23061in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23062the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23063cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23064version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23065is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23066signal.
23067
23068Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23069ADI-enabled.
23070
23071Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23072cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23073
23074
23075@table @code
23076@kindex adi examine
23077@item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23078
23079The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23080cacheline.
23081
23082@var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23083is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23084block size, to display.
23085
23086@var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23087to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23088
23089Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23090
23091@smallexample
23092(@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23093 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23094@end smallexample
23095
23096@kindex adi assign
23097@item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23098
23099The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23100to an address.
23101
23102@var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23103the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23104ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23105
23106@var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23107to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23108
23109@var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23110
23111For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23112variable "shmaddr":
23113
23114@smallexample
23115(@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23116(@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23117 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23118@end smallexample
23119
23120@end table
23121
23122@node Controlling GDB
23123@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23124
23125You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23126@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23127data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23128described here.
23129
23130@menu
23131* Prompt:: Prompt
23132* Editing:: Command editing
23133* Command History:: Command history
23134* Screen Size:: Screen size
23135* Numbers:: Numbers
23136* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23137* Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23138* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23139* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23140* Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23141@end menu
23142
23143@node Prompt
23144@section Prompt
23145
23146@cindex prompt
23147
23148@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23149called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23150can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23151instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23152the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23153which one you are talking to.
23154
23155@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23156prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23157or a prompt that does not.
23158
23159@table @code
23160@kindex set prompt
23161@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23162Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23163
23164@kindex show prompt
23165@item show prompt
23166Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23167@end table
23168
23169Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23170prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23171are:
23172
23173@table @code
23174@kindex set extended-prompt
23175@item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23176Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23177@xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23178substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23179string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23180is displayed.
23181
23182For example:
23183
23184@smallexample
23185set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23186@end smallexample
23187
23188Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23189@var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23190
23191@kindex show extended-prompt
23192@item show extended-prompt
23193Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23194the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23195corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23196@end table
23197
23198@node Editing
23199@section Command Editing
23200@cindex readline
23201@cindex command line editing
23202
23203@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23204@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23205command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23206or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23207substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23208debugging sessions.
23209
23210You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23211command @code{set}.
23212
23213@table @code
23214@kindex set editing
23215@cindex editing
23216@item set editing
23217@itemx set editing on
23218Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23219
23220@item set editing off
23221Disable command line editing.
23222
23223@kindex show editing
23224@item show editing
23225Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23226@end table
23227
23228@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23229@xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23230@end ifset
23231@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23232@xref{Command Line Editing},
23233@end ifclear
23234for more details about the Readline
23235interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23236encouraged to read that chapter.
23237
23238@node Command History
23239@section Command History
23240@cindex command history
23241
23242@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23243debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23244happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23245history facility.
23246
23247@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23248package, to provide the history facility.
23249@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23250@xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23251@end ifset
23252@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23253@xref{Using History Interactively},
23254@end ifclear
23255for the detailed description of the History library.
23256
23257To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23258the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23259(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23260means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23261affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23262pressed on a line by itself.
23263
23264@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23265The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23266history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23267use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23268
23269Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23270history.
23271
23272@table @code
23273@cindex history substitution
23274@cindex history file
23275@kindex set history filename
23276@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23277@item set history filename @var{fname}
23278Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23279This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23280list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23281exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23282the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23283to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23284@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23285is not set.
23286
23287@cindex save command history
23288@kindex set history save
23289@item set history save
23290@itemx set history save on
23291Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23292@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23293
23294@item set history save off
23295Stop recording command history in a file.
23296
23297@cindex history size
23298@kindex set history size
23299@cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23300@item set history size @var{size}
23301@itemx set history size unlimited
23302Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23303This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23304to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23305are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23306either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23307@value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23308
23309@cindex remove duplicate history
23310@kindex set history remove-duplicates
23311@item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23312@itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23313Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23314If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23315history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23316entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23317@code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23318removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23319
23320Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23321removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23322
23323@end table
23324
23325History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23326@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23327@xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23328@end ifset
23329@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23330@xref{Event Designators},
23331@end ifclear
23332for more details.
23333
23334@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23335Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23336is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23337@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23338follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23339a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23340history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23341@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23342
23343The commands to control history expansion are:
23344
23345@table @code
23346@item set history expansion on
23347@itemx set history expansion
23348@kindex set history expansion
23349Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23350
23351@item set history expansion off
23352Disable history expansion.
23353
23354@c @group
23355@kindex show history
23356@item show history
23357@itemx show history filename
23358@itemx show history save
23359@itemx show history size
23360@itemx show history expansion
23361These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23362@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23363@c @end group
23364@end table
23365
23366@table @code
23367@kindex show commands
23368@cindex show last commands
23369@cindex display command history
23370@item show commands
23371Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23372
23373@item show commands @var{n}
23374Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23375
23376@item show commands +
23377Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23378@end table
23379
23380@node Screen Size
23381@section Screen Size
23382@cindex size of screen
23383@cindex screen size
23384@cindex pagination
23385@cindex page size
23386@cindex pauses in output
23387
23388Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23389information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23390@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23391output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23392to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23393determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23394printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23395rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23396
23397Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23398driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23399together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23400@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23401you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23402width} commands:
23403
23404@table @code
23405@kindex set height
23406@kindex set width
23407@kindex show width
23408@kindex show height
23409@item set height @var{lpp}
23410@itemx set height unlimited
23411@itemx show height
23412@itemx set width @var{cpl}
23413@itemx set width unlimited
23414@itemx show width
23415These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23416a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23417commands display the current settings.
23418
23419If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23420@value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23421output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23422buffer.
23423
23424Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23425width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23426
23427@item set pagination on
23428@itemx set pagination off
23429@kindex set pagination
23430Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23431pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23432running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23433Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23434
23435@item show pagination
23436@kindex show pagination
23437Show the current pagination mode.
23438@end table
23439
23440@node Numbers
23441@section Numbers
23442@cindex number representation
23443@cindex entering numbers
23444
23445You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23446@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23447@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23448begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23449@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
2345010; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23451format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23452both input and output with the commands described below.
23453
23454@table @code
23455@kindex set input-radix
23456@item set input-radix @var{base}
23457Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23458for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23459specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23460example, any of
23461
23462@smallexample
23463set input-radix 012
23464set input-radix 10.
23465set input-radix 0xa
23466@end smallexample
23467
23468@noindent
23469sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23470leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23471@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23472interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23473@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23474change the radix.
23475
23476@kindex set output-radix
23477@item set output-radix @var{base}
23478Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23479for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23480specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23481
23482@kindex show input-radix
23483@item show input-radix
23484Display the current default base for numeric input.
23485
23486@kindex show output-radix
23487@item show output-radix
23488Display the current default base for numeric display.
23489
23490@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23491@itemx show radix
23492@kindex set radix
23493@kindex show radix
23494These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23495of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23496the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23497default value of 10.
23498
23499@end table
23500
23501@node ABI
23502@section Configuring the Current ABI
23503
23504@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23505application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23506conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23507current ABI.
23508
23509@cindex OS ABI
23510@kindex set osabi
23511@kindex show osabi
23512@cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23513
23514One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23515system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23516@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23517but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23518One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23519an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23520not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23521platform provides.
23522
23523When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23524``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23525@code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23526The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23527
23528@table @code
23529@item show osabi
23530Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23531
23532@item set osabi
23533With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23534
23535@item set osabi @var{abi}
23536Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23537@end table
23538
23539@cindex float promotion
23540
23541Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23542function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23543(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23544according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23545(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23546@code{double} and then passed.
23547
23548Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23549a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23550as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23551
23552@table @code
23553@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23554@item set coerce-float-to-double
23555@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23556Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23557to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23558
23559@item set coerce-float-to-double off
23560Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23561functions.
23562
23563@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23564@item show coerce-float-to-double
23565Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23566@end table
23567
23568@kindex set cp-abi
23569@kindex show cp-abi
23570@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23571objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23572used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23573programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23574multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23575program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23576Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23577before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23578``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23579use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23580``auto''.
23581
23582@table @code
23583@item show cp-abi
23584Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23585
23586@item set cp-abi
23587With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23588
23589@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23590@itemx set cp-abi auto
23591Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23592@end table
23593
23594@node Auto-loading
23595@section Automatically loading associated files
23596@cindex auto-loading
23597
23598@value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23599without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23600@dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23601@value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23602results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23603sources).
23604
23605@menu
23606* Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23607* libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23608
23609* Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23610* Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23611@end menu
23612
23613There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23614In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23615in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23616
23617Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23618file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23619(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23620
23621For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23622control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23623
23624@table @code
23625@anchor{set auto-load off}
23626@kindex set auto-load off
23627@item set auto-load off
23628Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23629You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23630(@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23631@smallexample
23632$ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23633@end smallexample
23634
23635Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23636and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23637still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23638To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23639@option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23640@code{set auto-load no}.
23641
23642@anchor{show auto-load}
23643@kindex show auto-load
23644@item show auto-load
23645Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23646or disabled.
23647
23648@smallexample
23649(gdb) show auto-load
23650gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23651libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23652local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23653 is on.
23654python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23655safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23656 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23657scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23658 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23659@end smallexample
23660
23661@anchor{info auto-load}
23662@kindex info auto-load
23663@item info auto-load
23664Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23665not.
23666
23667@smallexample
23668(gdb) info auto-load
23669gdb-scripts:
23670Loaded Script
23671Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23672libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23673local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23674 loaded.
23675python-scripts:
23676Loaded Script
23677Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23678@end smallexample
23679@end table
23680
23681These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23682
23683@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23684@item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23685@tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23686@item @xref{show auto-load}.
23687@tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23688@item @xref{info auto-load}.
23689@tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23690@item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23691@tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23692@item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23693@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23694@item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23695@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23696@item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23697@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23698@item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23699@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23700@item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23701@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23702@item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23703@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23704@item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23705@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23706@item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23707@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23708@item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23709@tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23710@item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23711@tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23712@item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23713@tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23714@item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23715@tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23716@item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23717@tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23718@item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23719@tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23720@item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23721@tab Control for thread debugging library.
23722@item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23723@tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23724@item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23725@tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23726@item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23727@tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23728@item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23729@tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23730@item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23731@tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23732@end multitable
23733
23734@node Init File in the Current Directory
23735@subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23736@cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23737
23738By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23739from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23740see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23741
23742Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23743configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23744
23745@table @code
23746@anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23747@kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23748@item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23749Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23750(@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23751
23752@anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23753@kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23754@item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23755Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23756current directory is enabled or disabled.
23757
23758@anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23759@kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23760@item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23761Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23762current directory have been auto-loaded.
23763@end table
23764
23765@node libthread_db.so.1 file
23766@subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23767@cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23768
23769This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23770
23771@value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23772to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23773
23774The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23775without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23776libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23777@samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23778auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23779library.
23780
23781Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23782@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23783
23784@table @code
23785@anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23786@kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23787@item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23788Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23789
23790@anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23791@kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23792@item show auto-load libthread-db
23793Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23794enabled or disabled.
23795
23796@anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23797@kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23798@item info auto-load libthread-db
23799Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23800for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23801@end table
23802
23803@node Auto-loading safe path
23804@subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23805@cindex auto-loading safe-path
23806
23807As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23808an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23809@value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23810directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23811Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23812
23813If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23814get loaded:
23815
23816@smallexample
23817$ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23818Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23819warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23820 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23821 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23822warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23823 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23824 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23825@end smallexample
23826
23827@noindent
23828To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23829invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23830
23831@smallexample
23832$ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23833@end smallexample
23834
23835The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23836
23837@table @code
23838@anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23839@kindex set auto-load safe-path
23840@item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23841Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23842loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23843Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23844directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23845(@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23846If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23847its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23848
23849The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23850systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23851to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23852
23853@anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23854@kindex show auto-load safe-path
23855@item show auto-load safe-path
23856Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23857scripts.
23858
23859@anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23860@kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23861@item add-auto-load-safe-path
23862Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23863automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23864by the host platform path separator in use.
23865@end table
23866
23867This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23868to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23869substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23870The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23871@value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23872
23873Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23874corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23875@option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23876This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23877system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23878their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23879init file in the current directory
23880(@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23881
23882To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23883example, you could use one of the following ways:
23884
23885@table @asis
23886@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23887Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23888You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23889by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23890
23891@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23892Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23893@value{GDBN} session.
23894
23895@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23896Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23897This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23898from trusted sources.
23899
23900@item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23901During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23902This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23903trusted sources.
23904@end table
23905
23906On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23907also suppresses any such warning messages:
23908
23909@table @asis
23910@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23911You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23912
23913@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23914Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23915(@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23916use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23917@end table
23918
23919This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23920@value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23921their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23922entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23923own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23924recommended to be entered.
23925
23926@node Auto-loading verbose mode
23927@subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23928@cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23929
23930For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23931be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23932execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23933all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23934be printed.
23935
23936For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23937(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23938may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23939
23940@smallexample
23941(gdb) set debug auto-load on
23942(gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23943auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23944 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23945auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23946auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23947auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23948warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23949 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23950@end smallexample
23951
23952@table @code
23953@anchor{set debug auto-load}
23954@kindex set debug auto-load
23955@item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23956Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23957
23958@anchor{show debug auto-load}
23959@kindex show debug auto-load
23960@item show debug auto-load
23961Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23962on or off.
23963@end table
23964
23965@node Messages/Warnings
23966@section Optional Warnings and Messages
23967
23968@cindex verbose operation
23969@cindex optional warnings
23970By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23971running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23972command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23973internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23974
23975Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23976which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23977see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23978
23979@table @code
23980@kindex set verbose
23981@item set verbose on
23982Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23983
23984@item set verbose off
23985Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23986
23987@kindex show verbose
23988@item show verbose
23989Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23990@end table
23991
23992By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23993object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23994find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23995Symbol Files}).
23996
23997@table @code
23998
23999@kindex set complaints
24000@item set complaints @var{limit}
24001Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24002unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24003@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24004to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24005
24006@kindex show complaints
24007@item show complaints
24008Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24009
24010@end table
24011
24012@anchor{confirmation requests}
24013By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24014lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24015you try to run a program which is already running:
24016
24017@smallexample
24018(@value{GDBP}) run
24019The program being debugged has been started already.
24020Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24021@end smallexample
24022
24023If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24024commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24025
24026@table @code
24027
24028@kindex set confirm
24029@cindex flinching
24030@cindex confirmation
24031@cindex stupid questions
24032@item set confirm off
24033Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24034the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24035automatically disables confirmation requests.
24036
24037@item set confirm on
24038Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24039
24040@kindex show confirm
24041@item show confirm
24042Displays state of confirmation requests.
24043
24044@end table
24045
24046@cindex command tracing
24047If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24048useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24049printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24050quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24051
24052@table @code
24053@kindex set trace-commands
24054@cindex command scripts, debugging
24055@item set trace-commands on
24056Enable command tracing.
24057@item set trace-commands off
24058Disable command tracing.
24059@item show trace-commands
24060Display the current state of command tracing.
24061@end table
24062
24063@node Debugging Output
24064@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24065@cindex optional debugging messages
24066
24067@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24068various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24069interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24070section documents those commands.
24071
24072@table @code
24073@kindex set exec-done-display
24074@item set exec-done-display
24075Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24076completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24077asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24078@kindex show exec-done-display
24079@item show exec-done-display
24080Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24081notification.
24082@kindex set debug
24083@cindex ARM AArch64
24084@item set debug aarch64
24085Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24086The default is off.
24087@kindex show debug
24088@item show debug aarch64
24089Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24090ARM AArch64.
24091@cindex gdbarch debugging info
24092@cindex architecture debugging info
24093@item set debug arch
24094Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24095@item show debug arch
24096Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24097@item set debug aix-solib
24098@cindex AIX shared library debugging
24099Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24100support module. The default is off.
24101@item show debug aix-thread
24102Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24103@item set debug aix-thread
24104@cindex AIX threads
24105Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24106module.
24107@item show debug aix-thread
24108Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24109@item set debug check-physname
24110@cindex physname
24111Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24112debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24113each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24114different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24115When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24116both ways and display any discrepancies.
24117@item show debug check-physname
24118Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24119@item set debug coff-pe-read
24120@cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24121Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24122exported symbols. The default is off.
24123@item show debug coff-pe-read
24124Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24125reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24126@item set debug dwarf-die
24127@cindex DWARF DIEs
24128Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24129The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24130A value of zero turns off the display.
24131@item show debug dwarf-die
24132Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24133@item set debug dwarf-line
24134@cindex DWARF Line Tables
24135Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24136DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24137A value of 1 provides basic information.
24138A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24139@item show debug dwarf-line
24140Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24141@item set debug dwarf-read
24142@cindex DWARF Reading
24143Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24144DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24145A value of 1 provides basic information.
24146A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24147@item show debug dwarf-read
24148Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24149@item set debug displaced
24150@cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24151Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24152displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24153@item show debug displaced
24154Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24155related to displaced stepping.
24156@item set debug event
24157@cindex event debugging info
24158Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24159default is off.
24160@item show debug event
24161Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24162info.
24163@item set debug expression
24164@cindex expression debugging info
24165Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24166expression parsing. The default is off.
24167@item show debug expression
24168Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24169@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24170@item set debug fbsd-lwp
24171@cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24172Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24173@item show debug fbsd-lwp
24174Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24175@item set debug frame
24176@cindex frame debugging info
24177Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24178default is off.
24179@item show debug frame
24180Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24181info.
24182@item set debug gnu-nat
24183@cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24184Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24185@item show debug gnu-nat
24186Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24187@item set debug infrun
24188@cindex inferior debugging info
24189Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24190The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24191for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24192@item show debug infrun
24193Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24194@item set debug jit
24195@cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24196Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24197@item show debug jit
24198Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24199@item set debug lin-lwp
24200@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24201@cindex Linux lightweight processes
24202Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24203@item show debug lin-lwp
24204Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24205@item set debug linux-namespaces
24206@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24207Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24208@item show debug linux-namespaces
24209Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24210@item set debug mach-o
24211@cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24212Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24213processing. The default is off.
24214@item show debug mach-o
24215Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24216reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24217@item set debug notification
24218@cindex remote async notification debugging info
24219Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24220The default is off.
24221@item show debug notification
24222Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24223@item set debug observer
24224@cindex observer debugging info
24225Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24226includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24227@item show debug observer
24228Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24229@item set debug overload
24230@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24231Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24232info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24233is off.
24234@item show debug overload
24235Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24236debugging info.
24237@cindex expression parser, debugging info
24238@cindex debug expression parser
24239@item set debug parser
24240Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24241Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24242parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24243details. The default is off.
24244@item show debug parser
24245Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24246@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24247@cindex serial connections, debugging
24248@cindex debug remote protocol
24249@cindex remote protocol debugging
24250@cindex display remote packets
24251@item set debug remote
24252Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24253the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24254@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24255@item show debug remote
24256Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24257
24258@item set debug separate-debug-file
24259Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24260@item show debug separate-debug-file
24261Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24262
24263@item set debug serial
24264Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24265default is off.
24266@item show debug serial
24267Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24268info.
24269@item set debug solib-frv
24270@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24271Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24272@item show debug solib-frv
24273Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24274messages.
24275@item set debug symbol-lookup
24276@cindex symbol lookup
24277Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24278The default is 0 (off).
24279A value of 1 provides basic information.
24280A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24281@item show debug symbol-lookup
24282Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24283@item set debug symfile
24284@cindex symbol file functions
24285Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24286The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24287@item show debug symfile
24288Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24289@item set debug symtab-create
24290@cindex symbol table creation
24291Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24292The default is 0 (off).
24293A value of 1 provides basic information.
24294A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24295@item show debug symtab-create
24296Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24297@item set debug target
24298@cindex target debugging info
24299Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24300includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24301default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24302value of large memory transfers.
24303@item show debug target
24304Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24305info.
24306@item set debug timestamp
24307@cindex timestampping debugging info
24308Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24309When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24310message.
24311@item show debug timestamp
24312Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24313debugging info.
24314@item set debug varobj
24315@cindex variable object debugging info
24316Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24317info. The default is off.
24318@item show debug varobj
24319Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24320debugging info.
24321@item set debug xml
24322@cindex XML parser debugging
24323Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24324@item show debug xml
24325Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24326@end table
24327
24328@node Other Misc Settings
24329@section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24330@cindex miscellaneous settings
24331
24332@table @code
24333@kindex set interactive-mode
24334@item set interactive-mode
24335If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24336in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24337for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24338the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24339in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24340If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24341its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24342is, non-interactively otherwise.
24343
24344In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24345correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24346in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24347inside a cygwin window.
24348
24349@kindex show interactive-mode
24350@item show interactive-mode
24351Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24352@end table
24353
24354@node Extending GDB
24355@chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24356@cindex extending GDB
24357
24358@value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24359@value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24360extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24361user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24362being debugged.
24363
24364@menu
24365* Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24366* Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24367* Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24368* Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24369* Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24370* Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24371@end menu
24372
24373To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24374of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24375can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24376the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24377are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24378@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24379
24380You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24381setting:
24382
24383@table @code
24384@kindex set script-extension
24385@kindex show script-extension
24386@item set script-extension off
24387All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24388
24389@item set script-extension soft
24390The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24391extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24392evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24393the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24394
24395@item set script-extension strict
24396The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24397extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24398language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24399
24400@item show script-extension
24401Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24402
24403@end table
24404
24405@node Sequences
24406@section Canned Sequences of Commands
24407
24408Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24409Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24410commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24411files.
24412
24413@menu
24414* Define:: How to define your own commands
24415* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24416* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24417* Output:: Commands for controlled output
24418* Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24419@end menu
24420
24421@node Define
24422@subsection User-defined Commands
24423
24424@cindex user-defined command
24425@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24426A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24427which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24428@code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24429separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24430via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24431
24432@smallexample
24433define adder
24434 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24435end
24436@end smallexample
24437
24438@noindent
24439To execute the command use:
24440
24441@smallexample
24442adder 1 2 3
24443@end smallexample
24444
24445@noindent
24446This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24447its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24448reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24449functions calls.
24450
24451@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24452@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24453In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24454been passed.
24455
24456@smallexample
24457define adder
24458 if $argc == 2
24459 print $arg0 + $arg1
24460 end
24461 if $argc == 3
24462 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24463 end
24464end
24465@end smallexample
24466
24467Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24468to process a variable number of arguments:
24469
24470@smallexample
24471define adder
24472 set $i = 0
24473 set $sum = 0
24474 while $i < $argc
24475 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24476 set $i = $i + 1
24477 end
24478 print $sum
24479end
24480@end smallexample
24481
24482@table @code
24483
24484@kindex define
24485@item define @var{commandname}
24486Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24487by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24488The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24489numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24490prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24491a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24492
24493The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24494which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24495commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24496
24497@kindex document
24498@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24499@item document @var{commandname}
24500Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24501accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24502defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24503reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24504After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24505@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24506
24507You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24508documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24509does not change the documentation.
24510
24511@kindex dont-repeat
24512@cindex don't repeat command
24513@item dont-repeat
24514Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24515command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24516(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24517
24518@kindex help user-defined
24519@item help user-defined
24520List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24521COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24522included (if any).
24523
24524@kindex show user
24525@item show user
24526@itemx show user @var{commandname}
24527Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24528not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24529definitions for all user-defined commands.
24530This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24531
24532@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24533@kindex show max-user-call-depth
24534@kindex set max-user-call-depth
24535@item show max-user-call-depth
24536@itemx set max-user-call-depth
24537The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24538levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24539infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24540This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24541@end table
24542
24543In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24544use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24545
24546When user-defined commands are executed, the
24547commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24548stops execution of the user-defined command.
24549
24550If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24551without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24552commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24553messages when used in a user-defined command.
24554
24555@node Hooks
24556@subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24557@cindex command hooks
24558@cindex hooks, for commands
24559@cindex hooks, pre-command
24560
24561@kindex hook
24562You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24563command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24564command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24565before that command.
24566
24567@cindex hooks, post-command
24568@kindex hookpost
24569A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24570Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24571@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24572that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24573pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24574
24575It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24576occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24577
24578@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24579@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24580
24581@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24582In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24583(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24584execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24585displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24586
24587For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24588single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24589you could define:
24590
24591@smallexample
24592define hook-stop
24593handle SIGALRM nopass
24594end
24595
24596define hook-run
24597handle SIGALRM pass
24598end
24599
24600define hook-continue
24601handle SIGALRM pass
24602end
24603@end smallexample
24604
24605As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24606command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24607you could define:
24608
24609@smallexample
24610define hook-echo
24611echo <<<---
24612end
24613
24614define hookpost-echo
24615echo --->>>\n
24616end
24617
24618(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24619<<<---Hello World--->>>
24620(@value{GDBP})
24621
24622@end smallexample
24623
24624You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24625not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24626name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24627@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24628@c or not?
24629You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24630@code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24631@samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24632
24633If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24634@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24635(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24636
24637If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24638get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24639
24640@node Command Files
24641@subsection Command Files
24642
24643@cindex command files
24644@cindex scripting commands
24645A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24646@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24647also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24648does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24649terminal.
24650
24651You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24652command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24653scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24654using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24655@xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24656
24657@table @code
24658@kindex source
24659@cindex execute commands from a file
24660@item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24661Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24662@end table
24663
24664The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24665unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24666@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24667printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24668execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24669
24670@value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24671If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24672directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24673(specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24674except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24675is not relevant to scripts.
24676
24677If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24678on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24679The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24680search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24681and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24682look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24683The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24684For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24685the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24686look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24687For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24688it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24689@file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24690will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24691
24692If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24693each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24694@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24695
24696Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24697without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24698normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24699when called from command files.
24700
24701@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24702mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24703standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24704not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24705the next command.
24706
24707@smallexample
24708gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24709@end smallexample
24710
24711(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24712will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24713would be directed to @file{log}.
24714
24715Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24716commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24717complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24718variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24719built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24720deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24721complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24722conditionally, etc.
24723
24724@table @code
24725@kindex if
24726@kindex else
24727@item if
24728@itemx else
24729This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24730commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24731expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24732are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24733There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24734of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24735end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24736
24737@kindex while
24738@item while
24739This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24740@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24741to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24742line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24743@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24744executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24745
24746@kindex loop_break
24747@item loop_break
24748This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24749Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24750line.
24751
24752@kindex loop_continue
24753@item loop_continue
24754This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24755in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24756branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24757the controlling expression.
24758
24759@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24760@item end
24761Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24762@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24763@end table
24764
24765
24766@node Output
24767@subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24768
24769During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24770@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24771explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24772describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24773want.
24774
24775@table @code
24776@kindex echo
24777@item echo @var{text}
24778@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24779@c because it is not in ANSI.
24780Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24781@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24782newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24783In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24784by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24785string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24786trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24787To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24788@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24789
24790A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24791the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24792
24793@smallexample
24794echo This is some text\n\
24795which is continued\n\
24796onto several lines.\n
24797@end smallexample
24798
24799produces the same output as
24800
24801@smallexample
24802echo This is some text\n
24803echo which is continued\n
24804echo onto several lines.\n
24805@end smallexample
24806
24807@kindex output
24808@item output @var{expression}
24809Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24810newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24811value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24812on expressions.
24813
24814@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24815Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24816the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24817Formats}, for more information.
24818
24819@kindex printf
24820@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24821Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24822the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24823@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24824which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24825specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24826executing the code below:
24827
24828@smallexample
24829printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24830@end smallexample
24831
24832As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24833are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24834by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24835evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24836style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24837printed.
24838
24839For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24840
24841@smallexample
24842printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24843@end smallexample
24844
24845@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24846specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24847character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24848
24849@itemize @bullet
24850@item
24851The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24852
24853@item
24854The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24855width.
24856
24857@item
24858The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24859@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24860
24861@item
24862The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24863supported.
24864
24865@item
24866The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24867
24868@item
24869The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24870@end itemize
24871
24872@noindent
24873Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24874underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24875the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24876supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24877
24878As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24879sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24880@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24881single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24882supported.
24883
24884Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24885(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24886together with a floating point specifier.
24887letters:
24888
24889@itemize @bullet
24890@item
24891@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24892
24893@item
24894@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24895
24896@item
24897@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24898@end itemize
24899
24900If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24901support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24902such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24903
24904In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24905available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24906
24907Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24908@smallexample
24909printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24910@end smallexample
24911
24912@anchor{eval}
24913@kindex eval
24914@item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24915Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24916the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24917
24918@end table
24919
24920@node Auto-loading sequences
24921@subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24922@cindex native script auto-loading
24923
24924When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24925command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24926@value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24927@xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24928
24929Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24930and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24931
24932@table @code
24933@anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24934@kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24935@item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24936Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24937
24938@anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24939@kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24940@item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24941Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24942disabled.
24943
24944@anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24945@kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24946@cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24947@item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24948Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24949auto-loaded.
24950@end table
24951
24952If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24953matching names are printed.
24954
24955@c Python docs live in a separate file.
24956@include python.texi
24957
24958@c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24959@include guile.texi
24960
24961@node Auto-loading extensions
24962@section Auto-loading extensions
24963@cindex auto-loading extensions
24964
24965@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24966when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24967command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24968@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24969section of modern file formats like ELF.
24970
24971@menu
24972* objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24973* .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24974* Which flavor to choose?::
24975@end menu
24976
24977The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24978debugging commands and features.
24979
24980Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24981and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24982See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24983for more information.
24984For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24985For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24986
24987Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24988@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24989
24990@node objfile-gdbdotext file
24991@subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24992@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24993@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24994@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24995
24996When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24997@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24998where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24999where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25000
25001@table @code
25002@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25003GDB's own command language
25004@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25005Python
25006@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25007Guile
25008@end table
25009
25010@var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25011is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25012components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25013If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25014script in the specified extension language.
25015
25016If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25017@var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25018
25019Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25020@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25021
25022For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25023scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25024found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25025its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25026is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25027between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25028
25029@table @code
25030@anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25031@kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25032@item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25033Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25034may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25035(@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25036
25037Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25038@code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25039
25040@anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25041This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25042@code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25043configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25044
25045Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25046@var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25047reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25048determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25049@file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25050delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25051platform.
25052
25053The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25054systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25055to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25056
25057@anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25058@kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25059@item show auto-load scripts-directory
25060Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25061
25062@anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25063@kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25064@item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25065Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25066Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25067@end table
25068
25069@value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25070@value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25071@var{objfile} is opened.
25072So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25073is evaluated more than once.
25074
25075@node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25076@subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25077@cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25078
25079For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25080when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25081it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25082If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25083specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25084specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25085script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25086
25087The following entries are supported:
25088
25089@table @code
25090@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25091@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25092@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25093@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25094@end table
25095
25096@subsubsection Script File Entries
25097
25098If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25099in the current directory and then along the source search path
25100(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25101except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25102directory is not relevant to scripts.
25103
25104File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25105for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25106
25107@example
25108/* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25109#define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25110 asm("\
25111.pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25112.byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25113.asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25114.popsection \n\
25115");
25116@end example
25117
25118@noindent
25119For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25120Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25121
25122@example
25123DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25124@end example
25125
25126The script name may include directories if desired.
25127
25128Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25129@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25130
25131If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25132using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25133and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25134will remove duplicates.
25135
25136@subsubsection Script Text Entries
25137
25138Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25139itself instead of loading it from a file.
25140The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25141the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25142contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25143The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25144execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25145all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25146on its name.
25147
25148Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25149testsuite.
25150
25151@example
25152#include "symcat.h"
25153#include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25154asm(
25155".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25156".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25157".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25158".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25159".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25160".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25161 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25162".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25163".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25164".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25165".byte 0\n"
25166".popsection\n"
25167);
25168@end example
25169
25170Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25171@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25172The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25173containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25174
25175@node Which flavor to choose?
25176@subsection Which flavor to choose?
25177
25178Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25179be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25180
25181@noindent
25182Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25183
25184@itemize @bullet
25185@item
25186Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25187
25188@item
25189Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25190
25191Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25192in the source search path.
25193For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25194isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25195
25196@item
25197Doesn't require source code additions.
25198@end itemize
25199
25200@noindent
25201Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25202
25203@itemize @bullet
25204@item
25205Works with static linking.
25206
25207Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25208trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25209objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25210scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25211@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25212
25213@item
25214Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25215
25216Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25217shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25218
25219@item
25220Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25221
25222In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25223libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25224@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25225cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25226@code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25227top of the source tree to the source search path.
25228@end itemize
25229
25230@node Multiple Extension Languages
25231@section Multiple Extension Languages
25232
25233The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25234and generally do not interfere with each other.
25235There are some things to be aware of, however.
25236
25237@subsection Python comes first
25238
25239Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25240existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25241``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25242extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25243(say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25244language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25245pretty-printed form of a value).
25246This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25247while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25248reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25249
25250@node Aliases
25251@section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25252@cindex aliases for commands
25253
25254It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25255For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25256a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25257that involves less typing.
25258
25259@value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25260of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25261abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25262
25263Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25264of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25265@samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25266
25267You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25268
25269@table @code
25270
25271@kindex alias
25272@item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25273
25274@end table
25275
25276@var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25277Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25278underscores.
25279
25280@var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25281that is being aliased.
25282
25283The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25284of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25285lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25286
25287The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25288and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25289
25290Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25291of a command so that there is less to type.
25292Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25293shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25294and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25295The following will accomplish this.
25296
25297@smallexample
25298(gdb) alias -a di = disas
25299@end smallexample
25300
25301Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25302With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25303for it with the @samp{document} command.
25304An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25305
25306Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25307@samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25308This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25309of a command.
25310
25311@smallexample
25312(gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25313(gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25314(gdb) set p elms 20
25315(gdb) show p elms
25316Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25317@end smallexample
25318
25319Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25320and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25321command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25322
25323Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25324@var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25325
25326@smallexample
25327(gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25328@end smallexample
25329
25330Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25331alias for a more complex command.
25332This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25333
25334@smallexample
25335(gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25336(gdb) spe 20
25337@end smallexample
25338
25339@node Interpreters
25340@chapter Command Interpreters
25341@cindex command interpreters
25342
25343@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25344infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25345between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25346
25347@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25348interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25349and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25350describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25351
25352By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25353However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25354interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25355startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25356
25357@table @code
25358@item console
25359@cindex console interpreter
25360The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25361used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25362@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25363
25364@item mi
25365@cindex mi interpreter
25366The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25367by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25368or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25369Interface}.
25370
25371@item mi2
25372@cindex mi2 interpreter
25373The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25374
25375@item mi1
25376@cindex mi1 interpreter
25377The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25378
25379@end table
25380
25381@cindex invoke another interpreter
25382
25383@kindex interpreter-exec
25384You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25385interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25386console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25387
25388@smallexample
25389interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25390@end smallexample
25391
25392@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25393@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25394
25395Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25396duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25397permanently.
25398
25399@cindex start a new independent interpreter
25400
25401Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25402possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25403device (usually a tty).
25404
25405For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25406@value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25407emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25408command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25409terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25410input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25411at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25412while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25413the separate MI interpreter.
25414
25415To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25416@code{new-ui} command:
25417
25418@kindex new-ui
25419@cindex new user interface
25420@smallexample
25421new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25422@end smallexample
25423
25424The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25425This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25426For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25427@var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25428interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25429pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25430
25431@smallexample
25432(@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25433@end smallexample
25434
25435@noindent
25436runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25437
25438@node TUI
25439@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25440@cindex TUI
25441@cindex Text User Interface
25442
25443@menu
25444* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25445* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25446* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25447* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25448* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25449@end menu
25450
25451The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25452interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25453file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25454commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25455on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25456is available.
25457
25458The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25459@samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25460You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25461using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25462enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25463@ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25464
25465@node TUI Overview
25466@section TUI Overview
25467
25468In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25469
25470@table @emph
25471@item command
25472This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25473prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25474managed using readline.
25475
25476@item source
25477The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25478line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25479
25480@item assembly
25481The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25482
25483@item register
25484This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25485when their values change.
25486@end table
25487
25488The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25489by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25490Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25491indicates the breakpoint type:
25492
25493@table @code
25494@item B
25495Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25496
25497@item b
25498Breakpoint which was never hit.
25499
25500@item H
25501Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25502
25503@item h
25504Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25505@end table
25506
25507The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25508
25509@table @code
25510@item +
25511Breakpoint is enabled.
25512
25513@item -
25514Breakpoint is disabled.
25515@end table
25516
25517The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25518thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25519changes.
25520
25521These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25522window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25523layouts:
25524
25525@itemize @bullet
25526@item
25527source only,
25528
25529@item
25530assembly only,
25531
25532@item
25533source and assembly,
25534
25535@item
25536source and registers, or
25537
25538@item
25539assembly and registers.
25540@end itemize
25541
25542A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25543
25544@table @emph
25545@item target
25546Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25547(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25548
25549@item process
25550Gives the current process or thread number.
25551When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25552
25553@item function
25554Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25555The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25556When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25557the string @code{??} is displayed.
25558
25559@item line
25560Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25561When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25562
25563@item pc
25564Indicates the current program counter address.
25565@end table
25566
25567@node TUI Keys
25568@section TUI Key Bindings
25569@cindex TUI key bindings
25570
25571The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25572@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25573(@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25574@end ifset
25575@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25576(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25577@end ifclear
25578The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25579@value{GDBN} standard mode.
25580
25581@table @kbd
25582@kindex C-x C-a
25583@item C-x C-a
25584@kindex C-x a
25585@itemx C-x a
25586@kindex C-x A
25587@itemx C-x A
25588Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25589the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25590its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25591the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25592The screen is then refreshed.
25593
25594@kindex C-x 1
25595@item C-x 1
25596Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25597either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25598is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25599
25600Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25601
25602@kindex C-x 2
25603@item C-x 2
25604Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25605layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25606When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25607previous layout and the new one.
25608
25609Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25610
25611@kindex C-x o
25612@item C-x o
25613Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25614(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25615gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25616
25617Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25618
25619@kindex C-x s
25620@item C-x s
25621Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25622keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25623@end table
25624
25625The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25626
25627@table @asis
25628@kindex PgUp
25629@item @key{PgUp}
25630Scroll the active window one page up.
25631
25632@kindex PgDn
25633@item @key{PgDn}
25634Scroll the active window one page down.
25635
25636@kindex Up
25637@item @key{Up}
25638Scroll the active window one line up.
25639
25640@kindex Down
25641@item @key{Down}
25642Scroll the active window one line down.
25643
25644@kindex Left
25645@item @key{Left}
25646Scroll the active window one column left.
25647
25648@kindex Right
25649@item @key{Right}
25650Scroll the active window one column right.
25651
25652@kindex C-L
25653@item @kbd{C-L}
25654Refresh the screen.
25655@end table
25656
25657Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25658are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25659window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25660other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25661and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25662
25663@node TUI Single Key Mode
25664@section TUI Single Key Mode
25665@cindex TUI single key mode
25666
25667The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25668frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25669switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25670
25671@table @kbd
25672@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25673@item c
25674continue
25675
25676@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25677@item d
25678down
25679
25680@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25681@item f
25682finish
25683
25684@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25685@item n
25686next
25687
25688@kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25689@item o
25690nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25691
25692@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25693@item q
25694exit the SingleKey mode.
25695
25696@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25697@item r
25698run
25699
25700@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25701@item s
25702step
25703
25704@kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25705@item i
25706stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25707
25708@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25709@item u
25710up
25711
25712@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25713@item v
25714info locals
25715
25716@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25717@item w
25718where
25719@end table
25720
25721Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25722The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25723it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25724with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25725SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25726this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25727
25728
25729@node TUI Commands
25730@section TUI-specific Commands
25731@cindex TUI commands
25732
25733The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25734These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25735the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25736of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25737
25738Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25739terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25740interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25741these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25742possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25743
25744@table @code
25745@item tui enable
25746@kindex tui enable
25747Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25748TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25749otherwise a default layout is used.
25750
25751@item tui disable
25752@kindex tui disable
25753Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25754
25755@item info win
25756@kindex info win
25757List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25758
25759@item layout @var{name}
25760@kindex layout
25761Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25762window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25763additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25764
25765@table @code
25766@item next
25767Display the next layout.
25768
25769@item prev
25770Display the previous layout.
25771
25772@item src
25773Display the source and command windows.
25774
25775@item asm
25776Display the assembly and command windows.
25777
25778@item split
25779Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25780
25781@item regs
25782When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25783windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25784register, assembler, and command windows.
25785@end table
25786
25787@item focus @var{name}
25788@kindex focus
25789Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25790@var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25791
25792@table @code
25793@item next
25794Make the next window active for scrolling.
25795
25796@item prev
25797Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25798
25799@item src
25800Make the source window active for scrolling.
25801
25802@item asm
25803Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25804
25805@item regs
25806Make the register window active for scrolling.
25807
25808@item cmd
25809Make the command window active for scrolling.
25810@end table
25811
25812@item refresh
25813@kindex refresh
25814Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25815
25816@item tui reg @var{group}
25817@kindex tui reg
25818Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25819@var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25820command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25821register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25822following groups are available on most targets:
25823@table @code
25824@item next
25825Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25826through all of the available register groups.
25827
25828@item prev
25829Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25830through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25831@var{next}.
25832
25833@item general
25834Display the general registers.
25835@item float
25836Display the floating point registers.
25837@item system
25838Display the system registers.
25839@item vector
25840Display the vector registers.
25841@item all
25842Display all registers.
25843@end table
25844
25845@item update
25846@kindex update
25847Update the source window and the current execution point.
25848
25849@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25850@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25851@kindex winheight
25852Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25853lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25854decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25855source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25856disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25857
25858@item tabset @var{nchars}
25859@kindex tabset
25860Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25861setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25862assembly windows.
25863@end table
25864
25865@node TUI Configuration
25866@section TUI Configuration Variables
25867@cindex TUI configuration variables
25868
25869Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25870
25871@table @code
25872@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25873@kindex set tui border-kind
25874Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25875The possible values are the following:
25876@table @code
25877@item space
25878Use a space character to draw the border.
25879
25880@item ascii
25881Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25882
25883@item acs
25884Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25885drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25886@end table
25887
25888@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25889@kindex set tui border-mode
25890@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25891@kindex set tui active-border-mode
25892Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25893or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25894@table @code
25895@item normal
25896Use normal attributes to display the border.
25897
25898@item standout
25899Use standout mode.
25900
25901@item reverse
25902Use reverse video mode.
25903
25904@item half
25905Use half bright mode.
25906
25907@item half-standout
25908Use half bright and standout mode.
25909
25910@item bold
25911Use extra bright or bold mode.
25912
25913@item bold-standout
25914Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25915@end table
25916@end table
25917
25918@node Emacs
25919@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25920
25921@cindex Emacs
25922@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25923A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25924edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25925@value{GDBN}.
25926
25927To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25928executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25929@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25930created Emacs buffer.
25931@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25932
25933Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25934things:
25935
25936@itemize @bullet
25937@item
25938All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25939the GUD buffer.
25940
25941This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25942and output done by the program you are debugging.
25943
25944This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25945commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25946in this way.
25947
25948All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25949with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25950way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25951stop.
25952
25953@item
25954@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25955
25956Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25957source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25958left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25959source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25960and the source.
25961
25962Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25963usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25964@end itemize
25965
25966We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25967a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25968that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25969@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25970
25971If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25972gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25973your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25974sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25975with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25976program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25977some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25978@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25979buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25980
25981The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25982line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25983that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25984,Commands to Specify Files}.
25985
25986By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25987need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25988keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25989customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25990one you want.
25991
25992In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25993addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25994
25995@table @kbd
25996@item C-h m
25997Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25998
25999@item C-c C-s
26000Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26001update the display window to show the current file and location.
26002
26003@item C-c C-n
26004Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26005calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26006to show the current file and location.
26007
26008@item C-c C-i
26009Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26010display window accordingly.
26011
26012@item C-c C-f
26013Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26014@code{finish} command.
26015
26016@item C-c C-r
26017Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26018command.
26019
26020@item C-c <
26021Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26022(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26023like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26024
26025@item C-c >
26026Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26027@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26028@end table
26029
26030In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26031tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26032
26033In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26034separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26035Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26036become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26037source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26038selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26039speedbar displays watch expressions.
26040
26041If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26042it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26043request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26044the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26045frame.
26046
26047The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26048which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26049the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26050communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26051delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26052to correspond properly with the code.
26053
26054A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26055given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26056Emacs Manual}).
26057
26058@node GDB/MI
26059@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26060
26061@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26062
26063@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26064@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26065@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26066@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26067is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26068use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26069
26070This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26071in the form of a reference manual.
26072
26073Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26074features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26075(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26076
26077@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26078
26079@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26080This chapter uses the following notation:
26081
26082@itemize @bullet
26083@item
26084@code{|} separates two alternatives.
26085
26086@item
26087@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26088it may or may not be given.
26089
26090@item
26091@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26092may repeat zero or more times.
26093
26094@item
26095@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26096may repeat one or more times.
26097
26098@item
26099@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26100@end itemize
26101
26102@ignore
26103@heading Dependencies
26104@end ignore
26105
26106@menu
26107* GDB/MI General Design::
26108* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26109* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26110* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26111* GDB/MI Output Records::
26112* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26113* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26114* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26115* GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26116* GDB/MI Program Context::
26117* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26118* GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26119* GDB/MI Program Execution::
26120* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26121* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26122* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26123* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26124* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26125* GDB/MI File Commands::
26126@ignore
26127* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26128* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26129* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26130@end ignore
26131* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26132* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26133* GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26134* GDB/MI Support Commands::
26135* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26136@end menu
26137
26138@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26139@node GDB/MI General Design
26140@section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26141@cindex GDB/MI General Design
26142
26143Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26144parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26145and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26146indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26147For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26148requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26149response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26150Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26151target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26152a command and reported as part of that command response.
26153
26154The important examples of notifications are:
26155@itemize @bullet
26156
26157@item
26158Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26159target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26160be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26161commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26162different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26163happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26164command itself was successfully executed.
26165
26166@item
26167Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26168notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26169diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26170report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26171this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26172until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26173
26174@item
26175General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26176the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26177a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26178be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26179orthogonal frontend design.
26180
26181@end itemize
26182
26183There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26184@value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26185the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26186processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26187we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26188the user interface.
26189
26190
26191@menu
26192* Context management::
26193* Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26194* Thread groups::
26195@end menu
26196
26197@node Context management
26198@subsection Context management
26199
26200@subsubsection Threads and Frames
26201
26202In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26203done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26204Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26205be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26206and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26207because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26208explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26209@value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26210to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26211
26212In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26213useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26214itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26215each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26216want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26217increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26218frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26219should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26220make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26221@samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26222identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26223
26224Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26225a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26226operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26227current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26228breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26229hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26230@samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26231frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26232communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26233@samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26234
26235Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26236frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26237right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26238simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26239before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26240to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26241if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26242thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26243optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26244sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26245selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26246change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26247problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26248all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26249right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26250@samp{--frame} options.
26251
26252@subsubsection Language
26253
26254The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26255By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26256But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26257to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26258which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26259For instance:
26260
26261@smallexample
26262-data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26263^done,value="4"
26264(gdb)
26265@end smallexample
26266
26267The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26268@samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26269@samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26270
26271@node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26272@subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26273
26274On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26275even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26276command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26277specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26278@code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26279either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26280frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26281find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26282@code{-list-target-features} command.
26283
26284@table @code
26285@item -gdb-set mi-async on
26286@item -gdb-set mi-async off
26287Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26288
26289When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26290@code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26291for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26292
26293When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26294commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26295@code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26296MI commands even while the target is running.
26297
26298@item -gdb-show mi-async
26299Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26300@end table
26301
26302Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26303@code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26304of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26305commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26306``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26307kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26308
26309Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26310many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26311running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26312when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26313it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26314are running.
26315
26316When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26317target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26318some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26319stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26320modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26321that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26322@code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26323context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26324stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26325@samp{--thread} option).
26326
26327Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26328highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26329@code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26330to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26331
26332@node Thread groups
26333@subsection Thread groups
26334@value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26335On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26336hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26337processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26338mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26339
26340The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26341target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26342accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26343thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26344neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26345current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26346that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26347into processes.
26348
26349To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26350hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26351@dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26352thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26353and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26354command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26355thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26356debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26357to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26358the members of specific thread group.
26359
26360To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26361wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26362introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26363@value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26364@code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26365groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26366In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26367after attaching to that thread group.
26368
26369Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26370Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26371type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26372such thread groups.
26373
26374@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26375@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26376@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26377
26378@menu
26379* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26380* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26381@end menu
26382
26383@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26384@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26385
26386@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26387@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26388@table @code
26389@item @var{command} @expansion{}
26390@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26391
26392@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26393@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26394@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26395
26396@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26397@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26398@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26399
26400@item @var{token} @expansion{}
26401"any sequence of digits"
26402
26403@item @var{option} @expansion{}
26404@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26405
26406@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26407@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26408
26409@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26410@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26411
26412@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26413@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26414"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26415
26416@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26417@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26418
26419@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26420@code{CR | CR-LF}
26421@end table
26422
26423@noindent
26424Notes:
26425
26426@itemize @bullet
26427@item
26428The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26429output is described below.
26430
26431@item
26432The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26433finishes.
26434
26435@item
26436Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26437list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26438followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26439parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26440@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26441@end itemize
26442
26443Pragmatics:
26444
26445@itemize @bullet
26446@item
26447We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26448
26449@item
26450We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26451@end itemize
26452
26453@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26454@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26455
26456@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26457@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26458The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26459followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26460is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26461terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26462
26463If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26464corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26465@var{token}.
26466
26467@table @code
26468@item @var{output} @expansion{}
26469@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26470
26471@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26472@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26473
26474@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26475@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26476
26477@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26478@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26479
26480@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26481@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26482
26483@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26484@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26485
26486@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26487@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26488
26489@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26490@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26491
26492@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26493@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26494
26495@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26496@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26497depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26498
26499@item @var{result} @expansion{}
26500@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26501
26502@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26503@code{ @var{string} }
26504
26505@item @var{value} @expansion{}
26506@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26507
26508@item @var{const} @expansion{}
26509@code{@var{c-string}}
26510
26511@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26512@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26513
26514@item @var{list} @expansion{}
26515@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26516@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26517
26518@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26519@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26520
26521@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26522@code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26523
26524@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26525@code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26526
26527@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26528@code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26529
26530@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26531@code{CR | CR-LF}
26532
26533@item @var{token} @expansion{}
26534@emph{any sequence of digits}.
26535@end table
26536
26537@noindent
26538Notes:
26539
26540@itemize @bullet
26541@item
26542All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26543
26544@item
26545The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26546for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26547may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26548output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26549all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26550target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26551prior command.
26552
26553@item
26554@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26555@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26556progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26557prefixed by @samp{+}.
26558
26559@item
26560@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26561@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26562(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26563@samp{*}.
26564
26565@item
26566@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26567@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26568client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26569output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26570
26571@item
26572@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26573@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26574console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26575output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26576
26577@item
26578@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26579@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26580All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26581
26582@item
26583@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26584@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26585instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26586the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26587
26588@item
26589@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26590New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26591@var{values}.
26592
26593
26594@end itemize
26595
26596@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26597details about the various output records.
26598
26599@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26600@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26601@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26602
26603@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26604@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26605
26606For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26607but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26608that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26609command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26610@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26611@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26612
26613This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26614recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26615(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26616
26617@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26618@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26619@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26620@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26621
26622The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26623program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26624
26625Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26626by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26627to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26628section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26629might change.
26630
26631Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26632for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26633list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26634parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26635
26636@itemize @bullet
26637@item
26638New MI commands may be added.
26639
26640@item
26641New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26642
26643@item
26644The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26645@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26646
26647@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26648@c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26649
26650@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26651@c resolve inconsistencies.
26652@end itemize
26653
26654If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26655will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26656output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26657@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26658responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26659
26660@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26661@c version?
26662
26663The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26664end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26665follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26666@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26667@cindex mailing lists
26668
26669@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26670@node GDB/MI Output Records
26671@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26672
26673@menu
26674* GDB/MI Result Records::
26675* GDB/MI Stream Records::
26676* GDB/MI Async Records::
26677* GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26678* GDB/MI Frame Information::
26679* GDB/MI Thread Information::
26680* GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26681@end menu
26682
26683@node GDB/MI Result Records
26684@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26685
26686@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26687@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26688In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26689@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26690
26691@table @code
26692@findex ^done
26693@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26694The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26695values.
26696
26697@item "^running"
26698@findex ^running
26699This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26700was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26701target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26702all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26703identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26704which threads are resumed.
26705
26706@item "^connected"
26707@findex ^connected
26708@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26709
26710@item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26711@findex ^error
26712The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26713the corresponding error message.
26714
26715If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26716code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26717error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26718
26719@table @samp
26720@item "undefined-command"
26721Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26722@end table
26723
26724@item "^exit"
26725@findex ^exit
26726@value{GDBN} has terminated.
26727
26728@end table
26729
26730@node GDB/MI Stream Records
26731@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26732
26733@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26734@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26735@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26736target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26737funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26738
26739Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26740identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26741Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26742@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26743line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26744
26745@table @code
26746@item "~" @var{string-output}
26747The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26748CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26749
26750@item "@@" @var{string-output}
26751The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26752target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26753asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26754
26755@item "&" @var{string-output}
26756The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26757internals.
26758@end table
26759
26760@node GDB/MI Async Records
26761@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26762
26763@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26764@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26765@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26766additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26767consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26768target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26769
26770The following is the list of possible async records:
26771
26772@table @code
26773
26774@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26775The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26776thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26777@samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26778that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26779notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26780notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26781emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26782because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26783thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26784it run freely.
26785
26786@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26787The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26788following values:
26789
26790@table @code
26791@item breakpoint-hit
26792A breakpoint was reached.
26793@item watchpoint-trigger
26794A watchpoint was triggered.
26795@item read-watchpoint-trigger
26796A read watchpoint was triggered.
26797@item access-watchpoint-trigger
26798An access watchpoint was triggered.
26799@item function-finished
26800An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26801@item location-reached
26802An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26803@item watchpoint-scope
26804A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26805@item end-stepping-range
26806An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26807similar CLI command was accomplished.
26808@item exited-signalled
26809The inferior exited because of a signal.
26810@item exited
26811The inferior exited.
26812@item exited-normally
26813The inferior exited normally.
26814@item signal-received
26815A signal was received by the inferior.
26816@item solib-event
26817The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26818This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26819set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26820in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26821@item fork
26822The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26823(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26824@item vfork
26825The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26826(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26827@item syscall-entry
26828The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26829syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26830@item syscall-return
26831The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26832@code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26833@item exec
26834The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26835(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26836@end table
26837
26838The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26839that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26840Depending on whether all-stop
26841mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26842stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26843If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26844value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26845field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26846always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26847several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26848processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26849if such information is not available.
26850
26851@item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26852@itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26853A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26854contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26855group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26856process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26857cannot be used in any way.
26858
26859@item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26860A thread group became associated with a running program,
26861either because the program was just started or the thread group
26862was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26863@value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26864contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26865
26866@item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26867A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26868either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26869from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26870thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26871only when the inferior exited with some code.
26872
26873@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26874@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26875A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26876contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26877field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26878
26879@item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26880Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26881is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26882@code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26883that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26884changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26885(via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26886will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26887user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26888
26889The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26890stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26891
26892We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26893highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26894that thread.
26895
26896@item =library-loaded,...
26897Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26898notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26899@var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26900opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26901@var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26902library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26903debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26904@var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26905and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26906@var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26907group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26908absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26909thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26910to this library.
26911
26912@item =library-unloaded,...
26913Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26914has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26915the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26916The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26917thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26918absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26919thread groups.
26920
26921@item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26922@itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26923Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26924@var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26925frame is @var{tpnum}.
26926
26927@item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26928Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26929initial value @var{initial}.
26930
26931@item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26932@itemx =tsv-deleted
26933Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26934trace state variables are deleted.
26935
26936@item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26937Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26938the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26939trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26940value of trace state variable is known.
26941
26942@item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26943@itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26944@itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26945Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26946respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26947user.
26948
26949The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26950breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26951@var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26952
26953Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26954command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26955
26956@item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26957@itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26958Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26959inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26960group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26961
26962The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26963method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26964and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26965for existing method and format values.
26966
26967@item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26968Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26969changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26970the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26971For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26972is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26973
26974@item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26975Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26976written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26977thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26978@code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26979executable code.
26980@end table
26981
26982@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26983@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26984
26985When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26986tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26987following fields:
26988
26989@table @code
26990@item number
26991The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26992of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26993@samp{1.2}.
26994
26995@item type
26996The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26997@samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26998
26999@item catch-type
27000If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27001indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27002
27003@item disp
27004This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27005the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27006meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27007
27008@item enabled
27009This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27010value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27011Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27012
27013@item addr
27014The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27015giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27016breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27017multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27018be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27019
27020@item func
27021If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27022If not known, this field is not present.
27023
27024@item filename
27025The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27026If not known, this field is not present.
27027
27028@item fullname
27029The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27030known. If not known, this field is not present.
27031
27032@item line
27033The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27034If not known, this field is not present.
27035
27036@item at
27037If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27038provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27039by a symbol name.
27040
27041@item pending
27042If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27043text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27044
27045@item evaluated-by
27046Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27047@samp{target}.
27048
27049@item thread
27050If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27051thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27052
27053@item task
27054If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27055field will hold the task identifier.
27056
27057@item cond
27058If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27059
27060@item ignore
27061The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27062
27063@item enable
27064The enable count of the breakpoint.
27065
27066@item traceframe-usage
27067FIXME.
27068
27069@item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27070For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27071
27072@item mask
27073For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27074
27075@item pass
27076A tracepoint's pass count.
27077
27078@item original-location
27079The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27080This field is optional.
27081
27082@item times
27083The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27084
27085@item installed
27086This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27087meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27088is not.
27089
27090@item what
27091Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27092
27093@end table
27094
27095For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27096(@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27097
27098@smallexample
27099-> -break-insert main
27100<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27101 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27102 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27103 times="0"@}
27104<- (gdb)
27105@end smallexample
27106
27107@node GDB/MI Frame Information
27108@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27109
27110Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27111frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27112fields:
27113
27114@table @code
27115@item level
27116The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27117zero. This field is always present.
27118
27119@item func
27120The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27121be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27122
27123@item addr
27124The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27125
27126@item file
27127The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27128address. This field may be absent.
27129
27130@item line
27131The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27132may be absent.
27133
27134@item from
27135The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27136corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27137
27138@end table
27139
27140@node GDB/MI Thread Information
27141@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27142
27143Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27144uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27145stated otherwise.
27146
27147@table @code
27148@item id
27149The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27150
27151@item target-id
27152The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27153
27154@item details
27155Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27156It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27157frontend. This field is optional.
27158
27159@item name
27160The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27161@code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27162@value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27163name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27164field is omitted.
27165
27166@item state
27167The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27168depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27169
27170@item frame
27171The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27172if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27173@ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27174
27175@item core
27176The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27177thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27178@end table
27179
27180@node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27181@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27182
27183Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27184stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27185@value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27186the @code{exception-name} field.
27187
27188@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27189@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27190@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27191@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27192
27193This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27194the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27195following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27196the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27197
27198Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27199readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27200
27201@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27202
27203Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27204information of the breakpoint.
27205
27206@smallexample
27207-> -break-insert main
27208<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27209 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27210 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27211 times="0"@}
27212<- (gdb)
27213@end smallexample
27214
27215@subheading Program Execution
27216
27217Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27218reason that execution stopped.
27219
27220@smallexample
27221-> -exec-run
27222<- ^running
27223<- (gdb)
27224<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27225 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27226 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27227 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27228<- (gdb)
27229-> -exec-continue
27230<- ^running
27231<- (gdb)
27232<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27233<- (gdb)
27234@end smallexample
27235
27236@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27237
27238Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27239
27240@smallexample
27241-> (gdb)
27242<- -gdb-exit
27243<- ^exit
27244@end smallexample
27245
27246Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27247take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27248performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27249or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27250@value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27251fails to exit in reasonable time.
27252
27253@subheading A Bad Command
27254
27255Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27256
27257@smallexample
27258-> -rubbish
27259<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27260<- (gdb)
27261@end smallexample
27262
27263
27264@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27265@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27266@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27267
27268The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27269commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27270
27271@subheading Motivation
27272
27273The motivation for this collection of commands.
27274
27275@subheading Introduction
27276
27277A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27278
27279@subheading Commands
27280
27281For each command in the block, the following is described:
27282
27283@subsubheading Synopsis
27284
27285@smallexample
27286 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27287@end smallexample
27288
27289@subsubheading Result
27290
27291@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27292
27293The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27294
27295@subsubheading Example
27296
27297Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27298not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27299
27300
27301@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27302@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27303@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27304
27305@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27306@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27307This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27308breakpoints.
27309
27310@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27311@findex -break-after
27312
27313@subsubheading Synopsis
27314
27315@smallexample
27316 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27317@end smallexample
27318
27319The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27320hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27321the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27322@samp{-break-list} command below.
27323
27324@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27325
27326The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27327
27328@subsubheading Example
27329
27330@smallexample
27331(gdb)
27332-break-insert main
27333^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27334enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27335fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27336times="0"@}
27337(gdb)
27338-break-after 1 3
27339~
27340^done
27341(gdb)
27342-break-list
27343^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27344hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27345@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27346@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27347@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27348@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27349@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27350body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27351addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27352line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27353(gdb)
27354@end smallexample
27355
27356@ignore
27357@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27358@findex -break-catch
27359@end ignore
27360
27361@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27362@findex -break-commands
27363
27364@subsubheading Synopsis
27365
27366@smallexample
27367 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27368@end smallexample
27369
27370Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27371@var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27372are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27373commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27374functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27375some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27376
27377@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27378
27379The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27380
27381@subsubheading Example
27382
27383@smallexample
27384(gdb)
27385-break-insert main
27386^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27387enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27388fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27389times="0"@}
27390(gdb)
27391-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27392^done
27393(gdb)
27394@end smallexample
27395
27396@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27397@findex -break-condition
27398
27399@subsubheading Synopsis
27400
27401@smallexample
27402 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27403@end smallexample
27404
27405Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27406@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27407@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27408command below).
27409
27410@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27411
27412The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27413
27414@subsubheading Example
27415
27416@smallexample
27417(gdb)
27418-break-condition 1 1
27419^done
27420(gdb)
27421-break-list
27422^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27423hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27424@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27425@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27426@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27427@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27428@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27429body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27430addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27431line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27432(gdb)
27433@end smallexample
27434
27435@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27436@findex -break-delete
27437
27438@subsubheading Synopsis
27439
27440@smallexample
27441 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27442@end smallexample
27443
27444Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27445list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27446
27447@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27448
27449The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27450
27451@subsubheading Example
27452
27453@smallexample
27454(gdb)
27455-break-delete 1
27456^done
27457(gdb)
27458-break-list
27459^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27460hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27461@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27462@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27463@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27464@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27465@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27466body=[]@}
27467(gdb)
27468@end smallexample
27469
27470@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27471@findex -break-disable
27472
27473@subsubheading Synopsis
27474
27475@smallexample
27476 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27477@end smallexample
27478
27479Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27480break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27481
27482@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27483
27484The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27485
27486@subsubheading Example
27487
27488@smallexample
27489(gdb)
27490-break-disable 2
27491^done
27492(gdb)
27493-break-list
27494^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27495hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27496@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27497@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27498@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27499@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27500@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27501body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27502addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27503line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27504(gdb)
27505@end smallexample
27506
27507@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27508@findex -break-enable
27509
27510@subsubheading Synopsis
27511
27512@smallexample
27513 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27514@end smallexample
27515
27516Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27517
27518@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27519
27520The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27521
27522@subsubheading Example
27523
27524@smallexample
27525(gdb)
27526-break-enable 2
27527^done
27528(gdb)
27529-break-list
27530^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27531hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27532@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27533@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27534@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27535@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27536@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27537body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27538addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27539line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27540(gdb)
27541@end smallexample
27542
27543@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27544@findex -break-info
27545
27546@subsubheading Synopsis
27547
27548@smallexample
27549 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27550@end smallexample
27551
27552@c REDUNDANT???
27553Get information about a single breakpoint.
27554
27555The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27556Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27557table.
27558
27559@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27560
27561The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27562
27563@subsubheading Example
27564N.A.
27565
27566@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27567@findex -break-insert
27568@anchor{-break-insert}
27569
27570@subsubheading Synopsis
27571
27572@smallexample
27573 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27574 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27575 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27576@end smallexample
27577
27578@noindent
27579If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27580
27581@table @var
27582@item linespec location
27583A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27584
27585@item explicit location
27586An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27587analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27588listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27589
27590@table @samp
27591@item --source @var{filename}
27592The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27593of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27594
27595@item --function @var{function}
27596The name of a function or method.
27597
27598@item --label @var{label}
27599The name of a label.
27600
27601@item --line @var{lineoffset}
27602An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27603@end table
27604
27605@item address location
27606An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27607@end table
27608
27609@noindent
27610The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27611
27612@table @samp
27613@item -t
27614Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27615@item -h
27616Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27617@item -f
27618If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27619refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27620breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27621an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27622cannot be parsed.
27623@item -d
27624Create a disabled breakpoint.
27625@item -a
27626Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27627is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27628@item -c @var{condition}
27629Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27630@item -i @var{ignore-count}
27631Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27632@item -p @var{thread-id}
27633Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27634@var{thread-id}.
27635@end table
27636
27637@subsubheading Result
27638
27639@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27640resulting breakpoint.
27641
27642Note: this format is open to change.
27643@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27644
27645@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27646
27647The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27648@samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27649
27650@subsubheading Example
27651
27652@smallexample
27653(gdb)
27654-break-insert main
27655^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27656fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27657times="0"@}
27658(gdb)
27659-break-insert -t foo
27660^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27661fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27662times="0"@}
27663(gdb)
27664-break-list
27665^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27666hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27667@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27668@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27669@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27670@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27671@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27672body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27673addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27674fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27675times="0"@},
27676bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27677addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27678fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27679times="0"@}]@}
27680(gdb)
27681@c -break-insert -r foo.*
27682@c ~int foo(int, int);
27683@c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27684@c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27685@c times="0"@}
27686@c (gdb)
27687@end smallexample
27688
27689@subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27690@findex -dprintf-insert
27691
27692@subsubheading Synopsis
27693
27694@smallexample
27695 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27696 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27697 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27698 [ @var{argument} ]
27699@end smallexample
27700
27701@noindent
27702If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27703the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27704
27705The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27706
27707@table @samp
27708@item -t
27709Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27710@item -f
27711If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27712refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27713breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27714an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27715cannot be parsed.
27716@item -d
27717Create a disabled breakpoint.
27718@item -c @var{condition}
27719Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27720@item -i @var{ignore-count}
27721Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27722to @var{ignore-count}.
27723@item -p @var{thread-id}
27724Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27725@var{thread-id}.
27726@end table
27727
27728@subsubheading Result
27729
27730@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27731resulting breakpoint.
27732
27733@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27734
27735@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27736
27737The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27738
27739@subsubheading Example
27740
27741@smallexample
27742(gdb)
277434-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
277444^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27745addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27746fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27747times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27748original-location="foo"@}
27749(gdb)
277505-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
277515^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27752addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27753fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27754times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27755original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27756(gdb)
27757@end smallexample
27758
27759@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27760@findex -break-list
27761
27762@subsubheading Synopsis
27763
27764@smallexample
27765 -break-list
27766@end smallexample
27767
27768Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27769
27770@table @samp
27771@item Number
27772number of the breakpoint
27773@item Type
27774type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27775@item Disposition
27776should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27777or @samp{nokeep}
27778@item Enabled
27779is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27780@item Address
27781memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27782@item What
27783logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27784name, line number
27785@item Thread-groups
27786list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27787@item Times
27788number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27789@end table
27790
27791If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27792@code{body} field is an empty list.
27793
27794@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27795
27796The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27797
27798@subsubheading Example
27799
27800@smallexample
27801(gdb)
27802-break-list
27803^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27804hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27805@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27806@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27807@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27808@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27809@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27810body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27811addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27812times="0"@},
27813bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27814addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27815line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27816(gdb)
27817@end smallexample
27818
27819Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27820
27821@smallexample
27822(gdb)
27823-break-list
27824^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27825hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27826@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27827@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27828@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27829@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27830@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27831body=[]@}
27832(gdb)
27833@end smallexample
27834
27835@subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27836@findex -break-passcount
27837
27838@subsubheading Synopsis
27839
27840@smallexample
27841 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27842@end smallexample
27843
27844Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27845@var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27846is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27847command @samp{passcount}.
27848
27849@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27850@findex -break-watch
27851
27852@subsubheading Synopsis
27853
27854@smallexample
27855 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27856@end smallexample
27857
27858Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27859@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27860read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27861option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27862trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27863either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27864i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27865@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27866
27867Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27868breakpoints inserted.
27869
27870@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27871
27872The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27873@samp{rwatch}.
27874
27875@subsubheading Example
27876
27877Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27878
27879@smallexample
27880(gdb)
27881-break-watch x
27882^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27883(gdb)
27884-exec-continue
27885^running
27886(gdb)
27887*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27888value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27889frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27890fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27891(gdb)
27892@end smallexample
27893
27894Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27895the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27896for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27897
27898@smallexample
27899(gdb)
27900-break-watch C
27901^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27902(gdb)
27903-exec-continue
27904^running
27905(gdb)
27906*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27907wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27908frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27909file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27910fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27911(gdb)
27912-exec-continue
27913^running
27914(gdb)
27915*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27916frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27917value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27918file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27919fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27920(gdb)
27921@end smallexample
27922
27923Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27924execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27925deleted.
27926
27927@smallexample
27928(gdb)
27929-break-watch C
27930^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27931(gdb)
27932-break-list
27933^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27934hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27935@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27936@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27937@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27938@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27939@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27940body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27941addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27942file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27943fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27944times="1"@},
27945bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27946enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27947(gdb)
27948-exec-continue
27949^running
27950(gdb)
27951*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27952value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27953frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27954file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27955fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27956(gdb)
27957-break-list
27958^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27959hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27960@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27961@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27962@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27963@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27964@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27965body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27966addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27967file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27968fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27969times="1"@},
27970bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27971enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27972(gdb)
27973-exec-continue
27974^running
27975^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27976frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27977value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27978file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27979fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27980(gdb)
27981-break-list
27982^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27983hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27984@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27985@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27986@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27987@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27988@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27989body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27990addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27991file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27992fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27993thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27994(gdb)
27995@end smallexample
27996
27997
27998@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27999@node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28000@section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28001
28002This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28003catchpoints.
28004
28005@menu
28006* Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28007* Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28008@end menu
28009
28010@node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28011@subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28012
28013@subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28014@findex -catch-load
28015
28016@subsubheading Synopsis
28017
28018@smallexample
28019 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28020@end smallexample
28021
28022Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28023the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28024Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28025in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28026expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28027
28028
28029@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28030
28031The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28032
28033@subsubheading Example
28034
28035@smallexample
28036-catch-load -t foo.so
28037^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28038what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28039(gdb)
28040@end smallexample
28041
28042
28043@subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28044@findex -catch-unload
28045
28046@subsubheading Synopsis
28047
28048@smallexample
28049 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28050@end smallexample
28051
28052Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28053used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28054Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28055created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28056expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28057
28058@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28059
28060The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28061
28062@subsubheading Example
28063
28064@smallexample
28065-catch-unload -d bar.so
28066^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28067what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28068(gdb)
28069@end smallexample
28070
28071@node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28072@subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28073
28074The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28075that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28076
28077@subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28078@findex -catch-assert
28079
28080@subsubheading Synopsis
28081
28082@smallexample
28083 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28084@end smallexample
28085
28086Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28087
28088The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28089
28090@table @samp
28091@item -c @var{condition}
28092Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28093@item -d
28094Create a disabled catchpoint.
28095@item -t
28096Create a temporary catchpoint.
28097@end table
28098
28099@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28100
28101The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28102
28103@subsubheading Example
28104
28105@smallexample
28106-catch-assert
28107^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28108enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28109thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28110original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28111(gdb)
28112@end smallexample
28113
28114@subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28115@findex -catch-exception
28116
28117@subsubheading Synopsis
28118
28119@smallexample
28120 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28121 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28122@end smallexample
28123
28124Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28125By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28126gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28127optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28128catchpoints.
28129
28130The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28131
28132@table @samp
28133@item -c @var{condition}
28134Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28135@item -d
28136Create a disabled catchpoint.
28137@item -e @var{exception-name}
28138Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28139be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28140@item -t
28141Create a temporary catchpoint.
28142@item -u
28143Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28144cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28145@end table
28146
28147@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28148
28149The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28150and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28151
28152@subsubheading Example
28153
28154@smallexample
28155-catch-exception -e Program_Error
28156^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28157enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28158what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28159times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28160(gdb)
28161@end smallexample
28162
28163@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28164@node GDB/MI Program Context
28165@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28166
28167@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28168@findex -exec-arguments
28169
28170
28171@subsubheading Synopsis
28172
28173@smallexample
28174 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28175@end smallexample
28176
28177Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28178@samp{-exec-run}.
28179
28180@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28181
28182The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28183
28184@subsubheading Example
28185
28186@smallexample
28187(gdb)
28188-exec-arguments -v word
28189^done
28190(gdb)
28191@end smallexample
28192
28193
28194@ignore
28195@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28196@findex -exec-show-arguments
28197
28198@subsubheading Synopsis
28199
28200@smallexample
28201 -exec-show-arguments
28202@end smallexample
28203
28204Print the arguments of the program.
28205
28206@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28207
28208The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28209
28210@subsubheading Example
28211N.A.
28212@end ignore
28213
28214
28215@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28216@findex -environment-cd
28217
28218@subsubheading Synopsis
28219
28220@smallexample
28221 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28222@end smallexample
28223
28224Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28225
28226@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28227
28228The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28229
28230@subsubheading Example
28231
28232@smallexample
28233(gdb)
28234-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28235^done
28236(gdb)
28237@end smallexample
28238
28239
28240@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28241@findex -environment-directory
28242
28243@subsubheading Synopsis
28244
28245@smallexample
28246 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28247@end smallexample
28248
28249Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28250If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28251search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28252@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28253occurs as normal.
28254Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28255multiple directories in a single command
28256results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28257search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28258If blanks are needed as
28259part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28260the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28261by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28262character must not be used
28263in any directory name.
28264If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28265
28266@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28267
28268The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28269
28270@subsubheading Example
28271
28272@smallexample
28273(gdb)
28274-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28275^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28276(gdb)
28277-environment-directory ""
28278^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28279(gdb)
28280-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28281^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28282(gdb)
28283-environment-directory -r
28284^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28285(gdb)
28286@end smallexample
28287
28288
28289@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28290@findex -environment-path
28291
28292@subsubheading Synopsis
28293
28294@smallexample
28295 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28296@end smallexample
28297
28298Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28299If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28300search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28301supplied in addition to the
28302@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28303occurs as normal.
28304Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28305multiple directories in a single command
28306results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28307search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28308If blanks are needed as
28309part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28310the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28311by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28312character must not be used
28313in any directory name.
28314If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28315
28316
28317@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28318
28319The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28320
28321@subsubheading Example
28322
28323@smallexample
28324(gdb)
28325-environment-path
28326^done,path="/usr/bin"
28327(gdb)
28328-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28329^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28330(gdb)
28331-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28332^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28333(gdb)
28334@end smallexample
28335
28336
28337@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28338@findex -environment-pwd
28339
28340@subsubheading Synopsis
28341
28342@smallexample
28343 -environment-pwd
28344@end smallexample
28345
28346Show the current working directory.
28347
28348@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28349
28350The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28351
28352@subsubheading Example
28353
28354@smallexample
28355(gdb)
28356-environment-pwd
28357^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28358(gdb)
28359@end smallexample
28360
28361@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28362@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28363@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28364
28365
28366@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28367@findex -thread-info
28368
28369@subsubheading Synopsis
28370
28371@smallexample
28372 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28373@end smallexample
28374
28375Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28376@var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28377@var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28378information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28379current thread.
28380
28381@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28382
28383The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28384about all threads.
28385
28386@subsubheading Result
28387
28388The result contains the following attributes:
28389
28390@table @samp
28391@item threads
28392A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28393@ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28394
28395@item current-thread-id
28396The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28397is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28398and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28399the command.
28400
28401@end table
28402
28403@subsubheading Example
28404
28405@smallexample
28406-thread-info
28407^done,threads=[
28408@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28409 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28410 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28411@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28412 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28413 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28414 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28415 state="running"@}],
28416current-thread-id="1"
28417(gdb)
28418@end smallexample
28419
28420@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28421@findex -thread-list-ids
28422
28423@subsubheading Synopsis
28424
28425@smallexample
28426 -thread-list-ids
28427@end smallexample
28428
28429Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28430At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28431threads.
28432
28433This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28434@code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28435
28436@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28437
28438Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28439
28440@subsubheading Example
28441
28442@smallexample
28443(gdb)
28444-thread-list-ids
28445^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28446current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28447(gdb)
28448@end smallexample
28449
28450
28451@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28452@findex -thread-select
28453
28454@subsubheading Synopsis
28455
28456@smallexample
28457 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28458@end smallexample
28459
28460Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28461thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28462topmost frame for that thread.
28463
28464This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28465@samp{--thread} option to each command.
28466
28467@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28468
28469The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28470
28471@subsubheading Example
28472
28473@smallexample
28474(gdb)
28475-exec-next
28476^running
28477(gdb)
28478*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28479file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28480(gdb)
28481-thread-list-ids
28482^done,
28483thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28484number-of-threads="3"
28485(gdb)
28486-thread-select 3
28487^done,new-thread-id="3",
28488frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28489args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28490@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28491(gdb)
28492@end smallexample
28493
28494@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28495@node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28496@section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28497
28498@subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28499@findex -ada-task-info
28500
28501@subsubheading Synopsis
28502
28503@smallexample
28504 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28505@end smallexample
28506
28507Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28508@var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28509
28510@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28511
28512The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28513about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28514
28515@subsubheading Result
28516
28517The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28518defined for each Ada task:
28519
28520@table @samp
28521@item current
28522This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28523
28524@item id
28525The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28526
28527@item task-id
28528The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28529
28530@item thread-id
28531The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28532task.
28533
28534This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28535on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28536thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28537
28538@item parent-id
28539This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28540In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28541
28542@item priority
28543The base priority of the task.
28544
28545@item state
28546The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28547possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28548
28549@item name
28550The name of the task.
28551
28552@end table
28553
28554@subsubheading Example
28555
28556@smallexample
28557-ada-task-info
28558^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28559hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28560@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28561@{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28562@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28563@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28564@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28565@{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28566@{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28567body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28568state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28569(gdb)
28570@end smallexample
28571
28572@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28573@node GDB/MI Program Execution
28574@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28575
28576These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28577record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28578asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28579other cases.
28580
28581@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28582@findex -exec-continue
28583
28584@subsubheading Synopsis
28585
28586@smallexample
28587 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28588@end smallexample
28589
28590Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28591to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28592@samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28593it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28594@itemize @bullet
28595@item
28596breakpoints or watchpoints
28597@item
28598signals or exceptions
28599@item
28600the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28601@item
28602the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28603@end itemize
28604In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28605Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28606value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28607specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28608ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28609specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28610
28611@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28612
28613The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28614
28615@subsubheading Example
28616
28617@smallexample
28618-exec-continue
28619^running
28620(gdb)
28621@@Hello world
28622*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28623func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28624line="13"@}
28625(gdb)
28626@end smallexample
28627
28628
28629@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28630@findex -exec-finish
28631
28632@subsubheading Synopsis
28633
28634@smallexample
28635 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28636@end smallexample
28637
28638Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28639function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28640If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28641execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28642function was called.
28643
28644@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28645
28646The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28647
28648@subsubheading Example
28649
28650Function returning @code{void}.
28651
28652@smallexample
28653-exec-finish
28654^running
28655(gdb)
28656@@hello from foo
28657*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28658file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28659(gdb)
28660@end smallexample
28661
28662Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28663@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28664value itself.
28665
28666@smallexample
28667-exec-finish
28668^running
28669(gdb)
28670*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28671args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28672file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28673gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28674(gdb)
28675@end smallexample
28676
28677
28678@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28679@findex -exec-interrupt
28680
28681@subsubheading Synopsis
28682
28683@smallexample
28684 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28685@end smallexample
28686
28687Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28688associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28689that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28690appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28691interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28692
28693Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28694asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28695@samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28696reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28697
28698In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28699All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28700@samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28701option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28702
28703@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28704
28705The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28706
28707@subsubheading Example
28708
28709@smallexample
28710(gdb)
28711111-exec-continue
28712111^running
28713
28714(gdb)
28715222-exec-interrupt
28716222^done
28717(gdb)
28718111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28719frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28720fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28721(gdb)
28722
28723(gdb)
28724-exec-interrupt
28725^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28726(gdb)
28727@end smallexample
28728
28729@subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28730@findex -exec-jump
28731
28732@subsubheading Synopsis
28733
28734@smallexample
28735 -exec-jump @var{location}
28736@end smallexample
28737
28738Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28739parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28740different forms of @var{location}.
28741
28742@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28743
28744The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28745
28746@subsubheading Example
28747
28748@smallexample
28749-exec-jump foo.c:10
28750*running,thread-id="all"
28751^running
28752@end smallexample
28753
28754
28755@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28756@findex -exec-next
28757
28758@subsubheading Synopsis
28759
28760@smallexample
28761 -exec-next [--reverse]
28762@end smallexample
28763
28764Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28765of the next source line is reached.
28766
28767If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28768of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28769source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28770function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28771source line where the function was called.
28772
28773
28774@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28775
28776The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28777
28778@subsubheading Example
28779
28780@smallexample
28781-exec-next
28782^running
28783(gdb)
28784*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28785(gdb)
28786@end smallexample
28787
28788
28789@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28790@findex -exec-next-instruction
28791
28792@subsubheading Synopsis
28793
28794@smallexample
28795 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28796@end smallexample
28797
28798Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28799call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28800instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28801printed as well.
28802
28803If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28804of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28805previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28806it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28807(from the current stack frame) is reached.
28808
28809@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28810
28811The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28812
28813@subsubheading Example
28814
28815@smallexample
28816(gdb)
28817-exec-next-instruction
28818^running
28819
28820(gdb)
28821*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28822addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28823(gdb)
28824@end smallexample
28825
28826
28827@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28828@findex -exec-return
28829
28830@subsubheading Synopsis
28831
28832@smallexample
28833 -exec-return
28834@end smallexample
28835
28836Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28837Displays the new current frame.
28838
28839@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28840
28841The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28842
28843@subsubheading Example
28844
28845@smallexample
28846(gdb)
28847200-break-insert callee4
28848200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28849file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28850(gdb)
28851000-exec-run
28852000^running
28853(gdb)
28854000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28855frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28856file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28857fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28858(gdb)
28859205-break-delete
28860205^done
28861(gdb)
28862111-exec-return
28863111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28864args=[@{name="strarg",
28865value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28866file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28867fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28868(gdb)
28869@end smallexample
28870
28871
28872@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28873@findex -exec-run
28874
28875@subsubheading Synopsis
28876
28877@smallexample
28878 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28879@end smallexample
28880
28881Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28882executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28883exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28884the program has exited exceptionally.
28885
28886When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28887is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28888@samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28889group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28890If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28891
28892Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28893the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28894following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28895(@pxref{Starting}).
28896
28897@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28898
28899The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28900
28901@subsubheading Examples
28902
28903@smallexample
28904(gdb)
28905-break-insert main
28906^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28907(gdb)
28908-exec-run
28909^running
28910(gdb)
28911*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28912frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28913fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28914(gdb)
28915@end smallexample
28916
28917@noindent
28918Program exited normally:
28919
28920@smallexample
28921(gdb)
28922-exec-run
28923^running
28924(gdb)
28925x = 55
28926*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28927(gdb)
28928@end smallexample
28929
28930@noindent
28931Program exited exceptionally:
28932
28933@smallexample
28934(gdb)
28935-exec-run
28936^running
28937(gdb)
28938x = 55
28939*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28940(gdb)
28941@end smallexample
28942
28943Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28944@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28945
28946@smallexample
28947(gdb)
28948*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28949signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28950@end smallexample
28951
28952
28953@c @subheading -exec-signal
28954
28955
28956@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28957@findex -exec-step
28958
28959@subsubheading Synopsis
28960
28961@smallexample
28962 -exec-step [--reverse]
28963@end smallexample
28964
28965Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28966of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28967function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28968function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28969execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28970previously executed source line.
28971
28972@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28973
28974The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28975
28976@subsubheading Example
28977
28978Stepping into a function:
28979
28980@smallexample
28981-exec-step
28982^running
28983(gdb)
28984*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28985frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28986@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28987fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28988(gdb)
28989@end smallexample
28990
28991Regular stepping:
28992
28993@smallexample
28994-exec-step
28995^running
28996(gdb)
28997*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28998(gdb)
28999@end smallexample
29000
29001
29002@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29003@findex -exec-step-instruction
29004
29005@subsubheading Synopsis
29006
29007@smallexample
29008 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29009@end smallexample
29010
29011Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29012@samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29013inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29014The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29015whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29016former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29017as well.
29018
29019@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29020
29021The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29022
29023@subsubheading Example
29024
29025@smallexample
29026(gdb)
29027-exec-step-instruction
29028^running
29029
29030(gdb)
29031*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29032frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29033fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29034(gdb)
29035-exec-step-instruction
29036^running
29037
29038(gdb)
29039*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29040frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29041fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29042(gdb)
29043@end smallexample
29044
29045
29046@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29047@findex -exec-until
29048
29049@subsubheading Synopsis
29050
29051@smallexample
29052 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29053@end smallexample
29054
29055Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29056argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29057until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29058reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29059
29060@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29061
29062The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29063
29064@subsubheading Example
29065
29066@smallexample
29067(gdb)
29068-exec-until recursive2.c:6
29069^running
29070(gdb)
29071x = 55
29072*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29073file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29074(gdb)
29075@end smallexample
29076
29077@ignore
29078@subheading -file-clear
29079Is this going away????
29080@end ignore
29081
29082@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29083@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29084@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29085
29086@subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29087@findex -enable-frame-filters
29088
29089@smallexample
29090-enable-frame-filters
29091@end smallexample
29092
29093@value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29094the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29095implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29096request that this functionality be enabled.
29097
29098Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29099
29100Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29101this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29102
29103@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29104@findex -stack-info-frame
29105
29106@subsubheading Synopsis
29107
29108@smallexample
29109 -stack-info-frame
29110@end smallexample
29111
29112Get info on the selected frame.
29113
29114@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29115
29116The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29117(without arguments).
29118
29119@subsubheading Example
29120
29121@smallexample
29122(gdb)
29123-stack-info-frame
29124^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29125file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29126fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29127(gdb)
29128@end smallexample
29129
29130@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29131@findex -stack-info-depth
29132
29133@subsubheading Synopsis
29134
29135@smallexample
29136 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29137@end smallexample
29138
29139Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29140is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29141
29142@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29143
29144There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29145
29146@subsubheading Example
29147
29148For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29149
29150@smallexample
29151(gdb)
29152-stack-info-depth
29153^done,depth="12"
29154(gdb)
29155-stack-info-depth 4
29156^done,depth="4"
29157(gdb)
29158-stack-info-depth 12
29159^done,depth="12"
29160(gdb)
29161-stack-info-depth 11
29162^done,depth="11"
29163(gdb)
29164-stack-info-depth 13
29165^done,depth="12"
29166(gdb)
29167@end smallexample
29168
29169@anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29170@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29171@findex -stack-list-arguments
29172
29173@subsubheading Synopsis
29174
29175@smallexample
29176 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29177 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29178@end smallexample
29179
29180Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29181and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29182@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29183call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29184at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29185larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29186@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29187which case only existing frames will be returned.
29188
29189If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29190the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29191values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29192type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29193structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29194supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29195
29196If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29197are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29198are still displayed, however.
29199
29200Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29201deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29202
29203@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29204
29205@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29206@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29207functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29208
29209@subsubheading Example
29210
29211@smallexample
29212(gdb)
29213-stack-list-frames
29214^done,
29215stack=[
29216frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29217file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29218fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29219frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29220file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29221fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29222frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29223file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29224fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29225frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29226file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29227fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29228frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29229file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29230fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29231(gdb)
29232-stack-list-arguments 0
29233^done,
29234stack-args=[
29235frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29236frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29237frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29238frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29239frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29240(gdb)
29241-stack-list-arguments 1
29242^done,
29243stack-args=[
29244frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29245frame=@{level="1",
29246 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29247frame=@{level="2",args=[
29248@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29249@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29250@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29251@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29252@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29253@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29254frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29255(gdb)
29256-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29257^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29258(gdb)
29259-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29260^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29261args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29262@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29263(gdb)
29264@end smallexample
29265
29266@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29267
29268
29269@anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29270@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29271@findex -stack-list-frames
29272
29273@subsubheading Synopsis
29274
29275@smallexample
29276 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29277@end smallexample
29278
29279List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29280following info:
29281
29282@table @samp
29283@item @var{level}
29284The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29285@item @var{addr}
29286The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29287@item @var{func}
29288Function name.
29289@item @var{file}
29290File name of the source file where the function lives.
29291@item @var{fullname}
29292The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29293@item @var{line}
29294Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29295@item @var{from}
29296The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29297if the frame's function is not known.
29298@end table
29299
29300If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29301whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29302levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29303are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29304an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29305frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29306actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29307returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29308Python frame filters will not be executed.
29309
29310@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29311
29312The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29313
29314@subsubheading Example
29315
29316Full stack backtrace:
29317
29318@smallexample
29319(gdb)
29320-stack-list-frames
29321^done,stack=
29322[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29323 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29324frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29325 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29326frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29327 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29328frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29329 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29330frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29331 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29332frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29333 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29334frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29335 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29336frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29337 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29338frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29339 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29340frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29341 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29342frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29343 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29344frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29345 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29346(gdb)
29347@end smallexample
29348
29349Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29350
29351@smallexample
29352(gdb)
29353-stack-list-frames 3 5
29354^done,stack=
29355[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29356 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29357frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29358 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29359frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29360 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29361(gdb)
29362@end smallexample
29363
29364Show a single frame:
29365
29366@smallexample
29367(gdb)
29368-stack-list-frames 3 3
29369^done,stack=
29370[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29371 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29372(gdb)
29373@end smallexample
29374
29375
29376@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29377@findex -stack-list-locals
29378@anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29379
29380@subsubheading Synopsis
29381
29382@smallexample
29383 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29384@end smallexample
29385
29386Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29387@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29388the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29389values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29390type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29391structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29392display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29393other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29394more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29395Python frame filters will not be executed.
29396
29397If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29398that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29399variables are still displayed, however.
29400
29401This command is deprecated in favor of the
29402@samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29403
29404@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29405
29406@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29407
29408@subsubheading Example
29409
29410@smallexample
29411(gdb)
29412-stack-list-locals 0
29413^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29414(gdb)
29415-stack-list-locals --all-values
29416^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29417 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29418-stack-list-locals --simple-values
29419^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29420 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29421(gdb)
29422@end smallexample
29423
29424@anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29425@subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29426@findex -stack-list-variables
29427
29428@subsubheading Synopsis
29429
29430@smallexample
29431 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29432@end smallexample
29433
29434Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29435@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29436the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29437values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29438type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29439structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29440supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29441
29442If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29443and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29444available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29445
29446@subsubheading Example
29447
29448@smallexample
29449(gdb)
29450-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29451^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29452(gdb)
29453@end smallexample
29454
29455
29456@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29457@findex -stack-select-frame
29458
29459@subsubheading Synopsis
29460
29461@smallexample
29462 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29463@end smallexample
29464
29465Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29466the stack.
29467
29468This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29469option to every command.
29470
29471@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29472
29473The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29474@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29475
29476@subsubheading Example
29477
29478@smallexample
29479(gdb)
29480-stack-select-frame 2
29481^done
29482(gdb)
29483@end smallexample
29484
29485@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29486@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29487@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29488
29489@ignore
29490
29491@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29492
29493For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29494expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29495used by @code{Insight}.
29496
29497The two main reasons for that are:
29498
29499@enumerate 1
29500@item
29501It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29502
29503@item
29504It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29505now).
29506@end enumerate
29507
29508The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29509slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29510describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29511hints about their use.
29512
29513@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29514expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29515least, the following operations:
29516
29517@itemize @bullet
29518@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29519@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29520@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29521@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29522@end itemize
29523
29524@end ignore
29525
29526@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29527
29528@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29529
29530Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29531changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29532work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29533simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29534is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29535frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29536expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29537expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29538variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29539operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29540object, or to change display format.
29541
29542Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29543that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29544a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29545element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29546children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29547leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29548objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29549is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29550child will be created.
29551
29552For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29553string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29554obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29555that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29556contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29557
29558A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29559the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29560variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29561operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29562be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29563objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29564real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29565variables that frontend has created.
29566
29567The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29568might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29569and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29570relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29571to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29572visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29573called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29574implicitly updated.
29575
29576Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29577fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29578object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29579variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29580variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29581expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29582frame. Consider this example:
29583
29584@smallexample
29585void do_work(...)
29586@{
29587 struct work_state state;
29588
29589 if (...)
29590 do_work(...);
29591@}
29592@end smallexample
29593
29594If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29595this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29596object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29597@code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29598object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29599
29600If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29601refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29602thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29603variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29604thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29605and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29606
29607The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29608access this functionality:
29609
29610@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29611@item @strong{Operation}
29612@tab @strong{Description}
29613
29614@item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29615@tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29616@item @code{-var-create}
29617@tab create a variable object
29618@item @code{-var-delete}
29619@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29620@item @code{-var-set-format}
29621@tab set the display format of this variable
29622@item @code{-var-show-format}
29623@tab show the display format of this variable
29624@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29625@tab tells how many children this object has
29626@item @code{-var-list-children}
29627@tab return a list of the object's children
29628@item @code{-var-info-type}
29629@tab show the type of this variable object
29630@item @code{-var-info-expression}
29631@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29632@item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29633@tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29634@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29635@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29636@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29637@tab get the value of this variable
29638@item @code{-var-assign}
29639@tab set the value of this variable
29640@item @code{-var-update}
29641@tab update the variable and its children
29642@item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29643@tab set frozeness attribute
29644@item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29645@tab set range of children to display on update
29646@end multitable
29647
29648In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29649how it can be used.
29650
29651@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29652
29653@subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29654@findex -enable-pretty-printing
29655
29656@smallexample
29657-enable-pretty-printing
29658@end smallexample
29659
29660@value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29661MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29662implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29663request that this functionality be enabled.
29664
29665Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29666
29667Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29668this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29669
29670This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29671may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29672
29673@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29674@findex -var-create
29675
29676@subsubheading Synopsis
29677
29678@smallexample
29679 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29680 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29681@end smallexample
29682
29683This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29684a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29685register.
29686
29687The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29688referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29689system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29690unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29691The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29692
29693The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29694specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29695frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29696object must be created.
29697
29698@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29699begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29700
29701@itemize @bullet
29702@item
29703@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29704
29705@item
29706@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29707
29708@item
29709@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29710@end itemize
29711
29712@cindex dynamic varobj
29713A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29714case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29715have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29716@code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29717will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29718compatibility for existing clients.
29719
29720@subsubheading Result
29721
29722This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29723are:
29724
29725@table @samp
29726@item name
29727The name of the varobj.
29728
29729@item numchild
29730The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29731reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29732@samp{has_more} attribute.
29733
29734@item value
29735The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29736aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29737will not be interesting.
29738
29739@item type
29740The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29741would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29742(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29743@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29744@emph{declared} one.
29745
29746@item thread-id
29747If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29748thread's global identifier.
29749
29750@item has_more
29751For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29752children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29753
29754@item dynamic
29755This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29756varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29757then this attribute will not be present.
29758
29759@item displayhint
29760A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29761value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29762@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29763@end table
29764
29765Typical output will look like this:
29766
29767@smallexample
29768 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29769 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29770@end smallexample
29771
29772
29773@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29774@findex -var-delete
29775
29776@subsubheading Synopsis
29777
29778@smallexample
29779 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29780@end smallexample
29781
29782Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29783With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29784
29785Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29786
29787
29788@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29789@findex -var-set-format
29790
29791@subsubheading Synopsis
29792
29793@smallexample
29794 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29795@end smallexample
29796
29797Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29798@var{format-spec}.
29799
29800@anchor{-var-set-format}
29801The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29802
29803@smallexample
29804 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29805 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29806@end smallexample
29807
29808The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29809based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29810for pointers, etc.).
29811
29812The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29813but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29814hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29815zero-hexadecimal format.
29816
29817For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29818variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29819
29820@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29821@findex -var-show-format
29822
29823@subsubheading Synopsis
29824
29825@smallexample
29826 -var-show-format @var{name}
29827@end smallexample
29828
29829Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29830
29831@smallexample
29832 @var{format} @expansion{}
29833 @var{format-spec}
29834@end smallexample
29835
29836
29837@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29838@findex -var-info-num-children
29839
29840@subsubheading Synopsis
29841
29842@smallexample
29843 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29844@end smallexample
29845
29846Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29847
29848@smallexample
29849 numchild=@var{n}
29850@end smallexample
29851
29852Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29853It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29854be available.
29855
29856
29857@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29858@findex -var-list-children
29859
29860@subsubheading Synopsis
29861
29862@smallexample
29863 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29864@end smallexample
29865@anchor{-var-list-children}
29866
29867Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29868create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29869a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29870@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29871@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29872values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29873value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29874and unions.
29875
29876@var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29877to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29878reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29879at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29880reported.
29881
29882If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29883@code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29884For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29885intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29886update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29887front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29888then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29889different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29890the visible items.
29891
29892For each child the following results are returned:
29893
29894@table @var
29895
29896@item name
29897Name of the variable object created for this child.
29898
29899@item exp
29900The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29901For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29902
29903For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29904expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29905
29906For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29907designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29908@samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29909type and value are not present.
29910
29911A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29912pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29913available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29914
29915@item numchild
29916Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
299170.
29918
29919@item type
29920The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29921(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29922@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29923@emph{declared} one.
29924
29925@item value
29926If values were requested, this is the value.
29927
29928@item thread-id
29929If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29930thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29931
29932@item frozen
29933If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29934
29935@item displayhint
29936A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29937value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29938@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29939
29940@item dynamic
29941This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29942varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29943then this attribute will not be present.
29944
29945@end table
29946
29947The result may have its own attributes:
29948
29949@table @samp
29950@item displayhint
29951A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29952value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29953@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29954
29955@item has_more
29956This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29957remaining after the end of the selected range.
29958@end table
29959
29960@subsubheading Example
29961
29962@smallexample
29963(gdb)
29964 -var-list-children n
29965 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29966 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29967(gdb)
29968 -var-list-children --all-values n
29969 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29970 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29971@end smallexample
29972
29973
29974@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29975@findex -var-info-type
29976
29977@subsubheading Synopsis
29978
29979@smallexample
29980 -var-info-type @var{name}
29981@end smallexample
29982
29983Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29984returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29985@value{GDBN} CLI:
29986
29987@smallexample
29988 type=@var{typename}
29989@end smallexample
29990
29991
29992@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29993@findex -var-info-expression
29994
29995@subsubheading Synopsis
29996
29997@smallexample
29998 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29999@end smallexample
30000
30001Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30002variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30003not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30004
30005For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30006@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30007
30008@smallexample
30009(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30010^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30011@end smallexample
30012
30013@noindent
30014Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30015found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30016
30017Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30018includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30019is of limited use.
30020
30021@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30022@findex -var-info-path-expression
30023
30024@subsubheading Synopsis
30025
30026@smallexample
30027 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30028@end smallexample
30029
30030Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30031context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30032Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30033result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30034the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30035watchpoint from a variable object.
30036
30037This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30038and will give an error when invoked on one.
30039
30040For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30041@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30042@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30043@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30044@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30045@smallexample
30046(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30047^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30048@end smallexample
30049
30050@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30051@findex -var-show-attributes
30052
30053@subsubheading Synopsis
30054
30055@smallexample
30056 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30057@end smallexample
30058
30059List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30060
30061@smallexample
30062 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30063@end smallexample
30064
30065@noindent
30066where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30067
30068@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30069@findex -var-evaluate-expression
30070
30071@subsubheading Synopsis
30072
30073@smallexample
30074 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30075@end smallexample
30076
30077Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30078object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30079can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30080this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30081(@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30082the current display format will be used. The current display format
30083can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30084
30085@smallexample
30086 value=@var{value}
30087@end smallexample
30088
30089Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30090before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30091
30092@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30093@findex -var-assign
30094
30095@subsubheading Synopsis
30096
30097@smallexample
30098 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30099@end smallexample
30100
30101Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30102by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30103value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30104subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30105
30106@subsubheading Example
30107
30108@smallexample
30109(gdb)
30110-var-assign var1 3
30111^done,value="3"
30112(gdb)
30113-var-update *
30114^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30115(gdb)
30116@end smallexample
30117
30118@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30119@findex -var-update
30120
30121@subsubheading Synopsis
30122
30123@smallexample
30124 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30125@end smallexample
30126
30127Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30128@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30129list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30130be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30131@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30132@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30133object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30134for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30135@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30136names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30137as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30138recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30139number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30140
30141With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30142currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30143diagnostic.
30144
30145If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30146only the selected range of children will be reported.
30147
30148@code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30149@samp{changelist}.
30150
30151Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30152
30153@table @samp
30154@item name
30155The name of the varobj.
30156
30157@item value
30158If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30159present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30160
30161@item in_scope
30162@anchor{-var-update}
30163This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30164
30165@table @code
30166@item "true"
30167The variable object's current value is valid.
30168
30169@item "false"
30170The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30171hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30172scope.
30173
30174@item "invalid"
30175The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30176This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30177either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30178command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30179objects.
30180@end table
30181
30182In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30183be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30184
30185@item type_changed
30186This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30187changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30188be @samp{false}.
30189
30190When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30191become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30192deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30193range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30194unset.
30195
30196@item new_type
30197If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30198hold the new type.
30199
30200@item new_num_children
30201For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30202type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30203
30204The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30205valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30206@value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30207instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30208children which may be available.
30209
30210The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30211number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30212detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30213only happen at the end of the update range).
30214
30215@item displayhint
30216The display hint, if any.
30217
30218@item has_more
30219This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30220available outside the varobj's update range.
30221
30222@item dynamic
30223This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30224varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30225then this attribute will not be present.
30226
30227@item new_children
30228If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30229update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30230be listed in this attribute.
30231@end table
30232
30233@subsubheading Example
30234
30235@smallexample
30236(gdb)
30237-var-assign var1 3
30238^done,value="3"
30239(gdb)
30240-var-update --all-values var1
30241^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30242type_changed="false"@}]
30243(gdb)
30244@end smallexample
30245
30246@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30247@findex -var-set-frozen
30248@anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30249
30250@subsubheading Synopsis
30251
30252@smallexample
30253 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30254@end smallexample
30255
30256Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30257@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30258frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30259frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30260implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30261a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30262@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30263values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30264implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30265Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30266@code{-var-update} does.
30267
30268@subsubheading Example
30269
30270@smallexample
30271(gdb)
30272-var-set-frozen V 1
30273^done
30274(gdb)
30275@end smallexample
30276
30277@subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30278@findex -var-set-update-range
30279@anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30280
30281@subsubheading Synopsis
30282
30283@smallexample
30284 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30285@end smallexample
30286
30287Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30288@code{-var-update}.
30289
30290@var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30291@var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30292children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30293(zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30294
30295@subsubheading Example
30296
30297@smallexample
30298(gdb)
30299-var-set-update-range V 1 2
30300^done
30301@end smallexample
30302
30303@subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30304@findex -var-set-visualizer
30305@anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30306
30307@subsubheading Synopsis
30308
30309@smallexample
30310 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30311@end smallexample
30312
30313Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30314
30315@var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30316@samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30317
30318If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30319This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30320single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30321the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30322Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30323When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30324pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30325
30326The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30327select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30328(@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30329a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30330
30331This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30332command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30333can be used to check this.
30334
30335@subsubheading Example
30336
30337Resetting the visualizer:
30338
30339@smallexample
30340(gdb)
30341-var-set-visualizer V None
30342^done
30343@end smallexample
30344
30345Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30346
30347@smallexample
30348(gdb)
30349-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30350^done
30351@end smallexample
30352
30353Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30354can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30355
30356@smallexample
30357(gdb)
30358-var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30359^done
30360@end smallexample
30361
30362@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30363@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30364@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30365
30366@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30367@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30368This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30369examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30370
30371For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30372@pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30373
30374@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30375@c @subheading -data-assign
30376@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30377@c @subsubheading GDB Command
30378@c set variable
30379@c @subsubheading Example
30380@c N.A.
30381
30382@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30383@findex -data-disassemble
30384
30385@subsubheading Synopsis
30386
30387@smallexample
30388 -data-disassemble
30389 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30390 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30391 -- @var{mode}
30392@end smallexample
30393
30394@noindent
30395Where:
30396
30397@table @samp
30398@item @var{start-addr}
30399is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30400@item @var{end-addr}
30401is the end address
30402@item @var{filename}
30403is the name of the file to disassemble
30404@item @var{linenum}
30405is the line number to disassemble around
30406@item @var{lines}
30407is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30408the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30409specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30410@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30411@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30412displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30413@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30414are displayed.
30415@item @var{mode}
30416is one of:
30417@itemize @bullet
30418@item 0 disassembly only
30419@item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30420@item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30421@item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30422@item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30423@item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30424@end itemize
30425
30426Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30427which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30428@xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30429@code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30430@end table
30431
30432@subsubheading Result
30433
30434The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30435@samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30436used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30437
30438For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30439following fields:
30440
30441@table @code
30442@item address
30443The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30444
30445@item func-name
30446The name of the function this instruction is within.
30447
30448@item offset
30449The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30450
30451@item inst
30452The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30453
30454@item opcodes
30455This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30456bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30457
30458@end table
30459
30460For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30461@samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30462
30463@table @code
30464@item line
30465The line number within @samp{file}.
30466
30467@item file
30468The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30469file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30470used.
30471
30472@item fullname
30473Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30474using the source file search path
30475(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30476and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30477
30478If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30479present in the debug information.
30480
30481@item line_asm_insn
30482This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30483@samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30484@code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30485@samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30486@samp{opcodes}.
30487
30488@end table
30489
30490Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30491manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30492adjust its format.
30493
30494@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30495
30496The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30497
30498@subsubheading Example
30499
30500Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30501
30502@smallexample
30503(gdb)
30504-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30505^done,
30506asm_insns=[
30507@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30508inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30509@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30510inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30511@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30512inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30513@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30514inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30515@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30516inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30517(gdb)
30518@end smallexample
30519
30520Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30521@code{main}.
30522
30523@smallexample
30524-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30525^done,asm_insns=[
30526@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30527inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30528@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30529inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30530@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30531inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30532[@dots{}]
30533@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30534@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30535(gdb)
30536@end smallexample
30537
30538Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30539
30540@smallexample
30541(gdb)
30542-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30543^done,asm_insns=[
30544@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30545inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30546@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30547inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30548@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30549inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30550(gdb)
30551@end smallexample
30552
30553Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30554
30555@smallexample
30556(gdb)
30557-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30558^done,asm_insns=[
30559src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30560file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30561fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30562line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30563func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30564src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30565file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30566fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30567line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30568func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30569@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30570inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30571(gdb)
30572@end smallexample
30573
30574
30575@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30576@findex -data-evaluate-expression
30577
30578@subsubheading Synopsis
30579
30580@smallexample
30581 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30582@end smallexample
30583
30584Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30585inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30586If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30587
30588@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30589
30590The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30591@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30592@samp{gdb_eval} command.
30593
30594@subsubheading Example
30595
30596In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30597@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30598Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30599output.
30600
30601@smallexample
30602211-data-evaluate-expression A
30603211^done,value="1"
30604(gdb)
30605311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30606311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30607(gdb)
30608411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30609411^done,value="4"
30610(gdb)
30611511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30612511^done,value="4"
30613(gdb)
30614@end smallexample
30615
30616
30617@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30618@findex -data-list-changed-registers
30619
30620@subsubheading Synopsis
30621
30622@smallexample
30623 -data-list-changed-registers
30624@end smallexample
30625
30626Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30627
30628@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30629
30630@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30631has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30632
30633@subsubheading Example
30634
30635On a PPC MBX board:
30636
30637@smallexample
30638(gdb)
30639-exec-continue
30640^running
30641
30642(gdb)
30643*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30644func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30645line="5"@}
30646(gdb)
30647-data-list-changed-registers
30648^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30649"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30650"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30651(gdb)
30652@end smallexample
30653
30654
30655@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30656@findex -data-list-register-names
30657
30658@subsubheading Synopsis
30659
30660@smallexample
30661 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30662@end smallexample
30663
30664Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30665are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30666integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30667names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30668consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30669include empty register names.
30670
30671@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30672
30673@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30674@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30675corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30676
30677@subsubheading Example
30678
30679For the PPC MBX board:
30680@smallexample
30681(gdb)
30682-data-list-register-names
30683^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30684"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30685"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30686"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30687"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30688"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30689"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30690(gdb)
30691-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30692^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30693(gdb)
30694@end smallexample
30695
30696@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30697@findex -data-list-register-values
30698
30699@subsubheading Synopsis
30700
30701@smallexample
30702 -data-list-register-values
30703 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30704@end smallexample
30705
30706Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30707registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30708by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30709missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30710registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30711indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30712
30713Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30714
30715@table @code
30716@item x
30717Hexadecimal
30718@item o
30719Octal
30720@item t
30721Binary
30722@item d
30723Decimal
30724@item r
30725Raw
30726@item N
30727Natural
30728@end table
30729
30730@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30731
30732The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30733all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30734
30735@subsubheading Example
30736
30737For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30738don't appear in the actual output):
30739
30740@smallexample
30741(gdb)
30742-data-list-register-values r 64 65
30743^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30744@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30745(gdb)
30746-data-list-register-values x
30747^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30748@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30749@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30750@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30751@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30752@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30753@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30754@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30755@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30756@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30757@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30758@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30759@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30760@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30761@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30762@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30763@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30764@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30765@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30766@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30767@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30768@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30769@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30770@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30771@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30772@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30773@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30774@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30775@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30776@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30777@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30778@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30779@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30780@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30781@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30782@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30783(gdb)
30784@end smallexample
30785
30786
30787@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30788@findex -data-read-memory
30789
30790This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30791
30792@subsubheading Synopsis
30793
30794@smallexample
30795 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30796 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30797 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30798@end smallexample
30799
30800@noindent
30801where:
30802
30803@table @samp
30804@item @var{address}
30805An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30806read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30807quoted using the C convention.
30808
30809@item @var{word-format}
30810The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30811same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30812,Output Formats}).
30813
30814@item @var{word-size}
30815The size of each memory word in bytes.
30816
30817@item @var{nr-rows}
30818The number of rows in the output table.
30819
30820@item @var{nr-cols}
30821The number of columns in the output table.
30822
30823@item @var{aschar}
30824If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30825value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30826member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30827characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30828
30829@item @var{byte-offset}
30830An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30831@end table
30832
30833This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30834@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30835@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30836(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30837of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30838using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30839in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30840@samp{addr}.
30841
30842The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30843@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30844@samp{prev-page}.
30845
30846@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30847
30848The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30849@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30850
30851@subsubheading Example
30852
30853Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30854@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30855word. Display each word in hex.
30856
30857@smallexample
30858(gdb)
308599-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
308609^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30861next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30862prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30863@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30864@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30865@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30866(gdb)
30867@end smallexample
30868
30869Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30870display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30871
30872@smallexample
30873(gdb)
308745-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
308755^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30876next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30877next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30878@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30879(gdb)
30880@end smallexample
30881
30882Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30883as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30884used as the non-printable character.
30885
30886@smallexample
30887(gdb)
308884-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
308894^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30890next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30891next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30892@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30893@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30894@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30895@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30896@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30897@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30898@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30899@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30900(gdb)
30901@end smallexample
30902
30903@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30904@findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30905
30906@subsubheading Synopsis
30907
30908@smallexample
30909 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30910 @var{address} @var{count}
30911@end smallexample
30912
30913@noindent
30914where:
30915
30916@table @samp
30917@item @var{address}
30918An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30919to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30920quoted using the C convention.
30921
30922@item @var{count}
30923The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30924literal.
30925
30926@item @var{offset}
30927The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30928should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30929is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30930arithmetics itself.
30931
30932@end table
30933
30934This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30935specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30936map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30937Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30938regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30939@value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30940
30941In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30942and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30943every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30944attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30945of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30946well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30947has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30948@value{GDBN} will not read it.
30949
30950The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30951the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30952list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30953and has the following fields:
30954
30955@table @code
30956@item begin
30957The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30958
30959@item end
30960The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30961
30962@item offset
30963The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30964the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30965
30966@item contents
30967The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30968
30969@end table
30970
30971
30972
30973@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30974
30975The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30976
30977@subsubheading Example
30978
30979@smallexample
30980(gdb)
30981-data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30982^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30983 end="0xbffff15e",
30984 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30985(gdb)
30986@end smallexample
30987
30988
30989@subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30990@findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30991
30992@subsubheading Synopsis
30993
30994@smallexample
30995 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30996 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30997@end smallexample
30998
30999@noindent
31000where:
31001
31002@table @samp
31003@item @var{address}
31004An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31005to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31006be quoted using the C convention.
31007
31008@item @var{contents}
31009The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31010not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31011
31012@item @var{count}
31013Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31014written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31015@value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31016@var{count} memory units.
31017
31018@end table
31019
31020@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31021
31022There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31023
31024@subsubheading Example
31025
31026@smallexample
31027(gdb)
31028-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31029^done
31030(gdb)
31031@end smallexample
31032
31033@smallexample
31034(gdb)
31035-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31036^done
31037(gdb)
31038@end smallexample
31039
31040@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31041@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31042@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31043
31044The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31045tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31046
31047@subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31048@findex -trace-find
31049
31050@subsubheading Synopsis
31051
31052@smallexample
31053 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31054@end smallexample
31055
31056Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31057@var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31058modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31059
31060@table @samp
31061
31062@item none
31063No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31064
31065@item frame-number
31066An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31067that index.
31068
31069@item tracepoint-number
31070An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31071trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31072
31073@item pc
31074An address is required as parameter. Finds
31075next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31076address.
31077
31078@item pc-inside-range
31079Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31080frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31081specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31082
31083@item pc-outside-range
31084Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31085next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31086the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31087
31088@item line
31089Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31090Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31091the specified location.
31092
31093@end table
31094
31095If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31096have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31097
31098@table @samp
31099@item found
31100This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31101on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31102
31103@item traceframe
31104The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31105the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31106
31107@item tracepoint
31108The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31109the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31110
31111@item frame
31112The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31113frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31114@xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31115
31116@end table
31117
31118@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31119
31120The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31121
31122@subheading -trace-define-variable
31123@findex -trace-define-variable
31124
31125@subsubheading Synopsis
31126
31127@smallexample
31128 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31129@end smallexample
31130
31131Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31132@var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31133trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31134with the @samp{$} character.
31135
31136@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31137
31138The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31139
31140@subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31141@findex -trace-frame-collected
31142
31143@subsubheading Synopsis
31144
31145@smallexample
31146 -trace-frame-collected
31147 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31148 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31149 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31150 [--memory-contents]
31151@end smallexample
31152
31153This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31154trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31155that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31156parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31157See the output description table below for more details.
31158
31159The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31160varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31161this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31162which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31163memory range and which is a computed expression.
31164
31165For instance, if the actions were
31166@smallexample
31167collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31168collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31169@end smallexample
31170
31171@noindent
31172the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31173object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31174element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31175objects would be computed expressions.
31176
31177An example output would be:
31178
31179@smallexample
31180(gdb)
31181-trace-frame-collected
31182^done,
31183 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31184 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31185 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31186 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31187 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31188 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31189 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31190 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31191 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31192 ...
31193 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31194 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31195 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31196 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31197(gdb)
31198@end smallexample
31199
31200Where:
31201
31202@table @code
31203@item explicit-variables
31204The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31205opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31206members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31207The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31208field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31209if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31210type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31211arrays, structures and unions.
31212
31213@item computed-expressions
31214The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31215current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31216this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31217@code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31218
31219@item registers
31220The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31221For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31222The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31223option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31224list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31225
31226@item tvars
31227The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31228trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31229current value are returned.
31230
31231@item memory
31232The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31233frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31234collected memory range and has the following fields:
31235
31236@table @code
31237@item address
31238The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31239
31240@item length
31241The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31242
31243@item contents
31244The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31245if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31246
31247@end table
31248
31249@end table
31250
31251@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31252
31253There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31254
31255@subsubheading Example
31256
31257@subheading -trace-list-variables
31258@findex -trace-list-variables
31259
31260@subsubheading Synopsis
31261
31262@smallexample
31263 -trace-list-variables
31264@end smallexample
31265
31266Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31267table has the following fields:
31268
31269@table @samp
31270@item name
31271The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31272
31273@item initial
31274The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31275field is always present.
31276
31277@item current
31278The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31279signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31280not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31281presently running.
31282
31283@end table
31284
31285@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31286
31287The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31288
31289@subsubheading Example
31290
31291@smallexample
31292(gdb)
31293-trace-list-variables
31294^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31295hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31296 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31297 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31298body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31299 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31300(gdb)
31301@end smallexample
31302
31303@subheading -trace-save
31304@findex -trace-save
31305
31306@subsubheading Synopsis
31307
31308@smallexample
31309 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31310@end smallexample
31311
31312Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31313@samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31314in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31315to perform the save.
31316
31317By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31318supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31319@ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31320
31321@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31322
31323The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31324
31325
31326@subheading -trace-start
31327@findex -trace-start
31328
31329@subsubheading Synopsis
31330
31331@smallexample
31332 -trace-start
31333@end smallexample
31334
31335Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31336have any fields.
31337
31338@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31339
31340The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31341
31342@subheading -trace-status
31343@findex -trace-status
31344
31345@subsubheading Synopsis
31346
31347@smallexample
31348 -trace-status
31349@end smallexample
31350
31351Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31352the following fields:
31353
31354@table @samp
31355
31356@item supported
31357May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31358supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31359@samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31360of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31361started. This field is always present.
31362
31363@item running
31364May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31365tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31366if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31367
31368@item stop-reason
31369Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31370may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31371value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31372the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31373the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31374tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31375The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31376tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31377This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31378
31379@item stopping-tracepoint
31380The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31381present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31382@samp{passcount}.
31383
31384@item frames
31385@itemx frames-created
31386The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31387in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31388during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31389circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31390
31391@item buffer-size
31392@itemx buffer-free
31393These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31394remaining space. These fields are optional.
31395
31396@item circular
31397The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31398trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31399necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31400and may fill up.
31401
31402@item disconnected
31403The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31404tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31405that the trace run will stop.
31406
31407@item trace-file
31408The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31409optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31410
31411@end table
31412
31413@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31414
31415The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31416
31417@subheading -trace-stop
31418@findex -trace-stop
31419
31420@subsubheading Synopsis
31421
31422@smallexample
31423 -trace-stop
31424@end smallexample
31425
31426Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31427fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31428@samp{running} fields are not output.
31429
31430@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31431
31432The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31433
31434
31435@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31436@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31437@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31438
31439
31440@ignore
31441@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31442@findex -symbol-info-address
31443
31444@subsubheading Synopsis
31445
31446@smallexample
31447 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31448@end smallexample
31449
31450Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31451
31452@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31453
31454The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31455
31456@subsubheading Example
31457N.A.
31458
31459
31460@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31461@findex -symbol-info-file
31462
31463@subsubheading Synopsis
31464
31465@smallexample
31466 -symbol-info-file
31467@end smallexample
31468
31469Show the file for the symbol.
31470
31471@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31472
31473There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31474@samp{gdb_find_file}.
31475
31476@subsubheading Example
31477N.A.
31478
31479
31480@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31481@findex -symbol-info-function
31482
31483@subsubheading Synopsis
31484
31485@smallexample
31486 -symbol-info-function
31487@end smallexample
31488
31489Show which function the symbol lives in.
31490
31491@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31492
31493@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31494
31495@subsubheading Example
31496N.A.
31497
31498
31499@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31500@findex -symbol-info-line
31501
31502@subsubheading Synopsis
31503
31504@smallexample
31505 -symbol-info-line
31506@end smallexample
31507
31508Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31509
31510@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31511
31512The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31513@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31514
31515@subsubheading Example
31516N.A.
31517
31518
31519@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31520@findex -symbol-info-symbol
31521
31522@subsubheading Synopsis
31523
31524@smallexample
31525 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31526@end smallexample
31527
31528Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31529
31530@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31531
31532The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31533
31534@subsubheading Example
31535N.A.
31536
31537
31538@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31539@findex -symbol-list-functions
31540
31541@subsubheading Synopsis
31542
31543@smallexample
31544 -symbol-list-functions
31545@end smallexample
31546
31547List the functions in the executable.
31548
31549@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31550
31551@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31552@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31553
31554@subsubheading Example
31555N.A.
31556@end ignore
31557
31558
31559@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31560@findex -symbol-list-lines
31561
31562@subsubheading Synopsis
31563
31564@smallexample
31565 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31566@end smallexample
31567
31568Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31569addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31570ascending PC order.
31571
31572@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31573
31574There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31575
31576@subsubheading Example
31577@smallexample
31578(gdb)
31579-symbol-list-lines basics.c
31580^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31581(gdb)
31582@end smallexample
31583
31584
31585@ignore
31586@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31587@findex -symbol-list-types
31588
31589@subsubheading Synopsis
31590
31591@smallexample
31592 -symbol-list-types
31593@end smallexample
31594
31595List all the type names.
31596
31597@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31598
31599The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31600@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31601
31602@subsubheading Example
31603N.A.
31604
31605
31606@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31607@findex -symbol-list-variables
31608
31609@subsubheading Synopsis
31610
31611@smallexample
31612 -symbol-list-variables
31613@end smallexample
31614
31615List all the global and static variable names.
31616
31617@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31618
31619@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31620
31621@subsubheading Example
31622N.A.
31623
31624
31625@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31626@findex -symbol-locate
31627
31628@subsubheading Synopsis
31629
31630@smallexample
31631 -symbol-locate
31632@end smallexample
31633
31634@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31635
31636@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31637
31638@subsubheading Example
31639N.A.
31640
31641
31642@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31643@findex -symbol-type
31644
31645@subsubheading Synopsis
31646
31647@smallexample
31648 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31649@end smallexample
31650
31651Show type of @var{variable}.
31652
31653@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31654
31655The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31656@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31657
31658@subsubheading Example
31659N.A.
31660@end ignore
31661
31662
31663@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31664@node GDB/MI File Commands
31665@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31666
31667This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31668and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31669
31670@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31671@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31672
31673@subsubheading Synopsis
31674
31675@smallexample
31676 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31677@end smallexample
31678
31679Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31680which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31681command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31682are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31683error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31684notification.
31685
31686@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31687
31688The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31689
31690@subsubheading Example
31691
31692@smallexample
31693(gdb)
31694-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31695^done
31696(gdb)
31697@end smallexample
31698
31699
31700@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31701@findex -file-exec-file
31702
31703@subsubheading Synopsis
31704
31705@smallexample
31706 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31707@end smallexample
31708
31709Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31710@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31711from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31712about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31713notification.
31714
31715@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31716
31717The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31718
31719@subsubheading Example
31720
31721@smallexample
31722(gdb)
31723-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31724^done
31725(gdb)
31726@end smallexample
31727
31728
31729@ignore
31730@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31731@findex -file-list-exec-sections
31732
31733@subsubheading Synopsis
31734
31735@smallexample
31736 -file-list-exec-sections
31737@end smallexample
31738
31739List the sections of the current executable file.
31740
31741@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31742
31743The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31744information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31745@samp{gdb_load_info}.
31746
31747@subsubheading Example
31748N.A.
31749@end ignore
31750
31751
31752@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31753@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31754
31755@subsubheading Synopsis
31756
31757@smallexample
31758 -file-list-exec-source-file
31759@end smallexample
31760
31761List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31762to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31763information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31764whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31765
31766@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31767
31768The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31769
31770@subsubheading Example
31771
31772@smallexample
31773(gdb)
31774123-file-list-exec-source-file
31775123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31776(gdb)
31777@end smallexample
31778
31779
31780@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31781@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31782
31783@subsubheading Synopsis
31784
31785@smallexample
31786 -file-list-exec-source-files
31787@end smallexample
31788
31789List the source files for the current executable.
31790
31791It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31792name) of a source file.
31793
31794@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31795
31796The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31797@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31798
31799@subsubheading Example
31800@smallexample
31801(gdb)
31802-file-list-exec-source-files
31803^done,files=[
31804@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31805@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31806@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31807(gdb)
31808@end smallexample
31809
31810@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31811@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31812
31813@subsubheading Synopsis
31814
31815@smallexample
31816 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31817@end smallexample
31818
31819List the shared libraries in the program.
31820With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31821names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31822
31823@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31824
31825The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31826have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31827The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31828library. Each range has the following fields:
31829
31830@table @samp
31831@item from
31832The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31833@item to
31834The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31835@end table
31836
31837@subsubheading Example
31838@smallexample
31839(gdb)
31840-file-list-exec-source-files
31841^done,shared-libraries=[
31842@{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31843@{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31844(gdb)
31845@end smallexample
31846
31847
31848@ignore
31849@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31850@findex -file-list-symbol-files
31851
31852@subsubheading Synopsis
31853
31854@smallexample
31855 -file-list-symbol-files
31856@end smallexample
31857
31858List symbol files.
31859
31860@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31861
31862The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31863
31864@subsubheading Example
31865N.A.
31866@end ignore
31867
31868
31869@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31870@findex -file-symbol-file
31871
31872@subsubheading Synopsis
31873
31874@smallexample
31875 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31876@end smallexample
31877
31878Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31879used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31880produced, except for a completion notification.
31881
31882@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31883
31884The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31885
31886@subsubheading Example
31887
31888@smallexample
31889(gdb)
31890-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31891^done
31892(gdb)
31893@end smallexample
31894
31895@ignore
31896@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31897@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31898@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31899
31900The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31901
31902@c @subheading -overlay-auto
31903
31904@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31905
31906@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31907
31908@c @subheading -overlay-map
31909
31910@c @subheading -overlay-off
31911
31912@c @subheading -overlay-on
31913
31914@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31915
31916@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31917@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31918@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31919
31920Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31921
31922@c @subheading -signal-handle
31923
31924@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31925
31926@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31927@end ignore
31928
31929
31930@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31931@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31932@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31933
31934
31935@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31936@findex -target-attach
31937
31938@subsubheading Synopsis
31939
31940@smallexample
31941 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31942@end smallexample
31943
31944Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31945@value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31946group, the id previously returned by
31947@samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31948
31949@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31950
31951The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31952
31953@subsubheading Example
31954@smallexample
31955(gdb)
31956-target-attach 34
31957=thread-created,id="1"
31958*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31959^done
31960(gdb)
31961@end smallexample
31962
31963@ignore
31964@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31965@findex -target-compare-sections
31966
31967@subsubheading Synopsis
31968
31969@smallexample
31970 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31971@end smallexample
31972
31973Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31974Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31975
31976@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31977
31978The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31979
31980@subsubheading Example
31981N.A.
31982@end ignore
31983
31984
31985@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31986@findex -target-detach
31987
31988@subsubheading Synopsis
31989
31990@smallexample
31991 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31992@end smallexample
31993
31994Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31995If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31996the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31997
31998@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31999
32000The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32001
32002@subsubheading Example
32003
32004@smallexample
32005(gdb)
32006-target-detach
32007^done
32008(gdb)
32009@end smallexample
32010
32011
32012@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32013@findex -target-disconnect
32014
32015@subsubheading Synopsis
32016
32017@smallexample
32018 -target-disconnect
32019@end smallexample
32020
32021Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32022generally not resumed.
32023
32024@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32025
32026The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32027
32028@subsubheading Example
32029
32030@smallexample
32031(gdb)
32032-target-disconnect
32033^done
32034(gdb)
32035@end smallexample
32036
32037
32038@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32039@findex -target-download
32040
32041@subsubheading Synopsis
32042
32043@smallexample
32044 -target-download
32045@end smallexample
32046
32047Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32048It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32049
32050@table @samp
32051@item section
32052The name of the section.
32053@item section-sent
32054The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32055@item section-size
32056The size of the section.
32057@item total-sent
32058The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32059@item total-size
32060The size of the overall executable to download.
32061@end table
32062
32063@noindent
32064Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32065@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32066
32067In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32068downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32069
32070@table @samp
32071@item section
32072The name of the section.
32073@item section-size
32074The size of the section.
32075@item total-size
32076The size of the overall executable to download.
32077@end table
32078
32079@noindent
32080At the end, a summary is printed.
32081
32082@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32083
32084The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32085
32086@subsubheading Example
32087
32088Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32089have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32090
32091@smallexample
32092(gdb)
32093-target-download
32094+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32095+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32096total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32097+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32098total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32099+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32100total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32101+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32102total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32103+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32104total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32105+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32106total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32107+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32108total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32109+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32110total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32111+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32112total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32113+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32114total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32115+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32116total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32117+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32118total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32119+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32120total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32121+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32122+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32123+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32124+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32125total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32126+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32127total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32128+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32129total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32130+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32131total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32132+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32133total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32134+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32135total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32136^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32137write-rate="429"
32138(gdb)
32139@end smallexample
32140
32141
32142@ignore
32143@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32144@findex -target-exec-status
32145
32146@subsubheading Synopsis
32147
32148@smallexample
32149 -target-exec-status
32150@end smallexample
32151
32152Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32153not, for instance).
32154
32155@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32156
32157There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32158
32159@subsubheading Example
32160N.A.
32161
32162
32163@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32164@findex -target-list-available-targets
32165
32166@subsubheading Synopsis
32167
32168@smallexample
32169 -target-list-available-targets
32170@end smallexample
32171
32172List the possible targets to connect to.
32173
32174@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32175
32176The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32177
32178@subsubheading Example
32179N.A.
32180
32181
32182@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32183@findex -target-list-current-targets
32184
32185@subsubheading Synopsis
32186
32187@smallexample
32188 -target-list-current-targets
32189@end smallexample
32190
32191Describe the current target.
32192
32193@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32194
32195The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32196other things).
32197
32198@subsubheading Example
32199N.A.
32200
32201
32202@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32203@findex -target-list-parameters
32204
32205@subsubheading Synopsis
32206
32207@smallexample
32208 -target-list-parameters
32209@end smallexample
32210
32211@c ????
32212@end ignore
32213
32214@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32215
32216No equivalent.
32217
32218@subsubheading Example
32219N.A.
32220
32221@subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32222@findex -target-flash-erase
32223
32224@subsubheading Synopsis
32225
32226@smallexample
32227 -target-flash-erase
32228@end smallexample
32229
32230Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32231
32232The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32233
32234The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32235addresses and memory region sizes.
32236
32237@smallexample
32238(gdb)
32239-target-flash-erase
32240^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32241(gdb)
32242@end smallexample
32243
32244@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32245@findex -target-select
32246
32247@subsubheading Synopsis
32248
32249@smallexample
32250 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32251@end smallexample
32252
32253Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32254
32255@table @samp
32256@item @var{type}
32257The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32258@item @var{parameters}
32259Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32260Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32261@end table
32262
32263The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32264which the target program is, in the following form:
32265
32266@smallexample
32267^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32268 args=[@var{arg list}]
32269@end smallexample
32270
32271@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32272
32273The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32274
32275@subsubheading Example
32276
32277@smallexample
32278(gdb)
32279-target-select remote /dev/ttya
32280^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32281(gdb)
32282@end smallexample
32283
32284@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32285@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32286@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32287
32288
32289@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32290@findex -target-file-put
32291
32292@subsubheading Synopsis
32293
32294@smallexample
32295 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32296@end smallexample
32297
32298Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32299@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32300
32301@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32302
32303The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32304
32305@subsubheading Example
32306
32307@smallexample
32308(gdb)
32309-target-file-put localfile remotefile
32310^done
32311(gdb)
32312@end smallexample
32313
32314
32315@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32316@findex -target-file-get
32317
32318@subsubheading Synopsis
32319
32320@smallexample
32321 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32322@end smallexample
32323
32324Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32325on the host system.
32326
32327@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32328
32329The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32330
32331@subsubheading Example
32332
32333@smallexample
32334(gdb)
32335-target-file-get remotefile localfile
32336^done
32337(gdb)
32338@end smallexample
32339
32340
32341@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32342@findex -target-file-delete
32343
32344@subsubheading Synopsis
32345
32346@smallexample
32347 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32348@end smallexample
32349
32350Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32351
32352@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32353
32354The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32355
32356@subsubheading Example
32357
32358@smallexample
32359(gdb)
32360-target-file-delete remotefile
32361^done
32362(gdb)
32363@end smallexample
32364
32365
32366@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32367@node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32368@section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32369
32370@subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32371@findex -info-ada-exceptions
32372
32373@subsubheading Synopsis
32374
32375@smallexample
32376 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32377@end smallexample
32378
32379List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32380With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32381names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32382
32383@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32384
32385The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32386
32387@subsubheading Result
32388
32389The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32390defined for each exception:
32391
32392@table @samp
32393@item name
32394The name of the exception.
32395
32396@item address
32397The address of the exception.
32398
32399@end table
32400
32401@subsubheading Example
32402
32403@smallexample
32404-info-ada-exceptions aint
32405^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32406hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32407@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32408body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32409@{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32410@end smallexample
32411
32412@subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32413
32414The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32415raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32416Catchpoint Commands}.
32417
32418
32419@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32420@node GDB/MI Support Commands
32421@section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32422
32423Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32424some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32425about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32426to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32427
32428@subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32429@cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32430@findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32431
32432@subsubheading Synopsis
32433
32434@smallexample
32435 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32436@end smallexample
32437
32438Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32439
32440Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32441is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32442Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32443for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32444dash.
32445
32446@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32447
32448There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32449
32450@subsubheading Result
32451
32452The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32453
32454@table @samp
32455@item exists
32456This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32457@code{"false"} otherwise.
32458
32459@end table
32460
32461@subsubheading Example
32462
32463Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32464
32465@smallexample
32466-info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32467^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32468@end smallexample
32469
32470@noindent
32471And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32472to the debugger:
32473
32474@smallexample
32475-info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32476^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32477@end smallexample
32478
32479@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32480@findex -list-features
32481@cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32482
32483Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32484this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32485or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32486important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32487of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32488startup.
32489
32490The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32491available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32492have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32493is given below.
32494
32495Example output:
32496
32497@smallexample
32498(gdb) -list-features
32499^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32500@end smallexample
32501
32502The current list of features is:
32503
32504@ftable @samp
32505@item frozen-varobjs
32506Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32507as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32508of @code{-varobj-create}.
32509@item pending-breakpoints
32510Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32511command.
32512@item python
32513Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32514pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32515@samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32516@item thread-info
32517Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32518@item data-read-memory-bytes
32519Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32520@code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32521@item breakpoint-notifications
32522Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32523CLI will be announced via async records.
32524@item ada-task-info
32525Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32526@item language-option
32527Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32528option (@pxref{Context management}).
32529@item info-gdb-mi-command
32530Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32531@item undefined-command-error-code
32532Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32533records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32534(@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32535@item exec-run-start-option
32536Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32537option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32538@end ftable
32539
32540@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32541@findex -list-target-features
32542
32543Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32544target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32545unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32546features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32547a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32548@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32549may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32550Example output:
32551
32552@smallexample
32553(gdb) -list-target-features
32554^done,result=["async"]
32555@end smallexample
32556
32557The current list of features is:
32558
32559@table @samp
32560@item async
32561Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32562execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32563while the target is running.
32564
32565@item reverse
32566Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32567@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32568
32569@end table
32570
32571@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32572@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32573@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32574
32575@c @subheading -gdb-complete
32576
32577@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32578@findex -gdb-exit
32579
32580@subsubheading Synopsis
32581
32582@smallexample
32583 -gdb-exit
32584@end smallexample
32585
32586Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32587
32588@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32589
32590Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32591
32592@subsubheading Example
32593
32594@smallexample
32595(gdb)
32596-gdb-exit
32597^exit
32598@end smallexample
32599
32600
32601@ignore
32602@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32603@findex -exec-abort
32604
32605@subsubheading Synopsis
32606
32607@smallexample
32608 -exec-abort
32609@end smallexample
32610
32611Kill the inferior running program.
32612
32613@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32614
32615The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32616
32617@subsubheading Example
32618N.A.
32619@end ignore
32620
32621
32622@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32623@findex -gdb-set
32624
32625@subsubheading Synopsis
32626
32627@smallexample
32628 -gdb-set
32629@end smallexample
32630
32631Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32632@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32633
32634@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32635
32636The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32637
32638@subsubheading Example
32639
32640@smallexample
32641(gdb)
32642-gdb-set $foo=3
32643^done
32644(gdb)
32645@end smallexample
32646
32647
32648@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32649@findex -gdb-show
32650
32651@subsubheading Synopsis
32652
32653@smallexample
32654 -gdb-show
32655@end smallexample
32656
32657Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32658
32659@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32660
32661The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32662
32663@subsubheading Example
32664
32665@smallexample
32666(gdb)
32667-gdb-show annotate
32668^done,value="0"
32669(gdb)
32670@end smallexample
32671
32672@c @subheading -gdb-source
32673
32674
32675@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32676@findex -gdb-version
32677
32678@subsubheading Synopsis
32679
32680@smallexample
32681 -gdb-version
32682@end smallexample
32683
32684Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32685
32686@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32687
32688The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32689default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32690
32691@subsubheading Example
32692
32693@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32694@c box in TeX.
32695@smallexample
32696(gdb)
32697-gdb-version
32698~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32699~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32700~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32701~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32702~ certain conditions.
32703~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32704~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32705~ details.
32706~This GDB was configured as
32707 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32708^done
32709(gdb)
32710@end smallexample
32711
32712@subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32713@findex -list-thread-groups
32714
32715@subheading Synopsis
32716
32717@smallexample
32718-list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32719@end smallexample
32720
32721Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32722group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32723When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32724thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32725top-level thread groups.
32726
32727Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32728With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32729available on the target.
32730
32731The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32732a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32733as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32734Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32735each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32736requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32737are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32738of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32739
32740To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32741together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32742and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32743permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32744will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32745@samp{threads} field.
32746
32747In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32748the following caveats:
32749
32750@itemize @bullet
32751@item
32752When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32753be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32754anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32755
32756@item
32757When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32758be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32759be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32760not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32761The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32762is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32763
32764@end itemize
32765
32766The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32767have the following fields:
32768
32769@table @code
32770@item id
32771Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32772The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32773convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32774
32775@item type
32776The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32777valid type.
32778
32779@item pid
32780The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32781for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32782
32783@item exit-code
32784The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32785This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32786only if the process is not running.
32787
32788@item num_children
32789The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32790absent for an available thread group.
32791
32792@item threads
32793This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32794thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32795specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32796
32797@item cores
32798This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32799thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32800such information is not available.
32801
32802@item executable
32803The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32804The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32805and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32806
32807@end table
32808
32809@subheading Example
32810
32811@smallexample
32812@value{GDBP}
32813-list-thread-groups
32814^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32815-list-thread-groups 17
32816^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32817 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32818@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32819 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32820 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32821-list-thread-groups --available
32822^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32823-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32824 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32825 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32826 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32827-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32828^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32829 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32830 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32831@end smallexample
32832
32833@subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32834@findex -info-os
32835
32836@subsubheading Synopsis
32837
32838@smallexample
32839-info-os [ @var{type} ]
32840@end smallexample
32841
32842If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32843operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32844supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32845of data of that type.
32846
32847The types of information available depend on the target operating
32848system.
32849
32850@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32851
32852The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32853
32854@subsubheading Example
32855
32856When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32857like this:
32858
32859@smallexample
32860@value{GDBP}
32861-info-os
32862^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32863hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32864 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32865 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32866body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32867 col2="CPUs"@},
32868 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32869 col2="File descriptors"@},
32870 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32871 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32872 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32873 col2="Message queues"@},
32874 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32875 col2="Processes"@},
32876 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32877 col2="Process groups"@},
32878 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32879 col2="Semaphores"@},
32880 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32881 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32882 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32883 col2="Sockets"@},
32884 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32885 col2="Threads"@}]
32886@value{GDBP}
32887-info-os processes
32888^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32889hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32890 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32891 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32892 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32893body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32894 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32895 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32896 ...
32897 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32898 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32899(gdb)
32900@end smallexample
32901
32902(Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32903does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32904for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32905popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32906@code{info os} omits it.)
32907
32908@subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32909@findex -add-inferior
32910
32911@subheading Synopsis
32912
32913@smallexample
32914-add-inferior
32915@end smallexample
32916
32917Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32918inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32919be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32920(@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32921field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32922thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32923
32924@subheading Example
32925
32926@smallexample
32927@value{GDBP}
32928-add-inferior
32929^done,inferior="i3"
32930@end smallexample
32931
32932@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32933@findex -interpreter-exec
32934
32935@subheading Synopsis
32936
32937@smallexample
32938-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32939@end smallexample
32940@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32941
32942Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32943
32944@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32945
32946The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32947
32948@subheading Example
32949
32950@smallexample
32951(gdb)
32952-interpreter-exec console "break main"
32953&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32954&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32955~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32956^done
32957(gdb)
32958@end smallexample
32959
32960@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32961@findex -inferior-tty-set
32962
32963@subheading Synopsis
32964
32965@smallexample
32966-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32967@end smallexample
32968
32969Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32970
32971@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32972
32973The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32974
32975@subheading Example
32976
32977@smallexample
32978(gdb)
32979-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32980^done
32981(gdb)
32982@end smallexample
32983
32984@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32985@findex -inferior-tty-show
32986
32987@subheading Synopsis
32988
32989@smallexample
32990-inferior-tty-show
32991@end smallexample
32992
32993Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32994
32995@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32996
32997The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32998
32999@subheading Example
33000
33001@smallexample
33002(gdb)
33003-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33004^done
33005(gdb)
33006-inferior-tty-show
33007^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33008(gdb)
33009@end smallexample
33010
33011@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33012@findex -enable-timings
33013
33014@subheading Synopsis
33015
33016@smallexample
33017-enable-timings [yes | no]
33018@end smallexample
33019
33020Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33021command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33022developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33023equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33024
33025@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33026
33027No equivalent.
33028
33029@subheading Example
33030
33031@smallexample
33032(gdb)
33033-enable-timings
33034^done
33035(gdb)
33036-break-insert main
33037^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33038addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33039fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33040times="0"@},
33041time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33042(gdb)
33043-enable-timings no
33044^done
33045(gdb)
33046-exec-run
33047^running
33048(gdb)
33049*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33050frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33051@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33052fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33053(gdb)
33054@end smallexample
33055
33056@node Annotations
33057@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33058
33059This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33060designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33061similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33062relatively high level.
33063
33064The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33065(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33066
33067@ignore
33068This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33069@end ignore
33070
33071@menu
33072* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33073* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33074* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33075* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33076* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33077* Annotations for Running::
33078 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33079* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33080@end menu
33081
33082@node Annotations Overview
33083@section What is an Annotation?
33084@cindex annotations
33085
33086Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33087characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33088information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33089is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33090information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33091additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33092cannot contain newline characters.
33093
33094Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33095characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33096no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33097@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33098annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33099means those three characters as output.
33100
33101The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33102@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33103how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33104values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33105is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33106subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33107for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33108been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33109Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33110
33111@table @code
33112@kindex set annotate
33113@item set annotate @var{level}
33114The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33115annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33116
33117@item show annotate
33118@kindex show annotate
33119Show the current annotation level.
33120@end table
33121
33122This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33123
33124A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33125
33126@smallexample
33127$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33128GNU gdb 6.0
33129Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33130GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33131and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33132under certain conditions.
33133Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33134There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33135for details.
33136This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33137
33138^Z^Zpre-prompt
33139(@value{GDBP})
33140^Z^Zprompt
33141@kbd{quit}
33142
33143^Z^Zpost-prompt
33144$
33145@end smallexample
33146
33147Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33148@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33149denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33150output from @value{GDBN}.
33151
33152@node Server Prefix
33153@section The Server Prefix
33154@cindex server prefix
33155
33156If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33157the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33158command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33159means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33160a transparent manner.
33161
33162The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33163the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33164value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33165@code{print} command.
33166
33167Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33168(@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33169
33170@node Prompting
33171@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33172
33173@cindex annotations for prompts
33174When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33175to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33176over, etc.
33177
33178Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33179input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33180denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33181annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33182annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33183associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33184features the following annotations:
33185
33186@smallexample
33187^Z^Zpre-prompt
33188^Z^Zprompt
33189^Z^Zpost-prompt
33190@end smallexample
33191
33192The input types are
33193
33194@table @code
33195@findex pre-prompt annotation
33196@findex prompt annotation
33197@findex post-prompt annotation
33198@item prompt
33199When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33200
33201@findex pre-commands annotation
33202@findex commands annotation
33203@findex post-commands annotation
33204@item commands
33205When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33206command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33207
33208@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33209@findex overload-choice annotation
33210@findex post-overload-choice annotation
33211@item overload-choice
33212When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33213
33214@findex pre-query annotation
33215@findex query annotation
33216@findex post-query annotation
33217@item query
33218When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33219
33220@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33221@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33222@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33223@item prompt-for-continue
33224When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33225expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33226prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33227presence of annotations.
33228@end table
33229
33230@node Errors
33231@section Errors
33232@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33233
33234@findex quit annotation
33235@smallexample
33236^Z^Zquit
33237@end smallexample
33238
33239This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33240
33241@findex error annotation
33242@smallexample
33243^Z^Zerror
33244@end smallexample
33245
33246This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33247
33248Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33249in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33250@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33251cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33252cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33253does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33254to the top level.
33255
33256@findex error-begin annotation
33257A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33258
33259@smallexample
33260^Z^Zerror-begin
33261@end smallexample
33262
33263Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33264message.
33265
33266Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33267@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33268@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33269
33270@node Invalidation
33271@section Invalidation Notices
33272
33273@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33274The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33275changed.
33276
33277@table @code
33278@findex frames-invalid annotation
33279@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33280
33281The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33282have changed.
33283
33284@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33285@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33286
33287The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33288deleted a breakpoint.
33289@end table
33290
33291@node Annotations for Running
33292@section Running the Program
33293@cindex annotations for running programs
33294
33295@findex starting annotation
33296@findex stopping annotation
33297When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33298@code{step} or @code{continue},
33299
33300@smallexample
33301^Z^Zstarting
33302@end smallexample
33303
33304is output. When the program stops,
33305
33306@smallexample
33307^Z^Zstopped
33308@end smallexample
33309
33310is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33311annotations describe how the program stopped.
33312
33313@table @code
33314@findex exited annotation
33315@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33316The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33317successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33318
33319@findex signalled annotation
33320@findex signal-name annotation
33321@findex signal-name-end annotation
33322@findex signal-string annotation
33323@findex signal-string-end annotation
33324@item ^Z^Zsignalled
33325The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33326annotation continues:
33327
33328@smallexample
33329@var{intro-text}
33330^Z^Zsignal-name
33331@var{name}
33332^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33333@var{middle-text}
33334^Z^Zsignal-string
33335@var{string}
33336^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33337@var{end-text}
33338@end smallexample
33339
33340@noindent
33341where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33342@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33343as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33344@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33345user's benefit and have no particular format.
33346
33347@findex signal annotation
33348@item ^Z^Zsignal
33349The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33350just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33351terminated with it.
33352
33353@findex breakpoint annotation
33354@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33355The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33356
33357@findex watchpoint annotation
33358@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33359The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33360@end table
33361
33362@node Source Annotations
33363@section Displaying Source
33364@cindex annotations for source display
33365
33366@findex source annotation
33367The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33368
33369@smallexample
33370^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33371@end smallexample
33372
33373where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33374file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33375first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33376within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33377debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33378@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33379line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33380@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33381source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33382followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33383depend on the language).
33384
33385@node JIT Interface
33386@chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33387@cindex just-in-time compilation
33388@cindex JIT compilation interface
33389
33390This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33391interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33392executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33393performance while maintaining platform independence.
33394
33395Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33396portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33397object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33398and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33399@value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33400symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33401
33402If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33403it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33404you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33405of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33406LLVM JIT.
33407
33408Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33409JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33410variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33411attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33412find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33413out about additional code.
33414
33415@menu
33416* Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33417* Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33418* Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33419* Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33420@end menu
33421
33422@node Declarations
33423@section JIT Declarations
33424
33425These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33426implement the interface:
33427
33428@smallexample
33429typedef enum
33430@{
33431 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33432 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33433 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33434@} jit_actions_t;
33435
33436struct jit_code_entry
33437@{
33438 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33439 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33440 const char *symfile_addr;
33441 uint64_t symfile_size;
33442@};
33443
33444struct jit_descriptor
33445@{
33446 uint32_t version;
33447 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33448 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33449 uint32_t action_flag;
33450 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33451 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33452@};
33453
33454/* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33455void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33456
33457/* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33458 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33459struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33460@end smallexample
33461
33462If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33463modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33464a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33465
33466@node Registering Code
33467@section Registering Code
33468
33469To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33470
33471@itemize @bullet
33472@item
33473Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33474information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33475
33476@item
33477Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33478file.
33479
33480@item
33481Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33482
33483@item
33484Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33485
33486@item
33487Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33488@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33489@end itemize
33490
33491When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33492@code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33493new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33494@value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33495
33496@node Unregistering Code
33497@section Unregistering Code
33498
33499If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33500
33501@itemize @bullet
33502@item
33503Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33504
33505@item
33506Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33507
33508@item
33509Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33510@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33511@end itemize
33512
33513If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33514and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33515
33516@node Custom Debug Info
33517@section Custom Debug Info
33518@cindex custom JIT debug info
33519@cindex JIT debug info reader
33520
33521Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33522or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33523debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33524issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33525format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33526by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33527such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33528@file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33529@file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33530
33531The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33532not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33533runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33534@code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33535the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33536object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33537compiler.
33538
33539@menu
33540* Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33541* Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33542@end menu
33543
33544@node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33545@subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33546@kindex jit-reader-load
33547@kindex jit-reader-unload
33548
33549Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33550and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33551
33552@table @code
33553@item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33554Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33555object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33556the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33557pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33558system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33559@file{/usr/local/lib}).
33560
33561Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33562reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33563reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33564the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33565@code{jit-reader-load}.
33566
33567@item jit-reader-unload
33568Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33569
33570@end table
33571
33572@node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33573@subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33574@cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33575
33576As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33577certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33578
33579@file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33580required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33581@value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33582the system include directory.
33583
33584Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33585can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33586@code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33587
33588The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33589which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33590
33591@findex gdb_init_reader
33592@smallexample
33593extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33594@end smallexample
33595
33596@cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33597
33598@code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33599functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33600generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33601(@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33602(@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33603reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33604
33605@smallexample
33606struct gdb_reader_funcs
33607@{
33608 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33609 int reader_version;
33610
33611 /* For use by the reader. */
33612 void *priv_data;
33613
33614 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33615 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33616 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33617 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33618@};
33619@end smallexample
33620
33621@cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33622@cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33623
33624The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33625@value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33626passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33627and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33628@code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33629files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33630gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33631frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33632frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33633target's address space.
33634
33635@node In-Process Agent
33636@chapter In-Process Agent
33637@cindex debugging agent
33638The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33639because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33640as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33641multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33642and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33643example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33644timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33645it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33646long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33647If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33648introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33649code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33650behavior without interrupting it.
33651
33652Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33653some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33654reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33655@dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33656process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33657itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33658performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33659interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33660because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33661
33662The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33663(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33664agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33665data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33666
33667@anchor{Control Agent}
33668You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33669debugging with the following commands:
33670
33671@table @code
33672@kindex set agent on
33673@item set agent on
33674Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33675debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33676by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33677if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33678and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33679conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33680
33681@kindex set agent off
33682@item set agent off
33683Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33684of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33685
33686@kindex show agent
33687@item show agent
33688Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33689the in-process agent.
33690@end table
33691
33692@menu
33693* In-Process Agent Protocol::
33694@end menu
33695
33696@node In-Process Agent Protocol
33697@section In-Process Agent Protocol
33698@cindex in-process agent protocol
33699
33700The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33701GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33702used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33703In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33704(@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33705in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33706some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33707of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33708types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33709
33710@menu
33711* IPA Protocol Objects::
33712* IPA Protocol Commands::
33713@end menu
33714
33715@node IPA Protocol Objects
33716@subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33717@cindex ipa protocol objects
33718
33719The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33720complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33721
33722The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33723or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33724two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33725However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33726
33727@enumerate
33728@item
33729word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33730compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33731@item
33732ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33733GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33734the other one.
33735@end enumerate
33736
33737Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33738
33739@enumerate
33740@item
33741agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33742(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33743@anchor{agent expression object}
33744@item
33745tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33746(@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33747memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33748@anchor{tracepoint action object}
33749@item
33750tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33751@anchor{tracepoint object}
33752
33753@end enumerate
33754
33755The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33756object:
33757
33758@multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33759@headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33760@item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33761@item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33762@item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33763@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33764@item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33765@item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33766address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33767of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33768@item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33769@item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33770memory address for collecting.
33771@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33772@item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33773@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33774@item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33775@item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33776@item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33777@item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33778@item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33779@item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33780@item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33781@item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33782@item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33783@item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33784@item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33785@item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33786@item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33787@item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33788@item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33789@item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33790@item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33791@ref{agent expression object}
33792@tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33793@ref{agent expression object}
33794@item actions @tab variable
33795@tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33796@end multitable
33797
33798@node IPA Protocol Commands
33799@subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33800@cindex ipa protocol commands
33801
33802The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33803specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33804
33805@table @samp
33806
33807@item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33808Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33809(@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33810head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33811in IPA finally.
33812
33813Replies:
33814@table @samp
33815@item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33816@var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33817The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33818@var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33819The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33820The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33821@item E @var{NN}
33822for an error
33823
33824@end table
33825
33826@item close
33827Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33828is about to kill inferiors.
33829
33830@item qTfSTM
33831@xref{qTfSTM}.
33832@item qTsSTM
33833@xref{qTsSTM}.
33834@item qTSTMat
33835@xref{qTSTMat}.
33836@item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33837Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33838
33839Replies:
33840@table @samp
33841@item E @var{NN}
33842for an error
33843@end table
33844@item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33845Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33846@end table
33847
33848@node GDB Bugs
33849@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33850@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33851@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33852
33853Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33854
33855Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33856may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33857the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33858reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33859
33860In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33861information that enables us to fix the bug.
33862
33863@menu
33864* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33865* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33866@end menu
33867
33868@node Bug Criteria
33869@section Have You Found a Bug?
33870@cindex bug criteria
33871
33872If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33873
33874@itemize @bullet
33875@cindex fatal signal
33876@cindex debugger crash
33877@cindex crash of debugger
33878@item
33879If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33880@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33881
33882@cindex error on valid input
33883@item
33884If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33885bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33886somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33887
33888@cindex invalid input
33889@item
33890If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33891that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33892``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33893for traditional practice''.
33894
33895@item
33896If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33897for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33898@end itemize
33899
33900@node Bug Reporting
33901@section How to Report Bugs
33902@cindex bug reports
33903@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33904
33905A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33906If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33907contact that organization first.
33908
33909You can find contact information for many support companies and
33910individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33911distribution.
33912@c should add a web page ref...
33913
33914@ifset BUGURL
33915@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33916In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33917@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33918@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33919page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33920be used.
33921
33922@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33923@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33924not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33925@samp{bug-gdb}.
33926
33927The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33928serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33929the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33930newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33931problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33932path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33933we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33934bug reports to the mailing list.
33935@end ifset
33936@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33937In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33938@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33939@end ifclear
33940@end ifset
33941
33942The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33943@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33944fact or leave it out, state it!
33945
33946Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33947problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33948assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33949Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33950stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33951name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33952of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33953the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33954easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33955
33956Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33957bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33958you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33959self-contained.
33960
33961Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33962bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33963@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33964bugs properly.
33965
33966To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33967
33968@itemize @bullet
33969@item
33970The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33971with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33972version}.
33973
33974Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33975the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33976
33977@item
33978The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33979version number.
33980
33981@item
33982The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33983@value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33984@option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33985@code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33986
33987@item
33988What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33989``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33990
33991@item
33992What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33993debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33994C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33995to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33996those compilers.
33997
33998@item
33999The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34000observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34001you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34002Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34003
34004If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34005and then we might not encounter the bug.
34006
34007@item
34008A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34009reproduce the bug.
34010
34011@item
34012A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34013incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34014
34015Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34016will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34017not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34018a chance to make a mistake.
34019
34020Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34021say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34022copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34023the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34024crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34025ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34026us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34027to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34028
34029@pindex script
34030@cindex recording a session script
34031To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34032such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34033Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34034include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34035
34036Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34037inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34038
34039@item
34040If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34041diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34042it by context, not by line number.
34043
34044The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34045sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34046
34047@end itemize
34048
34049Here are some things that are not necessary:
34050
34051@itemize @bullet
34052@item
34053A description of the envelope of the bug.
34054
34055Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34056which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34057changes will not affect it.
34058
34059This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34060will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34061with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34062We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34063
34064Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34065of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34066output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34067less time, and so on.
34068
34069However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34070report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34071
34072@item
34073A patch for the bug.
34074
34075A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34076the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34077a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34078to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34079
34080Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34081construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34082through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34083to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34084
34085And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34086patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34087help us to understand.
34088
34089@item
34090A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34091
34092Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34093things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34094@end itemize
34095
34096@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34097@c and consists of the two following files:
34098@c rluser.texi
34099@c hsuser.texi
34100@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34101@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34102@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34103@include rluser.texi
34104@include hsuser.texi
34105@end ifclear
34106
34107@node In Memoriam
34108@appendix In Memoriam
34109
34110The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34111contributors:
34112
34113@table @code
34114@item Fred Fish
34115Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34116to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34117the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34118
34119@item Michael Snyder
34120Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34121with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34122to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34123adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34124@end table
34125
34126Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34127enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34128
34129@node Formatting Documentation
34130@appendix Formatting Documentation
34131
34132@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34133@cindex reference card
34134The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34135for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34136subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34137@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34138release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34139you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34140
34141The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34142can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34143
34144@smallexample
34145make refcard.dvi
34146@end smallexample
34147
34148The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34149mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34150that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34151high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34152your @sc{dvi} output program.
34153
34154@cindex documentation
34155
34156All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34157distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34158a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34159on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34160formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34161and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34162
34163@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34164version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34165file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34166subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34167necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34168but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34169Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34170@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34171
34172If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34173Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34174@code{makeinfo}.
34175
34176If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34177@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34178version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34179
34180@smallexample
34181cd gdb
34182make gdb.info
34183@end smallexample
34184
34185If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34186a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34187Texinfo definitions file.
34188
34189@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34190produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34191document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34192has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34193command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34194(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34195require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34196
34197@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34198@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34199written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34200typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34201and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34202directory.
34203
34204If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34205typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34206subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34207@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34208
34209@smallexample
34210make gdb.dvi
34211@end smallexample
34212
34213Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34214
34215@node Installing GDB
34216@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34217@cindex installation
34218
34219@menu
34220* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34221* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34222* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34223* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34224* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34225* System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34226@end menu
34227
34228@node Requirements
34229@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34230@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34231
34232Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34233Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34234
34235@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34236@table @asis
34237@item ISO C90 compiler
34238@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34239working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34240
34241@end table
34242
34243@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34244@table @asis
34245@item Expat
34246@anchor{Expat}
34247@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34248included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34249can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34250The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34251standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34252use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34253
34254Expat is used for:
34255
34256@itemize @bullet
34257@item
34258Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34259@item
34260Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34261@item
34262Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34263or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34264@item
34265MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34266@item
34267Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34268@item
34269Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34270@pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34271@end itemize
34272
34273@item MPFR
34274@anchor{MPFR}
34275@value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
34276library. This library may be included with your operating system
34277distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34278@url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
34279for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
34280in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
34281option to specify its location.
34282
34283GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
34284expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
34285formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
34286will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
34287
34288@item zlib
34289@cindex compressed debug sections
34290@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34291compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34292of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34293is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34294information in such binaries.
34295
34296The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34297distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34298@url{http://zlib.net}.
34299
34300@item iconv
34301@value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34302Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34303on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34304other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34305
34306If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34307in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34308This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34309directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34310
34311On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34312have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34313@option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34314
34315@value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34316arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34317in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34318if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34319implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34320by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34321Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34322Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34323@end table
34324
34325@node Running Configure
34326@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34327@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34328@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34329of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34330build the @code{gdb} program.
34331@iftex
34332@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34333@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34334look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34335installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34336@end iftex
34337
34338The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34339@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34340appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34341
34342For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34343@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34344
34345@table @code
34346@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34347script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34348
34349@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34350the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34351
34352@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34353source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34354
34355@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34356@sc{gnu} include files
34357
34358@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34359source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34360
34361@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34362source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34363
34364@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34365source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34366
34367@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34368source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34369
34370@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34371source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34372@end table
34373
34374The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34375from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34376this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34377
34378First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34379if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34380identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34381argument.
34382
34383For example:
34384
34385@smallexample
34386cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34387./configure @var{host}
34388make
34389@end smallexample
34390
34391@noindent
34392where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34393@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34394(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34395correct value by examining your system.)
34396
34397Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34398@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34399libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34400binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34401
34402@need 750
34403@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34404system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34405shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34406
34407@smallexample
34408sh configure @var{host}
34409@end smallexample
34410
34411If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34412directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34413@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34414@file{configure}
34415creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34416you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34417
34418You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34419source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34420@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34421that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34422if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34423of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34424configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34425directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34426about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34427
34428You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34429However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34430the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34431that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34432let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34433
34434@node Separate Objdir
34435@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34436
34437If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34438you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34439host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34440allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34441rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34442handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34443@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34444program specified there.
34445
34446To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34447with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34448(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34449itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34450would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34451the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34452
34453For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34454separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34455
34456@smallexample
34457@group
34458cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34459mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34460cd ../gdb-sun4
34461../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34462make
34463@end group
34464@end smallexample
34465
34466When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34467directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34468(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34469the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34470directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34471@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34472
34473Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34474instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34475like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34476one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34477build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34478
34479One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34480directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34481@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34482programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34483You specify a cross-debugging target by
34484giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34485
34486When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34487it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34488called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34489
34490The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34491directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34492directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34493directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34494will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34495
34496When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34497directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34498if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34499with each other.
34500
34501@node Config Names
34502@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34503
34504The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34505script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34506aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34507of information in the following pattern:
34508
34509@smallexample
34510@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34511@end smallexample
34512
34513For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34514or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34515option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34516
34517The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34518any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34519aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34520@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34521script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34522abbreviations---for example:
34523
34524@smallexample
34525% sh config.sub i386-linux
34526i386-pc-linux-gnu
34527% sh config.sub alpha-linux
34528alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34529% sh config.sub hp9k700
34530hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34531% sh config.sub sun4
34532sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34533% sh config.sub sun3
34534m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34535% sh config.sub i986v
34536Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34537@end smallexample
34538
34539@noindent
34540@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34541directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34542
34543@node Configure Options
34544@section @file{configure} Options
34545
34546Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34547are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34548several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34549Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34550
34551@smallexample
34552configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34553 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34554 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34555 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34556 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34557 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34558 @var{host}
34559@end smallexample
34560
34561@noindent
34562You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34563@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34564@samp{--}.
34565
34566@table @code
34567@item --help
34568Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34569
34570@item --prefix=@var{dir}
34571Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34572@file{@var{dir}}.
34573
34574@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34575Configure the source to install programs under directory
34576@file{@var{dir}}.
34577
34578@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34579@need 2000
34580@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34581@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34582@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34583Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34584@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34585build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34586directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34587the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34588directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34589the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34590@var{dirname}.
34591
34592@item --norecursion
34593Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34594propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34595
34596@item --target=@var{target}
34597Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34598@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34599programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34600
34601There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34602
34603@item @var{host} @dots{}
34604Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34605
34606There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34607@end table
34608
34609There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34610needed for special purposes only.
34611
34612@node System-wide configuration
34613@section System-wide configuration and settings
34614@cindex system-wide init file
34615
34616@value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34617this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34618@value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34619
34620Here is the corresponding configure option:
34621
34622@table @code
34623@item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34624Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34625@var{file}.
34626@end table
34627
34628If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34629it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34630
34631@itemize @bullet
34632@item
34633If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34634it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34635are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34636if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34637init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34638@file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34639
34640@item
34641By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34642it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34643@option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34644then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34645wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34646@end itemize
34647
34648If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34649@option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34650data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34651time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34652system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34653@option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34654Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34655initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34656started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34657reread.
34658
34659@menu
34660* System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34661@end menu
34662
34663@node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34664@subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34665@cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34666
34667The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34668(as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34669a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34670automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34671configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34672should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34673
34674The following scripts are currently available:
34675@itemize @bullet
34676
34677@item @file{elinos.py}
34678@pindex elinos.py
34679@cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34680This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34681It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34682ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34683shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34684and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34685
34686@item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34687@pindex wrs-linux.py
34688@cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34689This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34690Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34691the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34692
34693@end itemize
34694
34695@node Maintenance Commands
34696@appendix Maintenance Commands
34697@cindex maintenance commands
34698@cindex internal commands
34699
34700In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34701includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34702that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34703provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34704messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34705
34706@table @code
34707@kindex maint agent
34708@kindex maint agent-eval
34709@item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34710@itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34711Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34712This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34713(@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34714expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34715@samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34716to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34717globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34718of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34719the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34720addition and return the sum.
34721If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34722If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34723
34724@kindex maint agent-printf
34725@item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34726Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34727into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34728This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34729printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34730
34731@kindex maint info breakpoints
34732@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34733Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34734breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34735internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34736breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34737is shown:
34738
34739@table @code
34740@item breakpoint
34741Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34742
34743@item watchpoint
34744Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34745
34746@item longjmp
34747Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34748@code{longjmp} calls.
34749
34750@item longjmp resume
34751Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34752
34753@item until
34754Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34755
34756@item finish
34757Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34758
34759@item shlib events
34760Shared library events.
34761
34762@end table
34763
34764@kindex maint info btrace
34765@item maint info btrace
34766Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34767
34768@kindex maint btrace packet-history
34769@item maint btrace packet-history
34770Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34771execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34772information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34773recording format.
34774
34775@table @code
34776@item bts
34777For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34778code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34779
34780@table @asis
34781@item Block number
34782Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34783@item Lowest @samp{PC}
34784@item Highest @samp{PC}
34785@end table
34786
34787@item pt
34788For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34789Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34790information is printed:
34791
34792@table @asis
34793@item Packet number
34794Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34795@item Trace offset
34796The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34797@item Packet opcode and payload
34798@end table
34799@end table
34800
34801@kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34802@item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34803Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34804packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34805needed.
34806
34807@kindex maint btrace clear
34808@item maint btrace clear
34809Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34810branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34811
34812This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34813buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34814available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34815buffer.
34816
34817@kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34818@item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34819@kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34820@item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34821Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34822packet history.
34823
34824@kindex set displaced-stepping
34825@kindex show displaced-stepping
34826@cindex displaced stepping support
34827@cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34828@item set displaced-stepping
34829@itemx show displaced-stepping
34830Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34831if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34832over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34833an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34834breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34835
34836@table @code
34837@item set displaced-stepping on
34838If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34839displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34840
34841@item set displaced-stepping off
34842@value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34843even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34844
34845@cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34846@item set displaced-stepping auto
34847This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34848only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34849architecture supports displaced stepping.
34850@end table
34851
34852@kindex maint check-psymtabs
34853@item maint check-psymtabs
34854Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34855Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34856
34857@kindex maint check-symtabs
34858@item maint check-symtabs
34859Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34860
34861@kindex maint expand-symtabs
34862@item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34863Expand symbol tables.
34864If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34865names matching @var{regexp}.
34866
34867@kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34868@kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34869@cindex demangler crashes
34870@item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34871@itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34872Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34873symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34874If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34875the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34876option to terminate the current session.
34877
34878@kindex maint cplus first_component
34879@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34880Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34881
34882@kindex maint cplus namespace
34883@item maint cplus namespace
34884Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34885
34886@kindex maint deprecate
34887@kindex maint undeprecate
34888@cindex deprecated commands
34889@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34890@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34891Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34892cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34893argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34894favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34895the replacement as part of the warning.
34896
34897@kindex maint dump-me
34898@item maint dump-me
34899@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34900Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34901This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34902with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34903
34904@kindex maint internal-error
34905@kindex maint internal-warning
34906@kindex maint demangler-warning
34907@cindex demangler crashes
34908@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34909@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34910@itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34911
34912Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34913@code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34914as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34915reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34916opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34917and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34918@value{GDBN} session.
34919
34920These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34921used as the text of the error or warning message.
34922
34923Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34924
34925@smallexample
34926(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34927@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34928A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34929debugging may prove unreliable.
34930Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34931Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34932(@value{GDBP})
34933@end smallexample
34934
34935@cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34936@cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34937@cindex demangler crashes
34938
34939@kindex maint set internal-error
34940@kindex maint show internal-error
34941@kindex maint set internal-warning
34942@kindex maint show internal-warning
34943@kindex maint set demangler-warning
34944@kindex maint show demangler-warning
34945@item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34946@itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34947@itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34948@itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34949@itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34950@itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34951When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34952gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34953core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34954override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34955described in the table below.
34956
34957@table @samp
34958@item quit
34959You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34960quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34961
34962@item corefile
34963You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34964create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34965that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34966demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34967disabled.
34968@end table
34969
34970@kindex maint packet
34971@item maint packet @var{text}
34972If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34973then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34974displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34975@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34976checksum.
34977
34978@kindex maint print architecture
34979@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34980Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34981@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34982
34983@kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34984@item maint print c-tdesc
34985Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34986a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
34987target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
34988is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
34989document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
34990The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
34991built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
34992modify XML target descriptions.
34993
34994@kindex maint check xml-descriptions
34995@item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
34996Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
34997equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
34998
34999@kindex maint print dummy-frames
35000@item maint print dummy-frames
35001Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35002
35003@smallexample
35004(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35005@dots{}
35006(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35007Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
3500858 return (a + b);
35009The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35010@dots{}
35011(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
350120xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35013(@value{GDBP})
35014@end smallexample
35015
35016Takes an optional file parameter.
35017
35018@kindex maint print registers
35019@kindex maint print raw-registers
35020@kindex maint print cooked-registers
35021@kindex maint print register-groups
35022@kindex maint print remote-registers
35023@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35024@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35025@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35026@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35027@itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35028Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35029
35030The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35031the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35032cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35033including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35034to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35035groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35036print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35037and offsets in the `G' packets.
35038
35039These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35040write the information.
35041
35042@kindex maint print reggroups
35043@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35044Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35045optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35046information.
35047
35048The register groups info looks like this:
35049
35050@smallexample
35051(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35052 Group Type
35053 general user
35054 float user
35055 all user
35056 vector user
35057 system user
35058 save internal
35059 restore internal
35060@end smallexample
35061
35062@kindex flushregs
35063@item flushregs
35064This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35065
35066@kindex maint print objfiles
35067@cindex info for known object files
35068@item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35069Print a dump of all known object files.
35070If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35071match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35072address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35073
35074@kindex maint print user-registers
35075@cindex user registers
35076@item maint print user-registers
35077List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35078typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35079include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35080@code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35081registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35082register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35083registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35084
35085@kindex maint print section-scripts
35086@cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35087@item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35088Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35089If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35090matching @var{regexp}.
35091For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35092and the full path if known.
35093@xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35094
35095@kindex maint print statistics
35096@cindex bcache statistics
35097@item maint print statistics
35098This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35099about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35100statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35101of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35102defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35103the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35104used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35105sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35106average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35107savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35108lengths.
35109
35110@kindex maint print target-stack
35111@cindex target stack description
35112@item maint print target-stack
35113A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35114kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35115so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35116In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35117until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35118address.
35119
35120This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35121the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35122
35123@kindex maint print type
35124@cindex type chain of a data type
35125@item maint print type @var{expr}
35126Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35127can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35128that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35129a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35130data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35131
35132@kindex maint selftest
35133@cindex self tests
35134@item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35135Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35136print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35137If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35138name will by ran.
35139
35140@kindex "maint info selftests"
35141@cindex self tests
35142@item maint info selftests
35143List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35144
35145@kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35146@kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35147@item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35148@item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35149Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35150information.
35151
35152The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35153describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35154@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35155expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35156too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35157always see the disassembly form.
35158
35159Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35160
35161@smallexample
35162(gdb) info addr argc
35163Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35164 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35165@end smallexample
35166
35167For more information on these expressions, see
35168@uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35169
35170@kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35171@kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35172@item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35173@itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35174Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35175
35176@cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35177In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35178produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35179reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35180This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35181cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35182compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35183memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35184slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35185
35186@kindex maint set profile
35187@kindex maint show profile
35188@cindex profiling GDB
35189@item maint set profile
35190@itemx maint show profile
35191Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35192
35193Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35194command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35195collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35196exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35197if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35198(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35199data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35200
35201Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35202compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35203
35204@kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35205@kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35206@cindex hardware debug registers
35207@item maint set show-debug-regs
35208@itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35209Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35210registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35211enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35212removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35213triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35214
35215@kindex maint set show-all-tib
35216@kindex maint show show-all-tib
35217@item maint set show-all-tib
35218@itemx maint show show-all-tib
35219Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35220at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35221command.
35222
35223@kindex maint set target-async
35224@kindex maint show target-async
35225@item maint set target-async
35226@itemx maint show target-async
35227This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35228asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35229default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35230to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35231
35232@kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35233@kindex maint show target-non-stop
35234@item maint set target-non-stop
35235@itemx maint show target-non-stop
35236
35237This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35238mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35239Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35240if supported by the target.
35241
35242@table @code
35243@item maint set target-non-stop auto
35244This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35245non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35246
35247@item maint set target-non-stop on
35248@value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35249does not indicate support.
35250
35251@item maint set target-non-stop off
35252@value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35253target supports it.
35254@end table
35255
35256@kindex maint set per-command
35257@kindex maint show per-command
35258@item maint set per-command
35259@itemx maint show per-command
35260@cindex resources used by commands
35261
35262@value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35263This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35264
35265@table @code
35266@item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35267@itemx maint show per-command space
35268Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35269If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35270took, following the command's own output.
35271This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35272@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35273
35274@item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35275@itemx maint show per-command time
35276Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35277for each command.
35278If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35279took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35280Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35281Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35282CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35283Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35284the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35285to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35286spent by the program been debugged.
35287This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35288@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35289
35290@item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35291@itemx maint show per-command symtab
35292Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35293for each command.
35294If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35295
35296@enumerate a
35297@item
35298number of symbol tables
35299@item
35300number of primary symbol tables
35301@item
35302number of blocks in the blockvector
35303@end enumerate
35304@end table
35305
35306@kindex maint space
35307@cindex memory used by commands
35308@item maint space @var{value}
35309An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35310A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35311
35312@kindex maint time
35313@cindex time of command execution
35314@item maint time @var{value}
35315An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35316A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35317
35318@kindex maint translate-address
35319@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35320Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35321@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35322@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35323the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35324the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35325command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35326
35327If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35328is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35329executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35330
35331@end table
35332
35333The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35334@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35335
35336@table @code
35337@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35338@kindex set watchdog
35339@cindex watchdog timer
35340@cindex timeout for commands
35341Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35342target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35343reports and error and the command is aborted.
35344
35345@item show watchdog
35346Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35347@end table
35348
35349@node Remote Protocol
35350@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35351
35352@menu
35353* Overview::
35354* Packets::
35355* Stop Reply Packets::
35356* General Query Packets::
35357* Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35358* Tracepoint Packets::
35359* Host I/O Packets::
35360* Interrupts::
35361* Notification Packets::
35362* Remote Non-Stop::
35363* Packet Acknowledgment::
35364* Examples::
35365* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35366* Library List Format::
35367* Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35368* Memory Map Format::
35369* Thread List Format::
35370* Traceframe Info Format::
35371* Branch Trace Format::
35372* Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35373@end menu
35374
35375@node Overview
35376@section Overview
35377
35378There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35379protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35380machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35381recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35382
35383In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35384transmitted and received data, respectively.
35385
35386@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35387@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35388@cindex remote serial protocol
35389All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35390and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35391@var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35392@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35393@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35394
35395@smallexample
35396@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35397@end smallexample
35398@noindent
35399
35400@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35401@noindent
35402The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35403characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35404eight bit unsigned checksum).
35405
35406Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35407specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35408
35409@smallexample
35410@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35411@end smallexample
35412
35413@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35414@noindent
35415That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35416has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35417since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35418
35419When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35420response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35421the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35422retransmission):
35423
35424@smallexample
35425-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35426<- @code{+}
35427@end smallexample
35428@noindent
35429
35430The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35431once a connection is established.
35432@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35433
35434The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35435debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35436the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35437when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35438threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35439behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35440execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35441
35442@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35443exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35444exceptions).
35445
35446@cindex remote protocol, field separator
35447Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35448@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35449@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35450
35451Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35452@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35453would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35454
35455@cindex remote protocol, binary data
35456@anchor{Binary Data}
35457Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35458digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35459protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35460Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35461connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35462binary data.
35463
35464The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35465as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35466character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35467For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35468bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35469@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35470@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35471must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35472is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35473(described next).
35474
35475Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35476Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35477instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35478repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35479binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35480@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35481produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35482code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35483encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35484@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35485after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
354863}} more times.
35487
35488The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35489greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35490seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35491five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35492@samp{0*"00}.
35493
35494The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35495error number. That number is not well defined.
35496
35497@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35498For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35499(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35500protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35501on that response.
35502
35503At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35504commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35505for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35506can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35507(step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35508support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35509
35510@node Packets
35511@section Packets
35512
35513The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35514@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35515@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35516I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35517
35518Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35519syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35520include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35521part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35522separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35523@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35524bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35525@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35526@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35527@var{baz}.
35528
35529@cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35530@anchor{thread-id syntax}
35531Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35532a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35533interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35534can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35535pick any thread.
35536
35537In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35538which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35539process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35540The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35541format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35542interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35543to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35544indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35545@samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35546error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35547@samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35548for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35549ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35550
35551The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35552@value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35553feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35554more information.
35555
35556Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35557letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35558
35559Here are the packet descriptions.
35560
35561@table @samp
35562
35563@item !
35564@cindex @samp{!} packet
35565@anchor{extended mode}
35566Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35567persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35568debugged.
35569
35570Reply:
35571@table @samp
35572@item OK
35573The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35574@end table
35575
35576@item ?
35577@cindex @samp{?} packet
35578@anchor{? packet}
35579Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35580step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35581target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35582
35583Reply:
35584@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35585
35586@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35587@cindex @samp{A} packet
35588Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35589specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35590@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35591
35592Reply:
35593@table @samp
35594@item OK
35595The arguments were set.
35596@item E @var{NN}
35597An error occurred.
35598@end table
35599
35600@item b @var{baud}
35601@cindex @samp{b} packet
35602(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35603Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35604
35605JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35606received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35607problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35608
35609Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35610it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35611some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35612switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35613of view, nothing actually happened.}
35614
35615@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35616@cindex @samp{B} packet
35617Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35618breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35619
35620Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35621(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35622
35623@cindex @samp{bc} packet
35624@anchor{bc}
35625@item bc
35626Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35627@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35628
35629Reply:
35630@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35631
35632@cindex @samp{bs} packet
35633@anchor{bs}
35634@item bs
35635Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35636@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35637
35638Reply:
35639@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35640
35641@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35642@cindex @samp{c} packet
35643Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35644is omitted, resume at current address.
35645
35646This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35647packet}.
35648
35649Reply:
35650@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35651
35652@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35653@cindex @samp{C} packet
35654Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35655@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35656
35657This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35658packet}.
35659
35660Reply:
35661@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35662
35663@item d
35664@cindex @samp{d} packet
35665Toggle debug flag.
35666
35667Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35668(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35669
35670@item D
35671@itemx D;@var{pid}
35672@cindex @samp{D} packet
35673The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35674remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35675before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35676
35677The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35678protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35679detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35680big-endian hex string.
35681
35682Reply:
35683@table @samp
35684@item OK
35685for success
35686@item E @var{NN}
35687for an error
35688@end table
35689
35690@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35691@cindex @samp{F} packet
35692A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35693This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35694Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35695
35696@item g
35697@anchor{read registers packet}
35698@cindex @samp{g} packet
35699Read general registers.
35700
35701Reply:
35702@table @samp
35703@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35704Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35705with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35706each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35707determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35708@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35709
35710When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35711Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35712literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35713that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35714is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
357154 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35716registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35717have been collected, and both have zero value:
35718
35719@smallexample
35720-> @code{g}
35721<- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35722@end smallexample
35723
35724@item E @var{NN}
35725for an error.
35726@end table
35727
35728@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35729@cindex @samp{G} packet
35730Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35731description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35732
35733Reply:
35734@table @samp
35735@item OK
35736for success
35737@item E @var{NN}
35738for an error
35739@end table
35740
35741@item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35742@cindex @samp{H} packet
35743Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35744@samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35745should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35746is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35747option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35748@var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35749@ref{thread-id syntax}.
35750
35751Reply:
35752@table @samp
35753@item OK
35754for success
35755@item E @var{NN}
35756for an error
35757@end table
35758
35759@c FIXME: JTC:
35760@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35761@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35762@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35763@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35764@c described. For example:
35765@c
35766@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35767@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35768@c otherwise returns current registers.
35769@c
35770@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35771@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35772@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35773
35774@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35775@anchor{cycle step packet}
35776@cindex @samp{i} packet
35777Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35778present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35779step starting at that address.
35780
35781@item I
35782@cindex @samp{I} packet
35783Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35784step packet}.
35785
35786@item k
35787@cindex @samp{k} packet
35788Kill request.
35789
35790The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35791
35792For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35793system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35794
35795For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35796
35797A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35798that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35799the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35800
35801If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35802@samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35803acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35804
35805If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35806not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35807probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35808(@pxref{? packet}).
35809
35810@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35811@cindex @samp{m} packet
35812Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35813(@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35814any particular boundary.
35815
35816The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35817data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35818and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35819use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35820suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35821@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35822@cindex size of remote memory accesses
35823@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35824
35825Reply:
35826@table @samp
35827@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35828Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35829The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35830server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35831@item E @var{NN}
35832@var{NN} is errno
35833@end table
35834
35835@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35836@cindex @samp{M} packet
35837Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35838(@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35839byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35840
35841Reply:
35842@table @samp
35843@item OK
35844for success
35845@item E @var{NN}
35846for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35847written).
35848@end table
35849
35850@item p @var{n}
35851@cindex @samp{p} packet
35852Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35853@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35854register value is encoded.
35855
35856Reply:
35857@table @samp
35858@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35859the register's value
35860@item E @var{NN}
35861for an error
35862@item @w{}
35863Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35864@end table
35865
35866@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35867@anchor{write register packet}
35868@cindex @samp{P} packet
35869Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35870number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35871digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35872
35873Reply:
35874@table @samp
35875@item OK
35876for success
35877@item E @var{NN}
35878for an error
35879@end table
35880
35881@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35882@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35883@cindex @samp{q} packet
35884@cindex @samp{Q} packet
35885General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35886described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35887
35888@item r
35889@cindex @samp{r} packet
35890Reset the entire system.
35891
35892Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35893
35894@item R @var{XX}
35895@cindex @samp{R} packet
35896Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35897This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35898
35899The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35900
35901@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35902@cindex @samp{s} packet
35903Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35904@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35905
35906This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35907packet}.
35908
35909Reply:
35910@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35911
35912@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35913@anchor{step with signal packet}
35914@cindex @samp{S} packet
35915Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35916requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35917
35918This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35919packet}.
35920
35921Reply:
35922@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35923
35924@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35925@cindex @samp{t} packet
35926Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35927@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35928There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35929
35930@item T @var{thread-id}
35931@cindex @samp{T} packet
35932Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35933
35934Reply:
35935@table @samp
35936@item OK
35937thread is still alive
35938@item E @var{NN}
35939thread is dead
35940@end table
35941
35942@item v
35943Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35944up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35945
35946@item vAttach;@var{pid}
35947@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35948Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35949The process ID is a
35950hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35951threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35952attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35953
35954@c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35955@c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35956@c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35957@c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35958@c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35959@c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35960@c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35961@c stopping or restarting threads.
35962
35963This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35964
35965Reply:
35966@table @samp
35967@item E @var{nn}
35968for an error
35969@item @r{Any stop packet}
35970for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35971@item OK
35972for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35973@end table
35974
35975@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35976@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35977@anchor{vCont packet}
35978Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35979
35980For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35981@var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35982remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35983syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35984extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35985can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35986@samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35987@var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35988error.
35989
35990Currently supported actions are:
35991
35992@table @samp
35993@item c
35994Continue.
35995@item C @var{sig}
35996Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35997@item s
35998Step.
35999@item S @var{sig}
36000Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36001@item t
36002Stop.
36003@item r @var{start},@var{end}
36004Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36005addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36006The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36007of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36008a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36009
36010If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36011becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36012single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36013jumps to @var{start}).
36014
36015(A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36016the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36017in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36018
36019@end table
36020
36021The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36022@samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36023not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36024
36025The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36026(@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36027A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36028When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36029the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36030signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36031as an implementation detail.
36032
36033The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36034@samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36035the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36036stopped.
36037
36038@emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36039@value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36040the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36041
36042The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36043multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36044
36045Reply:
36046@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36047
36048@item vCont?
36049@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36050Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36051
36052Reply:
36053@table @samp
36054@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36055The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36056command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36057@item @w{}
36058The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36059@end table
36060
36061@anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36062@item vCtrlC
36063@cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36064Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36065terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36066(@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36067while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36068@xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36069variant.
36070
36071Reply:
36072@table @samp
36073@item E @var{nn}
36074for an error
36075@item OK
36076for success
36077@end table
36078
36079@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36080@cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36081Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36082see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36083
36084@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36085@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36086Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36087@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36088its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36089flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36090Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36091together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36092stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36093packet is received.
36094
36095Reply:
36096@table @samp
36097@item OK
36098for success
36099@item E @var{NN}
36100for an error
36101@end table
36102
36103@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36104@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36105Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36106is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36107packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36108@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36109not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36110(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36111have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36112@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36113neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36114target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36115
36116
36117Reply:
36118@table @samp
36119@item OK
36120for success
36121@item E.memtype
36122for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36123@item E @var{NN}
36124for an error
36125@end table
36126
36127@item vFlashDone
36128@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36129Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36130The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36131@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36132@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36133regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36134request is completed.
36135
36136@item vKill;@var{pid}
36137@cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36138@anchor{vKill packet}
36139Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36140hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36141preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36142supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36143
36144Reply:
36145@table @samp
36146@item E @var{nn}
36147for an error
36148@item OK
36149for success
36150@end table
36151
36152@item vMustReplyEmpty
36153@cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36154The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36155string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36156incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36157
36158The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36159@command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36160packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36161If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36162packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36163other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36164
36165@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36166@cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36167Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36168command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36169@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36170(e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36171state.
36172
36173@c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36174
36175This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36176
36177Reply:
36178@table @samp
36179@item E @var{nn}
36180for an error
36181@item @r{Any stop packet}
36182for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36183@end table
36184
36185@item vStopped
36186@cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36187@xref{Notification Packets}.
36188
36189@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36190@anchor{X packet}
36191@cindex @samp{X} packet
36192Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36193Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36194units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36195@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36196
36197Reply:
36198@table @samp
36199@item OK
36200for success
36201@item E @var{NN}
36202for an error
36203@end table
36204
36205@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36206@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36207@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36208@cindex @samp{z} packet
36209@cindex @samp{Z} packets
36210Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36211watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36212
36213Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36214separately.
36215
36216@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36217for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36218remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36219@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36220avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36221be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36222
36223@item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36224@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36225@cindex @samp{z0} packet
36226@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36227Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36228@var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36229
36230A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36231@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36232@var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36233breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36234@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36235architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36236(@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36237architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36238@var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36239conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36240the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36241consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36242reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36243
36244See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36245for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36246
36247The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36248concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36249
36250@table @samp
36251
36252@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36253@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36254actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36255
36256@end table
36257
36258The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36259run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36260The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36261nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36262continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36263Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36264separators. Each expression has the following form:
36265
36266@table @samp
36267
36268@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36269@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36270actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36271
36272@end table
36273
36274@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36275code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36276overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36277target, is not defined.}
36278
36279Reply:
36280@table @samp
36281@item OK
36282success
36283@item @w{}
36284not supported
36285@item E @var{NN}
36286for an error
36287@end table
36288
36289@item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36290@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36291@cindex @samp{z1} packet
36292@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36293Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36294address @var{addr}.
36295
36296A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36297dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36298@var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36299same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36300
36301@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36302movement.}
36303
36304Reply:
36305@table @samp
36306@item OK
36307success
36308@item @w{}
36309not supported
36310@item E @var{NN}
36311for an error
36312@end table
36313
36314@item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36315@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36316@cindex @samp{z2} packet
36317@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36318Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36319The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36320
36321Reply:
36322@table @samp
36323@item OK
36324success
36325@item @w{}
36326not supported
36327@item E @var{NN}
36328for an error
36329@end table
36330
36331@item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36332@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36333@cindex @samp{z3} packet
36334@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36335Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36336The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36337
36338Reply:
36339@table @samp
36340@item OK
36341success
36342@item @w{}
36343not supported
36344@item E @var{NN}
36345for an error
36346@end table
36347
36348@item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36349@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36350@cindex @samp{z4} packet
36351@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36352Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36353The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36354
36355Reply:
36356@table @samp
36357@item OK
36358success
36359@item @w{}
36360not supported
36361@item E @var{NN}
36362for an error
36363@end table
36364
36365@end table
36366
36367@node Stop Reply Packets
36368@section Stop Reply Packets
36369@cindex stop reply packets
36370
36371The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36372@samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36373receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36374and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36375when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36376number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36377@value{GDBN} source code.
36378
36379In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36380such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36381notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36382
36383As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36384reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36385syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36386components.
36387
36388@table @samp
36389
36390@item S @var{AA}
36391The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36392number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36393@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36394
36395@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36396@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36397The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36398number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36399@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36400and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36401round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36402this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36403
36404@itemize @bullet
36405@item
36406If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36407corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36408series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36409two-digit hex number.
36410
36411@item
36412If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36413the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36414
36415@item
36416If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36417the core on which the stop event was detected.
36418
36419@item
36420If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36421specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36422reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36423signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36424
36425@item
36426Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36427and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36428future.
36429@end itemize
36430
36431The currently defined stop reasons are:
36432
36433@table @samp
36434@item watch
36435@itemx rwatch
36436@itemx awatch
36437The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36438hex.
36439
36440@item syscall_entry
36441@itemx syscall_return
36442The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36443syscall number, in hex.
36444
36445@cindex shared library events, remote reply
36446@item library
36447The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36448@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36449list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36450
36451@cindex replay log events, remote reply
36452@item replaylog
36453The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36454logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36455beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36456will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36457for more information.
36458
36459@item swbreak
36460@anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36461The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36462irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36463breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36464part must be left empty.
36465
36466On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36467breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36468breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36469responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36470address.
36471
36472This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36473did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36474appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36475remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36476indicating support.
36477
36478This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36479
36480@item hwbreak
36481The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36482The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36483
36484The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36485apply.
36486
36487@cindex fork events, remote reply
36488@item fork
36489The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36490is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36491@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36492field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36493fork events.
36494
36495This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36496did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36497appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36498remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36499indicating support.
36500
36501@cindex vfork events, remote reply
36502@item vfork
36503The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36504is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36505@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36506field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36507vfork events.
36508
36509This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36510did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36511appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36512remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36513indicating support.
36514
36515@cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36516@item vforkdone
36517The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36518has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36519address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36520shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36521applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36522
36523This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36524did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36525appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36526remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36527indicating support.
36528
36529@cindex exec events, remote reply
36530@item exec
36531The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36532is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36533This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36534
36535This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36536did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36537appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36538remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36539indicating support.
36540
36541@cindex thread create event, remote reply
36542@anchor{thread create event}
36543@item create
36544The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36545is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36546(@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36547@value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36548also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36549@var{r} part is ignored.
36550
36551@end table
36552
36553@item W @var{AA}
36554@itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36555The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36556applicable to certain targets.
36557
36558The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36559exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36560support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36561extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36562hex strings.
36563
36564@item X @var{AA}
36565@itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36566The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36567
36568The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36569terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36570support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36571extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36572hex strings.
36573
36574@anchor{thread exit event}
36575@cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36576@item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36577
36578The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36579should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36580@ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36581@var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36582
36583@item N
36584There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36585though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36586example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
365872. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36588subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36589alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36590executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36591that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36592sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36593@value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36594@samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36595also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36596support.
36597
36598@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36599@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36600written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36601while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36602for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36603
36604@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36605@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36606be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36607correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36608@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36609system calls.
36610
36611@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36612this very system call.
36613
36614The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36615call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36616with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36617reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36618or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36619Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36620
36621@end table
36622
36623@node General Query Packets
36624@section General Query Packets
36625@cindex remote query requests
36626
36627Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36628packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36629query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36630sending information to and from the stub.
36631
36632The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36633indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36634@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36635definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36636conventions:
36637
36638@itemize @bullet
36639@item
36640The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36641@item
36642Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36643letter.
36644@item
36645The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36646lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36647the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36648foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36649@end itemize
36650
36651The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36652parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36653separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36654full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36655in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36656with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36657packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36658for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36659are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36660existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36661packet.}.
36662
36663Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36664has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36665explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36666templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36667@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36668
36669Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36670
36671@table @samp
36672
36673@item QAgent:1
36674@itemx QAgent:0
36675Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36676delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36677
36678@item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36679@cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36680Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36681target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36682pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36683@samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36684@samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36685indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36686indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36687own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36688insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36689
36690@item qC
36691@cindex current thread, remote request
36692@cindex @samp{qC} packet
36693Return the current thread ID.
36694
36695Reply:
36696@table @samp
36697@item QC @var{thread-id}
36698Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36699@ref{thread-id syntax}.
36700@item @r{(anything else)}
36701Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36702@end table
36703
36704@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36705@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36706@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36707@anchor{qCRC packet}
36708Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36709IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36710significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36711@code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36712
36713@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36714files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36715Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36716separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36717significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36718detect trailing zeros.
36719
36720Reply:
36721@table @samp
36722@item E @var{NN}
36723An error (such as memory fault)
36724@item C @var{crc32}
36725The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36726@end table
36727
36728@item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36729@cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36730@cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36731Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36732of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36733to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36734debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36735of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36736processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36737with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36738randomization.
36739
36740This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36741
36742Reply:
36743@table @samp
36744@item OK
36745The request succeeded.
36746
36747@item E @var{nn}
36748An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36749
36750@item @w{}
36751An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36752by the stub.
36753@end table
36754
36755This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36756by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36757This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36758address space randomization.
36759
36760@item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36761@cindex startup with shell, remote request
36762@cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36763On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36764shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36765@command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36766used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36767inferior using a shell or not.
36768
36769If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36770to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36771@command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36772values are considered an error.
36773
36774This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36775mode}).
36776
36777Reply:
36778@table @samp
36779@item OK
36780The request succeeded.
36781
36782@item E @var{nn}
36783An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36784@end table
36785
36786This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36787by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36788(@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36789actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36790
36791Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36792command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36793
36794@item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
36795@anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36796@cindex set environment variable, remote request
36797@cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
36798On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
36799will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
36800packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
36801variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
36802environment}).
36803
36804The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36805representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
36806environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
36807represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
36808environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
36809has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
36810not be present.
36811
36812This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36813mode}).
36814
36815Reply:
36816@table @samp
36817@item OK
36818The request succeeded.
36819@end table
36820
36821This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36822by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36823(@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36824actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36825inferior.
36826
36827This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
36828@pxref{set environment}.
36829
36830@item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
36831@anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
36832@cindex unset environment variable, remote request
36833@cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
36834On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
36835before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
36836used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
36837been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
36838
36839The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36840representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
36841
36842This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36843mode}).
36844
36845Reply:
36846@table @samp
36847@item OK
36848The request succeeded.
36849@end table
36850
36851This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36852by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36853(@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36854actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36855inferior.
36856
36857This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
36858@pxref{unset environment}.
36859
36860@item QEnvironmentReset
36861@anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
36862@cindex reset environment, remote request
36863@cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
36864On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
36865environment variables in the remote target before starting the
36866inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
36867variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
36868initially present in the environment). It is sent to
36869@command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36870(@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
36871(@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
36872
36873This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36874mode}).
36875
36876Reply:
36877@table @samp
36878@item OK
36879The request succeeded.
36880@end table
36881
36882This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36883by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36884(@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36885actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36886inferior.
36887
36888@item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
36889@anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
36890@cindex set working directory, remote request
36891@cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
36892This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
36893current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
36894
36895The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
36896representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
36897its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
36898the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
36899directory to its original, empty value.
36900
36901This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36902mode}).
36903
36904Reply:
36905@table @samp
36906@item OK
36907The request succeeded.
36908@end table
36909
36910@item qfThreadInfo
36911@itemx qsThreadInfo
36912@cindex list active threads, remote request
36913@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36914@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36915Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36916may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36917works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36918obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36919be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36920sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36921
36922NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36923
36924Reply:
36925@table @samp
36926@item m @var{thread-id}
36927A single thread ID
36928@item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36929a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36930@item l
36931(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36932@end table
36933
36934In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36935more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36936@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36937ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36938with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36939Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36940fields.
36941
36942@emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36943initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36944mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36945message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36946the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36947
36948@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36949@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36950@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36951Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36952by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36953
36954@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36955thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36956
36957@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36958thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36959information associated with the variable.)
36960
36961@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36962load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36963a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36964object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36965Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36966differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36967
36968Reply:
36969@table @samp
36970@item @var{XX}@dots{}
36971Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36972local storage requested.
36973
36974@item E @var{nn}
36975An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36976
36977@item @w{}
36978An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36979@end table
36980
36981@item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36982@cindex get thread information block address
36983@cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36984Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36985
36986@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36987
36988Reply:
36989@table @samp
36990@item @var{XX}@dots{}
36991Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36992thread information block.
36993
36994@item E @var{nn}
36995An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36996address could not be retrieved.
36997
36998@item @w{}
36999An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37000@end table
37001
37002@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37003Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37004digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37005subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37006number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37007(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37008returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37009
37010Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37011
37012Reply:
37013@table @samp
37014@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37015Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37016returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37017and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37018digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37019is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37020digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37021@end table
37022
37023@item qOffsets
37024@cindex section offsets, remote request
37025@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37026Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37027image.
37028
37029Reply:
37030@table @samp
37031@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37032Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37033Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37034If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37035@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37036segments by the supplied offsets.
37037
37038@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37039@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37040to the @code{Bss} section.}
37041
37042@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37043Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37044contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37045@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37046conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37047@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37048does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37049as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37050kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37051@end table
37052
37053@item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37054@cindex thread information, remote request
37055@cindex @samp{qP} packet
37056Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37057encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37058(@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37059
37060Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37061(see below).
37062
37063Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37064
37065@item QNonStop:1
37066@itemx QNonStop:0
37067@cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37068@cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37069@anchor{QNonStop}
37070Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37071@xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37072
37073Reply:
37074@table @samp
37075@item OK
37076The request succeeded.
37077
37078@item E @var{nn}
37079An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37080
37081@item @w{}
37082An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37083the stub.
37084@end table
37085
37086This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37087by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37088Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37089@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37090
37091@item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37092@itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37093@cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37094@cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37095@anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37096Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37097catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37098
37099For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37100in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37101is listed, every system call should be reported.
37102
37103Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37104still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37105@code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37106report the requested syscalls.
37107
37108Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37109@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37110
37111If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37112kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37113numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37114client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37115
37116Reply:
37117@table @samp
37118@item OK
37119The request succeeded.
37120
37121@item E @var{nn}
37122An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37123
37124@item @w{}
37125An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37126the stub.
37127@end table
37128
37129Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37130command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37131This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37132by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37133
37134@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37135@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37136@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37137@anchor{QPassSignals}
37138Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37139Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37140(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37141strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37142the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37143reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37144combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37145new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37146@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37147
37148Reply:
37149@table @samp
37150@item OK
37151The request succeeded.
37152
37153@item E @var{nn}
37154An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37155
37156@item @w{}
37157An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37158the stub.
37159@end table
37160
37161Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37162command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37163This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37164by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37165
37166@item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37167@cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37168@cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37169@anchor{QProgramSignals}
37170Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37171Others should be silently discarded.
37172
37173In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37174signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37175example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37176stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37177@value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37178by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37179signals.
37180
37181This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37182resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37183
37184Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37185(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37186strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37187@samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37188@samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37189
37190Reply:
37191@table @samp
37192@item OK
37193The request succeeded.
37194
37195@item E @var{nn}
37196An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37197
37198@item @w{}
37199An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37200by the stub.
37201@end table
37202
37203Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37204command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37205This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37206by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37207
37208@anchor{QThreadEvents}
37209@item QThreadEvents:1
37210@itemx QThreadEvents:0
37211@cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37212@cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37213
37214Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37215reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37216event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37217non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37218synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37219exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37220forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37221same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37222stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37223its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37224
37225Reply:
37226@table @samp
37227@item OK
37228The request succeeded.
37229
37230@item E @var{nn}
37231An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37232
37233@item @w{}
37234An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37235the stub.
37236@end table
37237
37238Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37239command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37240
37241@item qRcmd,@var{command}
37242@cindex execute remote command, remote request
37243@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37244@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37245execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37246string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37247with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37248packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37249stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37250
37251Reply:
37252@table @samp
37253@item OK
37254A command response with no output.
37255@item @var{OUTPUT}
37256A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37257@item E @var{NN}
37258Indicate a badly formed request.
37259@item @w{}
37260An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37261@end table
37262
37263(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37264command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37265conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37266packets.)
37267
37268@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37269@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37270@ifnotinfo
37271@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37272@end ifnotinfo
37273@cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37274@anchor{qSearch memory}
37275Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37276Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37277@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37278
37279Reply:
37280@table @samp
37281@item 0
37282The pattern was not found.
37283@item 1,address
37284The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37285@item E @var{NN}
37286A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37287@item @w{}
37288An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37289@end table
37290
37291@item QStartNoAckMode
37292@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37293@anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37294Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37295protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37296
37297Reply:
37298@table @samp
37299@item OK
37300The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37301@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37302but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37303@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37304@item @w{}
37305An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37306@end table
37307
37308@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37309@cindex supported packets, remote query
37310@cindex features of the remote protocol
37311@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37312@anchor{qSupported}
37313Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37314query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37315@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37316features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37317at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37318packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37319high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37320be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37321stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37322automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37323reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37324unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37325helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37326versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37327
37328Reply:
37329@table @samp
37330@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37331The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37332depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37333possible forms).
37334@item @w{}
37335An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37336or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37337@end table
37338
37339The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37340@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37341are:
37342
37343@table @samp
37344@item @var{name}=@var{value}
37345The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37346with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37347on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37348@item @var{name}+
37349The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37350need an associated value.
37351@item @var{name}-
37352The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37353@item @var{name}?
37354The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37355@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37356needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37357but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37358@end table
37359
37360Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37361supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37362request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37363state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37364a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37365
37366The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37367are defined:
37368
37369@table @samp
37370@item multiprocess
37371This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37372extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37373extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37374including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37375@xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37376
37377@item xmlRegisters
37378This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37379description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37380specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37381description.
37382
37383@item qRelocInsn
37384This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37385@samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37386instruction reply packet}).
37387
37388@item swbreak
37389This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37390reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37391
37392@item hwbreak
37393This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37394reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37395
37396@item fork-events
37397This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37398extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37399extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37400including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37401
37402@item vfork-events
37403This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37404extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37405extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37406including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37407
37408@item exec-events
37409This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37410extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37411extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37412including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37413
37414@item vContSupported
37415This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37416supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37417@end table
37418
37419Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37420@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37421packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37422versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37423for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37424advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37425improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37426an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37427of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37428describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37429all the features it supports.
37430
37431Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37432responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37433
37434Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37435should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37436require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37437form response.
37438
37439Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37440@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37441in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37442stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37443
37444Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37445mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37446architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37447about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37448stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37449
37450These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37451
37452@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37453@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37454@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37455@item Feature Name
37456@tab Value Required
37457@tab Default
37458@tab Probe Allowed
37459
37460@item @samp{PacketSize}
37461@tab Yes
37462@tab @samp{-}
37463@tab No
37464
37465@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37466@tab No
37467@tab @samp{-}
37468@tab Yes
37469
37470@item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37471@tab No
37472@tab @samp{-}
37473@tab Yes
37474
37475@item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37476@tab No
37477@tab @samp{-}
37478@tab Yes
37479
37480@item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37481@tab No
37482@tab @samp{-}
37483@tab Yes
37484
37485@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37486@tab No
37487@tab @samp{-}
37488@tab Yes
37489
37490@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37491@tab No
37492@tab @samp{-}
37493@tab Yes
37494
37495@item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37496@tab No
37497@tab @samp{-}
37498@tab Yes
37499
37500@item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37501@tab No
37502@tab @samp{-}
37503@tab No
37504
37505@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37506@tab No
37507@tab @samp{-}
37508@tab Yes
37509
37510@item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37511@tab No
37512@tab @samp{-}
37513@tab Yes
37514
37515@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37516@tab No
37517@tab @samp{-}
37518@tab Yes
37519
37520@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37521@tab No
37522@tab @samp{-}
37523@tab Yes
37524
37525@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37526@tab No
37527@tab @samp{-}
37528@tab Yes
37529
37530@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37531@tab No
37532@tab @samp{-}
37533@tab Yes
37534
37535@item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37536@tab No
37537@tab @samp{-}
37538@tab Yes
37539
37540@item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37541@tab No
37542@tab @samp{-}
37543@tab Yes
37544
37545@item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37546@tab No
37547@tab @samp{-}
37548@tab Yes
37549
37550@item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37551@tab No
37552@tab @samp{-}
37553@tab Yes
37554
37555@item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37556@tab Yes
37557@tab @samp{-}
37558@tab Yes
37559
37560@item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37561@tab Yes
37562@tab @samp{-}
37563@tab Yes
37564
37565@item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37566@tab Yes
37567@tab @samp{-}
37568@tab Yes
37569
37570@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37571@tab Yes
37572@tab @samp{-}
37573@tab Yes
37574
37575@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37576@tab Yes
37577@tab @samp{-}
37578@tab Yes
37579
37580@item @samp{QNonStop}
37581@tab No
37582@tab @samp{-}
37583@tab Yes
37584
37585@item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37586@tab No
37587@tab @samp{-}
37588@tab Yes
37589
37590@item @samp{QPassSignals}
37591@tab No
37592@tab @samp{-}
37593@tab Yes
37594
37595@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37596@tab No
37597@tab @samp{-}
37598@tab Yes
37599
37600@item @samp{multiprocess}
37601@tab No
37602@tab @samp{-}
37603@tab No
37604
37605@item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37606@tab No
37607@tab @samp{-}
37608@tab No
37609
37610@item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37611@tab No
37612@tab @samp{-}
37613@tab No
37614
37615@item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37616@tab No
37617@tab @samp{-}
37618@tab No
37619
37620@item @samp{ReverseStep}
37621@tab No
37622@tab @samp{-}
37623@tab No
37624
37625@item @samp{TracepointSource}
37626@tab No
37627@tab @samp{-}
37628@tab No
37629
37630@item @samp{QAgent}
37631@tab No
37632@tab @samp{-}
37633@tab No
37634
37635@item @samp{QAllow}
37636@tab No
37637@tab @samp{-}
37638@tab No
37639
37640@item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37641@tab No
37642@tab @samp{-}
37643@tab No
37644
37645@item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37646@tab No
37647@tab @samp{-}
37648@tab No
37649
37650@item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37651@tab No
37652@tab @samp{-}
37653@tab No
37654
37655@item @samp{tracenz}
37656@tab No
37657@tab @samp{-}
37658@tab No
37659
37660@item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37661@tab No
37662@tab @samp{-}
37663@tab No
37664
37665@item @samp{swbreak}
37666@tab No
37667@tab @samp{-}
37668@tab No
37669
37670@item @samp{hwbreak}
37671@tab No
37672@tab @samp{-}
37673@tab No
37674
37675@item @samp{fork-events}
37676@tab No
37677@tab @samp{-}
37678@tab No
37679
37680@item @samp{vfork-events}
37681@tab No
37682@tab @samp{-}
37683@tab No
37684
37685@item @samp{exec-events}
37686@tab No
37687@tab @samp{-}
37688@tab No
37689
37690@item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37691@tab No
37692@tab @samp{-}
37693@tab No
37694
37695@item @samp{no-resumed}
37696@tab No
37697@tab @samp{-}
37698@tab No
37699
37700@end multitable
37701
37702These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37703
37704@table @samp
37705@cindex packet size, remote protocol
37706@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37707The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37708length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37709transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37710data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37711There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37712stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37713byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37714@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37715
37716@item qXfer:auxv:read
37717The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37718(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37719
37720@item qXfer:btrace:read
37721The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37722packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37723
37724@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37725The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37726packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37727
37728@item qXfer:exec-file:read
37729The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37730(@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37731
37732@item qXfer:features:read
37733The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37734(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37735
37736@item qXfer:libraries:read
37737The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37738(@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37739
37740@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37741The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37742(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37743
37744@item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37745The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37746@samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37747(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37748
37749@item qXfer:memory-map:read
37750The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37751(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37752
37753@item qXfer:sdata:read
37754The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37755(@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37756
37757@item qXfer:spu:read
37758The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37759(@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37760
37761@item qXfer:spu:write
37762The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37763(@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37764
37765@item qXfer:siginfo:read
37766The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37767(@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37768
37769@item qXfer:siginfo:write
37770The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37771(@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37772
37773@item qXfer:threads:read
37774The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37775(@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37776
37777@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37778The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37779packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37780
37781@item qXfer:uib:read
37782The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37783packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37784
37785@item qXfer:fdpic:read
37786The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37787packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37788
37789@item QNonStop
37790The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37791(@pxref{QNonStop}).
37792
37793@item QCatchSyscalls
37794The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37795(@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37796
37797@item QPassSignals
37798The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37799(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37800
37801@item QStartNoAckMode
37802The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37803prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37804
37805@item multiprocess
37806@anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37807@cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37808The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37809protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37810thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37811add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37812replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37813syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37814debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37815multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37816indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37817
37818@item qXfer:osdata:read
37819The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37820((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37821
37822@item ConditionalBreakpoints
37823The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37824defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37825when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37826
37827@item ConditionalTracepoints
37828The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37829for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37830
37831@item ReverseContinue
37832The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37833(@pxref{bc}).
37834
37835@item ReverseStep
37836The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37837(@pxref{bs}).
37838
37839@item TracepointSource
37840The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37841the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37842
37843@item QAgent
37844The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37845
37846@item QAllow
37847The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37848
37849@item QDisableRandomization
37850The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37851
37852@item StaticTracepoint
37853@cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37854The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37855
37856@item InstallInTrace
37857@anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37858The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37859
37860@item EnableDisableTracepoints
37861The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37862@samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37863to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37864
37865@item QTBuffer:size
37866The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37867packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37868
37869@item tracenz
37870@cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37871The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37872See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37873
37874@item BreakpointCommands
37875@cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37876The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37877rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37878
37879@item Qbtrace:off
37880The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37881
37882@item Qbtrace:bts
37883The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37884
37885@item Qbtrace:pt
37886The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37887
37888@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37889The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37890
37891@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37892The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37893
37894@item swbreak
37895The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37896breakpoints.
37897
37898@item hwbreak
37899The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37900breakpoints.
37901
37902@item fork-events
37903The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37904
37905@item vfork-events
37906The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37907and vforkdone events.
37908
37909@item exec-events
37910The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37911
37912@item vContSupported
37913The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37914@samp{vCont?} packet.
37915
37916@item QThreadEvents
37917The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37918
37919@item no-resumed
37920The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37921
37922@end table
37923
37924@item qSymbol::
37925@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37926@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37927Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37928requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37929
37930Reply:
37931@table @samp
37932@item OK
37933The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37934@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37935The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37936@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37937@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37938below.
37939@end table
37940
37941@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37942Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37943
37944@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37945target has previously requested.
37946
37947@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37948@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37949will be empty.
37950
37951Reply:
37952@table @samp
37953@item OK
37954The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37955@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37956The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37957encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37958(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37959@end table
37960
37961@item qTBuffer
37962@itemx QTBuffer
37963@itemx QTDisconnected
37964@itemx QTDP
37965@itemx QTDPsrc
37966@itemx QTDV
37967@itemx qTfP
37968@itemx qTfV
37969@itemx QTFrame
37970@itemx qTMinFTPILen
37971
37972@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37973
37974@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37975@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37976@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37977Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37978attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37979for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37980string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37981for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37982displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37983examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37984@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37985
37986Reply:
37987@table @samp
37988@item @var{XX}@dots{}
37989Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37990comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37991the thread's attributes.
37992@end table
37993
37994(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37995the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37996conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37997packets.)
37998
37999@item QTNotes
38000@itemx qTP
38001@itemx QTSave
38002@itemx qTsP
38003@itemx qTsV
38004@itemx QTStart
38005@itemx QTStop
38006@itemx QTEnable
38007@itemx QTDisable
38008@itemx QTinit
38009@itemx QTro
38010@itemx qTStatus
38011@itemx qTV
38012@itemx qTfSTM
38013@itemx qTsSTM
38014@itemx qTSTMat
38015@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38016
38017@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38018@cindex read special object, remote request
38019@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38020@anchor{qXfer read}
38021Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38022identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38023starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38024encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38025additional details about what data to access.
38026
38027Reply:
38028@table @samp
38029@item m @var{data}
38030Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38031target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38032it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38033block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38034It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38035request.
38036
38037@item l @var{data}
38038Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38039There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38040have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38041
38042@item l
38043The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38044There is no more data to be read.
38045
38046@item E00
38047The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38048
38049@item E @var{nn}
38050The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38051The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38052
38053@item @w{}
38054An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38055the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38056@end table
38057
38058Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38059@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38060formats, listed above.
38061
38062@table @samp
38063@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38064@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38065Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38066auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38067
38068This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38069by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38070
38071@item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38072@anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38073
38074Return a description of the current branch trace.
38075@xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38076packet may have one of the following values:
38077
38078@table @code
38079@item all
38080Returns all available branch trace.
38081
38082@item new
38083Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38084the last read request.
38085
38086@item delta
38087Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38088block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38089location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38090used to stitch traces together.
38091
38092If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38093@end table
38094
38095This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38096by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38097
38098@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38099@anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38100
38101Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38102@xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38103
38104This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38105by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38106
38107@item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38108@anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38109Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38110a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38111numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38112number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38113filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38114
38115This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38116by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38117
38118@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38119@anchor{qXfer target description read}
38120Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38121annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38122always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38123
38124This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38125by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38126
38127@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38128@anchor{qXfer library list read}
38129Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38130The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38131(@pxref{qXfer read}).
38132
38133Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38134not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38135the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38136
38137This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38138by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38139
38140@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38141@anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38142Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38143platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38144of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38145stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38146by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38147(@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38148
38149This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38150@value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38151
38152This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38153by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38154
38155If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38156packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38157contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38158arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38159
38160@table @code
38161@item start=@var{address}
38162A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38163link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38164then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38165chosen as the starting point.
38166
38167@item prev=@var{address}
38168A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38169link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38170specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38171the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38172exists prior to the starting point.
38173
38174@end table
38175
38176Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38177ignored.
38178
38179@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38180@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38181Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38182annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38183(@pxref{qXfer read}).
38184
38185This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38186by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38187
38188@item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38189@anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38190
38191Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38192information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38193be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38194Action Lists}.
38195
38196This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38197by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38198(@pxref{qSupported}).
38199
38200@item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38201@anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38202Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38203system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38204empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38205
38206This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38207by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38208(@pxref{qSupported}).
38209
38210@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38211@anchor{qXfer spu read}
38212Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38213annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38214@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38215in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38216in that context to be accessed.
38217
38218This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38219by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38220(@pxref{qSupported}).
38221
38222@item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38223@anchor{qXfer threads read}
38224Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38225annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38226(@pxref{qXfer read}).
38227
38228This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38229by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38230
38231@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38232@anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38233
38234Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38235@xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38236@samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38237
38238This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38239by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38240
38241@item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38242@anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38243
38244Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38245on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38246
38247This packet is not probed by default.
38248
38249@item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38250@anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38251Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38252annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38253executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38254
38255This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38256by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38257
38258@item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38259@anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38260Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38261@xref{Operating System Information}.
38262
38263@end table
38264
38265@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38266@cindex write data into object, remote request
38267@anchor{qXfer write}
38268Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38269identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38270into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38271written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38272is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38273to access.
38274
38275Reply:
38276@table @samp
38277@item @var{nn}
38278@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38279This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38280
38281@item E00
38282The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38283
38284@item E @var{nn}
38285The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38286The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38287
38288@item @w{}
38289An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38290recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38291@end table
38292
38293Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38294@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38295formats, listed above.
38296
38297@table @samp
38298@item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38299@anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38300Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38301The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38302empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38303
38304This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38305by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38306(@pxref{qSupported}).
38307
38308@item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38309@anchor{qXfer spu write}
38310Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38311annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38312@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38313in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38314in that context to be accessed.
38315
38316This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38317by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38318@end table
38319
38320@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38321Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38322not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38323@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38324must respond with an empty packet.
38325
38326@item qAttached:@var{pid}
38327@cindex query attached, remote request
38328@cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38329Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38330existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38331protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38332@var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38333process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38334the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38335
38336This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38337should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38338the @code{quit} command.
38339
38340Reply:
38341@table @samp
38342@item 1
38343The remote server attached to an existing process.
38344@item 0
38345The remote server created a new process.
38346@item E @var{NN}
38347A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38348@end table
38349
38350@item Qbtrace:bts
38351Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38352
38353Reply:
38354@table @samp
38355@item OK
38356Branch tracing has been enabled.
38357@item E.errtext
38358A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38359@end table
38360
38361@item Qbtrace:pt
38362Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38363
38364Reply:
38365@table @samp
38366@item OK
38367Branch tracing has been enabled.
38368@item E.errtext
38369A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38370@end table
38371
38372@item Qbtrace:off
38373Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38374
38375Reply:
38376@table @samp
38377@item OK
38378Branch tracing has been disabled.
38379@item E.errtext
38380A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38381@end table
38382
38383@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38384Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38385btrace recording method in bts format.
38386
38387Reply:
38388@table @samp
38389@item OK
38390The ring buffer size has been set.
38391@item E.errtext
38392A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38393@end table
38394
38395@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38396Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38397btrace recording method in pt format.
38398
38399Reply:
38400@table @samp
38401@item OK
38402The ring buffer size has been set.
38403@item E.errtext
38404A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38405@end table
38406
38407@end table
38408
38409@node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38410@section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38411
38412This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38413target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38414details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38415
38416@menu
38417* ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38418* MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38419@end menu
38420
38421@node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38422@subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38423
38424@menu
38425* ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38426@end menu
38427
38428@node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38429@subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38430@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38431
38432These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38433
38434@table @r
38435
38436@item 2
3843716-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38438
38439@item 3
3844032-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38441
38442@item 4
3844332-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38444
38445@end table
38446
38447@node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38448@subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38449
38450@menu
38451* MIPS Register packet Format::
38452* MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38453@end menu
38454
38455@node MIPS Register packet Format
38456@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38457@cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38458
38459The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38460In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38461sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38462to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38463byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38464most-significant -- least-significant.
38465
38466@table @r
38467
38468@item MIPS32
38469All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
3847032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38471registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38472
38473@item MIPS64
38474All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38475thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38476as @code{MIPS32}.
38477
38478@end table
38479
38480@node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38481@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38482@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38483
38484These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38485
38486@table @r
38487
38488@item 2
3848916-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38490
38491@item 3
3849216-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38493
38494@item 4
3849532-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38496
38497@item 5
3849832-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38499
38500@end table
38501
38502@node Tracepoint Packets
38503@section Tracepoint Packets
38504@cindex tracepoint packets
38505@cindex packets, tracepoint
38506
38507Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38508tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38509
38510@table @samp
38511
38512@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38513@cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38514Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38515is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38516the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38517count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38518then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38519the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38520for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38521tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38522by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38523encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38524further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38525actions.
38526
38527Replies:
38528@table @samp
38529@item OK
38530The packet was understood and carried out.
38531@item qRelocInsn
38532@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38533@item @w{}
38534The packet was not recognized.
38535@end table
38536
38537@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38538Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38539@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38540this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38541another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38542trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38543specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38544
38545In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38546can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38547is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38548actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38549taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38550@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38551tracepoint actions.
38552
38553The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38554actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38555following forms:
38556
38557@table @samp
38558
38559@item R @var{mask}
38560Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38561a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38562@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38563zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38564not fit in a 32-bit word.
38565
38566@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38567Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38568number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38569@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38570address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38571@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38572values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38573
38574@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38575Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38576it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38577@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38578two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38579in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38580packet).
38581
38582@end table
38583
38584Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38585packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38586length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38587action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38588actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38589must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38590``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38591separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38592
38593Replies:
38594@table @samp
38595@item OK
38596The packet was understood and carried out.
38597@item qRelocInsn
38598@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38599@item @w{}
38600The packet was not recognized.
38601@end table
38602
38603@item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38604@cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38605Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38606This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38607originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38608is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38609tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38610@var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38611
38612@var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38613string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38614This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38615fit in a single packet.
38616@c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38617@c tracepoint descriptions section.
38618
38619The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38620@samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38621@value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38622list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38623
38624The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38625report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38626query packets.
38627
38628Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38629if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38630Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38631much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38632tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38633the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38634could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38635be found.
38636
38637@item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38638@cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38639@cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38640Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38641value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38642and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38643the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38644target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38645mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38646if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38647@value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38648@samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38649hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38650variable.
38651
38652@item QTFrame:@var{n}
38653@cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38654Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38655register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38656request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38657
38658A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38659requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38660without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38661one of the following forms:
38662
38663@table @samp
38664@item F @var{f}
38665The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38666@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38667was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38668
38669@item T @var{t}
38670The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38671@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38672
38673@end table
38674
38675@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38676Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38677currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38678@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38679
38680@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38681Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38682currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38683is a hexadecimal number.
38684
38685@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38686Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38687currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38688and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38689numbers.
38690
38691@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38692Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38693frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38694
38695@item qTMinFTPILen
38696@cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38697This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38698tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38699the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38700it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38701the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38702system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38703arrange for that.
38704
38705Replies:
38706
38707@table @samp
38708@item 0
38709The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38710@item @var{length}
38711The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38712is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38713of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38714regardless of size.
38715@item E
38716An error has occurred.
38717@item @w{}
38718An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38719@end table
38720
38721@item QTStart
38722@cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38723Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38724tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38725@samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38726instruction reply packet}).
38727
38728@item QTStop
38729@cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38730End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38731
38732@item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38733@anchor{QTEnable}
38734@cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38735Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38736experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38737of data from it will resume.
38738
38739@item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38740@anchor{QTDisable}
38741@cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38742Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38743experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38744@samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38745
38746@item QTinit
38747@cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38748Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38749
38750@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38751@cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38752Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38753will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38754if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38755
38756@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38757containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38758still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38759there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38760
38761@item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38762@cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38763Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38764disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38765continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38766@value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38767
38768@item qTStatus
38769@cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38770Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38771
38772The reply has the form:
38773
38774@table @samp
38775
38776@item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38777@var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38778running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38779optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38780
38781@end table
38782
38783If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38784explanations as one of the optional fields:
38785
38786@table @samp
38787
38788@item tnotrun:0
38789No trace has been run yet.
38790
38791@item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38792The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38793@var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38794stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38795stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38796
38797@item tfull:0
38798The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38799
38800@item tdisconnected:0
38801The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38802
38803@item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38804The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38805
38806@item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38807The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38808string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38809(for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38810is hex encoded.
38811
38812@item tunknown:0
38813The trace stopped for some other reason.
38814
38815@end table
38816
38817Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38818Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38819the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38820numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38821trace.
38822
38823@table @samp
38824
38825@item tframes:@var{n}
38826The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38827
38828@item tcreated:@var{n}
38829The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38830be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38831
38832@item tsize:@var{n}
38833The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38834
38835@item tfree:@var{n}
38836The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38837
38838@item circular:@var{n}
38839The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38840trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38841necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38842and may fill up.
38843
38844@item disconn:@var{n}
38845The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38846tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38847that the trace run will stop.
38848
38849@end table
38850
38851@item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38852@cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38853@cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38854Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38855address @var{addr}.
38856
38857Replies:
38858@table @samp
38859@item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38860The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38861run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38862@code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38863steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38864
38865@end table
38866
38867@item qTV:@var{var}
38868@cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38869@cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38870Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38871
38872Replies:
38873@table @samp
38874@item V@var{value}
38875The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38876value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38877saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38878user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38879different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38880program is running.
38881
38882@item U
38883The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38884if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38885was not collected.
38886@end table
38887
38888@item qTfP
38889@cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38890@itemx qTsP
38891@cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38892These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38893the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38894of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38895to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38896that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38897
38898@item qTfV
38899@cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38900@itemx qTsV
38901@cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38902These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38903target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38904and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38905these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38906trace state variables.
38907
38908@item qTfSTM
38909@itemx qTsSTM
38910@anchor{qTfSTM}
38911@anchor{qTsSTM}
38912@cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38913@cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38914These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38915in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38916first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38917pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38918
38919Reply:
38920@table @samp
38921@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38922A single marker
38923@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38924a comma-separated list of markers
38925@item l
38926(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38927@item E @var{nn}
38928An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38929@item @w{}
38930An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38931stub.
38932@end table
38933
38934The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38935@var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38936
38937In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38938more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38939reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38940query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38941@dfn{last}).
38942
38943@item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38944@anchor{qTSTMat}
38945@cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38946This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38947target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38948syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38949tracepoint markers.
38950
38951@item QTSave:@var{filename}
38952@cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38953This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38954@var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38955as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38956absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38957
38958@item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38959@cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38960Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38961starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38962a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38963The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38964in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38965A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38966available.
38967
38968@item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38969This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38970@var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38971
38972@item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38973@anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38974@cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38975This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38976@var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38977use whatever size it prefers.
38978
38979@item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38980@cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38981This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38982types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38983@var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38984
38985@end table
38986
38987@subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38988When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38989relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38990different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38991enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38992return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38993PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38994of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38995it had executed in the original location.
38996
38997In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38998respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38999packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39000this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39001documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39002descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39003format of the request is:
39004
39005@table @samp
39006@item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39007
39008This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39009to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39010instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39011@var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39012memory starting at @var{to}.
39013@end table
39014
39015Replies:
39016@table @samp
39017@item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39018Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39019the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39020@item E @var{NN}
39021A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39022relocating the instruction.
39023@end table
39024
39025@node Host I/O Packets
39026@section Host I/O Packets
39027@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39028@cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39029
39030The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39031operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39032used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39033filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39034layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39035Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39036protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39037Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39038target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39039Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39040
39041The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39042its arguments. They have this format:
39043
39044@table @samp
39045
39046@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39047@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39048should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39049for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39050the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39051numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39052used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39053hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39054buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39055
39056@end table
39057
39058The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39059
39060@table @samp
39061
39062@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39063@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39064non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39065@var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39066value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39067operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39068binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39069normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39070documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39071@var{attachment}.
39072
39073@item @w{}
39074An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39075
39076@end table
39077
39078These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39079
39080@table @samp
39081@item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39082Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39083return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39084@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39085(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39086of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39087@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39088
39089@item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39090Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39091-1 if an error occurs.
39092
39093@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39094Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39095@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39096relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39097common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39098condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39099returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39100@var{count} was zero.
39101
39102The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39103If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39104attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39105number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39106some characters were escaped.
39107
39108@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39109Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39110to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39111file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39112separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39113packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39114which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39115error occurred.
39116
39117@item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39118Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39119On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39120and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39121If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39122returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39123
39124@item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39125Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39126or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39127
39128@item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39129Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39130the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39131
39132The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39133If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39134attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39135number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39136some characters were escaped.
39137
39138@item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39139Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39140@var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39141@value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39142the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39143inferior(s).
39144
39145If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39146@var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39147the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39148If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39149remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39150operation.
39151
39152@end table
39153
39154@node Interrupts
39155@section Interrupts
39156@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39157@anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39158
39159In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39160@value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39161@code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39162is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39163
39164The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39165mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39166currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39167interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39168@code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39169
39170@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39171transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39172@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39173the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39174transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39175and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39176(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39177@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39178
39179@code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39180When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39181it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39182
39183In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39184(@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39185command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39186reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39187packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39188@code{0x03}.
39189
39190Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39191precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39192implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39193threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39194currently-executing threads and processes.
39195If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39196running program, it should send one of the stop
39197reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39198of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39199for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39200Interrupts received while the
39201program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39202it is resumed next time.
39203
39204@node Notification Packets
39205@section Notification Packets
39206@cindex notification packets
39207@cindex packets, notification
39208
39209The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39210packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39211may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39212present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39213without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39214are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39215is not a problem.
39216
39217A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39218@var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39219and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39220as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39221never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39222receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39223to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39224
39225Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39226colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39227
39228Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39229notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39230timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39231not they understand it.
39232
39233Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39234protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39235future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39236new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39237recipients.
39238
39239(Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39240the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39241transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39242are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39243assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39244
39245Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39246@table @samp
39247@item @var{name}:@var{event}
39248The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39249exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39250carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39251@var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39252@item @var{ack}
39253The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39254acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39255@end table
39256
39257The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39258@value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39259
39260The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39261at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39262appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39263acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39264additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39265previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39266synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39267@value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39268the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39269@value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39270
39271Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39272otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39273expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39274@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39275Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39276the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39277
39278After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39279sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39280stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39281@value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39282stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39283
39284Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39285events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39286normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39287packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39288other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39289normally.
39290
39291If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39292@var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39293At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39294and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39295won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39296received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39297a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39298the process shall be repeated.
39299
39300The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39301following example:
39302@smallexample
39303<- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39304@code{...}
39305-> @code{vStopped}
39306<- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39307-> @code{vStopped}
39308<- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39309-> @code{vStopped}
39310<- @code{OK}
39311@end smallexample
39312
39313The following notifications are defined:
39314@multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39315
39316@item Notification
39317@tab Ack
39318@tab Event
39319@tab Description
39320
39321@item Stop
39322@tab vStopped
39323@tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39324described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39325for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39326@value{GDBN}.
39327@tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39328
39329@end multitable
39330
39331@node Remote Non-Stop
39332@section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39333
39334@value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39335multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39336supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39337@samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39338
39339@value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39340establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39341does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39342must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39343all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39344probe the target state after a mode change.
39345
39346In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39347would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39348asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39349inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39350in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39351mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39352when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39353of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39354affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39355to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39356threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39357
39358In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39359follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39360sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39361sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39362it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39363stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39364subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39365using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39366asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39367If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39368or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39369@samp{OK}.
39370
39371If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39372@samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39373the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39374(@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39375nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39376and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39377breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39378this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39379caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39380opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39381Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39382for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39383necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39384
39385@node Packet Acknowledgment
39386@section Packet Acknowledgment
39387
39388@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39389@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39390By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39391the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39392the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39393This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39394unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39395
39396In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39397TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39398It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39399overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39400@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39401
39402When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39403expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39404and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39405@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39406
39407If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39408no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39409by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39410@pxref{qSupported}.
39411If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39412disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39413(@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39414@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39415Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39416@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39417response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39418
39419Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39420between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39421it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39422connection.
39423Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39424new connection is established,
39425there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39426for the current connection, once disabled.
39427
39428@node Examples
39429@section Examples
39430
39431Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39432does not get any direct output:
39433
39434@smallexample
39435-> @code{R00}
39436<- @code{+}
39437@emph{target restarts}
39438-> @code{?}
39439<- @code{+}
39440<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39441-> @code{+}
39442@end smallexample
39443
39444Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39445
39446@smallexample
39447-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39448<- @code{+}
39449-> @code{s}
39450<- @code{+}
39451@emph{time passes}
39452<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39453-> @code{+}
39454-> @code{g}
39455<- @code{+}
39456<- @code{1455@dots{}}
39457-> @code{+}
39458@end smallexample
39459
39460@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39461@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39462@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39463
39464@menu
39465* File-I/O Overview::
39466* Protocol Basics::
39467* The F Request Packet::
39468* The F Reply Packet::
39469* The Ctrl-C Message::
39470* Console I/O::
39471* List of Supported Calls::
39472* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39473* Constants::
39474* File-I/O Examples::
39475@end menu
39476
39477@node File-I/O Overview
39478@subsection File-I/O Overview
39479@cindex file-i/o overview
39480
39481The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39482target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39483system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39484remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39485actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39486This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39487
39488The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39489It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39490@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39491translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39492protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39493
39494The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39495@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39496or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39497the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39498memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39499the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39500(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39501
39502The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39503the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39504after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39505previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39506request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39507
39508@smallexample
39509(@value{GDBP}) continue
39510 <- target requests 'system call X'
39511 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39512 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39513 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39514 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39515@end smallexample
39516
39517The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39518the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39519named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39520system are not supported by this protocol.
39521
39522File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39523
39524@node Protocol Basics
39525@subsection Protocol Basics
39526@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39527
39528The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39529as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39530@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39531the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39532of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39533This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39534to call the appropriate host system call:
39535
39536@itemize @bullet
39537@item
39538A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39539
39540@item
39541All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39542in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39543pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39544Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39545
39546@end itemize
39547
39548At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39549
39550@itemize @bullet
39551@item
39552If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39553system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39554standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39555expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39556packet.
39557
39558@item
39559@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39560representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39561
39562@item
39563@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39564
39565@item
39566It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39567
39568@item
39569If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39570by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39571target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39572by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39573packet.
39574
39575@end itemize
39576
39577Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39578necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39579
39580@itemize @bullet
39581@item
39582Return value.
39583
39584@item
39585@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39586
39587@item
39588``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39589
39590@end itemize
39591
39592After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39593the latest continue or step action.
39594
39595@node The F Request Packet
39596@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39597@cindex file-i/o request packet
39598@cindex @code{F} request packet
39599
39600The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39601
39602@table @samp
39603@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39604
39605@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39606This is just the name of the function.
39607
39608@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39609Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39610of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39611datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39612of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39613comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39614string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39615
39616@end table
39617
39618
39619
39620@node The F Reply Packet
39621@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39622@cindex file-i/o reply packet
39623@cindex @code{F} reply packet
39624
39625The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39626
39627@table @samp
39628
39629@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39630
39631@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39632
39633@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39634representation.
39635This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39636
39637@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39638case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39639The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39640
39641@smallexample
39642F0,0,C
39643@end smallexample
39644
39645@noindent
39646or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39647
39648@smallexample
39649F-1,4,C
39650@end smallexample
39651
39652@noindent
39653assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39654
39655@end table
39656
39657
39658@node The Ctrl-C Message
39659@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39660@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39661
39662If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39663reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39664the target should behave as if it had
39665gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39666interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39667(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39668packet.
39669
39670It's important for the target to know in which
39671state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39672
39673@itemize @bullet
39674@item
39675The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39676
39677@item
39678The system call on the host has been finished.
39679
39680@end itemize
39681
39682These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39683returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39684call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39685on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39686system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39687as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39688
39689@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39690yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39691@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39692before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39693@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39694The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39695or the full action has been completed.
39696
39697@node Console I/O
39698@subsection Console I/O
39699@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39700
39701By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39702descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39703on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39704(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39705by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
397060 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39707conditions is met:
39708
39709@itemize @bullet
39710@item
39711The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39712@code{read}
39713system call is treated as finished.
39714
39715@item
39716The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39717newline.
39718
39719@item
39720The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39721character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39722
39723@end itemize
39724
39725If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39726the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39727either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39728is stopped at the user's request.
39729
39730
39731@node List of Supported Calls
39732@subsection List of Supported Calls
39733@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39734
39735@menu
39736* open::
39737* close::
39738* read::
39739* write::
39740* lseek::
39741* rename::
39742* unlink::
39743* stat/fstat::
39744* gettimeofday::
39745* isatty::
39746* system::
39747@end menu
39748
39749@node open
39750@unnumberedsubsubsec open
39751@cindex open, file-i/o system call
39752
39753@table @asis
39754@item Synopsis:
39755@smallexample
39756int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39757int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39758@end smallexample
39759
39760@item Request:
39761@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39762
39763@noindent
39764@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39765
39766@table @code
39767@item O_CREAT
39768If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39769rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39770are concerned.
39771
39772@item O_EXCL
39773When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39774an error and open() fails.
39775
39776@item O_TRUNC
39777If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39778writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39779truncated to zero length.
39780
39781@item O_APPEND
39782The file is opened in append mode.
39783
39784@item O_RDONLY
39785The file is opened for reading only.
39786
39787@item O_WRONLY
39788The file is opened for writing only.
39789
39790@item O_RDWR
39791The file is opened for reading and writing.
39792@end table
39793
39794@noindent
39795Other bits are silently ignored.
39796
39797
39798@noindent
39799@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39800
39801@table @code
39802@item S_IRUSR
39803User has read permission.
39804
39805@item S_IWUSR
39806User has write permission.
39807
39808@item S_IRGRP
39809Group has read permission.
39810
39811@item S_IWGRP
39812Group has write permission.
39813
39814@item S_IROTH
39815Others have read permission.
39816
39817@item S_IWOTH
39818Others have write permission.
39819@end table
39820
39821@noindent
39822Other bits are silently ignored.
39823
39824
39825@item Return value:
39826@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39827occurred.
39828
39829@item Errors:
39830
39831@table @code
39832@item EEXIST
39833@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39834
39835@item EISDIR
39836@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39837
39838@item EACCES
39839The requested access is not allowed.
39840
39841@item ENAMETOOLONG
39842@var{pathname} was too long.
39843
39844@item ENOENT
39845A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39846
39847@item ENODEV
39848@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39849
39850@item EROFS
39851@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39852write access was requested.
39853
39854@item EFAULT
39855@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39856
39857@item ENOSPC
39858No space on device to create the file.
39859
39860@item EMFILE
39861The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39862
39863@item ENFILE
39864The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39865has been reached.
39866
39867@item EINTR
39868The call was interrupted by the user.
39869@end table
39870
39871@end table
39872
39873@node close
39874@unnumberedsubsubsec close
39875@cindex close, file-i/o system call
39876
39877@table @asis
39878@item Synopsis:
39879@smallexample
39880int close(int fd);
39881@end smallexample
39882
39883@item Request:
39884@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39885
39886@item Return value:
39887@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39888
39889@item Errors:
39890
39891@table @code
39892@item EBADF
39893@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39894
39895@item EINTR
39896The call was interrupted by the user.
39897@end table
39898
39899@end table
39900
39901@node read
39902@unnumberedsubsubsec read
39903@cindex read, file-i/o system call
39904
39905@table @asis
39906@item Synopsis:
39907@smallexample
39908int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39909@end smallexample
39910
39911@item Request:
39912@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39913
39914@item Return value:
39915On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39916Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39917returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39918
39919@item Errors:
39920
39921@table @code
39922@item EBADF
39923@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39924reading.
39925
39926@item EFAULT
39927@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39928
39929@item EINTR
39930The call was interrupted by the user.
39931@end table
39932
39933@end table
39934
39935@node write
39936@unnumberedsubsubsec write
39937@cindex write, file-i/o system call
39938
39939@table @asis
39940@item Synopsis:
39941@smallexample
39942int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39943@end smallexample
39944
39945@item Request:
39946@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39947
39948@item Return value:
39949On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39950Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39951is returned.
39952
39953@item Errors:
39954
39955@table @code
39956@item EBADF
39957@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39958writing.
39959
39960@item EFAULT
39961@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39962
39963@item EFBIG
39964An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39965host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39966
39967@item ENOSPC
39968No space on device to write the data.
39969
39970@item EINTR
39971The call was interrupted by the user.
39972@end table
39973
39974@end table
39975
39976@node lseek
39977@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39978@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39979
39980@table @asis
39981@item Synopsis:
39982@smallexample
39983long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39984@end smallexample
39985
39986@item Request:
39987@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39988
39989@var{flag} is one of:
39990
39991@table @code
39992@item SEEK_SET
39993The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39994
39995@item SEEK_CUR
39996The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39997bytes.
39998
39999@item SEEK_END
40000The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40001bytes.
40002@end table
40003
40004@item Return value:
40005On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40006the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40007value of -1 is returned.
40008
40009@item Errors:
40010
40011@table @code
40012@item EBADF
40013@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40014
40015@item ESPIPE
40016@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40017
40018@item EINVAL
40019@var{flag} is not a proper value.
40020
40021@item EINTR
40022The call was interrupted by the user.
40023@end table
40024
40025@end table
40026
40027@node rename
40028@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40029@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40030
40031@table @asis
40032@item Synopsis:
40033@smallexample
40034int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40035@end smallexample
40036
40037@item Request:
40038@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40039
40040@item Return value:
40041On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40042
40043@item Errors:
40044
40045@table @code
40046@item EISDIR
40047@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40048directory.
40049
40050@item EEXIST
40051@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40052
40053@item EBUSY
40054@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40055process.
40056
40057@item EINVAL
40058An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40059of itself.
40060
40061@item ENOTDIR
40062A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40063path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40064and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40065
40066@item EFAULT
40067@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40068
40069@item EACCES
40070No access to the file or the path of the file.
40071
40072@item ENAMETOOLONG
40073
40074@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40075
40076@item ENOENT
40077A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40078
40079@item EROFS
40080The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40081
40082@item ENOSPC
40083The device containing the file has no room for the new
40084directory entry.
40085
40086@item EINTR
40087The call was interrupted by the user.
40088@end table
40089
40090@end table
40091
40092@node unlink
40093@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40094@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40095
40096@table @asis
40097@item Synopsis:
40098@smallexample
40099int unlink(const char *pathname);
40100@end smallexample
40101
40102@item Request:
40103@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40104
40105@item Return value:
40106On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40107
40108@item Errors:
40109
40110@table @code
40111@item EACCES
40112No access to the file or the path of the file.
40113
40114@item EPERM
40115The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40116
40117@item EBUSY
40118The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40119being used by another process.
40120
40121@item EFAULT
40122@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40123
40124@item ENAMETOOLONG
40125@var{pathname} was too long.
40126
40127@item ENOENT
40128A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40129
40130@item ENOTDIR
40131A component of the path is not a directory.
40132
40133@item EROFS
40134The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40135
40136@item EINTR
40137The call was interrupted by the user.
40138@end table
40139
40140@end table
40141
40142@node stat/fstat
40143@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40144@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40145@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40146
40147@table @asis
40148@item Synopsis:
40149@smallexample
40150int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40151int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40152@end smallexample
40153
40154@item Request:
40155@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40156@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40157
40158@item Return value:
40159On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40160
40161@item Errors:
40162
40163@table @code
40164@item EBADF
40165@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40166
40167@item ENOENT
40168A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40169path is an empty string.
40170
40171@item ENOTDIR
40172A component of the path is not a directory.
40173
40174@item EFAULT
40175@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40176
40177@item EACCES
40178No access to the file or the path of the file.
40179
40180@item ENAMETOOLONG
40181@var{pathname} was too long.
40182
40183@item EINTR
40184The call was interrupted by the user.
40185@end table
40186
40187@end table
40188
40189@node gettimeofday
40190@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40191@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40192
40193@table @asis
40194@item Synopsis:
40195@smallexample
40196int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40197@end smallexample
40198
40199@item Request:
40200@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40201
40202@item Return value:
40203On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40204
40205@item Errors:
40206
40207@table @code
40208@item EINVAL
40209@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40210
40211@item EFAULT
40212@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40213@end table
40214
40215@end table
40216
40217@node isatty
40218@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40219@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40220
40221@table @asis
40222@item Synopsis:
40223@smallexample
40224int isatty(int fd);
40225@end smallexample
40226
40227@item Request:
40228@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40229
40230@item Return value:
40231Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40232
40233@item Errors:
40234
40235@table @code
40236@item EINTR
40237The call was interrupted by the user.
40238@end table
40239
40240@end table
40241
40242Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
402431 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40244to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40245would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40246needed.
40247
40248
40249@node system
40250@unnumberedsubsubsec system
40251@cindex system, file-i/o system call
40252
40253@table @asis
40254@item Synopsis:
40255@smallexample
40256int system(const char *command);
40257@end smallexample
40258
40259@item Request:
40260@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40261
40262@item Return value:
40263If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40264available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40265For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40266return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40267command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40268return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40269@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40270
40271@item Errors:
40272
40273@table @code
40274@item EINTR
40275The call was interrupted by the user.
40276@end table
40277
40278@end table
40279
40280@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40281to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40282the host is simplified before it's returned
40283to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40284is discarded, and the return value consists
40285entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40286
40287Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40288by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40289@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40290
40291@table @code
40292@item set remote system-call-allowed
40293@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40294Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40295protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40296
40297@item show remote system-call-allowed
40298@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40299Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40300protocol.
40301@end table
40302
40303@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40304@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40305@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40306
40307@menu
40308* Integral Datatypes::
40309* Pointer Values::
40310* Memory Transfer::
40311* struct stat::
40312* struct timeval::
40313@end menu
40314
40315@node Integral Datatypes
40316@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40317@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40318
40319The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40320@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40321@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40322
40323@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40324implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40325
40326@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40327
40328@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40329in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40330
40331@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40332
40333All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40334structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40335byte order.
40336
40337@node Pointer Values
40338@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40339@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40340
40341Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40342is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40343transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40344are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40345
40346@smallexample
40347@code{1aaf/12}
40348@end smallexample
40349
40350@noindent
40351which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40352The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40353the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40354at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40355
40356@smallexample
40357@code{123456/d}
40358@end smallexample
40359
40360@node Memory Transfer
40361@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40362@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40363
40364Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40365example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40366with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40367this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40368packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40369it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40370data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40371
40372
40373@node struct stat
40374@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40375@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40376
40377The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40378is defined as follows:
40379
40380@smallexample
40381struct stat @{
40382 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40383 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40384 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40385 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40386 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40387 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40388 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40389 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40390 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40391 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40392 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40393 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40394 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40395@};
40396@end smallexample
40397
40398The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40399appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40400structure is of size 64 bytes.
40401
40402The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40403range of values.
40404
40405@table @code
40406
40407@item st_dev
40408A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40409
40410@item st_ino
40411No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40412
40413@item st_mode
40414Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40415bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40416
40417@item st_uid
40418@itemx st_gid
40419@itemx st_rdev
40420No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40421
40422@item st_atime
40423@itemx st_mtime
40424@itemx st_ctime
40425These values have a host and file system dependent
40426accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40427support exact timing values.
40428@end table
40429
40430The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40431responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40432continuing.
40433
40434Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40435representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40436get truncated on the target.
40437
40438@node struct timeval
40439@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40440@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40441
40442The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40443is defined as follows:
40444
40445@smallexample
40446struct timeval @{
40447 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40448 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40449@};
40450@end smallexample
40451
40452The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40453appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40454structure is of size 8 bytes.
40455
40456@node Constants
40457@subsection Constants
40458@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40459
40460The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40461protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40462values before and after the call as needed.
40463
40464@menu
40465* Open Flags::
40466* mode_t Values::
40467* Errno Values::
40468* Lseek Flags::
40469* Limits::
40470@end menu
40471
40472@node Open Flags
40473@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40474@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40475
40476All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40477
40478@smallexample
40479 O_RDONLY 0x0
40480 O_WRONLY 0x1
40481 O_RDWR 0x2
40482 O_APPEND 0x8
40483 O_CREAT 0x200
40484 O_TRUNC 0x400
40485 O_EXCL 0x800
40486@end smallexample
40487
40488@node mode_t Values
40489@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40490@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40491
40492All values are given in octal representation.
40493
40494@smallexample
40495 S_IFREG 0100000
40496 S_IFDIR 040000
40497 S_IRUSR 0400
40498 S_IWUSR 0200
40499 S_IXUSR 0100
40500 S_IRGRP 040
40501 S_IWGRP 020
40502 S_IXGRP 010
40503 S_IROTH 04
40504 S_IWOTH 02
40505 S_IXOTH 01
40506@end smallexample
40507
40508@node Errno Values
40509@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40510@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40511
40512All values are given in decimal representation.
40513
40514@smallexample
40515 EPERM 1
40516 ENOENT 2
40517 EINTR 4
40518 EBADF 9
40519 EACCES 13
40520 EFAULT 14
40521 EBUSY 16
40522 EEXIST 17
40523 ENODEV 19
40524 ENOTDIR 20
40525 EISDIR 21
40526 EINVAL 22
40527 ENFILE 23
40528 EMFILE 24
40529 EFBIG 27
40530 ENOSPC 28
40531 ESPIPE 29
40532 EROFS 30
40533 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40534 EUNKNOWN 9999
40535@end smallexample
40536
40537 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40538 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40539
40540@node Lseek Flags
40541@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40542@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40543
40544@smallexample
40545 SEEK_SET 0
40546 SEEK_CUR 1
40547 SEEK_END 2
40548@end smallexample
40549
40550@node Limits
40551@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40552@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40553
40554All values are given in decimal representation.
40555
40556@smallexample
40557 INT_MIN -2147483648
40558 INT_MAX 2147483647
40559 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40560 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40561 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40562 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40563@end smallexample
40564
40565@node File-I/O Examples
40566@subsection File-I/O Examples
40567@cindex file-i/o examples
40568
40569Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40570address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40571
40572@smallexample
40573<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40574@emph{request memory read from target}
40575-> @code{m1234,6}
40576<- XXXXXX
40577@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40578-> @code{F6}
40579@end smallexample
40580
40581Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40582address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40583
40584@smallexample
40585<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40586@emph{request memory write to target}
40587-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40588@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40589-> @code{F6}
40590@end smallexample
40591
40592Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40593file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40594
40595@smallexample
40596<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40597-> @code{F-1,9}
40598@end smallexample
40599
40600Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40601host is called:
40602
40603@smallexample
40604<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40605-> @code{F-1,4,C}
40606<- @code{T02}
40607@end smallexample
40608
40609Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40610host is called:
40611
40612@smallexample
40613<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40614-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40615<- @code{T02}
40616@end smallexample
40617
40618@node Library List Format
40619@section Library List Format
40620@cindex library list format, remote protocol
40621
40622On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40623same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40624@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40625operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40626platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40627@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40628through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40629packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40630queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40631are loaded.
40632
40633The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40634lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40635associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40636which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40637
40638For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40639library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40640dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40641should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40642section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40643depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40644
40645@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40646library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40647
40648A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40649offset, looks like this:
40650
40651@smallexample
40652<library-list>
40653 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40654 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40655 </library>
40656</library-list>
40657@end smallexample
40658
40659Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40660allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40661
40662@smallexample
40663<library-list>
40664 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40665 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40666 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40667 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40668 </library>
40669</library-list>
40670@end smallexample
40671
40672The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40673
40674@smallexample
40675<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40676<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40677<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40678<!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40679<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40680<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40681<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40682<!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40683<!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40684@end smallexample
40685
40686In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40687single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40688section for each library.
40689
40690@node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40691@section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40692@cindex library list format, remote protocol
40693
40694On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40695(e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40696shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40697more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40698
40699The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40700loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40701target, the following parameters are reported:
40702
40703@itemize @minus
40704@item
40705@code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40706@code{struct link_map}.
40707@item
40708@code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40709(Thread Local Storage) access.
40710@item
40711@code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40712@code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40713memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40714address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40715@item
40716@code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40717@end itemize
40718
40719Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40720@code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40721for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40722
40723@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40724SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40725
40726A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40727looks like this:
40728
40729@smallexample
40730<library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40731 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40732 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40733 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40734 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40735</library-list-svr>
40736@end smallexample
40737
40738The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40739
40740@smallexample
40741<!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40742<!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40743<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40744<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40745<!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40746<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40747<!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40748<!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40749<!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40750@end smallexample
40751
40752@node Memory Map Format
40753@section Memory Map Format
40754@cindex memory map format
40755
40756To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40757memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40758memory map.
40759
40760The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40761(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40762lists memory regions.
40763
40764@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40765memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40766
40767The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40768
40769@smallexample
40770<?xml version="1.0"?>
40771<!DOCTYPE memory-map
40772 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40773 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40774<memory-map>
40775 region...
40776</memory-map>
40777@end smallexample
40778
40779Each region can be either:
40780
40781@itemize
40782
40783@item
40784A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40785bytes from there:
40786
40787@smallexample
40788<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40789@end smallexample
40790
40791
40792@item
40793A region of read-only memory:
40794
40795@smallexample
40796<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40797@end smallexample
40798
40799
40800@item
40801A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40802bytes in length:
40803
40804@smallexample
40805<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40806 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40807</memory>
40808@end smallexample
40809
40810@end itemize
40811
40812Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40813by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40814packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40815
40816The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40817
40818@smallexample
40819<!-- ................................................... -->
40820<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40821<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40822<!-- .................................... .............. -->
40823<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40824<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40825<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40826<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40827<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40828<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40829 and its type, or device. -->
40830<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40831 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40832 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40833 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40834<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40835<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40836<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40837@end smallexample
40838
40839@node Thread List Format
40840@section Thread List Format
40841@cindex thread list format
40842
40843To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40844@value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40845(@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40846the following structure:
40847
40848@smallexample
40849<?xml version="1.0"?>
40850<threads>
40851 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40852 ... description ...
40853 </thread>
40854</threads>
40855@end smallexample
40856
40857Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40858identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40859@samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40860the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40861present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40862of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40863auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
40864is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
40865
40866
40867@node Traceframe Info Format
40868@section Traceframe Info Format
40869@cindex traceframe info format
40870
40871To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40872inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40873memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40874collected in a traceframe.
40875
40876This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40877(@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40878
40879@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40880traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40881
40882The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40883
40884@smallexample
40885<?xml version="1.0"?>
40886<!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40887 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40888 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40889<traceframe-info>
40890 block...
40891</traceframe-info>
40892@end smallexample
40893
40894Each traceframe block can be either:
40895
40896@itemize
40897
40898@item
40899A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40900@var{length} bytes from there:
40901
40902@smallexample
40903<memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40904@end smallexample
40905
40906@item
40907A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40908collected:
40909
40910@smallexample
40911<tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40912@end smallexample
40913
40914@end itemize
40915
40916The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40917
40918@smallexample
40919<!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40920<!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40921
40922<!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40923<!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40924 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40925<!ELEMENT tvar>
40926<!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40927@end smallexample
40928
40929@node Branch Trace Format
40930@section Branch Trace Format
40931@cindex branch trace format
40932
40933In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40934@value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40935represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40936branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40937
40938This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40939(@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40940
40941@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40942traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40943
40944The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40945
40946@smallexample
40947<?xml version="1.0"?>
40948<!DOCTYPE btrace
40949 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40950 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40951<btrace>
40952 block...
40953</btrace>
40954@end smallexample
40955
40956@itemize
40957
40958@item
40959A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40960and ending at @var{end}:
40961
40962@smallexample
40963<block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40964@end smallexample
40965
40966@end itemize
40967
40968The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40969
40970@smallexample
40971<!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40972<!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40973
40974<!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40975<!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40976 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40977
40978<!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40979
40980<!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40981
40982<!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40983<!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40984 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40985 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40986 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40987
40988<!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40989@end smallexample
40990
40991@node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40992@section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40993@cindex branch trace configuration format
40994
40995For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40996configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40997(@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40998
40999The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41000settings for that format. The following information is described:
41001
41002@table @code
41003@item bts
41004This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41005@table @code
41006@item size
41007The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41008@end table
41009@item pt
41010This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41011PT}) format.
41012@table @code
41013@item size
41014The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41015@end table
41016@end table
41017
41018@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41019branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41020
41021The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41022
41023@smallexample
41024<!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41025<!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41026
41027<!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41028<!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41029
41030<!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41031<!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41032@end smallexample
41033
41034@include agentexpr.texi
41035
41036@node Target Descriptions
41037@appendix Target Descriptions
41038@cindex target descriptions
41039
41040One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41041is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41042architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41043a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41044and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41045architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41046vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41047
41048@itemize @bullet
41049@item
41050With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41051the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41052@item
41053Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41054audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41055variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41056@item
41057When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41058at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41059@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41060@end itemize
41061
41062To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41063target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41064actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41065processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41066descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41067
41068@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41069target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41070
41071@menu
41072* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41073* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41074* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41075 descriptions.
41076* Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41077* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41078@end menu
41079
41080@node Retrieving Descriptions
41081@section Retrieving Descriptions
41082
41083Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41084specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41085description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41086protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41087qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41088@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41089XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41090Format}.
41091
41092Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41093If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41094specify a file are:
41095
41096@table @code
41097@cindex set tdesc filename
41098@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41099Read the target description from @var{path}.
41100
41101@cindex unset tdesc filename
41102@item unset tdesc filename
41103Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41104will use the description supplied by the current target.
41105
41106@cindex show tdesc filename
41107@item show tdesc filename
41108Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41109@end table
41110
41111
41112@node Target Description Format
41113@section Target Description Format
41114@cindex target descriptions, XML format
41115
41116A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41117document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41118the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41119means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41120check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41121However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41122their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41123
41124Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41125and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41126sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41127@value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41128target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41129
41130Here is a simple target description:
41131
41132@smallexample
41133<target version="1.0">
41134 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41135</target>
41136@end smallexample
41137
41138@noindent
41139This minimal description only says that the target uses
41140the x86-64 architecture.
41141
41142A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41143optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41144are explained further below.
41145
41146@smallexample
41147<?xml version="1.0"?>
41148<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41149<target version="1.0">
41150 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41151 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41152 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41153 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41154</target>
41155@end smallexample
41156
41157@noindent
41158The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41159breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41160declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41161(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41162useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41163@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41164including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41165revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41166the version mismatch.
41167
41168@subsection Inclusion
41169@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41170@cindex XInclude
41171@ifnotinfo
41172@cindex <xi:include>
41173@end ifnotinfo
41174
41175It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41176several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41177share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41178divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41179the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41180
41181@smallexample
41182<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41183@end smallexample
41184
41185@noindent
41186When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41187the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41188the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41189using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41190@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41191current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41192@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41193original description.
41194
41195@subsection Architecture
41196@cindex <architecture>
41197
41198An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41199
41200@smallexample
41201 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41202@end smallexample
41203
41204@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41205@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41206
41207@subsection OS ABI
41208@cindex @code{<osabi>}
41209
41210This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41211Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41212
41213An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41214
41215@smallexample
41216 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41217@end smallexample
41218
41219@var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41220@w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41221
41222@subsection Compatible Architecture
41223@cindex @code{<compatible>}
41224
41225This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41226Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41227
41228A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41229
41230@smallexample
41231 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41232@end smallexample
41233
41234@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41235@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41236
41237A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41238is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41239given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41240Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41241or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41242in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41243capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41244
41245@smallexample
41246 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41247 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41248@end smallexample
41249
41250@subsection Features
41251@cindex <feature>
41252
41253Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41254system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41255registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41256has this form:
41257
41258@smallexample
41259<feature name="@var{name}">
41260 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41261 @var{reg}@dots{}
41262</feature>
41263@end smallexample
41264
41265@noindent
41266Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41267of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41268knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41269should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41270
41271@subsection Types
41272
41273Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41274interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41275but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41276Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41277Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41278and enum types.
41279
41280Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41281a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41282Types must be defined before they are used.
41283
41284@cindex <vector>
41285Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41286of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41287specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41288@var{count}:
41289
41290@smallexample
41291<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41292@end smallexample
41293
41294@cindex <union>
41295If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41296with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41297@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41298each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41299
41300@smallexample
41301<union id="@var{id}">
41302 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41303 @dots{}
41304</union>
41305@end smallexample
41306
41307@cindex <struct>
41308@cindex <flags>
41309If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41310it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41311A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41312A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41313If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41314specified.
41315
41316Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41317
41318@smallexample
41319<struct id="@var{id}">
41320 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41321 @dots{}
41322</struct>
41323@end smallexample
41324
41325Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41326No implicit padding is added.
41327
41328Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41329
41330@smallexample
41331<struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41332 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41333 @dots{}
41334</struct>
41335@end smallexample
41336
41337@smallexample
41338<flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41339 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41340 @dots{}
41341</flags>
41342@end smallexample
41343
41344The @var{name} value is required.
41345Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41346in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41347Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41348
41349The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41350is optional.
41351The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41352and zero represents the least significant bit.
41353
41354The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41355and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41356
41357Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41358
41359Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41360defining them with @samp{struct}:
41361
41362@itemize @bullet
41363@item
41364Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41365@item
41366They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41367@end itemize
41368
41369Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41370defining them with @samp{flags}:
41371
41372@itemize @bullet
41373@item
41374One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41375
41376@smallexample
41377(gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41378$1 = 42
41379@end smallexample
41380
41381@end itemize
41382
41383@subsection Registers
41384@cindex <reg>
41385
41386Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41387
41388@smallexample
41389<reg name="@var{name}"
41390 bitsize="@var{size}"
41391 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41392 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41393 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41394 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41395@end smallexample
41396
41397@noindent
41398The components are as follows:
41399
41400@table @var
41401
41402@item name
41403The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41404
41405@item bitsize
41406The register's size, in bits.
41407
41408@item regnum
41409The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41410than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41411a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41412defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41413the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41414packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41415in order of increasing register number.
41416
41417@item save-restore
41418Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41419calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41420@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41421some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41422ABI.
41423
41424@item type
41425The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41426defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41427and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41428for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41429architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41430@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41431
41432@item group
41433The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41434be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41435@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41436in @code{info registers}.
41437
41438@end table
41439
41440@node Predefined Target Types
41441@section Predefined Target Types
41442@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41443
41444Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41445from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41446standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41447types. The currently supported types are:
41448
41449@table @code
41450
41451@item bool
41452Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41453
41454@item int8
41455@itemx int16
41456@itemx int32
41457@itemx int64
41458@itemx int128
41459Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41460
41461@item uint8
41462@itemx uint16
41463@itemx uint32
41464@itemx uint64
41465@itemx uint128
41466Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41467
41468@item code_ptr
41469@itemx data_ptr
41470Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41471any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41472pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41473address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41474may be marked as data pointers.
41475
41476@item ieee_single
41477Single precision IEEE floating point.
41478
41479@item ieee_double
41480Double precision IEEE floating point.
41481
41482@item arm_fpa_ext
41483The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41484
41485@item i387_ext
41486The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41487
41488@item i386_eflags
4148932bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41490
41491@item i386_mxcsr
4149232bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41493
41494@end table
41495
41496@node Enum Target Types
41497@section Enum Target Types
41498@cindex target descriptions, enum types
41499
41500Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41501register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41502
41503Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41504
41505@smallexample
41506<enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41507 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41508 @dots{}
41509</enum>
41510@end smallexample
41511
41512Enums must be defined before they are used.
41513
41514@smallexample
41515<enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41516 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41517 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41518</enum>
41519<flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41520 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41521 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41522</flags>
41523<reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41524@end smallexample
41525
41526Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41527would be printed as:
41528
41529@smallexample
41530(gdb) info register flags
41531flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41532@end smallexample
41533
41534@node Standard Target Features
41535@section Standard Target Features
41536@cindex target descriptions, standard features
41537
41538A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41539target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41540@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41541the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41542default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41543described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41544can recognize them.
41545
41546This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41547which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41548with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41549if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41550feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41551description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41552standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41553they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41554
41555This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41556Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41557@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41558
41559Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41560company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41561architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41562containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41563
41564The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41565of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41566registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41567
41568@menu
41569* AArch64 Features::
41570* ARC Features::
41571* ARM Features::
41572* i386 Features::
41573* MicroBlaze Features::
41574* MIPS Features::
41575* M68K Features::
41576* NDS32 Features::
41577* Nios II Features::
41578* PowerPC Features::
41579* S/390 and System z Features::
41580* Sparc Features::
41581* TIC6x Features::
41582@end menu
41583
41584
41585@node AArch64 Features
41586@subsection AArch64 Features
41587@cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41588
41589The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41590targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41591@samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41592
41593The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41594it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41595and @samp{fpcr}.
41596
41597@node ARC Features
41598@subsection ARC Features
41599@cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41600
41601ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41602are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41603important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41604that one of the core registers features is present.
41605@samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41606
41607The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41608targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41609through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41610@samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41611and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41612@samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41613debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41614
41615The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41616ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41617@samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41618@samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41619This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41620registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41621
41622The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41623targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41624through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41625@samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41626@samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41627through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41628registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41629difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41630@samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41631ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41632
41633The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41634targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41635
41636@node ARM Features
41637@subsection ARM Features
41638@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41639
41640The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41641ARM targets.
41642It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41643@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41644
41645For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41646feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41647registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41648and @samp{xpsr}.
41649
41650The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41651should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41652
41653The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41654it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41655@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41656@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41657
41658The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41659should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41660they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41661@value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41662halves of the double-precision registers.
41663
41664The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41665need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41666VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41667quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41668If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41669be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41670
41671@node i386 Features
41672@subsection i386 Features
41673@cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41674
41675The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41676targets. It should describe the following registers:
41677
41678@itemize @minus
41679@item
41680@samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41681@item
41682@samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41683@item
41684@samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41685@samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41686@item
41687@samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41688@item
41689@samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41690@samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41691@end itemize
41692
41693The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41694
41695The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41696describe registers:
41697
41698@itemize @minus
41699@item
41700@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41701@item
41702@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41703@item
41704@samp{mxcsr}
41705@end itemize
41706
41707The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41708@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41709describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41710
41711@itemize @minus
41712@item
41713@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41714@item
41715@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41716@end itemize
41717
41718The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41719Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41720
41721@itemize @minus
41722@item
41723@samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41724@item
41725@samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41726@end itemize
41727
41728The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41729describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41730
41731The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41732describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41733
41734The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41735@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41736describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41737
41738@itemize @minus
41739@item
41740@samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41741@end itemize
41742
41743It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41744
41745@itemize @minus
41746@item
41747@samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41748@end itemize
41749
41750It should
41751describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41752
41753@itemize @minus
41754@item
41755@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41756@item
41757@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41758@end itemize
41759
41760It should
41761describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41762
41763@itemize @minus
41764@item
41765@samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41766@end itemize
41767
41768The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41769describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41770valid for i386 and amd64.
41771
41772@node MicroBlaze Features
41773@subsection MicroBlaze Features
41774@cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41775
41776The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41777targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41778@samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41779@samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41780@samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41781
41782The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41783If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41784
41785@node MIPS Features
41786@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41787@cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41788
41789The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41790It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41791@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41792on the target.
41793
41794The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41795contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41796registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41797
41798The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41799it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41800contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41801@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41802
41803The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41804contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41805@samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41806be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41807
41808The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41809contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41810Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41811
41812@node M68K Features
41813@subsection M68K Features
41814@cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41815
41816@table @code
41817@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41818@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41819@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41820One of those features must be always present.
41821The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41822used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41823@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41824@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41825
41826@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41827This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41828@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41829@samp{fpiaddr}.
41830@end table
41831
41832@node NDS32 Features
41833@subsection NDS32 Features
41834@cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41835
41836The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41837targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41838@samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41839and @samp{pc}.
41840
41841The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41842it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41843@samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41844@samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41845
41846@emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41847registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41848floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41849not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41850overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41851single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41852support to it could be totally removed some day.
41853
41854@node Nios II Features
41855@subsection Nios II Features
41856@cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41857
41858The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41859targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41860@samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41861@samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41862@samp{mpuacc}).
41863
41864@node PowerPC Features
41865@subsection PowerPC Features
41866@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41867
41868The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41869targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41870@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41871@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41872
41873The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41874contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41875
41876The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41877contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41878and @samp{vrsave}.
41879
41880The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41881contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41882will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41883(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41884through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41885through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41886
41887The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41888contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41889@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41890@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41891@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41892these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41893user.
41894
41895@node S/390 and System z Features
41896@subsection S/390 and System z Features
41897@cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41898@cindex target descriptions, System z features
41899
41900The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41901System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41902registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41903registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41904S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41905A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
4190632-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41907register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41908lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41909
41910The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41911contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41912@samp{fpc}.
41913
41914The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41915contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41916
41917The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41918contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41919targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41920the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41921mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
4192232-bit wide.
41923
41924The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41925contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41926@samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41927
41928The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
4192964-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41930combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41931through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41932@samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41933contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41934@samp{v31}.
41935
41936The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
41937the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
41938@samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
41939
41940The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
41941the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
41942@samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
41943
41944@node Sparc Features
41945@subsection Sparc Features
41946@cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41947@cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41948The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41949targets. It should describe the following registers:
41950
41951@itemize @minus
41952@item
41953@samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41954@item
41955@samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41956@item
41957@samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41958@item
41959@samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41960@end itemize
41961
41962They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41963
41964Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41965targets. It should describe the following registers:
41966
41967@itemize @minus
41968@item
41969@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41970@item
41971@samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41972@end itemize
41973
41974The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41975targets. It should describe the following registers:
41976
41977@itemize @minus
41978@item
41979@samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41980@samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41981@item
41982@samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41983for sparc64
41984@end itemize
41985
41986@node TIC6x Features
41987@subsection TMS320C6x Features
41988@cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41989@cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41990The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41991targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41992registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41993
41994The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41995contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41996through @samp{B31}.
41997
41998The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41999contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42000
42001@node Operating System Information
42002@appendix Operating System Information
42003@cindex operating system information
42004
42005@menu
42006* Process list::
42007@end menu
42008
42009Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42010the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42011processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42012mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42013target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42014on a different aspect of target.
42015
42016Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42017remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42018read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42019the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42020
42021@node Process list
42022@appendixsection Process list
42023@cindex operating system information, process list
42024
42025When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42026@samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42027an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42028@file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42029
42030An example document is:
42031
42032@smallexample
42033<?xml version="1.0"?>
42034<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42035<osdata type="processes">
42036 <item>
42037 <column name="pid">1</column>
42038 <column name="user">root</column>
42039 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42040 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42041 </item>
42042</osdata>
42043@end smallexample
42044
42045Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42046of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42047@samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42048displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42049should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42050is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42051which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42052
42053@node Trace File Format
42054@appendix Trace File Format
42055@cindex trace file format
42056
42057The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42058section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42059
42060The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42061@code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42062while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42063in the future.
42064
42065The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42066separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42067variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42068as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42069ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42070of this section.
42071
42072@table @code
42073@item R @var{size}
42074Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42075size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42076is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42077a single trace file.
42078
42079@item status @var{status}
42080Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42081remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42082file.
42083
42084@item tp @var{payload}
42085Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42086@code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42087may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42088reply packets.
42089
42090@item tsv @var{payload}
42091Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42092@code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42093may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42094reply packets.
42095
42096@item tdesc @var{payload}
42097Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42098the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42099the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42100@code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42101file. Includes are not allowed.
42102
42103@end table
42104
42105The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42106Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42107four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42108the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42109character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42110state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42111hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42112endianness.
42113
42114@c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42115
42116@table @code
42117@item R @var{bytes}
42118Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42119@code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42120actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42121
42122@item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42123Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42124address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42125@var{length} bytes.
42126
42127@item V @var{number} @var{value}
42128Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42129@var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42130
42131@end table
42132
42133Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42134of blocks.
42135
42136@node Index Section Format
42137@appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42138@cindex .gdb_index section format
42139@cindex index section format
42140
42141This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42142gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42143DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42144description.
42145
42146The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42147@code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42148represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42149@code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42150before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42151laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42152
42153A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42154
42155@enumerate
42156@item
42157The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42158unless otherwise noted:
42159
42160@enumerate
42161@item
42162The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42163Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42164Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42165and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42166symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42167(@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42168compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42169
42170@value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42171by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42172GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42173currently not flagged as deprecated.
42174
42175@item
42176The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42177
42178@item
42179The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42180that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42181to the next offset.
42182
42183@item
42184The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42185
42186@item
42187The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42188
42189@item
42190The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42191@end enumerate
42192
42193@item
42194The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42195values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42196the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42197element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42198elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
421990-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42200conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42201CU indices.
42202
42203@item
42204The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42205little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42206the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42207the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42208
42209@item
42210The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42211entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42212
42213@enumerate
42214@item
42215The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42216
42217@item
42218The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42219@code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42220
42221@item
42222The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42223@end enumerate
42224
42225@item
42226The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42227the hash table is always a power of 2.
42228
42229Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42230values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42231constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42232constant pool.
42233
42234If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42235is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42236valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42237
42238The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42239iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42240initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42241the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42242index version:
42243
42244@table @asis
42245@item Version 4
42246The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42247
42248@item Versions 5 to 7
42249The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42250@end table
42251
42252The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42253
42254The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42255@code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42256value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42257is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42258collision.
42259
42260The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42261don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42262algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42263the code.
42264
42265@item
42266The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42267so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42268strings.
42269
42270A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42271values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42272Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42273the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42274CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42275See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42276
42277A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42278@end enumerate
42279
42280Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42281If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42282CU index+attributes value for each use.
42283
42284The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42285(bit 0 = LSB):
42286
42287@table @asis
42288
42289@item Bits 0-23
42290This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42291@item Bits 24-27
42292These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42293@item Bits 28-30
42294The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42295
42296@table @asis
42297@item 0
42298This value is reserved and should not be used.
42299By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42300with previous versions of the index.
42301@item 1
42302The symbol is a type.
42303@item 2
42304The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42305@item 3
42306The symbol is a function.
42307@item 4
42308Any other kind of symbol.
42309@item 5,6,7
42310These values are reserved.
42311@end table
42312
42313@item Bit 31
42314This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42315
42316The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42317The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42318@value{GDBN} sources.
42319
42320@end table
42321
42322This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42323global/static attributes in the index.
42324
42325@smallexample
42326is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42327language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42328switch (die->tag)
42329 @{
42330 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42331 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42332 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42333 kind = TYPE;
42334 is_static = 1;
42335 break;
42336 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42337 kind = VARIABLE;
42338 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42339 break;
42340 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42341 kind = FUNCTION;
42342 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42343 break;
42344 case DW_TAG_constant:
42345 kind = VARIABLE;
42346 is_static = ! is_external;
42347 break;
42348 case DW_TAG_variable:
42349 kind = VARIABLE;
42350 is_static = ! is_external;
42351 break;
42352 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42353 kind = TYPE;
42354 is_static = 0;
42355 break;
42356 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42357 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42358 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42359 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42360 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42361 kind = TYPE;
42362 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42363 break;
42364 default:
42365 assert (0);
42366 @}
42367@end smallexample
42368
42369@node Man Pages
42370@appendix Manual pages
42371@cindex Man pages
42372
42373@menu
42374* gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42375* gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42376* gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42377* gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42378@end menu
42379
42380@node gdb man
42381@heading gdb man
42382
42383@c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42384
42385@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42386gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42387[@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42388[@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42389 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42390[@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42391[@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42392 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42393[@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42394@c man end
42395
42396@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42397The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42398going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42399program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42400
42401@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42402these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42403
42404@itemize @bullet
42405@item
42406Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42407
42408@item
42409Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42410
42411@item
42412Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42413
42414@item
42415Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42416effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42417@end itemize
42418
42419You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42420Modula-2.
42421
42422@value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42423commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42424command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42425by using the command @code{help}.
42426
42427You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42428usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42429executable program as the argument:
42430
42431@smallexample
42432gdb program
42433@end smallexample
42434
42435You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42436
42437@smallexample
42438gdb program core
42439@end smallexample
42440
42441You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42442to debug a running process:
42443
42444@smallexample
42445gdb program 1234
42446gdb -p 1234
42447@end smallexample
42448
42449@noindent
42450would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42451named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42452With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42453
42454Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42455
42456@c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42457@table @env
42458@item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42459Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42460
42461@item run [@var{arglist}]
42462Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42463
42464@item bt
42465Backtrace: display the program stack.
42466
42467@item print @var{expr}
42468Display the value of an expression.
42469
42470@item c
42471Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42472
42473@item next
42474Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42475function calls in the line.
42476
42477@item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42478look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42479
42480@item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42481type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42482
42483@item step
42484Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42485function calls in the line.
42486
42487@item help [@var{name}]
42488Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42489about using @value{GDBN}.
42490
42491@item quit
42492Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42493@end table
42494
42495@ifset man
42496For full details on @value{GDBN},
42497see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42498by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42499as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42500@end ifset
42501@c man end
42502
42503@c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42504Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42505file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42506encountered with no
42507associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42508if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42509Many options have
42510both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42511recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42512present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42513arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42514more usual convention.)
42515
42516All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42517in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42518option is used.
42519
42520@table @env
42521@item -help
42522@itemx -h
42523List all options, with brief explanations.
42524
42525@item -symbols=@var{file}
42526@itemx -s @var{file}
42527Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42528
42529@item -write
42530Enable writing into executable and core files.
42531
42532@item -exec=@var{file}
42533@itemx -e @var{file}
42534Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42535appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42536dump.
42537
42538@item -se=@var{file}
42539Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42540file.
42541
42542@item -core=@var{file}
42543@itemx -c @var{file}
42544Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42545
42546@item -command=@var{file}
42547@itemx -x @var{file}
42548Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42549
42550@item -ex @var{command}
42551Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42552
42553@item -directory=@var{directory}
42554@itemx -d @var{directory}
42555Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42556
42557@item -nh
42558Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42559
42560@item -nx
42561@itemx -n
42562Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42563
42564@item -quiet
42565@itemx -q
42566``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42567messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42568
42569@item -batch
42570Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42571files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42572Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42573commands in the command files.
42574
42575Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42576download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42577more useful, the message
42578
42579@smallexample
42580Program exited normally.
42581@end smallexample
42582
42583@noindent
42584(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42585terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42586
42587@item -cd=@var{directory}
42588Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42589instead of the current directory.
42590
42591@item -fullname
42592@itemx -f
42593Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42594@value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42595recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42596includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42597like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42598and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42599Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42600characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42601
42602@item -b @var{bps}
42603Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42604interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42605
42606@item -tty=@var{device}
42607Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42608@end table
42609@c man end
42610
42611@c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42612@ifset man
42613The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42614If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42615documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42616
42617@smallexample
42618info gdb
42619@end smallexample
42620
42621@noindent
42622should give you access to the complete manual.
42623
42624@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42625Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42626@end ifset
42627@c man end
42628
42629@node gdbserver man
42630@heading gdbserver man
42631
42632@c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42633@format
42634@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42635gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42636
42637gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42638
42639gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42640@c man end
42641@end format
42642
42643@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42644@command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42645than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42646
42647@ifclear man
42648@subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42649@end ifclear
42650@ifset man
42651Usage (server (target) side):
42652@end ifset
42653
42654First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42655the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42656@command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42657the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42658
42659To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42660program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42661your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42662
42663@smallexample
42664target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42665@end smallexample
42666
42667For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42668
42669@smallexample
42670@ifset man
42671@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42672target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42673@end ifset
42674@ifclear man
42675target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42676@end ifclear
42677@end smallexample
42678
42679This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42680to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42681waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42682
42683To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42684
42685@smallexample
42686target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42687@end smallexample
42688
42689This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42690going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42691that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
426922345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42693want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42694ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42695@value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42696you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42697print an error message and exit.
42698
42699@command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42700This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42701
42702@smallexample
42703target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42704@end smallexample
42705
42706@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42707necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42708
42709To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42710or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42711In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42712the program you want to debug.
42713
42714@smallexample
42715target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42716@end smallexample
42717
42718@ifclear man
42719@subheading Usage (host side)
42720@end ifclear
42721@ifset man
42722Usage (host side):
42723@end ifset
42724
42725You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42726@value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42727would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42728@option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42729That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42730new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42731(or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42732a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42733descriptor. For example:
42734
42735@smallexample
42736@ifset man
42737@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42738(gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42739@end ifset
42740@ifclear man
42741(gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42742@end ifclear
42743@end smallexample
42744
42745@noindent
42746communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42747
42748@smallexample
42749(gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42750@end smallexample
42751
42752@noindent
42753communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42754you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42755TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42756command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42757`Connection refused'.
42758
42759@command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42760described in
42761@ifset man
42762the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42763-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42764@end ifset
42765@ifclear man
42766@ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42767@end ifclear
42768In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42769
42770@smallexample
42771(gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42772@end smallexample
42773
42774The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42775case.
42776@c man end
42777
42778@c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42779There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42780
42781@itemize @bullet
42782
42783@item
42784Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42785
42786@smallexample
42787gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42788@end smallexample
42789
42790The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42791with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42792a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42793stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42794debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42795program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42796connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42797
42798@item
42799Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42800program:
42801
42802@smallexample
42803gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42804@end smallexample
42805
42806The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42807of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42808else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42809@value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42810
42811@item
42812Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42813
42814@smallexample
42815gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42816@end smallexample
42817
42818In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42819command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42820close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42821debug several processes in the same session.
42822@end itemize
42823
42824In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42825
42826@table @env
42827
42828@item --help
42829List all options, with brief explanations.
42830
42831@item --version
42832This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42833
42834@item --attach
42835@command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42836
42837@smallexample
42838target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42839@end smallexample
42840
42841@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42842necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42843
42844@item --multi
42845To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42846or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42847Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42848the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42849
42850@smallexample
42851target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42852@end smallexample
42853
42854@item --debug
42855Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42856process.
42857This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42858the developers.
42859
42860@item --remote-debug
42861Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42862This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42863the developers.
42864
42865@item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42866Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42867of debugging output.
42868@xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42869
42870@item --wrapper
42871Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42872for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42873wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42874@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42875
42876@item --once
42877By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42878additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42879with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42880connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42881
42882@c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42883
42884@c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42885@c QDisableRandomization.
42886
42887@end table
42888@c man end
42889
42890@c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42891@ifset man
42892The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42893If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42894documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42895
42896@smallexample
42897info gdb
42898@end smallexample
42899
42900should give you access to the complete manual.
42901
42902@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42903Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42904@end ifset
42905@c man end
42906
42907@node gcore man
42908@heading gcore
42909
42910@c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42911
42912@format
42913@c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42914gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42915@c man end
42916@end format
42917
42918@c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42919Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42920Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42921crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42922limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42923running without any change.
42924@c man end
42925
42926@c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42927@table @env
42928@item -o @var{filename}
42929The optional argument
42930@var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42931If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42932where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42933@end table
42934@c man end
42935
42936@c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42937@ifset man
42938The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42939If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42940documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42941
42942@smallexample
42943info gdb
42944@end smallexample
42945
42946@noindent
42947should give you access to the complete manual.
42948
42949@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42950Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42951@end ifset
42952@c man end
42953
42954@node gdbinit man
42955@heading gdbinit
42956
42957@c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42958
42959@format
42960@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42961@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42962@value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42963@end ifset
42964
42965~/.gdbinit
42966
42967./.gdbinit
42968@c man end
42969@end format
42970
42971@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42972These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42973@value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42974described in
42975@ifset man
42976the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42977-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42978@end ifset
42979@ifclear man
42980@ref{Sequences}.
42981@end ifclear
42982
42983Please read more in
42984@ifset man
42985the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42986-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42987@end ifset
42988@ifclear man
42989@ref{Startup}.
42990@end ifclear
42991
42992@table @env
42993@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42994@item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42995@end ifset
42996@ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42997@item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42998@end ifclear
42999System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43000@value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43001See more in
43002@ifset man
43003the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43004-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43005@end ifset
43006@ifclear man
43007@ref{System-wide configuration}.
43008@end ifclear
43009
43010@item ~/.gdbinit
43011User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43012@value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43013
43014@item ./.gdbinit
43015Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43016@value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43017See more in
43018@ifset man
43019the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43020-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43021@end ifset
43022@ifclear man
43023@ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43024@end ifclear
43025@end table
43026@c man end
43027
43028@c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43029@ifset man
43030gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43031
43032The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43033If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43034documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43035
43036@smallexample
43037info gdb
43038@end smallexample
43039
43040should give you access to the complete manual.
43041
43042@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43043Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43044@end ifset
43045@c man end
43046
43047@include gpl.texi
43048
43049@node GNU Free Documentation License
43050@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43051@include fdl.texi
43052
43053@node Concept Index
43054@unnumbered Concept Index
43055
43056@printindex cp
43057
43058@node Command and Variable Index
43059@unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43060
43061@printindex fn
43062
43063@tex
43064% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43065% meantime:
43066\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43067\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43068\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43069\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43070\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43071\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43072\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43073\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43074\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43075\page\colophon
43076% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43077@end tex
43078
43079@bye
This page took 0.254046 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.